Panasonic DMCLX100 de handleiding

Type
de handleiding

Deze handleiding is ook geschikt voor

SQW0024
M0914KZ0
Message Display →299
Operating Instructions
for advanced features
Digital Camera
Model No. DMC-LX100
Please read these instructions carefully before using this product,
and save this manual for future use.
Q&A Troubleshooting →310
Finding the information you need →2
Contents →4
Contents by Function →10
Menu list →303
2
SQW0024
Finding the information you need
In this “Operating Instructions for advanced features”, you can find the information you
need from the following pages.
By clicking a page number, you can jump to the linked page and quickly find the
information.
Search from “Contents”
P.4 -
Search from the list of function
names
“Contents by Function”
P.10 -
Search from “Names and
Functions of Main Parts”
P.14 -
Search from “List of monitor/
viewfinder displays”
P.293 -
Search from the list of
on-screen messages
“Message displays”
P.299 -
Search from the menu list
“Menu list”
P.303 -
[Rec] ......................... P.303
[Motion Picture]......... P.305
[Custom] ................... P.306
[Setup] ..................... P.308
[Playback] ................. P.309
Search from “Q&A
Troubleshooting”
P.310 -
For details on how to use this manual,
see the next page.
Wi-Fi
®
function →224
3
SQW0024
How to use this manual
Click this icon to jump to “Finding the information you need”.
Click this icon to jump to “Contents”.
Click this icon to jump to “Menu list”.
Click this icon to return to the previously displayed page.
Recording mode icons
Recording mode:
In Recording Modes that show icons in black, you can select and execute indicated
menus and functions.
• Click a cross reference in the text to jump to the corresponding page.
• By entering keywords in the search field at the top of the Adobe Reader screen, you
can run a keyword search and jump to the corresponding page.
• Operations and other details of this manual may vary depending on the Adobe Reader
version you are using.
About the symbols in the text
Indicates that the menu can be set by pressing [MENU/SET] button.
Indicates that the Wi-Fi setting can be made by pressing [Wi-Fi] button.
Configurations that can be performed in the [Custom] menu.
Tips for skilful use and points for recording.
Conditions in which a particular function cannot be used.
(→00) Indicates the reference page. Click to go to the corresponding page.
Click to view the description on the next page.
In this Operating Instructions, steps for setting a menu item are described as follows:
[Rec] → [Quality] → [ ]
4
SQW0024
Contents
Finding the information you need ..... 2
How to use this manual ...................... 3
Before use ......................................... 12
Standard Accessories ...................... 13
Before Use
Names and Functions of
Main Parts .......................................... 14
[MENU/SET] button / Cursor button /
Control dial.................................................18
Preparations
Attaching the lens cap and
shoulder strap ................................... 19
Charging battery ............................... 20
Remaining battery......................................21
Guidelines for number of recordable
pictures and operating time .......................22
Inserting and removing the battery/
the card (optional) ............................. 24
About the Card .................................. 25
Formatting the card (initialisation)..............26
Recording capacity guidelines
(pictures/recording time) ............................27
Setting the clock ............................... 29
Changing time settings ..............................30
Setting the menu ............................... 31
Setting the menu screen background ........33
Calling frequently-used menus
instantly (Quick Menu) .................... 34
Change the Quick Menu to your
preferred item ............................................35
Assigning frequently used
functions to the buttons
(Function buttons) ............................ 37
Changing settings using the
control ring ........................................ 39
Changing the settings assigned to the
control ring .................................................40
Using the [Setup] menu .................... 41
[Clock Set] .................................................41
[World Time] ...............................................41
[Travel Date] ..............................................42
[Wi-Fi] ........................................................42
[Beep] ........................................................43
[Live View Mode] .......................................43
[Monitor Display] / [Viewfinder] ..................44
[Monitor Luminance] ..................................45
[Sleep Mode]..............................................46
[USB Mode] ...............................................47
[TV Connection] .........................................47
[Menu Resume] .........................................49
[Menu Background]....................................49
[Menu Information] .....................................49
[Language] .................................................49
[Version Disp.]............................................50
[Self Timer Auto Off] ...................................50
[No.Reset] ..................................................50
[Reset] .......................................................50
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings] ................................51
[Format] .....................................................51
Entering Text ..................................... 52
Contents by Function ....................... 10
5
SQW0024
Holding the camera ........................... 53
Recording pictures using the
viewfinder ......................................... 54
Switching between the monitor and
viewfinder...................................................54
About Eye Sensor AF ................................55
Taking pictures .................................. 56
Recording motion pictures .............. 58
Select the recording mode ............... 59
Contents
Basics
Switching the display information
on the recording screen ................... 62
Viewing your pictures ....................... 67
Viewing motion pictures .............................70
Switching the display information
on the playback screen .................... 71
Deleting pictures ............................... 73
[Delete Single] ...........................................73
To delete multiple (up to 100)/
To delete all pictures ..................................74
Recording mode
Taking pictures with
automatic settings
[Intelligent Auto] Mode ..................... 75
Taking pictures using a handheld camera
([iHandheld Night Shot]) ............................78
Combining pictures into a single still
picture with rich gradation ([iHDR]) ............79
Taking pictures after setting the
aperture value and shutter speed ... 80
Taking pictures after automatically setting
the aperture value and shutter speed
([Program AE] Mode) .................................81
Taking pictures using picture
effects (Filter) ................................... 89
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures by setting the aperture
value ([Aperture-Priority] Mode).................83
Taking pictures by setting the shutter
speed ([Shutter-Priority] Mode)..................84
Taking pictures by setting the aperture
value and shutter speed
([Manual Exposure] Mode) ........................86
Checking the effects of the aperture value
and shutter speed ([Preview] Mode) ..........88
6
SQW0024
Contents
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the picture quality with
effects [Photo Style] ...................... 100
Adjusting highlights and shadows
[Highlight Shadow] ......................... 102
Adjusting the White Balance ......... 103
Setting the picture quality and
size ................................................... 107
Changing the aspect ratio of the still
pictures ....................................................107
Setting the picture size ............................108
Setting the compression rate of pictures
([Quality]) .................................................109
Using the picture correction
functions effectively ........................111
Correcting contrast and exposure
([i.Dynamic])............................................. 111
Enhancing the impression of
high-resolution ([i.Resolution]) ................. 111
Combining still pictures with different
exposures ([HDR]) ................................... 112
Suppressing the noise of a long
exposure ([Long Shtr NR]) ....................... 113
Setting the colour space .......................... 113
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus ... 114
Select the focus mode
(AFS, AFF, AFC) ...................................... 114
Switching [AF Mode] ................................ 115
Changing the position and size of the
AF area ....................................................121
Setting your preferred focusing method
...124
Taking close-up pictures
(Macro recording) ........................... 126
Focus range .............................................126
Taking pictures with
Manual Focus .................................. 128
MF Assist .................................................131
Taking pictures by locking the
focus and/or exposure
[AF/AE Lock] ................................... 133
Taking pictures with Exposure
Compensation ................................. 135
Setting the ISO Sensitivity ............. 136
Setting the upper limit of
ISO Sensitivity .........................................137
Setting the incremental value of
ISO Sensitivity .........................................138
Extending the ISO Sensitivity setting .......138
Setting the metering mode ............. 139
Setting the Shutter Type ................. 140
Selecting a Drive Mode ................... 141
Burst function ................................. 142
Recording while exposure is
changed automatically
[Auto Bracket] ................................. 145
Automatically changing the
aspect ratio while taking pictures
[Aspect Bracket] ............................. 147
Taking pictures with self-timer ...... 148
Recording panorama pictures ....... 150
Shutter and Drive Settings
7
SQW0024
Contents
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Taking pictures automatically
at set intervals
[Time Lapse Shot] ........................... 153
Creating stop motion animation
[Stop Motion Animation] ................ 156
Performing multiple exposures
for a single picture [Multi Exp.] .... 159
Disabling the beeps and flash
at the same time
[Silent Mode] ................................... 161
Recording with the
Face Recognition function
[Face Recog.] .................................. 162
Setting the profile for a baby
or pet to record in a picture ........... 165
Displaying the appropriate screen
for specific recording conditions
... 166
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter .............................. 168
Using Zoom ..................................... 170
Zoom types and use ................................171
Taking pictures using the flash
(supplied) ......................................... 176
Attaching the flash ...................................176
Changing the firing mode
(Manual flash) ..........................................179
Changing Flash Mode..............................180
Setting the 2nd curtain sync ....................182
Adjusting the flash output ........................183
Synchronising the flash output
with the camera during
Exposure Compensation .........................183
Performing wireless flash settings ...........184
Recording motion pictures ............ 187
Setting the format, picture size and
recording frame rate ................................187
Adjusting the focus while recording
motion pictures ([Continuous AF]) ...........189
Recording motion pictures .......................190
Recording 4K motion pictures..................194
Creating a high-resolution still picture
from a 4K motion picture [4K PHOTO] ....195
Taking still pictures while a motion
picture is being recorded ............... 198
Using the [Motion Picture] menu ... 199
[4K PHOTO] .............................................199
[Rec Format] ............................................199
[Rec Quality] ............................................199
[Picture Mode]..........................................199
[Continuous AF] .......................................199
[Mic Level Disp.] ......................................200
[Mic Level Adj.].........................................200
[Wind Cut] ................................................200
Recording motion pictures
8
SQW0024
Contents
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing the group picture .............. 201
Capturing still pictures from
motion pictures ............................... 203
Using the [Playback] menu ............ 204
[Slide Show] .............................................204
[Playback Mode] ......................................206
[Location Logging] ...................................207
[RAW Processing] ....................................208
[Title Edit] ................................................. 211
[Text Stamp] .............................................212
[Video Divide] ...........................................214
[Time Lapse Video] ..................................215
[Stop Motion Video] .................................215
[Resize] ....................................................216
[Cropping] ................................................217
[Rotate] / [Rotate Disp.] ...........................218
[Favorite] ..................................................219
[Print Set] .................................................220
[Protect] ...................................................221
[Face Rec Edit] ........................................222
[Picture Sort] ............................................223
[Delete Confirmation] ...............................223
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi
®
Function and
NFC Function .................................. 224
What you can do with the
Wi-Fi function .................................. 227
Operating the camera by
connecting it to a smartphone ....... 228
Installing the smartphone/tablet app
“Panasonic Image App” ...........................228
Connecting to a smartphone....................229
Connecting to a smartphone using
NFC function ............................................233
Taking pictures via a smartphone
(remote recording) ...................................234
Playing back pictures in the camera on
a smartphone ...........................................235
Saving pictures in the camera to the
smartphone ..............................................235
Easily transferring pictures in
the camera ...............................................236
Sending pictures in the camera to
social networking services .......................237
Adding location information to pictures
in the camera from a smartphone ............237
Operating the camera to send pictures
to a smartphone .......................................239
Displaying still pictures on a TV .... 242
Wireless printing ............................. 243
Sending pictures to AV device ....... 244
Sending pictures to a PC ............... 247
Using WEB services ....................... 251
When sending images to WEB service....251
When sending images to
[Cloud Sync. Service] ..............................255
Using “LUMIX CLUB” ..................... 258
About the [LUMIX CLUB] .........................258
About connections ......................... 263
[Via Network]
Connecting via a wireless access point ...264
[Direct]
Connecting directly ..................................267
Connecting quickly with the same settings
as used previously
([Select a destination from History] /
[Select a destination from Favorite]) ........268
Settings for sending pictures ...................270
[Wi-Fi Setup] .................................... 272
9
SQW0024
Contents
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures ......... 274
Viewing 4K motion pictures .....................274
Storing 4K motion pictures.......................275
Viewing on TV screen ..................... 276
VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™) ....278
Storing recorded still pictures and
motion pictures on your PC ........... 280
About supplied software ..........................281
Installing supplied software......................283
Copying still pictures and
motion pictures ........................................284
Storing recorded still pictures and
motion pictures in the recorder ..... 286
Copying by inserting the card into the
recorder ...................................................286
Dubbing playback pictures via AV cables
(optional) ..................................................286
Printing ............................................ 287
Printing multiple pictures..........................288
Printing with date and text .......................289
Making print settings on the camera ........290
Others
Optional accessories ...................... 291
External Flash (optional) ..........................291
Using the AC adaptor (optional) and
DC coupler (optional) instead
of the battery ............................................292
List of monitor/viewfinder
displays ............................................ 293
Message displays ........................... 299
Menu list .......................................... 303
Q&A Troubleshooting .................... 310
Usage cautions and notes ............. 326
10
SQW0024
Contents by Function
Recording
Recording mode ...........................................59
[Preview] .......................................................88
Picture effects (Filter)....................................89
Macro recording ..........................................126
Recording panorama pictures ....................150
[Time Lapse Shot] .......................................153
[Stop Motion Animation] ..............................156
[Multi Exp.] ..................................................159
[Silent Mode] ...............................................161
Focus (AF/MF)
Focus Mode ................................................ 114
AF Mode ..................................................... 115
Adjusting the AF area position ....................121
Manual Focus .............................................128
AF/AE Lock .................................................133
Exposure
AF/AE Lock .................................................133
Exposure Compensation ............................135
ISO sensitivity .............................................136
[Metering Mode] ..........................................139
[Auto Bracket] .............................................145
Recording
Drive
Drive Mode .................................................141
[Aspect Bracket] .........................................147
[Self Timer] .................................................148
Picture Quality and Colour Tone
[Photo Style] ...............................................100
[Highlight Shadow] ......................................102
White Balance ............................................103
[Picture Size] ..............................................108
[Quality] ......................................................109
[i.Dynamic] .................................................. 111
[i.Resolution] ............................................... 111
[HDR] .......................................................... 112
[Long Shtr NR] ............................................ 113
[Color Space] .............................................. 113
Flash
[Flash Mode] ...............................................180
2nd curtain synchro ....................................182
[Flash Adjust.] .............................................183
Wireless flash settings ................................184
Screen settings
[Monochrome Live View] ............................167
[Mic Level Disp.] .........................................200
Motion Picture
[Rec Format] ...............................................187
[Rec Quality] ...............................................187
Motion pictures in 4K ..................................194
[4K PHOTO]................................................195
Taking still pictures while a
motion picture is being recorded ................198
Motion Picture
Audio
[Mic Level Adj.] ...........................................200
[Wind Cut] ...................................................200
Basic settings
[Format] ........................................................26
[Clock Set] ....................................................29
How to set menu items .................................31
[Q.MENU] .....................................................34
[Beep] ...........................................................43
[Sleep Mode] ................................................46
[Reset] (initialisation) ....................................50
Diopter adjustment .......................................55
Display switching ....................................62, 71
Setup/Custom
Customisation
[CUSTOM] in the Quick Menu ......................35
Function buttons ...........................................37
Control ring ...................................................40
Custom Set ...................................................60
[Custom] menu ...........................................306
[Cursor Button Lock] .....................................38
Motion picture button ..................................192
11
SQW0024
Contents by Function
Playback
[Auto Review] ...............................................57
Picture playback ...........................................67
Playback Zoom .............................................68
Multi Playback ..............................................68
Motion picture playback ................................70
Delete ...........................................................73
Display/playback settings
[Slide Show] ................................................204
[Rotate]/[Rotate Disp.] ................................218
Playback
Edit
[RAW Processing] .......................................208
[Resize] .......................................................216
[Cropping] ...................................................217
Adding information
[Location Logging] ......................................207
[Title Edit] .................................................... 211
[Text Stamp] ................................................212
Image settings
[Favorite] .....................................................219
[Print Set] ....................................................220
[Protect] ......................................................221
Connect
“Image App” ................................................228
NFC ............................................................233
[WPS (Push-Button)] ..........................264, 267
Direct connection ........................................267
Image App
Remote recording .......................................234
Saving images ............................................235
Sending images ..................................236, 239
Sending and adding location information ...237
[Touch Sharing] ...........................................272
Wi-Fi
In combination with other devices
Playing back pictures on a TV ....................242
Printing images ...........................................243
Sending images to an AV device ................244
Sending images to a PC .............................247
Sending images to a WEB service .............251
Using [Cloud Sync. Service] .......................255
PC
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” ..................................281
SILKYPIX ....................................................282
TV
[VIERA Link] ...............................................278
Connecting with other devices
Recorder
Dubbing ......................................................286
Printer
PictBridge ...................................................287
12
SQW0024
Before Use
Before use
Camera handling
Keep the camera away from excessive vibration, force, or
pressure.
Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which may damage
the lens, monitor, viewfinder, or camera body. This may also cause the
camera to malfunction or prevent recording.
Dropping or hitting the camera against a hard surface
Pushing with excessive force on the lens or monitor
The camera is not dust resistant, splash resistant, or
waterproof.
Avoid using the camera in places with excessive dust or sand,
or where water can come into contact with the camera.
Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which present a risk
that sand, water, or foreign material may enter the camera through the lens
or openings around buttons. Be especially careful because these conditions
may damage the camera, and such damage may not be repairable.
In extremely dusty or sandy places
In the rain or by the shore, where the camera may be exposed to water
Condensation (When the lens, the monitor, or viewfinder, is fogged up)
Condensation may occur when the camera is exposed to sudden changes
of temperature or humidity. Avoid these conditions, which may make the
lens, monitor, or viewfinder, dirty, cause mould, or damage the camera.
If condensation does occur, turn off the camera and wait about two hours
before using it. Once the camera adjusts to the surrounding temperature,
the fogging will clear naturally.
Always take a test shot first
Before important events when you will use the camera (at weddings, for example),
always take a test shot to make sure that pictures and sound record correctly.
No compensation for missed shots
We cannot compensate for missed shots if technical problems with the camera or card
prevent recording.
Carefully observe copyright laws
Unauthorised use of recordings that contain works with copyright for purposes other
than personal use is prohibited under copyright law. Recording of certain material may
be restricted even for the purpose of personal use.
Also refer to “Usage cautions and notes” (→326)
13
SQW0024
Before Use
Standard Accessories
Check that all the accessories are supplied before using the camera.
The accessories and their shape will differ depending on the country or area where the
camera was purchased.
For details on the accessories, refer to Basic Operating Instructions.
Battery Pack is indicated as battery pack or battery in the text.
SD Memory Card, SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory Card are indicated as card
in the text.
Please dispose of all packaging appropriately.
Keep small parts in a safe place out of the reach of children.
Optional accessories
Cards are optional.
14
SQW0024
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
1 Self-timer indicator (→148) /
AF Assist Lamp (→53, 125)
2 Control ring (→39)
3 Aspect ratio selector switch
(→107)
4 Hot shoe (Hot shoe cover) (→176)
The hot shoe cover is already
attached to the hot shoe at the time
of purchase.
5 Aperture ring (→59)
6 Focus selector switch
(→114, 126, 128)
7 Lens front ring
To attach the auto lens cap
(optional), remove the lens front
ring.
8 Lens barrel
9 Lens (Filter diameter Φ43 mm)
1 2 5 643
9 8 7
15
SQW0024
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
10
Stereo microphone (→53, 200)
Be careful not to cover the
microphone with your finger. Doing
so may make sound difficult
to record.
11
Shutter speed dial (→59)
12
Shutter button
13
Zoom lever (→170)
14
[FILTER] button (→89)
15
Exposure compensation dial
(→135)
16
[iA] button (→59)
17
Camera [ON/OFF] switch
18
Speaker
Be careful not to cover the speaker
with your finger. Doing so may
make sound difficult to hear.
19
Tripod mount (→329)
Do not attach to a tripod with a
5.5 mm (0.22 inch) or longer screw.
Doing so may damage this unit.
It may not be possible to attach
certain types of tripods properly.
20
DC coupler cover
Open this cover to use an AC
adaptor (optional) and DC coupler
(optional) in place of the battery.
When using an AC adaptor
(optional), ensure that the
Panasonic DC coupler (optional)
and AC adaptor are used. (→292)
21
Release lever (→24)
22
Card/Battery door (→24)
(Top)
10 11 12 14
(Bottom)
18 20 21
13
1617 15
19 22
16
SQW0024
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
23
Viewfinder (LVF) (→54)
In this manual, “viewfinder” is used to indicate the LVF.
24
Eye Sensor (→54)
25
Diopter adjustment dial (→55)
26
[LVF] button (→54) / [Fn3] button (→37)
27
Strap eyelet (→19)
28
Monitor
29
[HDMI] socket (→276)
30
[AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket (→276, 284, 286, 287)
272523 2624
28
29
30
17
SQW0024
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
36
The illustrations and screens in this manual may differ from the actual product.
27
Strap eyelet (→19)
31
Wi-Fi
®
antenna
32
Wi-Fi connection lamp (→225)
33
[Wi-Fi] button (→225) / [Fn2] button (→37)
34
Motion picture button (→58)
35
[AF/AE LOCK] button (→133)
36
NFC antenna (→233)
37
[Q.MENU] button (→34)
38
Playback button (→67)
39
[Fn1] button (→37) / [
] (Delete/Cancel) button (→32, 73)
40
[DISP.] button (→62, 71)
41
[MENU/SET] button / Cursor button / Control dial (→18)
27 35343331 32
38
41
40
37
39
18
SQW0024
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
[MENU/SET] button / Cursor button / Control dial
[MENU/SET] button
Use this button to display the menus, enter the settings, etc. (→31)
Cursor button
This button is used to move the cursor on the menu screens and for
other functions. (→32)
You can perform the following operations while recording.
[ISO] button ( ) (→136)
[WB] (White Balance) button ( ) (→103)
[ ] (Drive Mode) button ( )
Single (→141), Burst (→142), Auto Bracket (→145),
Aspect Bracket (→147), Self-timer (→148), Panorama (→150)
[ ] (AF Mode) button ( ) (→115, 131)
Control dial
Turn the dial to select setting items and change setting values.
(→32, 67)
Disabling the button and dial operation (while recording)
When the [Cursor Button Lock] is assigned to the function button, operation of the
[MENU/SET] button, cursor button, and control dial is disabled. (→38)
Enabling/disabling the operation guide display
[Custom] → [Dial Guide] → [ON] / [OFF]
• When you set the operation guide to [ON], the operation
guide for the control ring ([
]), control dial ([ ]), and other
parts appear on the recording screen.
In this manual, the button that is to be used is indicated by .
19
SQW0024
Preparations
Attaching the lens cap and shoulder strap
Cover the lens with the lens cap to protect it when you are not taking pictures. We
recommend attaching the lens cap to the camera using the lens cap string to prevent loss
of the lens cap. We also recommend attaching the shoulder strap to prevent the camera
from being dropped.
1
Use the lens cap string (supplied) to attach the lens cap to the
camera
Make sure that the thicker portion of the string is not hanging over the lens cap or the
shoulder strap eyelet.
2
Attach the lens cap
To attach and remove the lens
cap, press the areas shown by
arrows in the illustration.
3
Attach the shoulder strap
Shoulder strap eyelet
• Attach the other end of the shoulder strap.
• Make sure that the shoulder strap does not come loose.
• Attach the shoulder strap with the LUMIX logo on the strap facing out.
• Use the shoulder strap around your shoulder.
Do not wrap the strap around your neck. It may result in injury or accident.
• Do not leave the shoulder strap where an infant can reach it.
It may result in an accident by mistakenly wrapping around the neck.
20
SQW0024
Preparations
Charging battery
Always charge before first use! (battery shipped uncharged)
About batteries that you can use with this unit
It has been found that counterfeit battery packs which look very similar to the
genuine products are made available to purchase in some markets. Some of
these battery packs are not adequately protected with internal protection to
meet the requirements of appropriate safety standards. There is a possibility
that these battery packs may lead to fire or explosion. Please be advised that
we are not liable for any accident or failure occurring as a result of use of a
counterfeit battery pack. To ensure that safe products are used we recommend
that a genuine Panasonic battery pack is used.
Use the dedicated charger and battery.
1
Attach the battery paying attention to the
direction of the battery
2
Connect the charger to the electrical outlet
The AC mains
lead does not
fit entirely into
the AC input
terminal. A
gap will remain.
Plug-in type
Battery
Charger
(model-specific)
Inlet type
Charging light
([CHARGE])
On: Charging in progress
Off: Charging complete
If light is flashing:
• Battery temperature is
too high or too low. We
recommend charging in a
location where the ambient
temperature is between 10 °C
and 30 °C (50 °F to 86 °F).
• Battery/charger connector is
dirty. Clean with a dry cloth.
• Charge the battery with the charger indoors.
3
Detach the battery after charging is completed
• The battery charger is in the standby condition when the AC power is supplied.
The primary circuit is always “live” as long as the battery charger is connected to
an electrical outlet.
21
SQW0024
Preparations
Charging battery
Notes on charging time
Charging time Approx. 190 min
• The charging time indicated above is the time required for charging in case when the
battery is completely used up. The time required for charging differs depending on
conditions of battery usage. Charging takes longer in cases when temperatures are
either high or low and when the battery has not been used for a long period of time.
Remaining battery
When using the camera, the remaining battery capacity is displayed.
Remaining battery (only when using battery)
(flashes red)
If the battery mark flashes red, recharge or replace a fully charged
battery.
Always use genuine Panasonic batteries.
If you use other batteries, we cannot guarantee the quality of this product.
Remove battery from camera after use.
Keep the battery in a plastic bag, making sure that it is kept away from metallic objects (such as
clips) when carrying or storing it.
To remove the battery, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the monitor goes
off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card or recorded
data.)
22
SQW0024
Preparations
Charging battery
Guidelines for number of recordable pictures and operating
time
Recording still pictures (When using monitor)
Number of recordable pictures
Approx. 350 pictures
(Approx. 300 pictures)
By CIPA standard
Recording time
Approx. 175 min
(Approx. 150 min)
Recording still pictures (When using viewfinder (LVF))
Number of recordable pictures
Approx. 320 pictures
(Approx. 270 pictures)
By CIPA standard
Recording time
Approx. 160 min
(Approx. 135 min)
The values when the flash (supplied) is used are provided in parentheses.
Recording conditions by CIPA standard
CIPA is an abbreviation of “Camera & Imaging Products Association”.
[Program AE] Mode
Temperature: 23 °C (73.4 °F)/Humidity: 50%RH when monitor is on.
Using a Panasonic SDHC Memory Card.
Using the supplied battery.
Starting recording 30 seconds after the camera is turned on (when [Stabilizer] is set to [
]).
Recording once every 30 seconds with full flash every second recording.
Rotating the zoom lever from Tele to Wide or vice versa in every recording.
Turning the camera off every 10 recordings and leaving it until the temperature of the battery
decreases.
Number reduced if intervals are longer (e.g. to approx. one quarter for 2-minute
intervals under the above conditions).
23
SQW0024
Preparations
Charging battery
Recording motion pictures (When using monitor)
[Rec Format] [AVCHD] [MP4] [MP4]
[Rec Quality] [FHD/17M/50i] [FHD/20M/25p] [4K/100M/25p]
Available recording time Approx. 125 min Approx. 135 min Approx. 90 min
Actual available recording time
*
Approx. 60 min Approx. 65 min Approx. 45 min
*
The time you can actually record when repeatedly turning the camera on and off, starting and
stopping recording and using zoom.
Recording conditions
Temperature 23 °C (73.4 °F), humidity 50%RH
[AVCHD] motion pictures:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
Motion pictures with their file size set to [FHD], [HD] or [VGA] in [MP4]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the file
size exceeds 4 GB.
Since the file size becomes larger with [FHD], recording with [FHD] will stop before 29 minutes 59
seconds.
Motion pictures with their file size set to [4K] in [MP4]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes. (You can continue
recording without interruption even if the file exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be
recorded and played back in separate files.)
Viewing pictures (When using monitor)
Playback time Approx. 260 min
The operating times and number of recordable pictures will differ according to the
environment and the operating conditions.
For example, in the following cases, the operating times shorten and the number of recordable
pictures is reduced.
In low-temperature environments, such as on ski slopes.
When operations such as the flash and zoom are used repeatedly.
If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan. Please
purchase a new battery.
24
SQW0024
Preparations
Inserting and removing the battery/the card (optional)
• Make sure that the camera is turned off.
1
Slide the release lever to the
[OPEN] position and open the
card/battery door
[OPEN]
[LOCK]
Release lever
2
Insert the battery and card,
making sure that their
orientation is correct
Battery:
Insert the battery all the way firmly until
a locking sound is heard, and check that
the lever is hooked over the battery.
Card:
Insert the card all the way firmly until it
clicks.
Do not touch
the terminal
Charged battery (check orientation)
Card
(check orientation:
terminals face monitor)
Lever
3
Close the card/battery door and
slide the release lever to the
[LOCK] position
To remove
To remove battery:
Move lever in direction of arrow.
To remove card:
Press the centre of the card.
Lever
Remove battery from camera after use.
Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
To remove the card or battery, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the
monitor turns off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card
or recorded data.)
25
SQW0024
Preparations
About the Card
The following SD standard-based cards (Panasonic brand recommended) can be used.
Type of Card Capacity Notes
SD Memory Cards 8 MB – 2 GB Can be used with devices compatible with the
respective formats.
Before using SDXC Memory Cards, check that your
computer and other devices support this type of card.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html
This unit is compatible with UHS-
Ι UHS Speed Class
3 standard SDHC/SDXC memory cards.
Only the cards listed on the left with the given capacities
are supported.
SDHC Memory Cards 4 GB – 32 GB
SDXC Memory Cards 48 GB, 64 GB
About the motion picture recording and speed class
According to the [Rec Format] (→187) and [Rec Quality] (→187) of a motion picture,
the required card differs. Use a card that meets the following ratings of the SD Speed
Class or UHS Speed Class.
• SD Speed Class and UHS Speed Class are the speed standards regarding
continuous writing. Confirm the SD speed by checking the card label or other card
related materials.
[Rec Format] [Rec Quality] Speed class Label example
[AVCHD] All
Class 4 or higher
[MP4] FHD/HD/VGA
[MP4] 4K UHS Speed Class 3
• Latest information:
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This site is available in English only.)
Access to the card
The access indication displays red when pictures are being
recorded on the card.
50
i
While the camera is accessing the card (for an operation such as picture writing, reading, deletion,
or formatting), do not turn off the camera or remove the battery, card, AC adaptor (optional) or DC
coupler (optional). Do not subject the camera to vibrations, impact, or static electricity. The card or
the data on the card may be damaged, and this unit may no longer operate normally. If operation
fails due to vibration, impact or static electricity, perform the operation again.
26
SQW0024
Preparations
About the Card
If you set the write-protect switch to “LOCK”, you may not be able to write, delete
or format the data or display it by recording date. These operations become
available again when you unlock the switch.
It is recommended that you copy important pictures to your computer
(as electromagnetic waves, static electricity, or faults may cause data to be
damaged).
Write-protect
switch
Formatting the card (initialisation)
Format the card before recording a picture with this unit. Since data cannot be
recovered after formatting, make sure to back up necessary data in advance.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Format]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
This requires a sufficiently charged battery, or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
Do not turn off the camera or perform other operations during formatting.
Always format cards with this camera. Please reformat the card with this camera if it has already
been formatted with a computer or another device.
If the card cannot be formatted, please try another card before contacting Panasonic.
27
SQW0024
Preparations
About the Card
Recording capacity guidelines (pictures/recording time)
The number of pictures you can take and the recording time vary in proportion to card
capacity (and depending on recording conditions and type of card).
Recording picture capacity (still pictures)
When aspect ratio is set to [4:3] and [Quality] is set to [ ]
[Picture Size] 8 GB 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB
L (12.5M) 1090 2200 4420 8820
M (6.5M)
1880 3810 7630 14970
S (3M)
3220 6500 13030 24700
When aspect ratio is set to [4:3] and [Quality] is set to [ ]
[Picture Size] 8 GB 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB
L (12.5M) 340 700 1400 2800
M (6.5M) 400 810 1620 3230
S (3M) 440 890 1780 3530
When the number of recordable pictures exceeds 9,999, “9999+” is displayed.
Recording time capacity (motion pictures)
• The recordable time is the total time of all the motion pictures which have been
recorded.
([h], [m] and [s] indicate “hour”, “minute” and “second”.)
When [Rec Format] is [AVCHD]
[Rec Quality] 8 GB 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB
[FHD/28M/50p] 37m00s 1h15m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s
[FHD/17M/50i] 1h00m00s 2h00m00s 4h05m00s 8h15m00s
[FHD/24M/25p] 43m00s 1h25m00s 2h55m00s 5h50m00s
[FHD/24M/24p] 43m00s 1h25m00s 2h55m00s 5h50m00s
28
SQW0024
Preparations
About the Card
When [Rec Format] is [MP4]
[Rec Quality] 8 GB 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB
[4K/100M/25p] 9m00s 20m00s 42m00s 1h20m00s
[4K/100M/24p] 9m00s 20m00s 42m00s 1h20m00s
[FHD/28M/50p] 37m00s 1h15m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s
[FHD/20M/25p] 49m00s 1h40m00s 3h20m00s 6h40m00s
[HD/10M/25p] 1h30m00s 3h10m00s 6h25m00s 12h50m00s
[VGA/4M/25p] 3h25m00s 7h00m00s 14h10m00s 28h15m00s
If the surrounding temperature is high, or a motion picture is recorded continuously, [ ] is
displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through to protect the camera.
[AVCHD] motion pictures:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
Motion pictures with their file size set to [FHD], [HD] or [VGA] in [MP4]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the
file size exceeds 4 GB.
Since the file size becomes larger with [FHD], recording with [FHD] will stop before 29 minutes
59 seconds.
Motion pictures with their file size set to [4K] in [MP4]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes. (You can continue
recording without interruption even if the file exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be
recorded and played back in separate files.)
The maximum available continuous recording time is displayed on the screen.
Switching the display between the number of recordable pictures
that you can take and the available recording time
[Custom] →[Remaining Disp.]
[
] (Remaining shots):
Displays the number of pictures that can be recorded.
[ ] (Remaining time):
Displays the remaining recording time.
Number of
recordable
pictures
Available
recording time
29
SQW0024
Preparations
Setting the clock
The clock is not set when the camera is shipped.
1
Turn the camera on
• If the language select screen is not displayed, proceed
to step
4
.
2
Press [MENU/SET] while the message is
displayed
3
Press to select the language, and press [MENU/SET]
• The [Please set the clock] message appears.
4
Press [MENU/SET]
5
Press to select the items (year,
month, day, hour, minute), and press
to set
• To cancel → Press [ ] button.
To set the display order or time display format
• Select [Style] and press [MENU/SET] to display the
setting screen for display order and time display
format.
: Home time
: Destination time
Style
Display order
Time display format
6
Press [MENU/SET]
• A confirmation screen is displayed. Press [MENU/SET].
7
When [Please set the home area] is displayed, press
[MENU/SET]
30
SQW0024
Preparations
Setting the clock
8
Press to set your home area and
press [MENU/SET]
City or area name
Current time
Difference from GMT
(Greenwich Mean Time)
If the clock is not set, the correct date cannot be printed when you order a photo studio to print the
picture, or when you stamp the date on the pictures with [Text Stamp].
Changing time settings
Select [Clock Set] from the [Setup] menu to change the current time settings.
• Clock settings will be saved for approx. 3 months even after the battery is removed,
provided a fully charged battery was installed in the camera for 24 hours beforehand.
1
Select [Clock Set] from the [Setup] menu
For details about how to set the menu (→31)
2
Set the date and time (Perform steps
5
-
6
. (→29))
31
SQW0024
Preparations
Setting the menu
You can use the menu to set camera and recording functions, operate playback functions,
and perform other operations. In particular, the [Setup] menu contains some important
settings relating to the camera’s clock and power. Check the settings of this menu before
proceeding to use the camera.
When [Menu Resume] (→49) in the [Setup] menu is set to [ON], the screen
displayed last after you selected the menu item will reappear. It is set to [ON] at
the time of purchase.
When the [Menu Information] (→49) in the [Setup] menu is set to [ON],
descriptions of the menu items and settings will appear on the menu screen.
Example: To change the [Quality] setting from [
] to [ ] in the [Rec] menu
In this Operating Instructions, steps for setting a menu item are described as
follows:
[Rec] → [Quality] → [ ]
1
Press [MENU/SET] to bring up the menu
[Rec]
(→303 -)
You can perform settings for picture size and the flash.
[Motion Picture]
(→305)
You can select the recording format and picture quality and other
settings.
[Custom]
(→306 -)
Operation of the unit, such as displaying of the screen and button
operations, can be set up according to your preferences. Also, it
is possible to register the modified settings.
[Setup]
(→308)
You can perform settings that make usage more convenient, such
as the changing the clock settings and beep volume. You can
also perform Wi-Fi function-related settings.
[Playback]
(→309)
You can specify picture protection, cropping, print settings, and
other settings for pictures you have taken.
32
SQW0024
Preparations
Setting the menu
2
Press to select the menu item and
press [MENU/SET]
• Items can also be selected by turning the control dial.
• You can also switch to the next page by pressing
[DISP.] button or rotating the zoom lever.
Page
Item
3
Press to select the setting and press
[MENU/SET]
• Items can also be selected by turning the control dial.
Selected setting
Settings
4
Press the [ ] button repeatedly until the recording or
playback screen reappears
• During recording, the menu screen can also be exited by pressing the shutter
button halfway.
33
SQW0024
Preparations
Setting the menu
Switching menu type
Example: Switching to the [Setup] menu from [Rec] menu
1
Press
Menu type
2
Press to select a menu switch icon [ ]
Items can also be selected by turning the control dial.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
Select the menu item and perform the setting.
The menu types and items that are displayed vary according to the mode.
The setting methods vary depending on the menu item.
Setting the menu screen background
You can set the background for the menu screen according to your preferences.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Menu Background]
2
Press to select the background colour and then press [MENU/SET]
Exit the menu after it is set.
34
SQW0024
Preparations
Calling frequently-used menus instantly
(Quick Menu)
You can easily call some of the menu items and set them.
• The menu items and setting items that are displayed differ depending on the recording
mode and settings during recording.
1
Press [Q.MENU] button to display the
Quick menu
2
Turn the control dial to select the menu
item, and press or
• The menu item can also be selected by pressing .
50
i
3
Turn the control dial to select the setting
• The setting can also be selected with .
4
Press [Q.MENU] button to close the Quick
menu
50
i
Switching the method for setting Quick Menu items
[Custom] → [Q.MENU]
[PRESET]: The default items can be set.
[CUSTOM]: The Quick Menu will consist of desired items. (→35)
Using the Quick menu on the monitor recording information
screen (→62) of [
] (monitor style)
(Press the [DISP.] button repeatedly until the screen appears.)
Press the [Q.MENU] button and turn the control dial to select an item,
and press [MENU/SET].
Turn the control dial to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] to
set.
You can also set with
and [MENU/SET].
35
SQW0024
Preparations
Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)
Change the Quick Menu to your preferred item
When [Q.MENU] (→34) in the [Custom] menu is set to [CUSTOM], the Quick Menu can
be changed as desired. Up to 15 items can be set to the Quick Menu.
1
Press to select [ ] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Press to select the menu item in the top row
and press [MENU/SET]
Items that can be
setup as Quick Menus
Items that can be displayed
in the Quick Menu screen
3
Press to select the empty space in the bottom row
and then press [MENU/SET]
If there is no empty space in the bottom row, you can replace an
existing item with a new select item by selecting the existing item.
To cancel the setting, move to the bottom row by pressing
and
select an item to cancel, and then press [MENU/SET].
Items that can be set are as follows:
[Rec] menu/Recording functions
[Photo Style] (→100)
[Picture Size] (→108)
[Quality] (→109)
[AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114)
[Metering Mode] (→139)
[i.Dynamic] (→111)
[i.Resolution] (→111)
[HDR] (→112)
[Shutter Type] (→140)
[Flash Mode] (→180)
[Flash Adjust.] (→183)
[i.Zoom] (→172)
[Digital Zoom] (→173)
[Stabilizer] (→168)
[Sensitivity] (→136)
[White Balance] (→103)
[AF Mode] (→115)
[Drive Mode] (→141)
[Motion Picture] menu
[4K PHOTO] (→195)
[Motion Pic. Set] (→187)
[Picture Mode] (→198)
36
SQW0024
Preparations
Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)
[Custom] menu
[Silent Mode] (→161)
[Peaking] (→130)
[Histogram] (→64)
[Guide Line] (→65)
[Zebra Pattern] (→166)
[Monochrome Live View] (→167)
[Rec Area] (→192)
[Zoom lever] (→175)
4
Press [ ] button
It will return to screen of step
1
(→35). Press [MENU/SET] to switch to the recording screen.
37
SQW0024
Preparations
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons
(Function buttons)
You can assign frequently-used functions to particular buttons.
1
Set the menu
[Custom] → [Fn Button Set]
2
Press to select the function button you want to
assign a function to and press [MENU/SET]
3
Press to select the function you want to assign
and press [MENU/SET]
For details on the functions that can be assigned, refer to (→38).
To restore the default function button settings, select [Restore to
Default].
38
SQW0024
Preparations
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons)
Assigning a function to a function button
Press the function button to use the assigned function.
• You can assign the following functions to the [Fn1], [Fn2], and [Fn3] buttons.
[Rec] menu/Recording functions
[Wi-Fi] (→225): [Fn2]
*
[LVF/Monitor Switch] (→55):
[Fn3]
*
[AF/AE Lock] (→133)
[AF-ON] (→129, 133)
[Preview] (→88): [Fn1]
*
[Level Gauge] (→66)
[Focus Area Set]
[Cursor Button Lock]
[Photo Style] (→100)
[Picture Size] (→108)
[Quality] (→109)
[AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114)
[Metering Mode] (→139)
[Highlight Shadow] (→102)
[i.Dynamic] (→111)
[i.Resolution] (→111)
[HDR] (→112)
[Shutter Type] (→140)
[Flash Mode] (→180)
[Flash Adjust.] (→183)
[i.Zoom] (→172)
[Digital Zoom] (→173)
[Stabilizer] (→168)
[Sensitivity] (→136)
[White Balance] (→103)
[AF Mode/MF] (→115)
[Drive Mode] (→141)
[Restore to Default]
[Motion Picture] menu
[4K PHOTO] (→195)
[Motion Pic. Set] (→187)
[Picture Mode] (→198)
[Custom] menu
[Utilize Custom Set feature]
(→60)
[Silent Mode] (→161)
[Peaking] (→130)
[Histogram] (→64)
[Guide Line] (→65)
[Zebra Pattern] (→166)
[Monochrome Live View]
(→167)
[Rec Area] (→192)
[Zoom lever] (→175)
*
Function button settings at the time of purchase.
• Certain functions cannot be assigned to some function buttons.
The function assigned to the function button may not work in some modes or on some display
screens.
When [Focus Area Set] is assigned to the function button, you can display the AF area or the MF
Assist position setting screen.
When the cursor button is locked, operation of the cursor button, [MENU/SET] button, and control
dial is disabled. To enable operation, press the function button again.
Not available in the following cases:
The function assigned to the [Fn1] button will not work in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect], [One Point Color], [Sunshine])
When [Multi Exp.] is set
The function assigned to the [Fn2] button will not work in the following case:
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When recording 4K motion pictures after setting [4K PHOTO] to [ON]
39
SQW0024
Preparations
Changing settings using the control ring
The “Control Ring” is an easy and convenient way to adjust several settings, depending
on the camera mode selected. You can use the control ring to change the settings of the
unit.
Items that can be set by the control ring vary depending on recording modes.
Following are the pre-assigned settings.
Recording mode Setting
[Intelligent Auto] Mode Step Zoom (→174)
[Program AE] Mode Step Zoom (→174)
[Aperture-Priority] Mode Step Zoom (→174)
[Shutter-Priority] Mode
Shutter speed adjustment
*
(→84)
[Manual Exposure] Mode
Shutter speed adjustment
*
(→86)
*
You can use the control ring to change the following settings values, which cannot be set using the
shutter speed dial.
Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds (electronic shutter (→140))
Slower speed than 1 second (mechanical shutter (→140))
Setting in 1/3 EV steps
The control ring is assigned to selecting the picture effect (Filter) when you are recording a
panorama picture. (→150)
When Manual Focus is set, focus adjustment is assigned to the control ring. (→128)
The control ring can be used to change to your preferred settings. (→40)
40
SQW0024
Preparations
Changing settings using the control ring
Changing the settings assigned to the control ring
Changes the settings assigned to the control ring.
1
Set the menu
[Custom] → [Control Ring]
2
Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET]
Settings that can be assigned
[DEFLT] [Normal]
[Zoom] (→170)
[Step Zoom] (→174)
[Sensitivity] (→136)
[White Balance] (→103)
[Filter Select] (→89)
[OFF] [Not Set]
To return to the default setting, select [Normal].
(→39)
If you do not use the control ring, select [OFF]
([Not Set]).
The assigned function setting applies to all the Recording Modes.
The function assigned to the control ring may not work in some combinations of Recording Mode
or settings used for recording (panorama picture recording, Filter setting, etc.)
When Manual Focus is set, the control ring is fixed to the function for adjusting the focus. You
cannot use the settings assigned using the [Control Ring]. (→128)
41
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
[Clock Set] and [Sleep Mode] are important for clock setting and battery life. Please
check these before use.
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Clock Set]
Set time, date, and display format. (→30)
[World Time]
Set the recording date and time with the local time at your destination.
• Set [Home] when you use the camera for the first time after purchasing it. You can set
[Destination] after setting [Home].
Settings: [Destination] / [Home]
1
Use to select [Destination] or [Home] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select area and press [MENU/SET]
City/area name
Difference with
home time
Current time at selected destination
When [Destination] has been selected When [Home] has been selected
To set summer time
Press
in step
2
. (Press again to release the setting)
When summer time [ ] is set, the current time is advanced by 1 hour. If the setting is cancelled,
the time automatically returns to the current time.
When you come back from your travel destination
Select [Home] in step
1
and press [MENU/SET].
If you cannot find your destination in the area displayed on the screen, set based on difference
with home time.
42
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Travel Date]
If you set your travel schedule and record pictures, the day of your trip on which the
picture was taken will be recorded.
[Travel Setup]
Settings: [SET] / [OFF]
1
Use to select [Travel Setup] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET]
3
Use to select the departure date and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select the return date and press [MENU/SET]
To record [Location]
Once the [Travel Setup] is set, you can set the location.
Select [Location] in step
1
above, and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET]
Enter your location (Entering text (→52))
To print [Location] or the number of days that have passed, either use [Text Stamp] or print using
the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the supplied DVD.
The travel date is calculated from the set departure date and the date set in the camera’s clock.
When destination is set in [World Time], days elapsed are calculated based on local destination
time.
When [Travel Setup] is set to [OFF], the number of days elapsed is not recorded. It is not
displayed even if [Travel Setup] is set to [SET] after recording.
When the current date passes the return date, [Travel Setup] is automatically cancelled.
[Travel Date] cannot be recorded for AVCHD motion pictures.
[Location] is not recorded when you record motion pictures.
[Wi-Fi]
Settings: [Wi-Fi Function] / [Wi-Fi Setup]
Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function. (→227, 272)
43
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Beep]
Sets the beep sounds or shutter sounds.
[Beep Volume]
Settings:
(High) / (Low) / (Off)
[Shutter Vol.]
Settings:
(High) / (Low) / (Off)
[Shutter Tone]
Settings:
/ /
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], [Beep Volume] and [Shutter Vol.] are set to “Off”.
[Live View Mode]
Sets the display speed and picture quality of the screen (Live View screen) when
recording pictures.
Settings
[30fps]
Picture quality has higher priority over display speed and pictures are displayed at
30 fps.
For example, use when you want to record a comparatively slow-moving subject while
confirming the focusing. Minimises power consumption and the operating time is
extended.
[60fps]
Display speed has higher priority over picture quality and pictures are displayed at
60 fps. The displayed pictures will appear slightly grainy.
For example, use when you want to record a fast-moving subject.
The [Live View Mode] setting does not affect the recorded picture.
The display speed may slow down in dark locations.
When the viewfinder is used, [Live View Mode] is fixed to [60fps].
When the AC adaptor (optional) is used, [Live View Mode] is fixed to [60fps].
44
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Monitor Display] / [Viewfinder]
Adjust brightness and colour of the monitor or viewfinder. It is suggested to use the
default settings.
These are intended to provide a preview of the actual picture, as accurately as possible.
Settings
[Brightness]
Adjusts the brightness.
[Contrast]
Adjusts the contrast.
[Saturation]
Adjusts the vividness of colours.
[Red Tint]
Adjusts red hues.
[Blue Tint]
Adjusts blue hues.
1
Press to select the setting item and press to make adjustments
You can also make adjustments with the control dial.
2
Press [MENU/SET]
It will adjust the monitor when the monitor is in use, and the viewfinder when the viewfinder is in
use.
Some subjects may look different from their actual appearance, but the recorded picture will not
be affected.
45
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Monitor Luminance]
Sets the monitor brightness according to the ambient light level.
Settings
The brightness is adjusted automatically depending on how bright it is around the camera.
The brightness is increased.
The brightness is standard.
The brightness is decreased.
Because the picture shown on the monitor screen emphasises brightness, some subjects may
look different than their actual appearance, but this will not affect the recorded picture.
[ ] returns to ordinary brightness if there is no operation for 30 seconds when recording. (Press
any button to make the screen brighter again.)
Setting [ ] or [ ] reduces the operating time.
Cannot select [ ] during playback.
When the AC adaptor (optional) is used, the initial setting is [ ].
46
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Sleep Mode]
The camera automatically turns off if no operation is performed for a preset period of time.
• To restore → Press the shutter button halfway, or turn on the power again.
Settings: [10MIN.] / [5MIN.] / [2MIN.] / [1MIN.] / [OFF]
Not available in the following cases:
During motion picture recording/playback
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When connected to computer/printer
During Slide Shows
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
When using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional)
47
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[USB Mode]
Select communication method for when connecting camera to a computer or printer with
USB connection cable (supplied).
Settings
[Select on connection]
Select communication method each time you connect to a computer
or PictBridge-compatible printer.
[PictBridge(PTP)]
Select when connecting to a PictBridge-compatible printer.
[PC]
Select when connecting to a computer.
[TV Connection]
Change the settings to be used when the camera is connected to a TV or other device.
[Video Out]
This setting performs when the AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable is connected.
Settings
[NTSC] Video output is set to NTSC system.
[PAL] Video output is set to PAL system.
[TV Aspect]
This setting performs when an AV cable (optional) is connected.
Settings: [16:9] / [4:3]
48
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[TV Connection] (continued)
[HDMI Mode]
Set the format for the HDMI output when playing back on the HDMI compatible high-
definition TV connected with this unit using the HDMI micro cable.
Settings
[AUTO]
Automatically sets the output resolution based on information from a
connected TV.
[4K]
Outputs pictures with a resolution of 3840×2160 pixels using a progressive
scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (2,160 lines).
[1080p]
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective
scanning lines (1,080 lines).
[1080i]
Outputs pictures using an interlace scan method for the number of effective
scanning lines (1,080 lines).
[720p]
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective
scanning lines (720 lines).
[576p]
*
1
/[480p]
*
2
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective
scanning lines (576
*
1
/480
*
2
lines).
*
1
When [Video Out] is set to [PAL]
*
2
When [Video Out] is set to [NTSC]
This will work when the HDMI micro cable is connected.
If no image appears on the TV with [AUTO], switch the setting to a constant setting other than
[AUTO] to set a format supported by your TV. (Please read the operating instructions for the TV.)
49
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[TV Connection] (continued)
[VIERA Link]
Enable automatic linking with other VIERA Link-compatible devices, and operability with
a VIERA remote control when connecting via an HDMI micro cable. (→278)
Settings
[ON]
Operations may be performed via the remote control of the VIERA Link-compatible
device.
Not all operations will be available.
Operability of the camera’s own buttons will be limited.
[OFF] Operations must be performed via the camera’s own buttons.
This will work when the HDMI micro cable is connected.
[Menu Resume]
Save the last operated menu position.
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
[Menu Background]
Set the background colour for the menu screen. (→33)
[Menu Information]
Explanations of the menu items and settings are displayed on the menu screen.
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
[Language]
Change display language.
Set the language displayed on the screen.
50
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Version Disp.]
Check the firmware version of the camera or supplied flash (when the flash is attached).
When you press [MENU/SET] while the version is displayed, software information for this unit,
such as the licence, is displayed.
[Self Timer Auto Off]
The self-timer is cancelled if the unit is turned off.
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
[No.Reset]
Reset picture file numbers. (The folder number is updated and the file number starts from
0001.)
• To reset folder number to 100:
First, format the card, and reset the file numbers using [No.Reset]. Then, select [Yes]
on the folder number reset screen.
A folder number between 100 and 999 can be assigned.
Numbers cannot be reset once folder number reaches 999. In this case, save all necessary
pictures to your computer, and format the card (→26).
[Reset]
Reset to the default settings.
[Reset Rec. settings?]
[Reset setup/custom settings?]
Information registered in [Face Recog.] is reset if recording settings are reset.
When the setup/custom settings are reset, the following settings are also reset:
The [Profile Setup] setting
The settings of [Rotate Disp.], [Picture Sort], [Delete Confirmation] in the [Playback] menu
Folder numbers and clock settings will not be reset.
51
SQW0024
Preparations
Using the [Setup] menu
For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31)
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings]
Returns [Wi-Fi] settings to default settings.
If you want to dispose or give away your camera, always reset it to prevent your personal
information from being mistakenly used.
When you request your camera to be fixed, backup your personal information and always reset it
as well.
[Format]
Format (initialise) a memory card. (→26)
52
SQW0024
Preparations
Entering Text
Use the cursor button to enter names with the Face Recognition function and in [Profile
Setup] (babies and pets), or to register locations in [Travel Date] etc.
• Only alphabetical characters and symbols can be entered.
• Example of operation for displaying a screen:
[Rec] → [Profile Setup] → [SET] → [Baby1] → [Name] → [SET]
1
Use to select characters
2
Press [MENU/SET] several times until the
desired character is displayed
Text is inserted at the cursor position.
• [ ]: Enter a blank.
To change the character type
• Press [DISP.] button
• Use
to select [ ] and press [MENU/SET]
Cursor position
To continue entering characters
• Use
to select [ ] and press [MENU/SET]
• Move the zoom lever toward T side
• Turn the control dial to the right
Editing text
Use to select [ ] [ ] and press [MENU/SET]. Then, move the cursor
to the text to edit
• You can also use the zoom lever or control dial to reposition the cursor.
Use to select [Delete] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select the correct text, and then press [MENU/SET]
3
When you are finished entering text, use to select
[Set] and press [MENU/SET]
A maximum of 30 characters can be entered (maximum of 9 characters when setting names in
[Face Recog.]).
A maximum of 15 characters can be entered for [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ] and [ ] (maximum of
6 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.]).
53
SQW0024
Basics
Holding the camera
• To avoid camera shake, hold it with both hands keeping
your arms close to your body while standing with your
feet slightly apart.
• Do not touch the lens.
• Do not block the microphone when recording motion
pictures.
• Do not block the AF Assist Lamp, or the flash when
you take a picture using it. Do not look at it from close
range.
• Make sure that the camera does not move at the
moment the shutter button is pressed.
AF Assist Lamp
Shoulder strap
Microphone
We recommend using the supplied shoulder strap to avoid dropping the camera.
About the direction detect function
Still pictures recorded with the camera held vertically can be
automatically displayed in portrait orientation during playback.
(Only when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [ON].)
• The direction detect function may not operate correctly if
pictures are taken with the camera pointing up or down.
• Motion pictures cannot be displayed in portrait orientation.
54
SQW0024
Basics
Recording pictures using the viewfinder
When you use the viewfinder, you can check the view of the subject even if you are in a
bright area.
Switching between the monitor and viewfinder
You can operate the [LVF]/[Fn3] button in two ways, using it
either as the [LVF] button or as a function button [Fn3].
You can use this button as the [LVF] button at the time of
purchase.
• For details on the function button, refer to (→37).
Eye Sensor
[LVF] button
1
Press [LVF] button
The display is switched as shown below.
Automatic switching
between viewfinder and
monitor
Viewfinder display Monitor display
Automatic switching between viewfinder and monitor
For automatic switching between the viewfinder and monitor, the eye sensor
automatically switches the display to viewfinder when your eye or an object moves close
to the viewfinder.
• The eye sensor may not work correctly depending on the shape of your eyeglasses,
the way you hold the camera, or whether the eyepiece and nearby area are exposed to
strong light. In this case, press the [LVF] button to switch the display.
• During motion picture playback or Slide Show, the eye sensor will not automatically
switch the display to the viewfinder.
• The sensitivity of the eye sensor can be set using [Eye Sensor] in the [Custom] menu.
(→55)
55
SQW0024
Basics
Recording pictures using the viewfinder
Setting the sensitivity of the eye sensor or setting to switch the
display between the viewfinder and monitor
[Custom] → [Eye Sensor]
[Sensitivity]
Use this setting to set the sensitivity of the eye sensor.
[HIGH] / [LOW]
[LVF/Monitor Switch]
Use this setting to switch the display between the viewfinder and monitor.
[LVF/MON AUTO] (Automatic switching between viewfinder and
monitor ) / [LVF] (Viewfinder display) / [MON] (Monitor display)
After the display is switched using the [LVF] button, the setting of [LVF/
Monitor Switch] will also change.
About diopter adjustment
Adjust the diopter to suit your vision so that you can see the
viewfinder clearly.
Turn the diopter adjustment dial to adjust until you are able to
clearly see the characters displayed in the viewfinder.
Diopter adjustment dial
About Eye Sensor AF
If the eye sensor is activated when [Eye Sensor AF] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON],
the camera automatically adjusts the focus.
• Eye Sensor AF adjusts focus only once when you look into the viewfinder. It does not
continuously adjust the focus while you are looking into the viewfinder.
Even when [Eye Sensor AF] is set and the camera automatically adjusts the focus, a beep will not
sound.
Not available in the following case:
[Eye Sensor AF] may not work when the lighting is low.
56
SQW0024
Basics
Taking pictures
• Press the [ ] button ( ) to set the drive mode to [ ] ([Single]).
1
Select the recording mode (→59)
2
Adjust focus according to subject
Press halfway (press lightly to focus)
• The aperture value and shutter speed are displayed.
(If the aperture value and shutter speed are shown
in red and flashing, you do not have the appropriate
exposure, unless you are using the flash.)
• When you take a picture in a dark location, [ ] is
displayed for the focus display and it may take longer
to adjust focus than usual.
• When [AFS/AFF/AFC] in the [Rec] menu is set to
[AFF] or [AFC]
A beep sounds only the first time the camera is
focused while you press the shutter button halfway.
When Auto Focus mode is set to Custom Multi, such
as [ ] and [ ], the AF area will be momentarily
displayed only for the first time when the camera is
focused while you press the shutter button halfway.
Focus display
( When focus is aligned:
illuminated
When focus is not aligned:
flashing)
Aperture value
Shutter speed
AF area
( When focus is aligned:
green)
3
Take a picture
Press fully (press the button all the way to record)
The focus display flashes and beep sounds when focus is not aligned.
Use the focus range displayed in red as a reference.
Even if the focus display is lit, the camera may be unable to bring the
subject into focus if it is out of range.
The AF area display may be larger depending on recording conditions
such as dark locations or zoom ratio.
The quality of the picture display may be lower during Auto Focus.
Focus display
Focus range
57
SQW0024
Basics
Taking pictures
Subjects/environments which may make focusing difficult:
• Fast-moving or extremely bright objects, or objects with no colour contrast.
• Taking pictures through glass or near objects emitting light.
• In the dark, or with significant jitter.
• When too close to object or when taking pictures of both distant and close
objects together in the same picture.
Displaying still pictures immediately after taking them
[Custom] → [Auto Review]
[Duration Time]
Set the time to display the pictures you have taken after taking still pictures.
[HOLD]: Displaying pictures until you press the shutter button halfway
[5SEC] / [4SEC] / [3SEC] / [2SEC] / [1SEC] / [OFF]
[Playback
Operation
Priority]
[ON]: During [Auto Review], you can switch the playback screen or delete
pictures.
[OFF]: During [Auto Review], you can perform the same button operations as
when you take a picture.
• When [Duration Time] is set to [HOLD], [Playback Operation Priority] is fixed to [ON].
58
SQW0024
Basics
Recording motion pictures
You can record full high-definition quality images that comply with the AVCHD standard,
as well as motion pictures recorded in MP4. You can also record a 4K motion picture in
MP4. (→194)
Audio is recorded in stereo.
1
Press the motion picture button to start
recording
• Immediately release the motion picture button after
pressing it.
• You can record motion pictures fitting each Recording
Mode (→59).
• While you are recording motion pictures, the recording
status indicator (red) will flash.
• If you do not perform any operation for approximately
1 minute or longer, some of the information on the
screen is turned off. To display the information again,
press the [DISP.] button.
• Do not block the microphones when recording motion
pictures.
• You can also use zoom while recording motion
pictures.
The operating sounds of the zoom lever or control
ring may be recorded in some cases.
• Still pictures can be taken during motion picture
recording. (→198)
Elapsed recording time
Remaining recording time
(approx.)
Recording state indicator
2
Press the motion picture button again to end recording
For details, read “Recording motion pictures”. (→187)
59
SQW0024
Basics
Select the recording mode
To select the recording mode using the aperture ring and shutter speed
dial
1
Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial
Slowly turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial until they
click to properly align the position.
You can set the aperture ring to [A] (AUTO) or to values between
[1.7] and [16].
To select [Intelligent Auto] Mode
1
Press [iA] button
[Intelligent Auto] Mode is set and the recording mode icon
changes to [
]. When you press the [iA] button again, the
recording mode is switched to one that enables settings to be
made using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial.
When [Intelligent Auto] Mode is selected, the recording mode
that was set using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial is
cancelled.
[Intelligent Auto] Mode (→75)
Take pictures with automatic settings.
[Program AE] Mode (→81)
Record pictures with the aperture value and shutter speed settings automatically
adjusted.
[Aperture-Priority] Mode (→83)
Determine aperture, then record pictures.
[Shutter-Priority] Mode (→84)
Determine shutter speed, then record pictures.
[Manual Exposure] Mode (→86)
Determine the aperture value and shutter speed respectively, and then record
pictures.
60
SQW0024
Basics
Select the recording mode
Registering a combination of settings to be used during recording
(Custom Set)
You can register up to three combinations of your preferred menu settings. Selecting
[Utilize Custom Set feature] from the [Custom] menu enables you to switch quickly to the
settings you selected for the custom settings.
Registering the custom set
Set your preferred menu settings such as [Rec] menu, [Motion Picture] menu, and
[Custom] menu
Set the menu
[Custom] → [Cust.Set Mem.]
Use to select custom set (C1-C3) for registration and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
The following menu items are not registered as custom settings.
[Rec] menu [Setup] menu [Playback] menu
Data registered with [Face
Recog.]
The [Profile Setup] setting
All menus [Rotate Disp.]
[Picture Sort]
[Delete Confirmation]
Using the custom set
Set the menu
[Custom] → [Utilize Custom Set feature]
Use to select custom set
Press [MENU/SET]
The settings are switched to those settings you selected for the
custom set.
50
i
Using the function button to call up the custom settings
Setting the function button to [Utilize Custom Set feature] allows you to switch quickly to
your preferred settings by pressing the function button.
Assign [Utilize Custom Set feature] to your preferred function button using [Fn Button
Set] in the [Custom] menu. (→37)
Press the function button to which [Utilize Custom Set feature] is assigned. Use to
select custom set and press [MENU/SET]
61
SQW0024
Basics
Select the recording mode
When changing the menu settings
Even if the menu settings are changed temporarily while any one of the custom settings is
selected, the currently registered settings will remain unchanged.
To change the currently registered settings, overwrite the registered data using [Cust.Set
Mem.] on the [Custom] menu.
Not available in the following case:
In the [Intelligent Auto] Mode
62
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the recording
screen
You can also turn off the recording information (such as icons for various settings) and the
level gauge (→66).
1
Press [DISP.] button to switch the display
• You can use [Monitor Disp. Style] and [LVF Disp.Style]
in the [Custom] menu to select either [ ] (Monitor
style display layout) or [ ] (Live View Finder style
display layout) for the display screen of the monitor
and viewfinder.
[ ] Monitor style display layout
• The display is switched as shown below. (Example of monitor style display)
With information
*
1
Without information
With information
*
1
+
level gauge
Without information
+
level gauge
50
i
50
i
Turned off
Monitor recording
information screen
*
2
*
1
When [Histogram] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], a histogram is displayed. (→64) When
[Expo.Meter] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the exposure meter is displayed. (→81)
*
2
This screen is displayed only when [Monitor Info. Disp.] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON].
(→65) While you are checking the recording information on the monitor, you can use the
viewfinder to record pictures.
63
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the recording screen
[ ] Live View Finder style display layout
• The display is switched as shown below. (Example of viewfinder style display)
With information
(Detailed
information)
*
With information
With information
(Detailed information)
*
+
level gauge
With information
+
level gauge
50
i
50
i
*
When [Histogram] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], a histogram is displayed. (→64) When
[Expo.Meter] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the exposure meter is displayed. (→81)
If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information
on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button.
Switching the monitor display method
[Custom] → [Monitor Disp. Style]
[
]: Live View Finder style display layout
[ ]: Monitor style display layout
Switching the viewfinder display method
[Custom] → [LVF Disp.Style]
[
]: Live View Finder style display layout
[ ]: Monitor style display layout
64
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the recording screen
Enabling/disabling the histogram display
[Custom] → [Histogram] → [ON] / [OFF]
Use
to set the position.
Displays distribution of brightness in picture – e.g.
if the graph peaks at the right, this means there are
several bright areas in the picture. A peak in the centre
represents correct brightness (correct exposure). This
can be used as a reference for exposure correction, etc.
(Example)
Dark ← OK → Bright
When the histogram is not the same as that of the recorded picture under the following conditions,
histogram will be displayed in orange:
When manual exposure assist indicates settings other than 0 EV in [Manual Exposure] Mode or
during Exposure Compensation.
When the flash fires.
When the correct exposure is not achieved or when the brightness of the screen cannot be
displayed accurately in a dark location.
The histogram displayed during recording is only a reference.
The histogram is different from those displayed using the image editing software of a computer.
65
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the recording screen
Enabling/disabling the guideline display
[Custom] → [Guide Line] → [ ] / [ ] / [ ] / [OFF]
• The guideline is not displayed during panorama picture recording.
When you select [
], you can use to set the
position.
Turning on/off the recording information screen of the monitor
[Custom] → [Monitor Info. Disp.] → [ON] / [OFF]
66
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the recording screen
Using the level gauge
If you want to make sure that the camera is not slanted or tilted, for example, when you
take a picture of a landscape, use the level gauge indication as a reference.
1
Press [DISP.] button to switch the display
Press the button to switch the display. Press the button until the
level gauge is displayed.
2
Correct camera angle
Using the level gauge
The yellow line indicates the current angle. Correct the angle of the camera so that it
matches the white line.
Tilting up or down
In this case, it is facing
upward.
Tilting left or right
In this case, the right side has
dropped.
• When the camera is tilted very little or not at all, the level gauge will turn green.
• When pictures are taken in portrait orientation, the level gauge is automatically
switched to one for portrait orientation.
Even when angle is more or less corrected, there may be an error of about ±1 degree.
When [Level Gauge] is assigned to a function button, you can turn the level gauge on and off
every time you press the function button.
Not available in the following cases:
When the camera is being moved, the level gauge may not be displayed correctly.
The level gauge may not be displayed correctly or the direction detect function (→53) may not
operate correctly if the pictures are taken with the camera pointing sharply up or down.
67
SQW0024
Basics
Viewing your pictures
1
Press the Playback button
2
Press or turn the control dial to
select the picture to be displayed
• When you press and hold , the pictures are
displayed one after another.
• The playback speed of pictures varies depending on
the playback conditions.
Ending Playback
Press the Playback button again or press the Motion picture button.
The Playback can also be ended by pressing the shutter button halfway.
When the camera is switched to the playback screen, the lens barrel is retracted after approx.
15 seconds.
Not available in the following cases:
This camera is compliant with the unified DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) standard
formulated by the Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association (JEITA),
and with Exif (Exchangeable image file format). Files that are not DCF-compliant cannot be played
back.
It may not be possible to properly play back pictures taken using other cameras on this unit or it
may not be possible to use the functions of this unit for those pictures.
Sending pictures to the WEB services
If you press while a single picture is being displayed, you can send the picture to the
WEB service quickly. (→254)
68
SQW0024
Basics
Viewing your pictures
Zooming in and viewing “Playback Zoom”
1
Move the zoom lever toward T side
Each time you move the zoom lever toward the T side, the
magnification increases through four levels: 2x, 4x, 8x, and 16x.
(The picture quality displayed becomes successively lower.)
To reduce zoom → Move the zoom lever toward W side.
Move zoom position → Press
.
Current zoom position
Playback zoom cannot be used during motion picture playback, automatic scrolling playback of
panorama pictures or continuous playback.
Viewing a list of pictures “Multi Playback”
1
Move the zoom lever toward W side
Move the zoom lever toward the W side and you can switch the
display methods in the following order: 1-picture screen (full-
screen) → 12-picture screen → 30-picture screen → Calendar
screen. (Move the lever to the T side to return.)
When you select a picture using the cursor button and press
[MENU/SET] on the 12-picture or 30-picture screen, the selected
picture is displayed on the 1-picture screen (full-screen).
Pictures can also be selected with the control dial.
Pictures displayed with [!] cannot be played back.
69
SQW0024
Basics
Viewing your pictures
Viewing pictures by their recording date “Calendar Playback”
1
Move the zoom lever toward the W side to display the
calendar screen
2
Use to select recording date and press
[MENU/SET]
Pictures are displayed in a 12-picture screen.
You can also select the date with the control dial.
Selected date
You can display the calendar between January 2000 to December 2099.
Only months when pictures were taken are shown on the calendar screen. Pictures taken without
clock settings are displayed with the date 1st January, 2014.
Pictures taken with destination settings made in [World Time] are displayed in the calendar screen
using the appropriate date for the destination’s time zone.
70
SQW0024
Basics
Viewing your pictures
Viewing motion pictures
This unit was designed to play motion pictures using the AVCHD and MP4 formats.
1
Select a picture with the motion picture icon ([ ]) in
playback mode, and press to start playback
After playback starts, the elapsed playback time is displayed on
the screen.
Some information will not be displayed for motion pictures
recorded in [AVCHD].
Motion picture recording time
Example:
29 minutes and
30 seconds: [29m30s]
Operations during motion picture playback
: Pause/play
: Stop
: Fast rewind (2 steps
*
1
)/Single-frame rewind
*
2
(while paused)
: Fast forward (2 steps
*
1
)/Single-frame forward (while paused)
Control dial (counterclockwise): Volume down
Control dial (clockwise): Volume up
[MENU/SET]: Capturing still pictures from motion pictures (while paused) (→203)
*
1
The fast forward or rewind speed increases if you press again.
*
2
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] are rewound frame by frame approximately every
0.5 seconds.
• If is pressed during fast forward or rewind, it will return to normal playback speed.
Motion pictures can be viewed on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the supplied DVD.
Motion pictures that were recorded by setting the picture effect (Filter) to [Miniature Effect] are
played back at approximately 8x speed.
71
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the playback
screen
You can disable the display of picture information (file number, etc.) and recording
information (settings used for recording, etc.) when a picture is played back.
1
Press [DISP.] button to switch the display
• The display is switched as shown below.
With information
*
1
Detailed information
display
*
2
Histogram display
*
2
Without
information
*
1,
*
2,
*
3
10:00 1.DEC.2014
100-0001
100-00011/98
R
G
B
Y
Without information
*
1
If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information
on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button.
*
2
During Playback Zoom, Motion Picture Playback, Automatic Scrolling Playback of panorama
pictures, continuous playback or Slide Show: You can only turn the display on or off.
*
3
This screen is displayed only when [Highlight] (→72) in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON].
A histogram of each colour, including R (red), G (green), B (blue), and Y (luminance), is separately
displayed during playback.
During Multi Playback or calendar screen: Display cannot be changed.
72
SQW0024
Basics
Switching the display information on the playback screen
Enabling/disabling the overexposed area display
[Custom] → [Highlight] → [ON] / [OFF]
You can set overexposed areas (areas that are too bright and where there are no shades
of grey) to flash on the screen when the [Auto Review] function is activated or during
playback. This does not affect recorded pictures.
• To reduce overexposed areas, record
a picture by setting negative exposure
compensation (→135) using the histogram
display (→64) and so on as a reference.
(The right edge of the histogram shows the
overexposed portion.)
• This feature is disabled during Multi
Playback, Calendar Playback or Playback
Zoom.
[ON] [OFF]
73
SQW0024
Basics
Deleting pictures
Deleted pictures cannot be recovered.
Pictures will not be deleted in the following cases:
• Protected pictures.
• Card switch is in “LOCK” position.
• Pictures that are not based on the DCF standard. (→67)
Do not turn off the camera while deleting.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
[Delete Single]
1
Press [ ] button to delete displayed picture
2
Use to select [Delete Single] and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press
[MENU/SET].
Delete SingleDelete Single
Delete Multi
Delete Multi
Delete All
Delete All
You can set either [Yes] or [No] as the default setting on the deletion confirmation
screen when you perform [Delete Confirmation] in the [Playback] menu. [No] is
selected at the time of purchase. (→223)
74
SQW0024
Basics
Deleting pictures
To delete multiple (up to 100)/To delete all pictures
A picture group (→201) is handled as 1 picture. (All the pictures in the selected picture
group are deleted.)
1
Press [ ] button while viewing a picture
2
Use to select [Delete Multi]/[Delete All] and press
[MENU/SET]
Items can also be selected by turning the control dial.
When [Delete All] is selected
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press
[MENU/SET].
You can select [All Delete Except Favorite] in [Delete All] if there
are pictures that have been set as [Favorite] (→219).
Delete SingleDelete Single
Delete MultiDelete Multi
Delete All
Delete All
3
(When [Delete Multi] is selected)
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
Pictures can also be selected with the control dial.
Picture selected
OK
4
(When [Delete Multi] is selected) Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET].
May take time depending on number of pictures deleted.
75
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings
[Intelligent Auto] Mode
Recording mode:
This mode is recommended for those who want to point and shoot as the camera
optimises settings to match the subject and recording environment.
The camera optimises the settings and the following functions are activated automatically.
• Automatic Scene Detection / Backlight Compensation / [Face/Eye Detection] /
Auto White Balance / Intelligent ISO sensitivity control / [Red-Eye Removal] / [i.Zoom] /
[i.Resolution] / [Stabilizer] / [i.Dynamic] / [Long Shtr NR] / [Quick AF] / [AF Assist Lamp]
1
Press [iA] button
The camera switches to [Intelligent Auto] Mode.
• When you press the [iA] button again, the recording
mode is switched to one that is set using the aperture
ring and shutter speed dial.
2
Point the camera at the subject
• When the camera identifies the optimal scene, the
icon for each scene turns blue for 2 seconds and then
changes to the normal red indication.
• When you press and press the shutter button
halfway, AF Tracking is activated. For details (→117).
50
i
Changing the operation method of the [iA] button
[Custom] → [iA Button Switch]
[Single Press]: When you press the [iA] button, the camera switches to [Intelligent Auto]
Mode.
[Press and hold]: If you press and hold the [iA] button, the camera switches to
[Intelligent Auto] Mode.
76
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode
Automatic Scene Detection
When taking pictures
[i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Macro]
[i-Night Portrait]
*
1
[i-Night Scenery]
[i-Handheld Night
Shot]
*
2
[i-Food]
[i-Baby]
*
3
[i-Sunset] When scene does not correspond to any of the above
*
1
When the flash (supplied/optional) is used.
*
2
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is [ON]. (→78)
*
3
When children (that are registered in the camera with Face Recognition) under 3 years old are
recognised.
When recording motion pictures
[i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Low Light] [i-Macro]
When scene does not correspond to any of the above
• In [ ], [ ], and [ ], the camera adjusts the focus on the eye that is closest to this
unit and matches the exposure with the face. In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the eye to be
focused on cannot be changed. ([Face/Eye Detection])
• When the camera identifies [ ] as the optimal scene and if the camera determines
that jitter is reduced by the use of a tripod or by other means, a shutter speed that
is slower than usual is selected. After pressing the shutter button, do not move the
camera while recording.
• Automatic Scene Detection does not function until the focus is locked on a subject
during AF Tracking.
• When [Face Recog.] is set to [ON] and if the camera recognises a face similar to a
registered face, [R] is displayed on the upper right corner of the [ ], [ ], and [ ]
icons.
Depending on recording conditions, different scene types may be determined for the same
subject.
About Backlight Compensation
Backlight compensation is automatically activated in [Intelligent Auto] Mode. Backlight
is a condition where a light shines from behind a subject. When there is a backlight,
the subject appears darker and the camera will automatically attempt to correct it by
increasing the brightness of the picture.
77
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode
Using the flash (supplied/optional)
1
Turn off the camera
2
Remove the hot shoe cover
3
Attach the flash
4
Turn on the camera and the flash
For details (→176, 291).
Flash
When the [ON/OFF] switch for the flash (supplied/optional) is set to [OFF], the flash is
set to [
] (Forced Flash Off). When the [ON/OFF] switch is set to [ON], the flash is set
to [ ] (AUTO).
When the flash is turned on, the camera automatically sets [ ], [ ] (Auto/Red-Eye
Reduction), [ ], or [ ] based on the type of subject and brightness.
When [ ] or [ ] is displayed, the [Red-Eye Removal] function is activated to automatically
detect red-eye and correct the picture data.
When [ ] or [ ] is selected, the shutter speed is reduced.
Available menus
You can set only the following menus.
Menu Item
[Rec] [Picture Size] / [Quality] / [AFS/AFF/AFC] / [Burst Rate] / [Self Timer] /
[iHandheld Night Shot] / [iHDR] / [Time Lapse Shot] /
[Stop Motion Animation] / [Face Recog.]
[Motion Picture] [Rec Format] / [Rec Quality] / [AFS/AFF/AFC]
[Custom] [Silent Mode] / [Guide Line] / [Remaining Disp.]
[Setup] All menu items can be set. (→41)
78
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode
Taking pictures using a handheld camera
([iHandheld Night Shot])
If a night scene is detected automatically while the unit is being handheld, [iHandheld
Night Shot] can record a still picture with less jitter and less noise without using a tripod
by combining a burst of pictures.
[Rec] → [iHandheld Night Shot] → [ON] / [OFF]
The angle of view becomes narrow slightly.
A message indicating that multiple pictures are to be recorded appears on the screen. After the
shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
When the camera is fixed in place on a tripod or by other means, [ ] will not be identified.
The flash is fixed to the [ ] (Forced Flash Off) setting.
Not available in the following cases:
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
[iHandheld Night Shot] cannot be used in the following cases:
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
79
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode
Combining pictures into a single still picture with rich
gradation ([iHDR])
When there is, for example, strong contrast between the background and the subject,
[iHDR] records multiple still pictures with differing exposures and combines them to
create a single still picture rich in gradation.
[iHDR] is activated when required. When activated, [ ] will be displayed on the screen.
[Rec] → [iHDR] → [ON] / [OFF]
The angle of view becomes narrow slightly.
A message indicating that multiple pictures are to be recorded appears on the screen. After the
shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few
moments before you can record another picture.
In the case of composition from a burst, afterimages may appear if the subject was moving.
Not available in the following cases:
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
[iHDR] cannot be used in the following cases:
When the flash is used
When using [Burst]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
80
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and
shutter speed
Recording mode:
You can set the exposure using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial settings.
Using the [Rec] menu to change settings and set up your own recording environment.
You can also record pictures by applying picture effects. (→89)
1
Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial to set your
preferred recording mode.
Set the aperture ring where it clicks.
Align with
the indicator
Recording mode Aperture ring Shutter speed dial
[Program AE] Mode (→81) [A] (AUTO) [A] (AUTO)
[Aperture-Priority] Mode (→83)
Your preferred settings
*
1
[A] (AUTO)
[Shutter-Priority] Mode (→84) [A] (AUTO)
Your preferred settings
*
2
[Manual Exposure] Mode (→86)
Your preferred settings
*
1
Your preferred settings
*
2
• In [Aperture-Priority] Mode, [Shutter-Priority] Mode, and [Manual Exposure] Mode,
the effect of the aperture value and shutter speed you have set is not applied to the
recording screen. To check the effect on the recording screen, use [Preview] Mode.
(→88)
The brightness of the screen may vary from the actual pictures recorded. Check the
brightness of pictures using the playback screen.
A faster shutter speed than the set shutter speed may be used when you record a
motion picture.
*
1
You can set the aperture values between F1.7 and F16.
You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom position.
*
2
You can set the shutter speed between 1 second and 1/4000 seconds.
Turn the control ring or control dial to set the shutter speed in the following cases.
Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second
Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps
81
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures after automatically setting the aperture value
and shutter speed ([Program AE] Mode)
Take pictures using automatic aperture values and shutter speed settings in accordance
with the brightness of a subject.
1
Turn the aperture ring to select [A] (AUTO)
2
Turn the shutter speed dial to select [A] (AUTO)
[Program AE] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes
to [P].
3
Press the shutter button halfway
If the aperture value and shutter speed flash red, you do not have
the correct exposure.
2500 125 60 30 15
5.64.02.0 2.8
Programme Shift indication
4
While the numeric values are displayed in yellow (approximately 10 seconds),
turn the control dial to change the values using Programme Shift (→82)
To cancel Programme Shift, either turn off the camera or turn the control dial until the
Programme Shift indication turns off.
To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to adjust the compensation value.
(→135)
Enabling/disabling the exposure meter display
[Custom] → [Expo.Meter] → [ON] / [OFF]
When you set this function to [ON], an exposure meter is
displayed during Programme Shift, aperture setting, and
shutter speed operation.
Proper exposure is not possible in the range indicated in red.
If the exposure meter is not displayed, press the [DISP.]
button to switch the display of the monitor. (→62)
The exposure meter will turn off if no operation is performed
for approximately 4 seconds.
Exposure meter
2500 125 60 30 15
5.64.02.0 2.8
82
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
About Programme Shift
The function for maintaining the same exposure (brightness) while changing the shutter
speed and aperture value combination is called “Programme Shift”. You can use
“Programme Shift” to take pictures by adjusting the shutter speed and aperture value
even in [Program AE] Mode.
<Example of Programme Shift>
1.4
2.0
2.8
4.0
5.6
8.0
11
16
22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1613 14 15
1
1/2
1/4
1/8
1/15
1/30
1/60
1/125
1/250
1/500
1/1000
1/2000
1/4000
1/8000
1/16000
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
(Aperture value)
(EV)
(Shutter speed)
Programme Shift amount
Programme Shift diagram
Programme Shift limit
EV is an abbreviation of “Exposure Value”, a unit indicating the amount of exposure. The EV
changes with the aperture value or the shutter speed.
Not available in the following cases:
Programme Shift cannot be used in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When [Sensitivity] is set to [
]
83
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value
([Aperture-Priority] Mode)
When the aperture value is increased, the range of depth in focus expands, and the
picture shows up clearly from the position of the camera to the background. When the
aperture value is reduced, the range of depth in focus shrinks, and the background can
get blurry.
1
Turn the shutter speed dial to select [A] (AUTO)
2
Turn the aperture ring to select the aperture value
[Aperture-Priority] Mode is set and the recording mode icon
changes to [A].
To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to
adjust the compensation value. (→135)
Aperture values
that can be set
*
Shutter speed set (seconds)
F1.7 - F16
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
*
You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom
position.
605 30 15 8 4
8.0 11 16
Aperture value
Exposure meter
When you turn the aperture ring, an exposure meter is displayed. If the correct exposure is not
achieved, the numeric values of the aperture are shown in red.
If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric
values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red.
84
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures by setting the shutter speed
([Shutter-Priority] Mode)
When you increase the shutter speed, you can reduce jitter when recording a subject.
When you decrease the shutter speed, the subject’s movement is shown.
1
Turn the aperture ring to select [A] (AUTO)
2
Turn the shutter speed dial to select the shutter speed
[Shutter-Priority] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes
to [S].
To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to
adjust the compensation value. (→135)
Shutter speeds that can be set (seconds)
Aperture value
set
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
F1.7 - F16
8 15 30 60 125
2.02.85.68.01 4.0
Shutter speed
Exposure meter
Setting the shutter speed to values not provided on the shutter speed dial
Turn the control ring or control dial to set the following shutter speeds. Check the shutter speed on
the screen.
For details on setting the shutter method, refer to (→140).
Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second
Turn the shutter speed dial to select [4000-] or [1+]
Turn the control ring or control dial to select the shutter speed
Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps
You can set the shutter speed from the setting value of the shutter speed dial in the range of ± 2/3
steps.
Example: To set the shutter speed to 1/400 seconds
Turn the shutter speed dial to select [500]
Turn the control ring or control dial to select [400]
85
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
When you turn the shutter speed dial, an exposure meter is displayed. If the correct exposure is
not achieved, the numeric value of the shutter speed is shown in red.
If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric
values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red.
If you switch the recording mode to [Shutter-Priority] Mode when [Sensitivity] is set to [ ],
[Sensitivity] will change to [AUTO].
We recommend using a tripod or self-timer when the shutter speed is slow.
86
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
([Manual Exposure] Mode)
Determine the exposure by manually setting the aperture value and the shutter speed.
The Manual Exposure Assist appears on the lower portion of the screen to indicate the
exposure.
1
Turn the aperture ring to select the aperture value
2
Turn the shutter speed dial to select the shutter speed
[Manual Exposure] Mode is set and the recording mode icon
changes to [M].
Aperture values that
can be set
*
1
Shutter speeds that can be set
*
2
(seconds)
F1.7 - F16
T (Time),
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
*
1
You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom
position.
*
2
You may not be able to select some shutter speeds depending
on the aperture value.
60 125 250 500 1
000
5.64.02.0 2.8
Shutter speed
Manual
Exposure Assist
Aperture value
Exposure meter
Setting the shutter speed to values not provided on the shutter speed dial
Turn the control ring or control dial to set the following shutter speeds. For the setting procedures,
refer to (→84).
Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second
Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps
If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric
values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red.
If you switch the recording mode to [Manual Exposure] Mode when [Sensitivity] is set to [ ],
[Sensitivity] will change to [AUTO].
We recommend using a tripod or self-timer when the shutter speed is slow.
87
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Manual exposure assist (estimate)
Shows pictures with standard brightness (appropriate exposure).
Shows brighter pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a faster shutter
speed or increase aperture value.
Shows darker pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a slower shutter
speed or reduce aperture value.
About T (time)
When you set the shutter speed to T (time) and fully press the shutter button, the shutter
opens. (Approximately up to 120 seconds)
When you press the shutter button again, the shutter closes. Use this function when you
want to keep the shutter open for an extended period, for example, to record pictures of
fireworks or night scenes.
• When you take pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), make sure to use a fully
charged battery (→20).
• Manual exposure assist is not displayed.
• If you set the shutter speed to T (time) when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO], [Sensitivity]
will change to [200].
• You cannot use this function when the electronic shutter is used.
• You can use this function only in [Manual Exposure] Mode.
When you take pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), we recommend
using remote recording with a tripod or smartphone as a remote shutter release
(→228, 234), in order to prevent jitter.
When you take still pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), the pictures
may have higher noise levels. If you want to suppress noise, we recommend
taking pictures by setting [Long Shtr NR] to [ON] in the [Rec] menu. (→113)
Enabling/disabling the preview of the selected aperture value and
shutter speed effects on the recording screen
[Custom] → [Constant Preview] (M Mode) → [ON] / [OFF]
This function is disabled when the flash is used.
You can use this function only in [Manual Exposure] Mode.
88
SQW0024
Recording mode
Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Checking the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed
([Preview] Mode)
Recording mode:
You can use [Preview] Mode to check the effects of the selected aperture value and
shutter speed.
Checking the effect of the selected aperture value: This enables you to check the
depth of field (focus range) by physically narrowing the lens aperture blades to the
aperture value used for the actual recording.
Checking the effect of the selected shutter speed: This allows you to check motion
in a scene by displaying the screen at the shutter speed used for the actual recording.
When the shutter speed is increased, the screen is displayed like a frame dropping.
Use this function to check the effect when you want to capture an image in a scene by
stopping the motion, for example, when you take a picture of water flowing.
1
Assign [Preview] to the function button (→37)
The following step is an example of assigning [Preview] to the [Fn1] button.
2
Press the [Fn1] button to switch the confirmation screen
Every time you press the [Fn1] button, the screen switches.
Normal recording screen Effect of aperture value Effect of shutter speed
Shtr Speed Effect On
Fn1
Shtr Speed Effect Off
Fn1
Depth of field characteristic
Recording
conditions
Aperture value Small Large
Focal length Telephoto Wide-angle
Distance to a subject Close Far
Depth of field
(Focus range)
Shallow (narrow)
Example:
To take a picture by
deliberately blurring the
background
Deep (wide)
Example:
To take a picture by adjusting
the focus while including the
background
You can take a picture even when [Preview] Mode is activated.
The range in which you can check the effect of a selected shutter speed is between 8 seconds
and 1/16000 seconds.
89
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects
(Filter)
Recording mode:
You can select your own settings from various effects and take pictures while confirming
these effects on the screen. You can set the effects to be applied to a picture by selecting
a sample picture. You can add picture effects while you record a panorama picture.
1
Press [FILTER] button
2
Press or turn the control dial to
select the picture effect (Filter)
• You can select from among 22 picture effects (Filter).
(→92 - 99)
• The picture effect for the sample picture you selected
is applied to the picture shown on the preview display.
Preview display
No
Effect
3
Press [MENU/SET]
The display of a picture with a selected picture effect
appears on the screen.
Example: When the picture effect ([Sunshine]) is selected
in [Program AE] Mode
Picture effects
(This is not displayed when [No Effect] is
selected.)
Adjusting the picture effect (→91)
(This is displayed only when a picture effect is
selected.)
Changing the picture effect (Filter)
Press the [FILTER] button again and perform the same procedure from step
2
above.
90
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
Settings will be stored even if the recording mode is changed or the camera is turned off.
If you do not want to add picture effects, please select [No Effect].
When you set a picture effect, the following settings are fixed.
White Balance: [AWB]
[Photo Style]: [Standard]
[Highlight Shadow]: [Standard]
[i.Dynamic]: [OFF]
[HDR]: [OFF]
[Color Space]: [sRGB]
The flash is set to [ ] (Forced Flash Off).
The display of a picture reflecting a selected effect in the preview screen or recording screen may
differ from the actual recorded pictures.
Switching the display of a selection screen for applying picture effects
(Filter)
1
Press the [DISP.] button to switch the display
Every time you press the [DISP.] button, the screen for which picture effects are selected
changes.
When you switch the screen to the guide display, a description of the picture effects appears.
Normal display Guide display List display
No
Effect
No
Effect
No
Effect
91
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
Adjusting the picture effects according to your preferences
You can easily adjust the setting conditions (such as degree and colouring of an effect) of
the picture effects according to your preferences.
1
Press to display the setting screen
2
Turn the control dial to adjust the setting conditions of
the picture effects
The settings that can be adjusted vary depending on the
selected picture effect. Refer to “Items that can be set” for the
corresponding picture effect.
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
When you select picture effects, [
] appears on the screen.
If you do not want to change the current setting, select the centre
point (standard) in the adjustment level bar.
Taking two still pictures with and without picture effects
([Simultaneous record w/o filter])
You can take two still pictures at the same time by pressing the shutter button once; one
with effects and one without effects.
[Rec] → [Simultaneous record w/o filter]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
When [ON] is set, the camera will take a still picture with the effects applied and then a still picture
without the effects.
A still picture recorded without effects applied will use the same menu settings as when the picture
effects (Filter) were applied. The following settings are fixed.
White Balance: [AWB] (You cannot perform fine adjustments.)
[i.Dynamic]: [OFF]
After taking the picture, [Auto Review] will display only the still picture with the effects applied.
If you set this function to [ON], burst, Auto Bracket, Aspect Bracket, White Balance Bracket, [Time
Lapse Shot], [Stop Motion Animation] and panorama picture recording will be disabled.
This function is disabled during motion picture recording.
92
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Expressive]
This effect emphasises the colour to make a pop art picture.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Vividness Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring
[Retro]
This effect gives a faded image.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring Yellowish colouring Reddish colouring
[Old Days]
This effect adds a bright, soft and nostalgic feel to the overall image.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Contrast Low contrast High contrast
[High Key]
This effect adds a bright, airy and soft feel to the overall image.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring Pinkish colouring Light-bluish colouring
When recording a panorama picture in a scene with low brightness, you may
not be able to achieve the desired results.
93
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Low Key]
This effect adds a dark and relaxing feel to the overall image and
enhances bright parts.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring Reddish colouring Bluish colouring
[Sepia]
This effect creates a sepia image.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Contrast Low contrast High contrast
[Monochrome]
This effect creates a black and white picture.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring Yellowish colouring Bluish colouring
[Dynamic Monochrome]
This effect gives a higher contrast to create an impressive black and
white picture.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Contrast Low contrast High contrast
94
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Rough Monochrome]
This effect creates a black and white picture with granular noise.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Grainy image
effect
Weak grainy image
effect
Strong grainy image
effect
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay
compared to normal recording.
[Silky Monochrome]
This effect blurs the overall image to add a soft feel to a black and
white picture.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Degree of
defocusing
Slight defocusing
Strong defocusing
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay
compared to normal recording.
[Impressive Art]
This effect gives your photo a dramatic contrast look.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Vividness Black & white Gaudy colouring
When recording a panorama picture, the places where successively taken
pictures are stitched may be noticeable.
[High Dynamic]
This effect produces the optimum brightness for both dark and bright
parts.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Vividness Black & white Gaudy colouring
95
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Cross Process]
This effect gives your photo a dramatic colour look.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring
Greenish colouring / Bluish colouring /
Yellowish colouring / Reddish colouring
[Toy Effect]
This effect reduces peripheral brightness to give the impression of a
toy camera.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring Orangish colour Bluish colouring
[Toy Pop]
This effect creates a vivid and bright image with the look of a toy
camera.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Range in which
peripheral
brightness is
reduced
Small
Large
[Bleach Bypass]
This effect gives a higher contrast and a lower saturation to create a
calm and tranquil picture.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Contrast Low contrast High contrast
96
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Miniature Effect]
This effect blurs peripheral areas to give the impression of a diorama.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Vividness Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring
Defocusing a picture
You can create the impression of a diorama by intentionally creating
a blurred area and focusing area using [Miniature Effect]. You can
set the recording direction (direction of blurred area), position and
size of the focusing area.
Press [Fn1] button
Press or to move the focusing area (frame)
Turn the control dial to select the size of the focusing
area (frame)
Press [MENU/SET]
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is
restored.
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal
recording.
No audio is recorded for motion pictures.
When a motion picture is recorded, the finished recording will be approximately 1/8th of the actual
recorded time period. (If you record a motion picture for 8 minutes, the resulting motion picture
recording time will be approximately 1 minute.) The recordable time displayed on the camera is
approx. 8x longer than actual time needed for recording. When the Recording Mode is changed, be
sure to check the recordable time.
If you stop recording motion pictures too soon, the camera may continue recording until a certain
time. Hold the camera until the camera stops recording.
If [MF] is selected for the focus mode, move the focusing area to the position at which the focus has
been adjusted.
97
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Soft Focus]
This effect blurs the overall image to produce a soft feel.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Degree of
defocusing
Slight defocusing
Strong defocusing
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay
compared to normal recording.
[Fantasy]
This effect creates a fantastical image in a pale colour tone.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Vividness Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring
[Star Filter]
This effect transforms pin-points of light into a star effect.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Length of the rays
of light
Rays of light is
short
Rays of light is long
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay
compared to normal recording.
98
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[One Point Color]
This effect leaves one selected colour to emphasise impressiveness.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Amount of colour
retained
Leaves a small
amount of colour
Leaves a large amount
of colour
Selecting colour
Press [Fn1] button
Select the colour to be retained with and press
[MENU/SET]
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is
restored.
The selected colour may not be retained for some subjects.
99
SQW0024
Picture effects (Filter)
Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter)
For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89).
[Sunshine]
This effect adds a cast of light to the scene.
Items that can be set (Press to display the setting screen)
Colouring
Yellowish colouring / Reddish colouring /
Bluish colouring / Whitish colouring
Setting the light source
Press [Fn1] button
Press to move the centre of the light source to a
different position
You can move the centre of the light source to the edge of the
screen.
Tips on positioning the centre of the light
source
You can move the centre of the light source to a point
outside the image to obtain a more natural finish.
Turn the control dial to adjust the size of the light source
You can change the light source among four sizes.
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is restored.
Press [MENU/SET]
The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal
recording.
100
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the picture quality with effects
[Photo Style]
Recording mode:
You can adjust the colours and picture quality according to the concept of the picture that
you want to create.
[Rec] → [Photo Style]
[Standard] Standard setting.
[Vivid] Setting with slightly high contrast and saturation.
[Natural] Setting with slightly low contrast.
[Monochrome]
Setting that creates a picture using monochrome shades of grey only,
such as black and white.
[Scenery]
Setting that creates a picture using vivid colours for the blue sky and
green.
[Portrait] Setting that produces the look of a healthy complexion.
[Custom]
Setting for using colours and picture quality that were registered in
advance.
[Photo Style] is fixed to [Standard] when the picture effect (Filter) is set.
The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu
is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
101
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the picture quality with effects [Photo Style]
Adjusting the picture quality
Press to select the type of Photo Style
Standard
Press to select an item and press to adjust
[Contrast]
[+] Increases the contrast in a picture.
[–] Decreases the contrast in a picture.
[Sharpness]
[+] Enhances the outlines in a picture.
[–] Softens the outlines in a picture.
[Noise Reduction]
[+]
Increases the noise reduction effect to reduce noise. This
setting may slightly lower the resolution.
[–]
Lowers the noise reduction effect to achieve a picture
quality with clearer resolution.
[Saturation]
*
1
[+] Gaudy colouring
[–] Subdued colouring
[Color Tone]
*
1
[+] Bluish colouring
[–] Yellowish colouring
[Filter Effect]
*
2
[Yellow]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Low)
Records a blue sky clearly.
[Orange]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Medium)
Records a blue sky with vibrant colours.
[Red]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: High)
Records a blue sky with even more vibrant colours.
[Green]
Applies subdued colouring for the skin and lips of a
person. Emphasises green leaves and makes them
brighter.
[Off]
*
1
[Color Tone] is displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected. Otherwise, [Saturation] is
displayed.
*
2
[Filter Effect] is displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected.
When the picture quality is adjusted, [+] will be displayed in the icon.
Press [MENU/SET]
Registering the setting for the adjusted picture quality to [Custom]
Perform the picture quality adjustment in Step of “Adjusting the picture quality” and
press the [DISP.] button
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET].
102
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting highlights and shadows
[Highlight Shadow]
Recording mode:
You can adjust the highlights and shadows in a picture while confirming the brightness of
these areas on the screen.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Highlight Shadow]
2
Press to select the item
([Standard]) No adjustments.
([Higher contrast])
Makes the highlighted areas brighter and shadowed areas
darker.
([Lower contrast])
Makes the highlighted areas darker and shadowed areas
brighter.
([Brighten shadows]) Makes the shadowed areas brighter.
/ / (Custom)
You can set a custom registration shape.
3
Turn the control ring to adjust the
brightness of the highlighted areas
and turn the control dial to adjust the
brightness of the shadowed areas
• To register your preferred settings, press to select
the registration target icon (Custom 1 ([ ]), Custom 2
([ ]), and Custom 3 ([ ])).
Highlighted area
Shadowed area
Preview display
4
Press [MENU/SET]
You can press the [DISP.] button on the brightness adjustment screen to switch the screen display.
The settings registered in [ ], [ ], or [ ] will be retained even if the camera is turned off.
The settings adjusted in [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] will be restored to the default settings when the
camera is turned off.
The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu
is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
103
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Recording mode:
In sunlight, under incandescent lights or in other such conditions where the colour of
white takes on a reddish or bluish tinge, this item adjusts to the colour of white which is
closest to what is seen by the eye in accordance with the light source.
1
Press [WB] button ( )
2
Turn the control dial to select the White
Balance and press [MENU/SET]
[AWB] Automatic adjustment in accordance with the light source.
[
]
Adjust to the colour under a clear sky.
[
]
Adjust to the colour under a cloudy sky.
[
]
Adjust to the colour in the shade.
[
]
Adjust to the colour under incandescent lights.
[
]
*
Adjust to the colour that is optimal for taking pictures using the
flash.
[
]/[ ]/[ ]/[ ]
Use the White Balance value that was set manually.
[
] Use the preset colour temperature setting.
*
The [AWB] setting is applied when recording motion pictures.
Under fluorescent lighting, LED lighting fixtures, etc., the optimal White Balance will
vary depending on the lighting type, so use [AWB], [ ], [ ], [ ] or [ ].
The White Balance may not operate correctly if you take pictures using a flash or the subject is
recorded outside of the effective flash range (→177).
[White Balance] setting is fixed to [AWB] in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set
104
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Auto White Balance
When [AWB] (Automatic White Balance) is set, the colouring is adjusted in accordance
with the light source. However, if the scene is too bright or too dark or if other extreme
conditions apply, the pictures may appear reddish or bluish. The White Balance may
not operate correctly if there is a multiple number of light sources. In that case, set the
[White Balance] to settings other than [AWB] to adjust the colouring.
: [AWB] operational range
10000K
9000K
8000K
7000K
6000K
5000K
4000K
3000K
2000K
Cloudy sky (rain)
Shade
Incandescent lighting
Sunset/sunrise
Candlelight
Sunlight
White fluorescent lighting
Blue sky
K=Kelvin Colour Temperature
Setting the White Balance manually
Take a picture of a white object under the target light source to adjust colours.
1
Press [WB] button ( )
2
Turn the control dial to select [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ], and press
3
Point the camera at a white object such as a piece of
paper, ensuring that it is inside the frame at the centre
of the screen, and press [MENU/SET]
It may not be possible to set the correct White Balance if subjects are too bright or too dark. In this
case, adjust the brightness and try to set the White Balance again.
105
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Setting the White Balance using colour temperature
You can set the White Balance using colour temperature. Colour temperature is a
numeric value that expresses the colour of light (unit: K
*
). A picture becomes bluish when
the colour temperature value is higher, and reddish when the temperature value is lower.
*
Kelvin
1
Press [WB] button ( )
2
Turn the control dial to select [ ] and press
3
Use to select the colour temperature value and
press [MENU/SET]
You can set the colour temperature from 2,500 K to 10,000 K.
Performing White Balance fine adjustments
White Balance settings can be individually fine-tuned if colours still do not appear as
anticipated.
1
Select the White Balance and press
2
Use to perform White Balance fine
adjustments
: A (amber: orangish colours) : B (blue: bluish colours)
: G (green: greenish colours) : M (magenta: reddish
colours)
Pressing [DISP.] button resets the position back to the centre.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the A (amber) or B (blue) side,
the colour of the White Balance icon displayed on the screen will change to the fine-tuned colour.
When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the G (green) or M (magenta)
side, [+] (green) or [-] (magenta) will be displayed in the White Balance icon on the screen.
Settings remain applied when using flash.
You can perform fine adjustments of the White Balance independently for each White Balance
setting item.
When you set a new White Balance value by selecting [ ], [ ], [ ] or [ ], or change the
colour temperature by selecting [
], the White Balance fine adjustment level will be returned to
the standard setting (centre point).
106
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Bracket recording using White Balance
Bracket settings are performed based on the fine adjustment values for White Balance,
and three pictures with different colouring are automatically recorded when the shutter
button is pressed once.
1
Perform fine adjustments of the White Balance in
step
2
of “Performing White Balance fine adjustments”
and turn the control dial to perform the Bracket setting
Turning the control dial to the right : Horizontal ([A] to [B])
Turning the control dial to the left : Vertical ([G] to [M])
2
Press [MENU/SET]
When the White Balance Bracket is set, [BKT] appears on the White Balance icon.
When the camera is turned off (Including [Sleep Mode]), the White Balance Bracket setting is
cancelled.
The shutter sound will be emitted only once.
Not available in the following cases:
The White Balance Bracket does not function in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
During motion picture recording
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
When the [Quality] setting is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
107
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Setting the picture quality and size
Changing the aspect ratio of the still pictures
Recording mode:
You can easily switch the aspect ratio of still pictures using the aspect ratio selector
switch.
1
Switching the aspect ratio selector switch
[4:3] Aspect ratio of a 4:3 TV
[1:1] Aspect ratio of a square image
[16:9] Aspect ratio of high-definition TV, etc.
[3:2] Aspect ratio of standard film cameras
Edges may be cut off when printing - be sure to check in advance. (→324)
Not available in the following case:
During panorama picture recording
108
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Setting the picture quality and size
Setting the picture size
Recording mode:
The higher the numbers of pixels, the finer the detail of the pictures will appear even
when they are printed onto large sheets.
[Rec] → [Picture Size]
Aspect ratio 4:3 1:1 16:9 3:2
[Picture Size]
[L] 12.5M
4112×3088
[L] 10M
3088×3088
[L] 11M
4480×2520
[L] 12M
4272×2856
[ M] 6.5M
2976×2232
[ M] 5M
2240×2240
[ M] 8M
3840×2160
[ M] 6.5M
3120×2080
[ S] 3M
2048×1536
[ S] 2.5M
1536×1536
[ S] 2M
1920×1080
[ S] 3M
2112×1408
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH], [Picture Size] is fixed to [S].
Not available in the following case:
During panorama picture recording
109
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Setting the picture quality and size
Setting the compression rate of pictures ([Quality])
Recording mode:
Set the compression rate used for storing pictures.
[Rec] → [Quality]
Settings File format Description
[
]
JPEG
Gives priority to picture quality and saves pictures in JPEG file
format.
[
]
Saves pictures in JPEG file format using standard picture quality.
This setting is useful when you want to increase the number of
recordable pictures without changing the number of pixels.
[
]
RAW + JPEG
Saves pictures in JPEG file format in addition to the RAW file
format.
*
1
[ ]
[
] RAW
Saves pictures in the RAW file format.
*
2
*
1
If you delete a RAW file from the camera, the corresponding JPEG file is also deleted.
*
2
The picture size is fixed to the maximum recordable pixels for each image aspect ratio ([L]).
About RAW file
In RAW file format the data is saved without any picture processing by the camera. This
format delivers a higher picture quality than the JPEG format, but the amount of data
is greater. To play back and edit RAW file pictures, you must use this unit or dedicated
software.
You can perform advanced editing of RAW file pictures, such as correcting the White
Balance of pictures recorded previously, and save the pictures in file formats that can be
displayed on a PC.
• You can develop the RAW file pictures using [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu.
(→208)
• To develop and edit RAW file pictures on a PC, use the supplied DVD software
(Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s “SILKYPIX Developer Studio”).
110
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Setting the picture quality and size
Not available in the following cases:
The following effects cannot be used on RAW file pictures.
[Intelligent Auto] Mode
Picture effects (Filter)
White Balance
*
1
[Photo Style]
*
1
/ [Highlight Shadow]
*
1
/ [i.Dynamic]
*
1
/ [Red-Eye Removal]
*
2
/ [i.Resolution]
*
1
/
[Color Space]
*
1
([Rec] menu)
You cannot set to [ ], [ ] or [ ] in the following case:
During panorama picture recording
*
1
When you use [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu, the adjustments are made based on the
settings used during recording. Therefore, you can save JPEG file pictures by using the settings
applied during recording.
*
2
If [Red-Eye Removal] is activated during recording, you can use [RAW Processing] in the
[Playback] menu to save JPEG file pictures in which red-eye was detected and corrected.
111
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Using the picture correction functions effectively
Correcting contrast and exposure ([i.Dynamic])
Recording mode:
Automatically adjusts contrast and exposure to give more lifelike colours when there is
significant contrast between background and subject.
[Rec] → [i.Dynamic]
Settings: [AUTO] / [HIGH] / [STANDARD] /[LOW] / [OFF]
When [AUTO] is set, you can automatically set the strength of the effects based on the recording
conditions.
The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu
is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
Not available in the following cases:
Compensation effect may not be achieved depending on the conditions.
The [i.Dynamic] does not function in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
Enhancing the impression of high-resolution ([i.Resolution])
Recording mode:
You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to record still pictures with
sharper outlines and clearer resolution.
[Rec] → [i.Resolution]
Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] /[LOW] / [EXTENDED] / [OFF]
When [EXTENDED] is set, you can take more natural pictures with the impression of high-
resolution.
The [EXTENDED] setting will automatically change to the [LOW] setting when recording motion
pictures.
The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu
is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
112
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Using the picture correction functions effectively
Combining still pictures with different exposures ([HDR])
Recording mode:
The camera can combine 3 still pictures taken at different exposures into a single
properly exposed picture with rich gradation. The individual pictures used to create the
HDR picture are not saved. You can minimise the loss of gradations in bright areas and
dark areas when, for example, the contrast between the background and the subject is
large.
A combined HDR picture is saved in JPEG format.
[Rec] → [HDR]
[ON] Creates a combined HDR picture.
[OFF] Does not create a combined HDR picture.
[SET]
[Dynamic
Range]
[AUTO]: Takes pictures after automatically setting the adjustment range
of the exposure based on the contrast of a subject.
[±1EV] / [±2EV] / [±3EV]: Takes pictures using the adjustment range of
the exposure being set.
[Auto Align]
[ON]: Automatically adjusts the displacement of pictures caused by
jitter, etc. We recommend using this setting to take pictures with a
handheld camera.
[OFF]: Does not adjust the displacement of pictures. We recommend
using this setting when you use a tripod.
What is HDR?
HDR stands for High Dynamic Range and refers to a technique for expressing a wide
contrast range.
After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few
moments before you will be able to record another picture.
A subject that was in motion when it was recorded may be recorded as an afterimage.
When [Auto Align] is set to [ON], the angle of view narrows slightly.
When you take pictures using a flash, the flash mode is fixed to [ ] (Forced Flash Off).
Not available in the following cases:
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
[HDR] cannot be used in the following cases:
When the [Quality] setting is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
113
SQW0024
Picture Quality and colouring Settings
Using the picture correction functions effectively
Suppressing the noise of a long exposure ([Long Shtr NR])
Recording mode:
The camera can automatically eliminate the noise made when taking pictures with a
slower shutter speed (e.g. to record night scenes) in order to take sharp pictures.
[Rec] → [Long Shtr NR]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
While the camera eliminates the noise, [Long shutter noise reduction ongoing] is displayed for the
same period as the shutter speed selected for the signal processing time.
Not available in the following cases:
The [Long Shtr NR] does not function in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
During motion picture recording
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
When using the electronic shutter
Setting the colour space
Recording mode:
You can set the method for reproducing the colours to correctly display the recorded
pictures on the screens of a PC or printer, etc.
[Rec] → [Color Space]
[sRGB] Sets the sRGB colour space. This setting is widely used for devices such as PCs.
[AdobeRGB]
Sets the AdobeRGB colour space.
AdobeRGB colour space has a wider colour reproduction range than sRGB
colour space. Therefore, AdobeRGB colour space is mainly used for business
applications such as commercial printing.
Select [sRGB] if you do not have expert knowledge about AdobeRGB colour space.
During motion picture recording, the setting is fixed to [sRGB].
114
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
1
Switch the focus selector
switch to [ ] or [ ]
Auto Focus is
activated.
Align with the
indicator.
Select the focus mode (AFS, AFF, AFC)
Recording mode:
Set the focusing operation to be performed when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
[Rec] → [AFS/AFF/AFC]
Focus
selector
switch
Settings
The movement of the
subject and the scene
(recommended)
Description
*
*
[AFS]
Subject is still
(Scenery, anniversary
photograph, etc.)
“AFS” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Single”.
Focus is set automatically when the shutter button
is pressed halfway.
Focus will be fixed while it is pressed halfway.
[AFF]
Movement cannot be
predicted (Children,
pets, etc.)
“AFF” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Flexible”.
In this mode, focusing is performed automatically
when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
If the subject moves while the shutter button is
pressed halfway, the focus is corrected to match
the movement automatically.
[AFC]
Subject is moving
(Sport, trains, etc.)
“AFC” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus
Continuous”. In this mode, while the shutter
button is pressed halfway, focusing is constantly
performed to match the movement of the subject.
When the subject is moving, the focusing is
performed by predicting the subject position at the
time of recording.
Focusing is performed manually. (→128)
*
In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the setting is fixed to AF Macro even if you switch the focus selector
switch to [
] or [ ] (AF Macro).
115
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
When recording using [AFF], [AFC]
Focusing may take time if the zoom is suddenly changed from max. W to max. T, or if
you suddenly move closer to a subject from a greater distance.
Press the shutter button halfway again when it is difficult to focus on the subject.
While the shutter button pressed halfway, shake may be seen on the screen.
If the light on a subject is insufficient when using [AFF] or [AFC], the camera performs the same
focusing operation as [AFS]. In this case, the indication on the screen will change to yellow [AFS].
Not available in the following case:
The camera adjusts the focus using [AFS] in the following case:
During panorama picture recording
Switching [AF Mode]
Recording mode:
This allows the focusing method that suits the positions and number of the subjects to be
selected.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select Auto Focus mode and press
[MENU/SET]
If you press when [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] is selected, the AF
area setting screen appears. For details on operation of the AF
area setting screen, refer to (→121).
Auto Focus is fixed to [ ] (1-area-focusing) in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect])
Not available in the following case:
Cannot set to [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing) in the following case:
When [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) is set to [AFF] or [AFC]
116
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Taking front-on pictures of people (Face/Eye Detection)
The camera automatically detects the faces and eyes of subjects. The camera adjusts
the focus on the eye that is closer to the camera and the exposure using the face (when
[Metering Mode] is set to [ ] (Multi Metering)).
• The camera can detect up to 15 faces. The camera can detect only the eyes of faces to
be focused on.
When the camera recognises a face, the AF area and eye
used for focusing are displayed.
Yellow: When the shutter button is pressed halfway, the frame
turns green when the camera is focused.
White: Displayed when more than one face is detected. Other
faces that are the same distance away as faces within
the yellow AF area are also focused.
Eye used for focusing
You can change the position and size of the AF area and eye to be used for focusing.
(→121)
If [Metering Mode] is set to [ ] (Multi Metering) when [ ] (Face/Eye Detection) is selected, the
camera will adjust the exposure using the face of a subject. (→139)
Not available in the following case:
If conditions prevent the face from being recognised, such as when the movement of the subject is
too rapid, the AF Mode setting switches to [
] (49-area-focusing).
117
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Automatically locking the focus on a moving subject (AF Tracking)
1
Align the AF Tracking frame with the subject and press
the shutter button halfway
When the subject is recognised, the AF Tracking frame changes
from white to yellow, and the subject is automatically kept in focus.
If AF Lock fails, a red frame flashes for a while and then turns off.
Retry the locking operation.
To release AF Tracking → Press [MENU/SET].
Focus range: same as macro recording [
]
In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, every time you press
, AF Tracking
and Face Detection are switched.
AF Tracking frame
When you set [Metering Mode] to [ ] (Multi Metering), the camera adjusts the exposure using a
locked subject. (→139)
Under certain recording conditions, such as when the subject is small or dark, [ ] (AF Tracking)
may not operate correctly. When [
] (AF Tracking) does not work, focus will be on [ ] (1-area-
focusing).
Not available in the following cases:
[ ] (AF Tracking) cannot be used in the following case:
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
In the following cases, [ ] (AF Tracking) performs the operation of [ ] (1-area-focusing).
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Sepia], [Monochrome], [Dynamic Monochrome],
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine])
[Monochrome] in [Photo Style]
Subject not centred in picture (49-area-focusing) / , etc. (Custom Multi)
(49-area-focusing)
Focuses on the subject in the wide range area (up to 49-area-
focusing) on the recording screen.
You can select the focusing area. (→121)
118
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
, etc. (Custom Multi)
You can set the preferred shape of an AF area by selecting 49 points in the AF area,
based on the subject.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Select a Custom Multi icon ([ ], etc.), and press
When you press , the AF area setting screen appears.
3
Use to select the setting item
The currently set shape of an AF area is displayed on the bottom-
left of the screen.
([Horizontal
Pattern])
Horizontal line shape
Ideal shape for panning,
etc.
([Vertical
Pattern])
Vertical line shape
Ideal shape for recording
structures, etc.
([User
Defined])
Custom shape
/ /
(Custom)
You can set a custom registration shape.
Current AF area shape
4
Press
The AF area setting screen appears.
5
Select the AF area
The selected AF area is displayed in yellow whereas the unselected area is displayed in white.
When selecting [ ] / [ ]
When [ ] is selected, you can set the size and position of the
area in the vertical direction and when [
] is selected, you can
set the size and position of the area in the horizontal direction.
Operation of buttons Description
Moves position
Control dial Changes the size (up to three lines)
[DISP.] button Restores to the initial settings
119
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
When selecting [ ] / [ ] / [ ] / [ ]
Use to select AF area and press [MENU/SET] to set
(repeat)
If you press [MENU/SET] again, the setting will be cancelled.
To cancel all the settings, press the [DISP.] button.
6
Press [Fn2] button
Registering the set AF area in [ ], [ ], and [ ] (Custom)
Press on the screen of step
3
on (→118)
Use to select the registration target icon and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
The settings registered in [ ], [ ], or [ ] will be retained even if the camera is turned off.
The settings adjusted in [ ], [ ], or [ ] will be restored to the default settings when the
camera is turned off.
If you press the cursor button when [Direct Focus Area] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the
AF area setting screen will appear.
120
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Determined position for focus (1-area-focusing) / (Pinpoint-focusing)
(1-area-focusing)
Focuses on AF area in centre of picture. (Recommended when focus is difficult to align)
• You can change the position and size of the AF area. (→121)
Locking the focus
If a subject you want to record is not in the centre,
follow the steps below. (Only when [AFS/AFF/AFC]
is set to [AFS])
Focus display
( When focus is aligned: illuminated
When focus is not aligned: flashing)
AF area
( When focus is aligned: green
When focus is not aligned: red)
1
Adjust focus according to
subject
Align the AF
area with the
subject
Hold down
halfway
2
Return to desired composition
Press fully
(Pinpoint-focusing)
Enables more precise focusing on a smaller point than [ ] (1-area-focusing).
You can set the focus position using the enlarged screen. (→122)
When you press the shutter button halfway, an enlarged display of the focus position appears.
You can set the timeout for the enlarged display using [Pinpoint AF Time] in the [Custom] menu.
(→122)
If [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing) is selected while recording motion pictures, the setting is changed to
[
] (1-area-focusing).
Not available in the following case:
Cannot set to [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing) in the following case:
When [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) is set to [AFF] or [AFC]
121
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Changing the position and size of the AF area
When selecting [ ] / [ ]
You can change the position and size of the AF area.
Select [ ] or [ ] and press
The AF area setting screen appears.
To change the AF area
To move the position of the AF area: Press
To change the size of the AF area: Turn the control dial
If you set the AF area to an eye in the yellow frame when [
] is
selected, the eye to be used for focusing will be changed.
To restore the AF area to its initial state (position)
→ Press [DISP.] button.
Press [MENU/SET]
When selecting [ ]
You can set the focus position by selecting an AF area group. The AF area, which is
configured with 49 points, is divided into groups consisting of 9 points each (6 points or
4 points for the groups located at the edges of the screen).
Select [ ] and press
The AF area setting screen appears.
Press to select an AF area group
Press [MENU/SET]
Only the [+] indications (centre points of the selected group) remain on
the screen.
To cancel the settings for the AF area frame, press [MENU/SET].
Examples of group
122
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
When selecting [ ]
You can enlarge the screen to perform more precise settings of the focus position.
• You cannot set the focus position at the edges of the screen.
Select [ ] and press
Use to set the focus position and press [MENU/SET]
The enlarged assist screen will appear for setting the focus position.
Move [+] to the focus position with
Pressing [DISP.] button will bring the focus position back to the
centre of the assist screen.
Changing the display of the assist screen
[Custom] → [Pinpoint AF Display]
[FULL]: Enlarges the assist screen using the entire screen.
[PIP]: Enlarges the assist screen on part of the screen.
• When [PIP] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3
times to 6 times. When [FULL] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced
approximately 3 times to 10 times. Enlarge or reduce the screen by magnification
factors of x1 steps using the control dial.
Setting the timeout for the enlarged display
[Custom] → [Pinpoint AF Time] →
[LONG] (approx. 1.5 seconds) / [MID] (approx. 1.0 seconds) /
[SHORT] (approx. 0.5 seconds)
• If you release the shutter button, the enlarged display will turn off even before the
screen timeout.
123
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Enabling/disabling use of cursor button to move the AF area
[Custom] → [Direct Focus Area] → [ON] / [OFF]
When [
], [ ], or [ ] is selected, you can move the AF area and when [ ] is
selected, you can move the enlarged position.
• When [Custom Multi] such as [ ] is selected, the AF area setting screen is displayed.
• Use the Quick menu (→34) to set functions to be assigned to the cursor button, such as
[Drive Mode], [White Balance] and [Sensitivity].
When you set [Metering Mode] (→139) to [ ] (spot-focusing), the metering target will move
along with the AF area. When the AF area is moved to the edges of the screen, the metering
operation may be affected by the surrounding brightness.
Not available in the following cases:
[Direct Focus Area] is fixed to [OFF] in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set
The position and size of the AF area cannot be changed in the Digital Zoom range.
124
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Setting your preferred focusing method
You can use the [Custom] menu to set the focusing method in detail.
Enabling/disabling focus adjustment when the shutter button is
pressed halfway
[Custom] → [Shutter AF] → [ON] / [OFF]
Enabling/disabling shutter release when the shutter button is
pressed halfway
[Custom] → [Half Press Release] → [ON] / [OFF]
Focusing using the [AF/AE LOCK] button
You can use the [AF/AE LOCK] button instead of the shutter button to focus on a subject.
1
Set the [Custom] menu
[Custom] → [Shutter AF] → [OFF]
[Custom] → [AF/AE Lock] → [AF-ON]
2
Press the [AF/AE LOCK] button
The camera focuses on a subject.
3
2
3
Press the shutter button to take a picture
The camera takes a picture by adjusting the exposure.
Enabling/disabling pre-adjustment of focus
[Custom] → [Quick AF] → [ON] / [OFF]
The focus is automatically adjusted when camera blurring is small even when the shutter
button is not pressed. (Increases battery consumption)
Press shutter button halfway if focus is difficult to align.
[Quick AF] cannot be used in the following cases:
• In the [Preview] Mode
• When the lighting is low
125
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Turning on/off the AF Assist Lamp
[Custom] → [AF Assist Lamp] → [ON] / [OFF]
Illuminates the AF Assist Lamp when the shutter button is pressed halfway when it is too
dark to facilitate focusing. (A large AF area is displayed based on recording conditions.)
The AF Assist Lamp has an effective distance of 1.5 m (4.9 feet).
AF Assist Lamp is effective for a subject at the centre of the screen. Use the lamp by
positioning a subject at the centre of the screen.
If you do not want to illuminate the AF Assist Lamp when you take a picture in a dark
location (e.g. taking a picture of an animal in the dark), set this function to [OFF]. When
the AF Assist Lamp is set to [OFF], sharper focusing will become difficult.
The setting is fixed to [OFF] in the following case:
• When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
Enabling/disabling recording when a subject is out of focus
[Custom] → [Focus/Release Priority]
[FOCUS]: Recording is disabled unless the focusing is performed properly.
[RELEASE]: Recording is performed when you fully press the shutter button to
place priority on the shutter release timing that helps to avoid missed
opportunities.
Note that a picture may be out of focus when [RELEASE] is set, even if the focus mode
is set to [AFS], [AFF], or [AFC].
This function is disabled during motion picture recording.
Enabling/disabling manual focus adjustment after AF
[Custom] → [AF+MF] → [ON] / [OFF]
You can manually perform fine focusing during AF Lock (pressing the shutter button
halfway when [AFS/AFF/AFC] is set to [AFS] or setting AF Lock using the [AF/AE LOCK]
button).
126
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking close-up pictures
(Macro recording)
Recording mode:
When you want to enlarge the subject, setting to [ ] (AF Macro) enables you to take
pictures at an even closer distance than the normal focus range (up to 3 cm (0.098 feet)
for max. Wide).
1
Switch the focus selector
switch to [ ]
Enables close-
up focusing on
a subject. (Auto
Focus functions.)
Align with the
indicator.
Focus range
When a subject is too close to the camera, the picture may not be properly focused.
Shortest recording distance
The shortest recording distance is the distance from the lens front to the subject. This
distance changes gradually depending on the zoom position.
Max. Wide
Max. Tele
0.03 m (0.098 feet)
0.3 m (0.98 feet)
When the focus selector switch
is set to [
] (AF Macro).
Focus selector
switch
Zoom
Max. Wide Max. Tele
[
] 50 cm (1.6 feet) 50 cm (1.6 feet)
[
]
(AF Macro)
3 cm (0.098 feet) 30 cm (0.98 feet)
[
] (→128) 3 cm (0.098 feet) 30 cm (0.98 feet)
Focus range is displayed when operating the zoom, etc.
Focus range
127
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking close-up pictures (Macro recording)
In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the shortest recording distance will be the same as that for [ ],
regardless of the focus selector switch setting.
It may take some time until distant subjects come into focus.
Using a tripod and [Self Timer] is recommended. Also, when recording a subject close to the
camera, we recommend taking a picture without using the flash.
Moving the camera after aligning the focus is likely to result in poorly focused pictures if subject is
close to the camera, due to the margin for focus alignment being severely reduced.
Resolution may be reduced around the edges of the picture.
128
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Recording mode:
Manual Focus is convenient when you want to lock the focus to take pictures or when it is
difficult to adjust focus using Auto Focus.
1
Switch the focus selector
switch to [ ]
Focus manually
on a subject.
Align with the
indicator.
2
Press [ ] button ( )
3
Press to determine the area to
be enlarged, and press [MENU/SET]
• The screen changes to the assist screen and an
enlarged display appears. (MF Assist) (→131)
• If you press [DISP.] button, the area to be enlarged will
be reset to the centre.
4
Turn the control ring to adjust focus
Turning the control ring to the right:
Focusing on a nearby subject
Turning the control ring to the left:
Focusing on a distant subject
• Colour is added to the portions of the image that are in
focus. (Peaking) (→130)
• You can confirm the direction of focus adjustment
toward the close distance side or far distance side.
(MF Guide) (→129)
MF Assist
(Enlarged screen)
Peaking
Indicator for
(infinity)
MF Guide
After zoom operation, readjust the focus.
After cancelling [Sleep Mode], be sure to readjust the focus.
129
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Enabling/disabling MF Guide display
[Custom] → [MF Guide] → [ON] / [OFF]
Quickly adjusting the focus using Auto Focus
[Custom] → [AF/AE Lock] → [AF-ON]
If you press the [AF/AE LOCK] button in Manual Focus, Auto Focus is activated.
Auto Focus is activated at the centre of the frame.
When Auto Focus is activated on the MF Assist screen, the
camera will adjust the focus at the centre of the MF Assist
screen.
130
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Enabling/disabling [Peaking] to add colour to the portions of the
image that are in focus
[Custom] → [Peaking]
[Peaking] functions during Manual Focus or when you are adjusting focus manually
using [AF+MF].
[ON] Colour is added to the portions of the image that are in focus.
[OFF] The portions of the image that are in focus are not displayed.
[SET]
[Detect
Level]
The detection level for in-focus portions is set.
When [HIGH] is set, portions to be highlighted are reduced, allowing you to
achieve a more precise focus.
Settings: [HIGH] / [LOW]
The detection level setting does not affect the focus range.
[Display
Color]
Sets the highlighting colour used for [Peaking].
Settings
The available colour settings differ depending on the setting of [Detect
Level].
Changing the [Detect Level] setting also changes the [Display Color]
setting as follows.
[Detect Level] [HIGH] [LOW]
[Display Color]
[
] (Light blue) [ ] (Blue)
[
] (Yellow) [ ] (Orange)
[
] (Green) [ ] (White)
When [Peaking] is set to [ON], [ ] ([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) or [ ] ([Detect Level]:
[LOW]) will be displayed.
When [Fn Button Set] (→37) in the [Custom] menu is set to [Peaking], you can switch the setting
in the following order every time the assigned function button is pressed: [ON] ([Detect Level]:
[LOW]) → [ON] ([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) → [OFF].
Since portions with clear outlines on the screen are highlighted as in-focus portions, portions to be
highlighted vary depending on the recording conditions.
The colour used for highlighting does not affect recorded pictures.
Not available in the following case:
[Peaking] does not function in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome])
131
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
MF Assist
Displaying the MF Assist
• Turn the control ring to display MF Assist.
• You can also display MF Assist by pressing
to display the setting screen, pressing
the cursor button to set the position to be enlarged, and then pressing [MENU/SET].
• When you perform the following operation, the position to be enlarged will be returned
to the centre.
When you press the [DISP.] button on the screen used for setting of the position to
be enlarged
• If you press the cursor button when [Direct Focus Area] in the [Custom] menu is set to
[ON], the setting screen for the enlarged position appears.
Closing the MF Assist
• To exit MF Assist, press the shutter button halfway.
• You can also exit MF Assist by pressing [MENU/SET].
• When you display MF Assist by turning the control ring, MF Assist is automatically
ended approximately 10 seconds after you finish the operation.
Not available in the following case:
The MF Assist is disabled in the Digital Zoom range or when recording motion pictures.
Setting the display method of MF Assist
[Custom] → [MF Assist]
[ ]
Turn the control ring or press the [
] button ( ) to enlarge the position.
[
]
Turn the control ring to enlarge the position.
[
]
Press the [
] button ( ) to enlarge the position.
[OFF]
The control ring or [
] button ( ) cannot be used to enlarge the position.
132
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Changing the MF Assist display
[Custom] → [MF Assist Display]
[FULL]: Enlarges the assist screen using the entire screen.
[PIP]: Enlarges the assist screen on part of the screen.
• When [PIP] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3
times to 6 times. When [FULL] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced
approximately 3 times to 10 times. Enlarge or reduce the screen by magnification
factors of x1 steps using the control dial.
133
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure
[AF/AE Lock]
Recording mode:
The AF/AE Lock function is convenient, for example, when there is too much contrast with
the subject and you cannot get appropriate exposure (AE Lock) or when you want to take
a still picture composed with the subject outside the AF area (AF Lock).
1
Point the camera at the subject
2
Lock the focus and/or exposure while you
press and hold the [AF/AE LOCK] button
• When you release the [AF/AE LOCK] button, the focus
and/or exposure lock is cancelled.
• Only the exposure is locked at the time of purchase.
3
While you press and hold the
[AF/AE LOCK] button, move the camera to
compose the picture you want to take and
fully press the shutter button
• When [AE LOCK] is set, press the shutter button
halfway to focus, then press it fully.
:
Focus is locked (AF Lock)
Setting the function of the [AF/AE LOCK] button
[Custom] → [AF/AE Lock]
[AE LOCK]
Locks exposure only.
[AEL], aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the correct
exposure is achieved.
[AF LOCK]
Locks focus only.
[AFL], focus, aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the subject
comes into focus.
[AF/AE LOCK]
Locks focus and exposure.
[AFL], [AEL], focus, aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the
subject is in focus and the correct exposure is achieved.
[AF-ON] Auto Focus is activated.
Maintaining/not maintaining the lock when [AF/AE LOCK] button is
released
[Custom] → [AF/AE Lock Hold] → [ON] / [OFF]
134
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure [AF/AE Lock]
AF Lock only is effective in the following case:
[Manual Exposure] Mode
During Manual Focus, only AE Lock can be used.
Only the AF Lock is enabled when you are recording motion pictures. Once you cancel AF Lock
while recording motion pictures, you cannot perform the AF Lock operation again.
The subject can be focused again by pressing the shutter button halfway, even when AE is locked.
Programme Shift can be set even when AE is locked.
Lock is cancelled when a zoom operation is performed after locking the exposure and/or focus.
Perform the locking operation again.
135
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Taking pictures with Exposure Compensation
Recording mode:
Corrects the exposure when there is a backlight or when the subject is too dark or too
bright.
1
Turn the exposure compensation dial to
select the compensation value
Under-exposed Optimum exposure Over-exposed
Adjust the exposure to the [+] direction Adjust the exposure to the [-] direction
• You can set the exposure compensation value in the range between –3 EV and
+3 EV.
Depending on the brightness, this may not be possible in some cases.
When [Auto Exposure Comp.] of [Flash] in the [Rec] menu is set to [ON], the flash output is also
automatically adjusted based on the exposure compensation value. (→183)
136
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Setting the ISO Sensitivity
Recording mode:
Set ISO Sensitivity (sensitivity to lighting) manually.
We recommend higher settings to take clear pictures in darker locations.
1
Press [ISO] button ( )
2
Turn the control dial to select ISO
Sensitivity and press [MENU/SET]
AUTO
ISO Sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200
*
1
depending
on the brightness of a subject.
(Intelligent ISO)
ISO Sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200
*
1
depending
on the movement and brightness of a subject.
100
*
2
/200/400/800/1600/
3200/6400/12800/25600
ISO Sensitivity is xed at the selected setting.
When [ISO Increments] is set to [1/3EV], more ISO Sensitivity
settings can be selected. (→138)
*
1
When [ISO Limit Set] (→137) in the [Rec] menu is set to other than [OFF], the ISO Sensitivity is
automatically set in the range up to the [ISO Limit Set] setting value.
*
2
Only when [Extended ISO] is [ON].
Setting guide
Sensitivity [200] [25600]
Location
(recommended)
Bright
(outdoors)
Dark
Shutter speed Slow Fast
Interference Low High
Subject blur High Low
137
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Setting the ISO Sensitivity
When [High Dynamic] is selected for the picture effect (Filter), [Sensitivity] is fixed to [AUTO].
When a picture effect (Filter) other than [High Dynamic] is selected or when [Multi Exp.] is set, ISO
Sensitivity can be set in a range up to [3200].
For details on the available flash range used when the [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO], refer to
(→177).
Cannot select [ ] in the following cases:
[Shutter-Priority] Mode
[Manual Exposure] Mode
When [Direct Focus Area] (→123) is set to [ON], the cursor button functions as an operation for
moving the AF area. In that case, use the Quick menu (→34) to set the ISO Sensitivity.
You can use the following settings when recording motion pictures:
[AUTO], [200] - [6400]
Setting the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity
Recording mode:
You can set the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or [ ].
[Rec] → [ISO Limit Set]
Settings: [400] / [800] / [1600] / [3200] / [6400] / [12800] / [25600] / [OFF]
Not available in the following case:
During motion picture recording
138
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Setting the ISO Sensitivity
Setting the incremental value of ISO Sensitivity
Recording mode:
You can change the setting to increase ISO Sensitivity by 1 EV or 1/3 EV.
[Rec] → [ISO Increments]
[1/3EV]
[L.100]
*
/ [L.125]
*
/ [L.160]
*
/ [200] / [250] / [320] / [400] / [500] / [640] / [800] / [1000] /
[1250] / [1600] / [2000] / [2500] / [3200] / [4000] / [5000] / [6400] / [8000] / [10000] /
[12800] / [16000] / [20000] / [25600]
[1 EV]
[L.100]
*
/ [200] / [400] / [800] / [1600] / [3200] / [6400] / [12800] / [25600]
*
Only when [Extended ISO] is [ON].
When this setting is changed from [1/3EV] to [1 EV], the setting for [Sensitivity] may be changed.
(The closest ISO Sensitivity that can be set for [1 EV] will be used.)
Extending the ISO Sensitivity setting
Recording mode:
You can extend the numeric values that can be set for ISO Sensitivity.
[Rec] → [Extended ISO]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
139
SQW0024
Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure)
Setting the metering mode
Recording mode:
You can change the metering method used for measuring brightness.
[Rec] → [Metering Mode]
[Metering Mode] Brightness measurement position Conditions
(Multiple)
Whole screen
Normal usage
(produces balanced pictures)
(Centre weighted)
Centre and surrounding area Subject in centre
(Spot)
Centre of [+] (spot metering target)
Spot metering target
Great difference between
brightness of subject and
background
(e.g. person in spotlight on stage,
backlighting)
• The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting
in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be
changed automatically.
140
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Setting the Shutter Type
Recording mode:
You can take pictures using two types of shutter modes: the mechanical shutter and
electronic shutter.
Mechanical shutter Electronic shutter
Description
Starts the exposure electronically
and ends the exposure using the
mechanical shutter.
Starts and ends the exposure
electronically.
Flash
Shutter Speed
(seconds)
60 - 1/4000
1
*
1
- 1/16000
Shutter sound
Mechanical shutter sound
*
2
+
Electronic shutter sound
*
3
Electronic shutter sound
*
3
*
1
You can set ISO Sensitivity up to [ISO 3200]. When ISO Sensitivity is higher than [ISO 3200], the
shutter speed will be faster than 1 second.
*
2
You cannot turn off the mechanical shutter sound.
*
3
You can use [Shutter Vol.] to adjust the volume of the electronic shutter sound. (→43)
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Shutter Type]
[AUTO]
The shutter mode automatically switches based on the recording conditions
and shutter speed.
The mechanical shutter mode has higher priority over the electronic
shutter mode because the mechanical shutter has less function-related
restrictions when recording with a flash, etc.
[MSHTR] Uses only the mechanical shutter mode to take a picture.
[ESHTR] Uses only the electronic shutter mode to take a picture.
When [ ] is displayed on the screen, the electronic shutter is used to take a picture.
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH], the electronic shutter is used to take a picture.
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], the electronic shutter is used to take a picture.
If you take a picture of a moving subject using the electronic shutter, the subject in the
picture may be skewed in some cases.
When you take a picture under a fluorescent or LED lighting fixture using the electronic
shutter, the recorded picture may have horizontal stripes. If you use a slower shutter
speed, the horizontal stripes may be reduced. (→84)
Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, likeness rights, etc. of a subject when you
use this function. Use at your own risk.
141
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Selecting a Drive Mode
Recording mode:
You can switch the operation to be performed when you press the shutter button.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the drive mode and
press [MENU/SET]
Drive Mode
[Single] When the shutter button is pressed, only one picture is recorded.
[Burst] (→142)
The pictures are recorded in succession while the shutter button is
pressed.
[Auto Bracket]
*
(→145)
Each time the shutter button is pressed, the pictures are
recorded with different exposure settings based on the Exposure
Compensation range.
[Aspect Bracket]
*
(→147)
When the shutter button is pressed, 4 pictures with 4 different aspect
ratios are automatically recorded.
[Self Timer]
(→148)
When the shutter button is pressed, recording takes place after the
set time has elapsed.
[Panorama
Shot]
*
(→150)
The pictures are recorded in succession while you press the shutter
button and move the camera horizontally or vertically, and then the
camera combines the pictures into a single panorama picture.
*
Cannot be set when using [Intelligent Auto] Mode.
• To cancel drive mode, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ]. The recording is switched to
“Single”.
• When you press , you can change the settings of each drive mode. Note,
however, that you cannot change the settings of [Single] and [Aspect Bracket].
142
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Burst function
Recording mode:
The pictures are recorded in succession while the shutter button is pressed.
• Pictures that are taken while the [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] are recorded together as a
single burst group (→201).
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the burst icon ([ ],
etc.) and press
3
Press to select the burst speed and
press [MENU/SET]
[SH]
(Super high
speed)
*
1
[H]
(High speed)
[M]
(Middle
speed)
[L]
(Low speed)
Speed
(pictures/
sec.)
[AFS] 40 11 7 2
[AFF] / [AFC] 6.5 6.5 2
Live View during burst
recording
None None Available Available
No. of
pictures
*
2
With RAW files
20
*
3
20
*
3
20
*
3
Without RAW
files
60
Depends on the capacity of the card
*
3
*
1
The electronic shutter will be activated.
*
2
The number of burst pictures is limited by the picture-taking conditions and the type and/or
status of the card used.
*
3
Pictures can be taken until the card becomes full. However, the burst speed will become
slower halfway through the recording. The exact time when the slower burst speed will start
depends on the settings of the aspect ratio, picture size, and quality as well as the type of
card used.
• The burst speed may become slower depending on the following settings:
[Picture Size] (→108), [Quality] (→109), Sensitivity (→136), Focus mode
(→114), [Focus/Release Priority] (→125)
• Burst speed can also be set with [Burst Rate] in the [Rec] menu.
• For information about RAW files, refer to (→109).
143
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Burst function
4
Focus on the subject and take a picture
• Hold down the shutter button fully to activate the Burst
Mode.
50
i
To cancel burst
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
Focusing in burst mode
Focusing varies depending on the focus mode (→114) and the setting of [Focus/Release
Priority] (→125) in the [Custom] menu.
Focus mode [Focus/Release Priority] Focus
[AFS]
[FOCUS]
At the first picture
[RELEASE]
[AFF] / [AFC]
*
1
[FOCUS]
Normal focusing
*
2
[RELEASE]
Predicted focusing
*
3
[MF] Focus set with Manual Focus
*
1
Focus is fixed in the first picture when dark subjects are recorded or the burst speed is set to [SH].
*
2
Since the camera records a burst of pictures while it adjusts the focus, the burst speed may be
slower.
*
3
The camera predicts the focus within a possible range by giving higher priority to the burst speed.
144
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Burst function
When the burst speed is set to [H] and if many burst pictures are taken, the burst speed may be
reduced while burst pictures are being taken.
When the burst speed is set to [SH] or [H] (the focus mode is set to [AFS] or [MF]), and the
exposure and White Balance are fixed to those of the first picture.
When the burst speed is set to [H] (the focus mode is set to [AFF] or [AFC]), [M], or [L], and the
exposure and White Balance are adjusted individually for each still picture.
Burst speed may be reduced if shutter speed (pictures/sec.) is reduced in darker locations.
With repeated recordings, it may take a while between recordings, depending on the usage
conditions.
It may take a while to store still pictures that were taken using the burst function. If you
continue to record while storing, the number of burst pictures that can be taken will be
reduced. A high-speed card is recommended when recording using the burst function.
Not available in the following cases:
The Burst Mode is disabled in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome],
[Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine])
When White Balance Bracket is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
During motion picture recording
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
When recording using the flash
During T (time) recording
When recording with [iHandheld Night Shot]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
[SH] in Burst Mode cannot be used In the following cases:
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
145
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Recording while exposure is changed automatically
[Auto Bracket]
Recording mode:
Each time the shutter button is pressed, recordings are made of up to 7 pictures with
different exposure settings based on the Exposure Compensation range.
Example of Auto Bracket recording when [Step] is set to [3·1/3] and [Sequence]
is set to [0/–/+]
1st picture 2nd picture 3rd picture
±0 EV –1/3 EV +1/3 EV
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the Auto Bracket icon
([ ], etc.) and press
3
Press to select the compensation
range and press [MENU/SET]
4
Focus on the subject and take a picture
• If you press and hold the shutter button, a burst of
pictures can be recorded.
• The display of Auto Bracket flashes until all of the burst
pictures you have set are recorded.
• The camera restarts recording from the first still picture
if you change the Auto Bracket settings or turn off the
camera before all of the burst pictures you have set
are recorded.
50
i
To cancel [Auto Bracket]
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
146
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Recording while exposure is changed automatically [Auto Bracket]
Changing the Single/Burst setting, compensation range, and recording sequence
of Auto Bracket
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Auto Bracket]
Press to select [Single/Burst Settings], [Step] or [Sequence] and press
[MENU/SET]
Press to select the setting and press [MENU/SET]
[Single/Burst
Settings]
(single)
(burst)
[Step]
3·1/3 (3 pictures)
3·2/3 (3 pictures)
3·1 (3 pictures)
5·1/3 (5 pictures)
5·2/3 (5 pictures)
5·1 (5 pictures)
7·1/3 (7 pictures)
7·2/3 (7 pictures)
7·1 (7 pictures)
[Sequence]
0/–/+
–/0/+
You can take one picture at a time when [
] is set.
A burst of pictures can be recorded up to the number of pictures you have set when [
] is set.
Close the menu after changing settings.
When you take pictures using Auto Bracket after performing Exposure Compensation, the camera
will take pictures using the corrected exposure value as a reference.
Not available in the following cases:
The [Auto Bracket] is disabled in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome],
[Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine])
When White Balance Bracket is set
During motion picture recording
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
When recording using the flash
During T (time) recording
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
147
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Automatically changing the aspect ratio while taking
pictures
[Aspect Bracket]
Recording mode:
When you press the shutter button once, the camera automatically takes four pictures
with four types of aspect ratios (4:3, 3:2, 16:9, and 1:1). (The shutter sounds only once.)
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the aspect bracket icon
([ ]) and press [MENU/SET]
The range that can be
recorded for each aspect
ratio is displayed.
3
Focus on the subject and take a picture
To cancel aspect bracket
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
When [Picture Size] is set to [S], the setting is automatically changed to [M].
The same shutter speed, aperture value, focus, [Exposure], [White Balance], and [Sensitivity]
settings are used for all four pictures.
Not available in the following cases:
The [Aspect Bracket] is disabled in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Toy Effect],
[Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine])
During motion picture recording
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
During T (time) recording
When White Balance Bracket is set
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
148
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Taking pictures with self-timer
Recording mode:
We recommend using a tripod. This is also effective for preventing jitter when pressing
the shutter button, by setting the self-timer to 2 seconds.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the self-timer icon
([ ], etc.) and press
3
Press to select the self-timer
operation setting and press [MENU/SET]
The shutter is activated after 10 seconds.
The shutter is activated after 10 seconds and three
pictures are taken at intervals of approximately
2 seconds.
The shutter is activated after 2 seconds.
• You can also set the time for the self-timer using [Self
Timer] in the [Rec] menu.
4
Press the shutter button halfway to focus,
then press it fully to start recording
• The focus and exposure are fixed when the shutter
button is pressed halfway.
• After the self-timer indicator flashes, recording will
start.
To cancel self-timer
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
• You can cancel the self-timer by turning off the camera. (When [Self Timer Auto Off]
(→50) is set to [ON].)
149
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Taking pictures with self-timer
If you take a picture with a flash when [ ] is set, the flash output may not be stable in some
cases.
Not available in the following cases:
It cannot be set to [ ] in the following cases:
When White Balance Bracket is set
When [Multi Exp.] is set
During T (time) recording
Self-timer is disabled in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting)
150
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Recording panorama pictures
Recording mode:
You can easily record a panorama picture by panning the camera towards the direction
you want to record, and automatically combining the burst of pictures taken during that
time.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the panorama icon ([ ], etc.)
and press
3
Press to select the recording direction and then press
[MENU/SET]
Left → Right
A horizontal guide line is displayed.
Right → Left
Down → Up
A vertical guide line is displayed.
Up → Down
• You can also select the recording direction using [Panorama Direction] in the
[Rec] menu.
Applying a picture effect (Filter)
Press the [FILTER] button to select a picture effect
(→89)
Recording direction
Picture effects
(This is not displayed when [No Effect] is selected.)
Adjusting the picture effect
(This is displayed only when a picture effect is selected.)
You can also set the picture effects by turning the control
ring.
[Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect], and [Sunshine] are
not available.
When recording panorama pictures, the following effects are not applied to the recording
screen.
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter]
Press [MENU/SET]
4
Press the shutter button halfway to focus
151
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Recording panorama pictures
5
Press the shutter button fully and pan the camera in a small
circular motion to the recording direction to start recording
Taking pictures from left to right
Recording direction and progress status
(approximate)
1 sec.
2 sec.
3 sec.
4 sec.
• Pan the camera at a constant speed.
• You may not be able to take pictures successfully if you move the camera too
quickly or too slowly.
6
Press the shutter button fully again to end recording
• You can also end recording if you stop panning the camera while taking pictures.
• Recording can also be ended by moving the camera to the end of the guide.
Tips
Pan the camera in the recording direction as steadily as possible.
If the camera shakes too much, it may not be
able to take pictures or may end up creating a
narrow (small) panorama picture.
Pan the camera to a point slightly ahead of the point that you want to take.
(However, the last frame is not recorded to the end.)
152
SQW0024
Shutter and Drive Settings
Recording panorama pictures
About panorama picture playback
Panorama pictures can be enlarged by operating the zoom lever the same way as with
other still pictures. If you play back panorama pictures in the same way as playing back
a motion picture, the panorama pictures are scrolled automatically. (→70)
• Unlike motion picture playback, you cannot perform fast forward or fast rewind while
the panorama pictures are scrolling automatically. (You can perform single-frame
forward or rewind while the automatic scrolling operation is paused.)
To cancel
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
The zoom position is fixed to the W end.
[Stabilizer] does not work when it is set to [ ] (Normal).
Since the aperture value and shutter speed are automatically controlled during panorama picture
recording, settings made by the aperture ring or shutter speed dial are disabled.
The focus, exposure and White Balance are all fixed to optimal values for the first picture.
If the focusing or brightness of pictures recorded as part of a panorama picture after the first
picture are significantly different from those of the first picture, the panorama picture as a whole
(when all pictures are stitched together) may not have consistent focus and brightness.
When the picture effect (Filter) is set, [White Balance] is fixed to [AWB].
Since several pictures are stitched together to create a panorama picture, some subjects may be
distorted or the joining portions of successively taken pictures that are stitched may be noticeable.
The number of recording pixels per horizontal line and vertical line of a panorama picture varies
depending on the recording direction and number of stitched pictures.
The maximum number of recording pixels is as follows:
Taking pictures in landscape orientation: Approx. 8176×1920
Taking pictures in portrait orientation: Approx. 2560×7680
[Shutter Type] is fixed to [AUTO].
Not available in the following cases:
You cannot record a panorama picture in the following cases.
When White Balance Bracket is set
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
During T (time) recording
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
When [Silent Mode] is set
When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON]
Panorama pictures may not be created or pictures may not be recorded properly when taking
pictures of the following subjects or when taking pictures in the following recording conditions:
Subjects that have a continuous monotone or pattern (sky, beach, etc.)
Moving subjects (person, pet, vehicle, waves, or flowers swaying in the wind, etc.)
Subjects whose colours or patterns change quickly (such as an image appearing on a display)
Dark locations
Locations with a flickering light source (fluorescent lamp, candle light, etc.)
153
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Taking pictures automatically at set intervals
[Time Lapse Shot]
Recording mode:
You can preset data such as recording start time and time lapse to take still pictures
automatically. This setting is convenient for taking pictures at constant intervals for
landscape scenes, observation of the gradual changes in animals/plants, and other
applications. The pictures are recorded as a single group picture (→201). When [Time
Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu is used, you can create a motion picture. (→215)
• Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→29)
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Time Lapse Shot]
2
Press to select the item and press
[MENU/SET]
[Start Time] [Now] Starts the recording by fully-pressing the shutter button.
[Start Time
Set]
Set the time to start recording. Any time up to 23 hours
59 minutes ahead can be set.
Press to select the item (hour and/or minute),
and to set the start time, and then press
[MENU/SET]
[Shooting
Interval] /
[Image
Count]
The recording interval and the number of pictures can be set.
: Select the item (minute/second/number of pictures)
: Setting
[MENU/SET]: Set
You can set the interval from 1 second to 99 minutes 59 seconds in
1-second intervals.
You can set the number of pictures to be recorded from 1 picture to 9,999
pictures.
Be sure to use an interval
setting that is longer than the exposure time
(shutter speed)
. (Illustration below)
If the interval
setting is shorter than the exposure time (shutter speed)
(e.g. recording at night), it may cause the recording to skip.
First Second Third
3
Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
154
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot]
4
Press the shutter button fully
• The recording starts automatically.
• During recording standby, the camera turns off automatically when no operation
is performed for a preset interval. The [Time Lapse Shot] recording will continue
even if the camera is turned off, and the camera is automatically turned on at the
recording start time. If you want to turn on the camera manually, press the shutter
button halfway.
• When you press the [Fn2] button while the camera is turned on, the pause or end
selection screen will appear. Perform the operation based on the instructions on
the screen. When you press the [Fn2] button while the camera is in the pause
state, the restart or end selection screen will appear. You can also restart the
operation from the pause state by fully pressing the shutter button.
• When a confirmation screen for continuing the creation of a motion picture is
displayed, select [Yes].
5
Select the motion picture creation method
• [Rec Format]: [MP4]
[Rec Quality]
Sets the picture quality of the motion picture.
[4K/25p] / [4K/24p] / [FHD/50p] / [FHD/25p] / [HD/25p] / [VGA/25p]
[Frame Rate]
Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you
can create a more seamless stop motion animation.
[50fps]
*
/ [25fps] / [12.5fps] / [8.3fps] / [6.25fps] / [5fps] / [2.5fps] / [1fps]
*
Only available with [FHD/50p] setting
You can set the number of frames to [24fps], [12fps], [8fps], [6fps], [4.8fps],
[2.4fps], or [1fps] when [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/24p].
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence.
[REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording.
6
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes],
the operation is executed.
• You can also create a motion picture using [Time
Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu. (→215)
155
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot]
This function is not intended for application-specific systems (monitoring cameras).
If you leave the camera unattended during [Time Lapse Shot] recording, make sure that the
camera is not stolen.
Exercise caution when you perform [Time Lapse Shot] recording for a long period of time
in cold regions or in a low-temperature or high-temperature/high-humidity environment,
since such use could cause malfunctions.
The camera may not be able to record using the preset interval and number of pictures to be
recorded under some recording conditions.
If the recording time is longer than the preset interval due to a long exposure, this may cause the
recording to skip.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
[Time Lapse Shot] is paused in the following cases:
When the remaining battery power runs out
Turning the camera off
If this occurs during [Time Lapse Shot] recording, you can restart the operation by replacing
the battery or card in the pause state and turning the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [ON]. (Note,
however, that the pictures recorded after restarting the operation are saved as another group
picture.) When you replace the battery or card, turn the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [OFF].
Do not connect the AV cable (optional), HDMI micro cable or USB connection cable (supplied)
during [Time Lapse Shot] recording.
When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, the
picture will be displayed with a black band on the upper/lower side or the left/right side of a stop
motion animation.
If the power supply is cut off due to a power outage or AC adaptor disconnection while a motion
picture is being recorded using the AC adaptor (optional), that motion picture will not be recorded.
You cannot create a motion picture that is longer than 29 minutes 59 seconds, or whose file
exceeds 4 GB.
When a stop motion animation is shorter than 2 seconds, “2s” will be displayed for the motion
picture recording time (→70).
When the number of recorded pictures is one, it will not be saved as a group picture.
Not available in the following cases:
[Time Lapse Shot] cannot be used In the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
156
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Creating stop motion animation
[Stop Motion Animation]
Recording mode:
You can stitch still pictures to create stop motion animation.
Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→29)
• Still pictures that were captured using frame-by-frame recording are grouped into a
single group picture. (→201)
Before creating stop motion animation
When you use [Stop Motion Animation] to record still pictures by moving a subject such
as a doll little by little and then stitching those pictures, you can create a stop motion
animation as if the subject is moving.
To create stop motion animation using this camera, it is necessary to record 1 to
50 frames of still pictures for every 1 second of motion picture.
To produce smooth movement of the subject, record the motion using as many frames
as possible and set a higher number of frames per second (frame rate) when you
create a stop motion animation.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Stop Motion Animation]
2
Press to select the recording method,
and press [MENU/SET]
[Auto
Shooting]
[ON] Takes pictures automatically at a set recording interval. When the
shutter button is pressed fully, recording starts.
[OFF] Takes pictures manually, one frame at a time.
[Shooting
Interval]
(Available only when [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON])
Set the interval used for [Auto Shooting]. You can set the interval from 1 second
to 60 seconds in 1-second intervals.
Press to select the interval (seconds), press to set the
selected time, and then press [MENU/SET]
157
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation]
3
Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
4
Press to select [New] and press
[MENU/SET]
5
Press the shutter button fully
• Up to 9,999 frames can be recorded.
6
Move the subject to decide on the
composition
• Repeat the recording of still pictures in the same way.
• When you turn off the camera during recording, a message to restart recording
will appear when you turn on the camera. To start recording from the next still
picture, select [Yes].
How to create stop motion animation effectively
Up to two previously recorded pictures are displayed on the recording screen.
Check this screen as a guideline for determining the amount of required motion.
You can press the Playback button to check the recorded pictures. Press the
[ ] button to delete unnecessary pictures. To return to the recording screen,
press the Playback button again.
7
Press [MENU/SET] to end recording. Next, select [Stop Motion
Animation] in the [Rec] menu and then press [MENU/SET]
again
• A confirmation screen is displayed. It is ended when [Yes] is selected.
• A confirmation screen for creating a motion picture is displayed next, so select
[Yes].
8
Select a method to create a stop motion animation
• [Rec Format]: [MP4]
[Rec Quality]
Sets the picture quality of the motion picture.
[4K/25p] / [4K/24p] / [FHD/50p] / [FHD/25p] / [HD/25p] / [VGA/25p]
[Frame Rate]
Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you
can create a more seamless stop motion animation.
[50fps]
*
/ [25fps] / [12.5fps] / [8.3fps] / [6.25fps] / [5fps] / [2.5fps] / [1fps]
*
Only available with [FHD/50p] setting
You can set the number of frames to [24fps], [12fps], [8fps], [6fps], [4.8fps],
[2.4fps], or [1fps] when [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/24p].
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence.
[REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording.
158
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation]
9
Press to select [OK] and press
[MENU/SET]
• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes],
the operation is executed.
• You can also create a stop motion animation using
[Stop Motion Video] in the [Playback] menu. (→215)
Adding pictures to an already recorded stop motion animation group
When you select [Additional] in step
4
, group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion
Animation] are displayed. Select a group picture and press [MENU/SET]. Then, select
[Yes] on the confirmation screen.
[Auto Shooting] may not be performed according to the preset interval because recording could
take time under some recording conditions, such as when pictures are taken using a flash.
When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, the
picture will be displayed with a black band on the upper/lower side or the left/right side of a stop
motion animation.
When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, this
will produce grainy pictures in a stop motion animation.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
If the power supply is cut off due to a power outage or AC adaptor disconnection while a motion
picture is being recorded using the AC adaptor (optional), that motion picture will not be recorded.
You cannot create a motion picture that is longer than 29 minutes 59 seconds, or whose file
exceeds 4 GB.
When a stop motion animation is shorter than 2 seconds, “2s” will be displayed for the motion
picture recording time (→70).
If only one still picture is recorded, it will not be recorded as a group picture. You cannot select
only one recorded still picture using [Additional].
Not available in the following cases:
[Stop Motion Animation] cannot be used in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON]
159
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Performing multiple exposures for a single picture
[Multi Exp.]
Recording mode:
You can create an effect similar to the operation of up to four times of exposure on a
single picture.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Multi Exp.]
2
Press to select [Start] and press
[MENU/SET]
3
Decide on your composition and take the
first picture
• After recording the first picture, press the shutter
button halfway to proceed to the next recording.
• Press to select the item and then press [MENU/
SET]. You can perform the following operations.
[Next]: Proceed to the next recording.
[Retake]: Delete the result of the last shot and take
another picture.
[Exit]: Exit Multi Exposure and save the picture that
was taken.
Next
Retake
Exit
4
Record the second, third, and fourth
pictures
• When you press [Fn1] button while taking pictures, the
pictures that you took are saved and Multi Exposure
is closed.
Retake
Exit
5
Press to select [Exit] and press
[MENU/SET]
• You can also end the operation by pressing the shutter
button halfway.
160
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Performing multiple exposures for a single picture [Multi Exp.]
About the automatic gain compensation setting
Select [Auto Gain] on the screen in step
2
(→159).
[ON]: Combines several pictures into one by automatically adjusting the brightness in
accordance with the number of pictures taken.
[OFF]: Combines several pictures into one by simply overlapping the exposure
results of all pictures, as is. Perform the Exposure Compensation based on
the requirements of a subject.
To overlay the pictures on the RAW file picture in a card
Set [Overlay] to [ON] on the screen in step
2
(→159). After selecting [Start], the
pictures on a card will be displayed. Select the RAW file pictures and press [MENU/
SET] to continue recording.
• You can perform [Overlay] on RAW file pictures recorded using this camera only.
Pictures are not saved in memory until Multi Exposure is ended.
Information for the picture taken last will be used as recording information of pictures taken using
Multi Exposure.
While [Multi Exp.] recording is being performed, you cannot set items displayed in grey on the
menu screen.
Not available in the following cases:
[Multi Exp.] cannot be used in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set
During panorama picture recording
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
161
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time
[Silent Mode]
Recording mode:
This mode is useful when you are taking pictures in a quiet environment or public facilities
or when you take pictures of a subject such as a baby or animal.
1
Set the menu
[Custom] → [Silent Mode]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
• This mode will mute beeps, set the flash to [Forced Flash Off], and disable AF
Assist Lamp. The settings for the following functions are fixed:
[Shutter Type]: [ESHTR]
[Flash Mode]: [
] (Forced Flash Off)
[AF Assist Lamp]: [OFF]
[Beep Volume]: [ ] (Off)
[Shutter Vol.]: [ ] (Off)
Even when this mode is set to [ON], the following lamps/indicators will light or flash.
Self-timer indicator
Wi-Fi connection lamp
The operation sounds of this camera such as the lens aperture sound are not muted.
Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, likeness rights, etc. of a subject when you
use this function. Use at your own risk.
162
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Recording with the Face Recognition function
[Face Recog.]
Recording mode:
The Face Recognition function recognises a face similar to a registered face and
automatically adjusts focus and exposure for the face with higher priority. Even if a person
you want to focus on is standing at the back or corner in a group photo, the camera will
automatically recognise the person and record this person’s face clearly.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Face Recog.]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF] / [MEMORY]
Default [Face Recog.] setting is [OFF].
When the face pictures are registered, the setting will be [ON] automatically.
How the Face Recognition function works
During recording
• The camera recognises a registered face and adjusts
focus and exposure.
• When registered faces that have set names are
recognised, the names are displayed (max. 3 people).
During playback
• The name and age are displayed (if information is
registered).
• The names that have been set for the recognised faces
are displayed (max. 3 people).
• Only pictures of the selected registered people are played
back ([Category Play]).
[Face Recog.] functions only when Auto Focus mode is set to [ ].
Only the first picture of the burst recording will contain Face Recognition information.
The name of the person recognised in the first picture is displayed in the case of group pictures.
Face Recognition searches for faces similar to those registered, but there is no guarantee it
will always recognise these faces. In some cases, the camera cannot recognise or incorrectly
recognises even registered people depending on their expression or the environment.
Even if Face Recognition information is registered, pictures recorded when the name is [OFF] are
not categorised for Face Recognition in [Category Play].
Even if Face Recognition information is changed, Face Recognition information for
previously recorded pictures is not changed.
For example, if a name is changed, pictures recorded before the change are not categorised for
Face Recognition in [Category Play].
To change name information for pictures already recorded, perform a [REPLACE] (→222) in [Face
Rec Edit].
163
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.]
Not available in the following cases:
[Face Recog.] cannot be set in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect])
During motion picture recording
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
Registering face pictures
Up to 6 people’s face pictures can be registered along with such information as name and
birthdate.
Recording tips when registering face pictures
• Make sure the subject’s eyes are open and mouth closed;
have the subject face the camera directly, and make sure
the outline of the face, the eyes and eyebrows are not
hidden by hair.
• Make sure there are no heavy shadows on the face.
(During registration, the flash is not used.)
Good example for registering
a face
If the camera seems to have difficulty recognising faces when recording
• Register additional pictures of the same person’s face, indoors and outdoors or with
different expressions or angles.
• Register additional pictures at the place you are recording.
• If a registered person is no longer recognised, re-register that person.
1
Use to select [MEMORY] and then press
[MENU/SET]
32
654
1
New
KEN
New
2
Use to select [New] and then press
[MENU/SET]
If 6 people are already registered, first delete a registered
person. (→164)
3
Align the face with the guide and record
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the
operation is executed.
Faces of subjects other than people (e.g. pets) cannot be
registered.
When
is pressed, an explanation is displayed.
164
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.]
4
Use to select the item for editing and press [MENU/SET]
[Name]
Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET]
Enter the name (See “Entering Text”: (→52))
[Age] Set the birthdate.
Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET]
Use to select year, month and day, set with , and press
[MENU/SET]
[Add Images] Up to 3 face pictures of the person can be registered.
Use to select [Add] and press [MENU/SET]
If only one picture is registered, you can skip the cursor button operation.
Just press [MENU/SET] to register an additional face picture.
When a registered face picture is selected with cursor button, a screen to
confirm deletion is displayed. Select [Yes] to delete the face picture.
(If only one picture is registered, it cannot be deleted.)
Record the picture (step
3
(→163))
Editing or deleting information about registered persons
Information about registered people can be edited or deleted.
1
Use to select [MEMORY] and then press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select the picture of the person to be edited or deleted and
press [MENU/SET]
3
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[Info Edit] Edit name or other registered information. (Step
4
above)
[Priority] Set priority order for focus and exposure.
Use to select the registration order and press [MENU/SET]
[Delete] Delete information and face pictures of registered persons.
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
165
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Setting the profile for a baby or pet to record in a
picture
Recording mode:
You can set a name or birthday of a baby or pet before taking a picture to record the
name or age in months/years in the picture.
Setting the name and age in months/years
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Profile Setup]
Settings: [ ] ([Baby1]) / [ ] ([Baby2]) / [ ] ([Pet]) / [OFF] / [SET]
Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [Baby1], [Baby2] or [Pet] and then press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [Age] or [Name] and then press
[MENU/SET]
Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET]
Age: Set birthday with , and press [MENU/SET]
Name: (See “Entering Text”: (→52))
Use to select [Exit] and then press [MENU/SET] to
finish
Cancelling the display of the name and age in months/years
Select [OFF] in step
.
[Age] and [Name] print setting can be made on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the
supplied DVD. Text may also be stamped onto the still picture using [Text Stamp].
Not available in the following case:
You cannot record the name or age in months/years in still pictures that are taken while recording
motion pictures ([
] (motion picture priorities)) (→198).
166
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Displaying the appropriate screen for specific
recording conditions
Checking the area where overexposure may occur ([Zebra Pattern])
Recording mode:
You can check the area in a picture that is brighter than a certain brightness, which could
result in overexposure, by displaying such an area using a zebra pattern. You can also
set the brightness to be represented by the zebra pattern.
[Custom] → [Zebra Pattern]
[ZEBRA1]
Displays an area brighter than a certain brightness using a
right-leaning zebra pattern.
[ZEBRA2]
Displays an area brighter than a certain brightness using a
left-leaning zebra pattern.
[OFF]
[SET]
Sets the brightness to be displayed for each zebra pattern.
[Zebra 1] / [Zebra 2]
1
Use to select the brightness and then press [MENU/SET]
The range of brightness you can select from is [50%] to [105%]. The [OFF]
setting is available for [Zebra 2]. When [100%] or [105%] is selected, only the
overexposed areas are displayed with the zebra pattern. When a smaller numeric
value is set, the range of brightness to be displayed by each zebra pattern will
increase.
167
SQW0024
Functions for specific subjects and purposes
Displaying the appropriate screen for specific recording conditions
If there is overexposure, we recommend taking pictures using a lower exposure value (→135),
using the histogram (→64) as a guideline.
The displayed zebra pattern is not recorded.
If you set [Zebra Pattern] to [Fn Button Set] (→37) in the [Custom] menu, every time you press
the assigned function button the setting will switch in the following order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra 2] →
[Zebra OFF]. When [ZEBRA2] is set to [OFF], you can switch the setting quickly in the following
order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra OFF].
Setting a monochrome display for the recording screen
([Monochrome Live View])
Recording mode:
You can display the recording screen in black and white. This function is useful when a
black and white screen will make it easier to adjust focus in Manual Focus mode.
[Custom] → [Monochrome Live View]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
• This does not affect recorded pictures.
168
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter
Recording mode:
Automatically detects and prevents jitter.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Stabilizer]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
(Normal)
Corrects vertical and horizontal jitter.
(Panning)
Corrects vertical jitter. This setting is ideal for panning (technique of
recording a subject by matching the camera movement with the movement
of a subject going in a specific direction).
[OFF] [Stabilizer] does not work.
To prevent jitter
If a warning is displayed about jitter, use [Stabilizer], a tripod,
or [Self Timer]. In some cases, jitter can be reduced by using
a higher setting for [Sensitivity].
Jitter alert display
50
i
169
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter
When you use a tripod, we recommend setting [Stabilizer] to [OFF].
To perform a panning by selecting [ ], we recommend taking pictures using the viewfinder.
Cases where the stabiliser function may be ineffective:
When there is a lot of jitter
When the zoom magnification is high (also in the Digital Zoom range)
When taking pictures while following a moving subject
When the shutter speed becomes slower to take pictures indoors or in dark places
The panning effect by selecting [ ] is not fully achieved in the following cases:
Bright summer days or other bright locations
When the shutter speed is higher than 1/100 seconds
When the motion of a subject is slow and the speed with which the camera is moved is too slow
(a nice background blur is not achieved)
When the camera is not adequately tracking the motion of a subject
Not available in the following case:
[Stabilizer] cannot be used by selecting [ ] (Normal) during panorama picture recording.
170
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
Recording mode:
You can adjust the area of a picture to be taken using zoom.
Zoom lever Control ring
Move the zoom lever Turn the control ring
*
*
You can perform zoom operation by assigning
the [Zoom] setting to the control ring. (→40)
T side : Telephoto, Enlarge the subject
W side : Wide-angle, Capture a wider area
Clockwise: Telephoto, Enlarge the subject
Counterclockwise: Wide-angle, Capture a wider
area
The illustration is an example of when using Optical Zoom, [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] in [Program
AE] Mode.
Focus range
i.Zoom range
Optical Zoom range
Digital Zoom range
Current zoom position (Focal lengths the same as those of a 35 mm film camera)
Do not touch the lens barrel during zooming.
Adjust the focus after adjusting the zoom.
The zoom ratio and the zoom bar displayed on the screen are estimates.
The camera may make a rattling noise and vibrate when the zoom lever is operated - this is not a
malfunction.
171
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
Zoom types and use
The zoom ratio changes when the picture size is changed.
Optical Zoom
You can zoom in without degrading the picture quality.
Maximum magnification: 3.1x
Not available in the following case:
During panorama picture recording
Extra optical zoom
This function works when picture sizes with [ ] have been selected in [Picture Size]
(→108). Extra optical zoom allows you to zoom in using a higher zoom ratio than Optical
Zoom, without degrading the picture quality.
Maximum magnification: 6.2x
(Including the optical zoom ratio. This maximum zoom ratio varies depending on
the picture size.)
Not available in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Toy Effect], [Toy Pop])
During panorama picture recording
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON]
When [iHDR] is set to [ON]
When the [Quality] setting is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
During motion picture recording
172
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
To increase the zoom ratio further, the following zoom can be used in combination.
[i.Zoom]
Recording mode:
You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to increase the zoom ratio
up to 2x higher than the original zoom ratio with limited deterioration of picture quality.
[Rec] → [i.Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF]
[Motion Picture] → [i.Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF]
Not available in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop])
During panorama picture recording
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON]
When [iHDR] is set to [ON]
When the [Quality] setting is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
173
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
[Digital Zoom]
Recording mode:
Zoom 4x further than Optical/Extra optical zoom. Note that, with Digital Zoom,
enlarging will decrease picture quality.
[Rec] → [Digital Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF]
[Motion Picture] → [Digital Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF]
When [Digital Zoom] is used simultaneously with [i.Zoom], you can only increase the zoom ratio
up to 2x.
When using [Digital Zoom], we recommend using a tripod and the self-timer (→148) for taking
pictures.
The AF area is largely displayed at the centre in the Digital Zoom range.
Not available in the following cases:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect])
During panorama picture recording
When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When the [Quality] setting is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
174
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
[Step Zoom]
Recording mode:
You can set the zoom operation to allow easy visualisation of the angle of view (picture
angle) for the focal length of a regular fixed focal length lens (as with a 35 mm film
camera). When using the [Step Zoom], you can operate the zoom ratio as easily as
changing the camera lens.
1
Turn the control ring (→39)
Current zoom position
(Focal lengths the same as those of a 35 mm film camera)
Using the zoom lever for [Step Zoom]
You can use the zoom lever for [Step Zoom] by setting [Zoom lever] to [Step Zoom] in
the [Custom] menu.
The focal length values are for reference only.
Not available in the following case:
During motion picture recording
175
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
Changing the zoom operation settings
[Custom] → [Zoom lever]
[Custom] → [Control Ring]
Zoom
The zoom operates in the normal way.
Step Zoom
Each time zoom is operated, the zoom stops at the position for
one of the preset focal lengths.
Retaining the zoom position when the camera is turned off
[Custom] → [Zoom Resume] → [ON] / [OFF]
176
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Recording mode:
When the flash (supplied) is attached, you can use all flash modes ([MANUAL] setting,
etc.) available for this unit. (Note, however, that this flash cannot be used as a wireless
flash unit.) This section describes how to take a picture using the flash (supplied).
• For details on how to take a picture using the external flash (optional), refer to (→291).
With the flash you can take pictures in dark places or adjust the entire contrast of a
picture by illuminating a subject with a bright background.
Attaching the flash
The hot shoe cover is already attached to the hot shoe at the time of purchase.
Attach the flash to the hot shoe after removing the hot shoe cover.
Removing the hot shoe cover
• Make sure that the Camera [ON/OFF] switch is set to [OFF].
1
Remove the hot shoe cover by pulling it in the
direction indicated by arrow while pressing it in the
direction indicated by arrow
Be sure to attach the hot shoe cover when the hot shoe is
not in use.
Keep the hot shoe cover safely after removing it so that you
do not lose it.
Attaching the flash
1
Turn off the flash
Hot shoe
Flash [ON/OFF] switch
2
Firmly insert the flash into the hot shoe of this
unit until it clicks
Set the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [ON] and turn on the
flash when you take a picture.
Keep the hot shoe cover out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
Do not carry the camera holding by the flash when the flash is mounted on the camera.
177
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Removing the flash
Turn off the camera and the flash
Press and hold the lock release button and pull
the flash in the direction indicated by the arrow to
detach the flash
When detaching the flash, do so slowly and carefully.
Attach the hot shoe cover to the hot shoe of the camera.
Store the detached flash in its soft case.
Lock release
button
About [Forced Flash Off] ([ ])
[ ] (Forced Flash Off) will appear on the recording screen and the flash will not fire in
the following cases.
Communication light emission with a wireless flash is also disabled. (→184)
• When the flash is not attached to the camera
• When the flash [ON/OFF] switch is set to [OFF] even if the flash is attached
• When the flash cannot be used to take pictures, for example, when recording motion
pictures
The available flash range when [Sensitivity] setting is [AUTO]
Edges of picture may become slightly dark if using flash at short distances without
using zoom (close to max. W). This may be remedied by using a little zoom.
Max. Wide Max. Tele
Approx. 60 cm - 14.1 m (1.97 feet - 46 feet)
*
Approx. 30 cm - 8.5 m (0.98 feet - 27.9 feet)
*
*
When the flash (supplied) is attached and [ISO Limit Set] is [OFF].
178
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
How to use the flash effectively
Taking a picture using the flash with the subject too close may cause overexposure.
When you set [Highlight] in the [Custom] menu to [ON], the overexposed areas will flash
black and white during [Auto Review] or playback. If that happens, we recommend taking
the picture again, for example, after setting a lower flash output using [Flash Adjust.]
(→183).
Do not put your hands over the light-emitting area of the flash or look at it from close range.
Do not use the flash at close distances to other subjects (heat/light may damage subject).
Flash charging may take time if battery is low or if using flash repeatedly. When the flash is being
charged, the flash icon flashes red, and you cannot take a picture even when you fully press the
shutter button.
The flash is fixed to [ ] (Forced Flash Off) in following cases:
During motion picture recording
When the picture effect (Filter) is set
During panorama picture recording
When using the electronic shutter
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
179
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Changing the firing mode (Manual flash)
Recording mode:
You can select whether the flash output is set automatically or manually.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Firing Mode]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[TTL] The camera automatically sets the flash output.
[MANUAL]
You can set the flash ratio manually. Using [TTL] allows you to take a picture
as intended, even for dark scenes where the flash output tends to be higher.
When [MANUAL] is selected, the flash ratio (e.g. [1/1]) is displayed with the flash icon on the
screen.
Setting the flash ratio (When [MANUAL] is selected)
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Manual Flash Adjust.]
Press to select an item and press [MENU/SET]
You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64] in 1/3 steps.
180
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Changing Flash Mode
Recording mode:
Set the flash to match the recording.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Mode]
2
Press to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
: [Forced Flash On]
: [Forced On/Red-Eye]
*
Always takes pictures using the flash.
Ideal for taking pictures with a backlight or when a
subject is located under bright lighting such as a
fluorescent light.
: [Slow Sync.]
: [Slow Sync./Red-Eye]
*
Takes brighter pictures such as pictures of subjects
against a nightscape by decreasing the shutter speed
when firing a flash.
Ideal for taking pictures of people against a
nightscape.
: [Forced Flash Off]
Always takes pictures without flash under all recording
conditions.
Ideal for taking pictures where the use of flash is
prohibited.
*
This is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF] (→184) and [Firing Mode] is
set to [TTL] (→179).
Two flashes will be emitted. Do not move until after the second flash. Interval between
flashes varies according to brightness of subject.
The red-eye reduction effect varies depending on the subject and is affected by factors such as
distance from the subject and whether the subject is looking at the camera during the preliminary
flash. In some cases, red-eye reduction may be negligible.
Reducing red-eye
Recording mode:
Automatically detects red-eye and corrects still picture data when recording with flash
red-eye reduction ([ ], [ ]).
[Rec] → [Red-Eye Removal]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
When this function is set to [ON], the flash icon changes to [ ]/[ ].
Not available in the following case:
Depending on the circumstance, it may not be possible to correct red-eye.
181
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Shutter speeds for each flash mode
Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds)
1/60
*
1
- 1/4000
Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds)
1 - 1/16000
120
*
2
- 1/16000
*
1
The shutter speed is set to 60 seconds in [Shutter-Priority] Mode and to T (time) in [Manual
Exposure] Mode.
*
2
The shutter speed is set to T (time) in [Manual Exposure] Mode.
• In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, shutter speed changes depending on the identified scene.
Flash settings for each Recording Mode (When the flash (supplied) is attached)
(○: Available, –: Not available)
Recording Mode
[Intelligent Auto] Mode
*
*
*
*
[Program AE] Mode
[Aperture-Priority] Mode
[Shutter-Priority] Mode
[Manual Exposure] Mode
*
You cannot perform flash settings using the [Rec] menu. Set to [ ], [ ], [ ] or [ ]
depending on the subject and brightness.
Flash settings may be changed when changing Recording Mode.
Flash settings will be retained even if the camera is turned off.
182
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Setting the 2nd curtain sync
Recording mode:
2nd curtain sync is a recording method in which the flash fires just before the shutter
closes when you take a picture of a moving subject (such as a car) using the flash with a
slow shutter speed.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Synchro]
2
Press to select the setting item and press [MENU/SET]
[1ST] 1st curtain sync is the normal recording method
when using the flash.
[2ND] The light source is captured in back of the subject
and this produces a picture that is vibrant and
lively.
Normally, set to [1ST].
If you set to [2ND], [2nd] will be displayed in the flash icon on the screen.
[2ND] is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF]. (→184)
The [Flash Synchro] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied flash is
used. (→291)
When a fast shutter speed is set, the [Flash Synchro] effect may not be sufficiently achieved.
When [2ND] is set, you cannot set the flash setting to [ ] or [ ].
183
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Adjusting the flash output
Recording mode:
Adjust the flash output if a picture taken using the flash is too bright or too dark.
1
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Adjust.]
2
Press to set the flash output and press [MENU/SET]
Settings: -3 EV to +3 EV (unit: 1/3 EV)
When you do not want to adjust the intensity of the flash, select [±0 EV].
When the intensity of the flash is adjusted, [+] or [-] is displayed on the flash icon.
[Flash Adjust.] is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF] (→184) and [Firing
Mode] is set to [TTL] (→179).
The [Flash Adjust.] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied flash is
used. (→291)
Synchronising the flash output with the camera during
Exposure Compensation
Recording mode:
The flash output is automatically adjusted in accordance with the exposure compensation
value.
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Auto Exposure Comp.]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
About Exposure Compensation (→135)
The [Auto Exposure Comp.] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied
flash is used. (→291)
184
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Performing wireless flash settings
Recording mode:
When you use the flashes (optional: DMW-FL360L, DMW-FL580L) with the wireless flash
recording function, you can separately control the firing of the flashes in three groups and
of the flash attached to the hot shoe of the camera.
Although the flash (supplied) is not equipped with the wireless flash recording function, it
can be attached to the hot shoe of this unit and you can control the firing of the wireless
flash.
Positioning the wireless flash
Position the wireless flash with its wireless sensor facing the camera. The following
illustration is an example of the range within which the flash can be positioned. The
flash controllable range varies depending on the surrounding environment.
Flash controllable range
(when a supplied flash is attached)
Example of positioning flashes
2 m
(6.6 feet)
2 m
(6.6 feet)
3 m (9.8 feet)
3 m
(9.8 feet)
• This flash positioning example shows a case where flash unit C is positioned in order to
eliminate the shadows from the subject’s background, which is produced by flash unit A
and flash unit B of the flash group.
• For the number of wireless flashes to be controlled, we recommend setting up to three
flash units in each group.
• When a subject is too close, the communication light emission may affect the exposure
of the picture. This problem can be mitigated if you decrease the flash output by setting
[Communication Light] to [LOW] or using a flash diffuser or similar device.
Preparation
Attach a supplied flash or an optional flash (DMW-FL360L, DMW-FL580L) to this unit.
1
Set the wireless flash to RC mode and position the flash
Select the channel and group of the wireless flash.
185
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
2
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Wireless]
3
Press to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET]
When [Wireless] is set to [ON], [WL] will appear with the flash icon on the recording screen.
To perform detailed settings for the wireless flash, perform the following settings from the [Flash].
4
Press to select [Wireless Channel] and press
[MENU/SET]
Firing Mode Flash output
Luminosity ratio
5
Press to select the channel and press [MENU/SET]
Select the same channel as the channel set for the wireless flash
in step
1
.
6
Press to select [Wireless Setup] and press
[MENU/SET]
7
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
Press the [DISP.] button to perform a test firing.
[External
Flash]
[Firing
Mode]
[TTL]: The camera automatically sets the flash output.
[AUTO]
*
: Sets the flash output using an external flash.
[MANUAL]: Manually sets the flash ratio of an external flash.
[OFF]: An external flash fires only for a communication light emission.
[Flash
Adjust.]
Adjusts the flash output of an external flash manually when [Firing
Mode] is set to [TTL].
[Manual
Flash
Adjust.]
Sets the flash ratio of an external flash when [Firing Mode] is set to
[MANUAL].
You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64]
in 1/3 steps.
[A Group]/
[B Group]/
[C Group]
[Firing
Mode]
[TTL]: The camera automatically sets the wireless flash output.
[AUTO]: Sets the flash output using the wireless flash.
[MANUAL]: Manually sets the flash ratio of the wireless flash.
[OFF]: The wireless flashes of the set group do not fire.
[Flash
Adjust.]
Adjusts the flash output of the wireless flash manually when [Firing
Mode] is set to [TTL].
[Manual
Flash
Adjust.]
Sets the flash ratio of the wireless flash when [Firing Mode] is set to
[MANUAL].
You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64]
in 1/3 steps.
*
When the flash (supplied) is attached to this unit, you cannot perform these settings.
186
SQW0024
Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures using the flash (supplied)
Setting the communication light emission to be used when wireless flash
recording is performed
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Communication Light]
Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW]
187
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
You can record full high-definition quality images that comply with the AVCHD standard,
as well as motion pictures recorded in MP4. You can also record a 4K motion picture in
MP4. (→194)
Audio is recorded in stereo.
Setting the format, picture size and recording frame rate
Recording mode:
1
Set the menu
[Motion Picture] → [Rec Format]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[AVCHD] This is a data format suitable for playback on high-definition TVs.
[MP4]
This data format is suited for playing back motion pictures on a computer and other
such devices.
3
Use to select [Rec Quality] and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
Exit the menu after it is executed.
188
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
When [AVCHD] is selected
Item Picture size
Recording frame rate
Sensor output Bit rate
[FHD/28M/50p]
*
1920×1080 50p 50 fps Approx. 28 Mbps
[FHD/17M/50i] 1920×1080 50i 50 fps Approx. 17 Mbps
[FHD/24M/25p] 1920×1080 50i 25 fps Approx. 24 Mbps
[FHD/24M/24p] 1920×1080 24p 24 fps Approx. 24 Mbps
*
AVCHD Progressive
When [MP4] is selected
Item Picture size
Recording frame rate
Sensor output Bit rate
[4K/100M/25p] 3840×2160 25p 25 fps Approx. 100 Mbps
[4K/100M/24p] 3840×2160 24p 24 fps Approx. 100 Mbps
[FHD/28M/50p] 1920×1080 50p 50 fps Approx. 28 Mbps
[FHD/20M/25p] 1920×1080 25p 25 fps Approx. 20 Mbps
[HD/10M/25p] 1280×720 25p 25 fps Approx. 10 Mbps
[VGA/4M/25p] 640×480 25p 25 fps Approx. 4 Mbps
• What is bit rate
Bit rate is the volume of data for a definite period of time, and the quality becomes
higher when the number gets bigger. This unit uses the “VBR” recording method. “VBR”
is an abbreviation of “Variable Bit Rate”, and the bit rate (volume of data for definite
period of time) is changed automatically depending on the subject to record. Therefore,
the recording time is shortened when a subject with fast movement is recorded.
189
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
About the compatibility of the recorded motion pictures
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] or [MP4] may be played back with poor picture or
sound quality or playback may not be possible even when played back with equipment
compatible with these formats. Also, the recording information may not be displayed
properly. In this case, use this unit.
• When you import and play back motion pictures recorded with [FHD/28M/50p],
[FHD/24M/25p], or [FHD/24M/24p] in [AVCHD] using a device other than this unit,
a compatible Blu-ray disc recorder or PC installed with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” is
required.
• For details on motion pictures recorded with [4K/100M/25p] or [4K/100M/24p] in the
[MP4] format, refer to “Enjoying 4K motion pictures” (→274).
Adjusting the focus while recording motion pictures
([Continuous AF])
Recording mode:
Focusing varies depending on the focus mode (→114) and the setting of [Continuous AF]
in the [Motion Picture] menu.
[Focus] [Continuous AF] Setting
[AFS]/[AFF]/
[AFC]
[ON]
Allow the focus to be constantly adjusted
automatically while recording motion pictures.
(→114)
[OFF]
Fix focus position at the start of motion picture
recording.
[MF] [ON] / [OFF] Allow the focus to be adjusted manually. (→128)
• When the focus mode is set to [AFS], [AFF], or [AFC], the camera will refocus if the
shutter button is pressed halfway while recording motion pictures.
• When Auto Focus is activated while you are recording motion pictures, the focusing
operation sound may be recorded under some conditions. If you want to suppress this
sound, we recommend taking pictures after setting [Continuous AF] to [OFF] in the
[Motion Picture] menu.
• When using zoom while recording motion pictures, it may take some time to focus.
190
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Recording mode:
You can record motion pictures by manually setting the aperture value and shutter speed.
(→80)
The camera automatically sets the aperture value and shutter speed and identifies the
optimal scene to record motion pictures in [Intelligent Auto] Mode. (→76)
1
Press the motion picture button to start recording
Immediately release the motion picture button after pressing it.
While you are recording motion pictures, the recording status
indicator (red) will flash.
If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute
or longer, some of the information on the screen is turned off.
To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button. This
operation takes place to prevent screen burn-in. This is not a
malfunction.
Do not block the microphones when recording motion pictures.
You can also use zoom while recording motion pictures.
The operating sounds of the zoom lever or control ring may be
recorded in some cases.
Still pictures can be taken during motion picture recording.
(→198)
Elapsed recording time
Remaining recording time
(approx.)
Recording state indicator
2
Press the motion picture button again to end recording
191
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
About the aperture value and shutter speed to be used for recording
motion pictures
About aperture value
• To record motion pictures with a sharp focus on both subject and background, set
the aperture value to a higher number. To record motion pictures with a defocused
background, set a lower number.
About the shutter speed
• To record a sharp motion picture of a fast-moving subject, set a faster shutter speed.
To record a motion picture with a trailing effect for a subject’s movements, set a
slower shutter speed.
• When you set a faster shutter speed, the screen noise may increase due to the
higher sensitivity.
• When you record a subject under fluorescent or LED lighting fixtures, etc., the colours
and screen brightness may change or horizontal striping may appear on the screen.
If this happens, we recommend manually adjusting the shutter speed to 1/60 seconds
or 1/100 seconds.
About operation sound when recording ends
Since motion pictures are recorded until the motion picture button is pressed to stop
recording, the operating sound level in the picture may be higher. To suppress this sound,
we recommend trying the following method.
Divide the end part of a motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214) in the [Playback]
menu. In some cases, motion pictures cannot be divided at a position close to the
end part of the motion picture. To avoid this problem, continue recording for an extra 3
seconds.
192
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Enabling/disabling the motion picture button
[Custom] → [Video Button] → [ON] / [OFF]
This function prevents incorrect operation of the button.
Switching the angle of view setting used for recording still pictures
and motion pictures
[Custom] → [Rec Area] → (Picture) / (Motion picture)
If the aspect ratio is different for still pictures and motion pictures, the angle of view will
change when starting to record a motion picture.
When you set [Rec Area] to [ ], the angle of view setting used for recording motion
pictures is displayed.
[Rec Area] should be interpreted as a guideline.
193
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
If the surrounding temperature is high, or a motion picture is recorded continuously, [ ] is
displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through to protect the camera.
If Extra optical zoom is used before pressing the motion picture button, these settings will be
cleared, and the recordable area will be changed significantly.
Note that if you perform operations such as zoom, using buttons or dials, while recording a motion
picture, operation noise may be recorded.
The zoom speed will be slower than normal during motion picture recording.
The available recording time displayed on the screen may not decrease regularly.
Depending on the type of the card, the card access indication may appear for a while after
recording motion pictures. This is not a malfunction.
If you stop recording motion pictures too soon when you have set picture effect (Filter) of
[Miniature Effect], the camera may continue recording for a certain time. Hold the camera until the
camera stops recording.
[ISO Limit Set] is disabled when you are recording motion pictures.
Even if you set [Stabilizer] to [ ] (Panning) when you are recording motion pictures, it is fixed to
[
] (Normal).
It is recommended to use a fully charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler
(optional) when recording motion pictures. (→292)
If while recording motion pictures using the AC adaptor and the power supply is cut off due to a
power outage or if the AC adaptor is disconnected etc., the motion picture being recorded will not
be recorded.
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures cannot be recorded in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature
Effect]
*
, [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine])
*
Only when recording motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
194
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Recording 4K motion pictures
Recording mode:
You can record high-resolution 4K motion pictures by setting [Rec Quality] to [4K].
• To record 4K motion pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
• When you record 4K motion pictures, the angle of view will be narrower than motion
pictures of other sizes.
To record 4K motion pictures
Select the recording mode (→59)
Set the [Rec Format] in the [Motion Picture] menu to [MP4] (→187)
Set [Rec Quality] in the [Motion Picture] menu to [4K/100M/25p] or [4K/100M/24p]
(→188)
Press the motion picture button to start recording
Press the motion picture button again to end recording
195
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Creating a high-resolution still picture from a 4K motion
picture [4K PHOTO]
You can create a still picture with approximately 8 megapixel resolution from a 4K motion
picture recorded by setting [4K PHOTO]. You can create a still picture that captures a
moment, similar to high-speed burst recording.
This setting is not available in [Intelligent Auto] Mode.
Recording 4K motion pictures
• To record 4K motion pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
1
Set the menu
[Motion Picture] → [4K PHOTO]
2
Press to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation
is executed.
The appropriate motion picture mode for capturing a still picture
from a 4K motion picture is selected and the motion picture can
be recorded using still picture quality.
Since the camera puts higher priority on the focus of a still picture
captured from a 4K motion picture, focusing movement during
motion picture recording may be noticeable.
The camera will automatically perform the following setting items.
Menu Item
[Rec Format] [MP4]
[Rec Quality] [4K/100M/25p]
3
Press [ ] button to display the recording screen
196
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
4
Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial to set the recording mode
We recommend setting [Shutter-Priority] Mode and setting the shutter speed to 1/1000 seconds
or higher to minimise subject blur. To record a subject that is moving quickly, set the shutter
speed to 1/2000 seconds or higher.
5
Operate the aspect ratio selector switch to set the
aspect ratio for a motion picture
The aspect ratio of a still picture captured from a 4K motion
picture is the same as the aspect ratio of the motion picture.
6
Press the motion picture button to start recording
When you record 4K motion pictures, the angle of view will be
narrower than motion pictures of other sizes.
Setting a marker
When you press the [Fn2] button while recording, you can add a marker to the
motion picture.
When you create still pictures from a motion picture, you can quickly move to a
marker position you want to capture as a still picture.
You can add up to 40 markers in a single motion picture.
7
Press the motion picture button again to end recording
Motion picture recording can also be started or finished by pressing the shutter button.
197
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Recording motion pictures
Creating still pictures from a motion picture
1
Display the picture that you want to capture as a still
picture by pressing to pause a motion picture being
played back on the camera
You can press to perform single-frame forward/rewind
operations.
When you press the [Fn2] button and press
, you can quickly
move to the marker position you set while recording the motion
picture. (You can perform the same operation even during motion
picture playback.)
If you press the [Fn2] button again, you can perform single-frame
forward/rewind operations by pressing
.
Fn2
2
Press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET].
[
] is displayed for a captured still picture.
If you want to capture a still picture from a motion picture while the camera is connected to a TV
with the HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF].
198
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Taking still pictures while a motion picture is being
recorded
Recording mode:
Still pictures can be recorded even while a motion picture is being recorded.
(Simultaneous recording)
1
Press the shutter button fully during the
motion picture recording
• When you take a still picture, the simultaneous
still/motion picture recording icon is displayed.
Setting the motion picture priority or still picture priority mode
Recording mode:
You can use [Picture Mode] in the [Motion Picture] menu to set the recording method of a
still picture to be taken while you record a motion picture.
(motion
picture
priorities)
Takes a still picture using [Picture Size] [S] (2M). The picture quality may be different
to [S] (2M) of standard pictures.
Only pictures in JPEG file format are recorded when [Quality] is set to [
], [ ],
or [
]. ([Quality] is used with the [ ] setting when [ ] is set.)
You can take up to 30 still pictures while you are recording a motion picture.
When the picture effect (Filter) is set to [Miniature Effect], a still picture may be taken
with a slight delay from the time you fully press the shutter button.
(Still
picture
priorities)
A still picture is taken with [Picture Size] and [Quality] that you have set.
While a still picture is being taken, the screen turns black. During this period, the still
picture is taken in the motion picture and the audio is muted.
You can take up to 4 still pictures while you are recording a motion picture.
The aspect ratio of a still picture is fixed to [16:9].
Not available in the following cases:
Still pictures cannot be recorded in the following cases:
When [Rec Format] is set to [MP4], [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/100M/25p], [4K/100M/24p], or
[VGA/4M/25p]
When [Rec Format] is set to [AVCHD], [Rec Quality] is set to [FHD/24M/24p] (only available with
[
] ([Photo Priority]) setting)
199
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Using the [Motion Picture] menu
For the setting procedures for the [Motion Picture] menu, refer to (→31).
• The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic],
[i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and
[Motion Picture] menus.
If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will
also be changed automatically.
• [Motion Picture] menu will not be displayed in the following cases:
During panorama picture recording
[4K PHOTO]
• For details (→195).
[Rec Format]
• For details (→187).
[Rec Quality]
• For details (→187).
[Picture Mode]
• For details (→198).
[Continuous AF]
• For details (→189).
200
SQW0024
Recording motion pictures
Using the [Motion Picture] menu
For the setting procedures for the [Motion Picture] menu, refer to (→31).
[Mic Level Disp.]
Recording mode:
You can set whether or not to display the microphone level on the recording screen.
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
Not available in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect])
[Mic Level Adj.]
Recording mode:
You can adjust the audio input level in 4 steps.
Not available in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect])
[Wind Cut]
Recording mode:
If you hear wind noise during an audio recording, you can use [Wind Cut] to effectively
reduce the wind noise.
Settings: [AUTO] / [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW] / [OFF]
When [Wind Cut] is set, the sound quality may differ from that of normal recordings.
Not available in the following case:
When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect])
201
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing the group picture
You can consecutively play back multiple pictures in a group or play back group pictures
one by one.
[
]: Group pictures recorded consecutively by setting
[Burst Rate] to [SH] (→142)
[ ]: Group pictures recorded using [Time Lapse Shot]
(→153)
[ ]: Group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion
Animation] (→156)
• You can delete or edit pictures in group units. (For example,
if you delete one of pictures in a group, all pictures in that
group will be deleted.)
15 pic.15 pic.
Playing back group pictures consecutively
1
Select a picture with the group picture icon ([ ], [ ], or [ ]),
and press
When you play back group pictures one by one, the option settings are displayed.
[From the first picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the first picture in a
group.
[From the current picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the picture currently
played back.
Operations during continuous playback
Continuous playback / Pause Stop
Fast rewind playback Fast forward playback
Returning to the previous picture
(while paused)
Scrolling to the next picture
(while paused)
202
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing the group picture
Playing back group pictures one by one
1
Select a picture with the submenu icon ([ ]), and
press
The submenu screen will appear.
Display In GroupDisplay In Group
Upload(Wi-Fi)Upload(Wi-Fi)
2
Use to select [Display In Group] and press
[MENU/SET]
3
Use to scroll through the pictures
When you use to select [Exit Display In Group] and press
[MENU/SET] after pressing
again, the normal playback screen
reappears.
You can use the same operations for pictures stored in a group
as in normal still picture playback. (Multi Playback, Playback
Zoom, deletion of pictures, etc.)
Pictures will not be grouped if they are recorded without setting [Clock Set].
Burst pictures recorded on another device may not be recognised as group pictures.
203
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Capturing still pictures from motion pictures
Save a scene from a motion picture as a still picture.
• For the method of capturing a still picture from a 4K motion picture recorded by setting
[4K PHOTO] to [ON], refer to (→195).
1
Display the picture that you want to
capture as a still picture by pressing to
pause a motion picture being played back
on the camera
• When you press while paused, you can perform
fast forward/rewind operations.
2
Press [MENU/SET]
• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and
press [MENU/SET].
• The still picture is saved with aspect ratio of [16:9] and
[Quality] of [ ]. The picture size varies depending on
the motion picture being played back.
For motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K]: [M] (8M)
For motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [FHD], [HD]: [S] (2M)
The picture quality becomes slightly lower depending on the [Rec Quality] setting of the original
motion picture.
When a still picture captured from a motion picture is played back, [ ] is displayed.
If you want to capture a still picture from a motion picture while the camera is connected to a TV
with the HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF].
Not available in the following case:
You cannot capture a still picture from the following motion pictures.
Motion pictures recorded in [MP4] using the [VGA/4M/25p] setting
204
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
You can specify picture protection, resizing, print settings, and other settings for pictures
you have taken.
• For the setting procedures of the menu. (→31)
In the following cases, new pictures are created after they have been edited. Before starting to
edit, make sure that there is enough free space in the memory card.
[RAW Processing]
[Text Stamp]
[Time Lapse Video]
[Stop Motion Video]
[Resize]
[Cropping]
It may not be possible to set or edit pictures taken with other cameras.
[Slide Show]
Automatically play pictures in order. Recommended when viewing on TV screen.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Slide Show]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
When you select [Category Selection], use to select
category and press [MENU/SET]. For details about category,
refer to (→206).
3
Use to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
Operations during Slide Show
Pause/Play Stop
Previous Next
Control dial
(counterclockwise)
Volume down
Control dial
(clockwise)
Volume up
205
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
To change settings such as music or display time
Select [Effect] or [Setup] and then press [MENU/SET].
[Effect] [AUTO] / [NATURAL] / [SLOW] / [SWING] / [URBAN] / [OFF]
[Setup] [Duration] [1SEC] / [2SEC] / [3SEC] / [5SEC]
[Repeat] [ON] / [OFF]
[Sound] [OFF]: Music and audio will not play back.
[AUTO]: With still pictures, music will play back, and with motion
pictures, audio will play back.
[Music]: Music effect will play back.
[Audio]: Audio is played back from motion pictures.
When [URBAN] has been selected, the picture may appear in black and white as a screen effect.
[AUTO] can be used only when [Category Selection] is selected. The pictures are played back with
the recommended effects for each category.
When you perform a Slide Show playback by setting [Video Only] or [Category Selection] to [ ],
[
], or [ ], [Effect] is fixed to [OFF].
When you perform a Slide Show playback for a group picture, and even if [Effect] is set, the effects
are disabled.
When panorama pictures, motion pictures, or group pictures are played back, the [Duration]
setting is disabled.
[Duration] can be set only when [Effect] is set to [OFF].
Part of [Effect] cannot be used when displaying pictures on television using an HDMI micro cable
or when displaying pictures recorded in portrait position.
Music effects cannot be added.
206
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Playback Mode]
Recorded pictures can be played back in a variety of ways.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Playback Mode]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
When selecting [Category Play] in step
2
above
3
Use to select the category and press [MENU/SET]
The available categories are as follows.
[Face Recog.]
*
[i-Portrait], [i-Night Portrait], [i-Baby] in Automatic Scene Detection
[i-Scenery], [i-Sunset] in Automatic Scene Detection
[i-Night Portrait], [i-Night Scenery], [i-Handheld Night Shot] in Automatic Scene
Detection
[i-Food] in Automatic Scene Detection
[Travel Date]
A burst of pictures recorded by setting [Burst Rate] to [SH]
[Time Lapse Shot], [Time Lapse Video]
[Stop Motion Animation], [Stop Motion Video]
*
Use to select a person to be played back and press [MENU/SET]. Face Recognition is
applied for all the pictures in the group.
[Playback Mode] automatically changes to [Normal Play] when the camera is turned on, or when
switching from the recording standby screen to the playback screen.
The category for recording motion pictures is different from the category of still pictures used in
some Recording Modes. For that reason, the pictures may not be played back.
207
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Location Logging]
After you send location information (latitude and longitude) obtained by your smartphone/
tablet to this unit, you can write this information on pictures using the unit.
Preparation
Send location information to this unit from your smartphone/tablet. (→237)
You must install “Panasonic Image App” on your smartphone/tablet. (→228)
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Location Logging] → [Add Location Data]
2
Use to select a period for writing location information, and then press
[MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
[
] is displayed for pictures that have location information written to it.
Abort writing location information
Press [MENU/SET] while location information is being written
[ ] is displayed for the period of the abort operation.
If selected again while [
] is displayed, writing location information will resume where it left off.
Delete received location information
Use to select [Delete Location Data] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select a period for deleting location information, and then press
[MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
Location information can be written only to pictures recorded with this unit.
Not available in the following cases:
Location information may not be written if there is not enough free space on your card.
The location information will not be written on pictures that were recorded after you sent the
location information (→237).
Location information will not be written to AVCHD motion pictures.
The location information cannot be written to pictures recorded without setting [Clock Set].
Writing the location information using a smartphone/tablet
When you use your smartphone/tablet as a remote controller for this unit, you can write
the location information on pictures using the smartphone/tablet. (→238)
208
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[RAW Processing]
You can use the camera to develop still pictures that were recorded in RAW format.
The created still pictures are saved in JPEG format. You can develop the pictures while
confirming the effects on the screen.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [RAW Processing]
2
Press to select RAW file and press [MENU/SET]
3
Press to select the item
The following items can be set. The settings used during recording are applied at the time of
setting.
[White Balance]
You can select White Balance to make adjustments. When you select an
item with [ ], you can develop the pictures using the same settings that
were applied for recording.
[Exposure Comp.]
You can perform Exposure Compensation in the range from –1 EV to
+1 EV.
[Photo Style]
You can select the [Photo Style] effects ([Standard], [Vivid], [Natural],
[Monochrome], [Scenery], or [Portrait]).
[i.Dynamic]
You can select the [i.Dynamic] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW], or
[OFF]).
[Contrast] You can adjust the contrast.
[Highlight] You can adjust the brightness of a highlighted area.
[Shadow] You can adjust the brightness of a shadowed area.
[Saturation] /
[Color Tone]
You can adjust the saturation. (You can adjust the colouring when
[Monochrome] is selected for [Photo Style].)
[Filter Effect]
You can select a Filter effect. (Only when [Monochrome] is selected for
[Photo Style])
[Noise Reduction] You can set noise reduction.
[i.Resolution]
You can select the [i.Resolution] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW],
[EXTENDED], or [OFF]).
[Sharpness] You can adjust the impression of resolution.
[Setup]
You can perform the following settings.
[Reinstate Adjustments]: You can restore the settings to the ones used
during recording.
[Color Space]: You can select [Color Space] from either [sRGB] or
[Adobe RGB].
[Picture Size]: You can select the picture size ([L], [M], or [S]) of a JPEG
file when saving pictures.
209
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
4
Press [MENU/SET] to set
The setting methods vary depending on the item. For details, refer to “Setting each item”.
5
Press [MENU/SET]
The screen in step
3
reappears. To set another item, repeat steps
3
to
5
.
6
Press to select [Begin Processing] and press [MENU/SET]
Confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
Setting each item
When you select an item, the setting screen appears.
Control dial
Used to make adjustments
Used to display the colour temperature
setting screen (→105)
(Only when [White Balance] is set to [
])
Used to display the White Balance fine
adjustment screen (→105)
(Only when [White Balance] is set)
[DISP.] Used to display the comparison screen
[MENU/SET]
Used to finalise an adjustment you just made
and to return to the item selection screen
• If you have selected [Noise Reduction], [i.Resolution], or [Sharpness],
the comparison screen is not displayed.
• Pictures can be enlarged by operating the zoom lever.
The following operating methods are available to make adjustments on the comparison
screen.
Control dial
Used to make adjustments
[DISP.] Used to return to the setting screen
[MENU/SET]
Used to finalise an adjustment you just made
and to return to the item selection screen
Current setting
210
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
When [Setup] is selected
When you select an item, the screen for selecting [Reinstate Adjustments], [Color
Space], or [Picture Size] is displayed.
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
When [Reinstate Adjustments] is selected, confirmation screen is displayed. When you select
[Yes], the item selection screen reappears.
Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET]
The result of a RAW file developed by this camera and a RAW file developed by the supplied DVD
software “SILKYPIX Developer Studio” will not be exactly the same.
The range that can be set using Exposure Compensation varies from the range used during
recording.
The [White Balance] setting of still pictures recorded using [Multi Exp.] is fixed to the setting used
during recording.
If [Red-Eye Removal] is activated during recording, you can use [RAW Processing] in the
[Playback] menu to save JPEG file pictures in which red-eye was detected and corrected.
You cannot perform RAW processing using multiple still pictures simultaneously.
Not available in the following cases:
When an AV cable (optional) or an HDMI micro cable is connected, [RAW Processing] is disabled.
You can perform RAW processing on pictures recorded using this unit only. [RAW Processing]
cannot be used for pictures recorded on other devices or for pictures recorded in formats other
than the RAW format.
211
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Title Edit]
You can enter characters (comments) on a recorded picture.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Title Edit] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select a still picture
[Single]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
TitleTitle
Edit
Edit
[Multi] (up to 100 pictures)
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
To execute → Use
to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET].
[Title Edit] setting
OK
[Title Edit] already set
3
Enter characters (Entering text (→52))
To delete a title, delete all the characters in the character input screen.
To print text, use [Text Stamp] or “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the supplied DVD.
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
], [ ] or [ ]
212
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Text Stamp]
You can stamp the recording date and time, names, travel destination, travel dates, etc. on
the recorded still pictures.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Text Stamp] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select a still picture
[Single]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
TextText
Stamp
Stamp
[Multi] (up to 100 pictures)
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
To execute → Use
to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET].
[Text Stamp] setting
(
[Text Stamp] already set)
OK
3
Use to select [Set] and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] (→213)
5
Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] (→213)
6
Press [ ] button
7
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
Confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
213
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
Items that can be stamped
[Shooting Date] [W/O TIME]: Stamp recording date
[WITH TIME]: Stamp recording date and time
[Name]
: Stamp name registered in Face Recognition
: Stamp name registered in [Profile Setup]
[Location] Stamp location registered in [Setup] menu’s [Travel Date]
[Travel Date] Stamp number of days that have elapsed since the travel date set in [Setup]
menu’s [Travel Date]
[Title] Stamp text registered in [Title Edit]
• Items set to [OFF] are not stamped.
Do not request date printing in store or make date printing on printer for still pictures with
date stamps. (Date printing may be overlapped.)
Characters may be cut off on certain printers.
If you stamp text on the pictures in a group, those pictures are saved as new pictures.
Text is difficult to read when stamped on pictures of 0.3M or less.
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
Still pictures taken without setting clock
214
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Video Divide]
A single motion picture can be split into 2 parts. This is convenient when you want to keep
just the necessary scenes, or if you wish to delete unnecessary scenes to increase free
space on your card, such as when travelling.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Video Divide]
2
Use to select a motion picture to split and press [MENU/SET]
3
Press at where you want to split a motion picture to pause it
If you press while paused, you can make finer adjustments to the splitting positions in a
motion picture.
If you press
again, the motion picture is played back from the last position prior to activating
pause.
4
Press
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press
[MENU/SET].
The original motion picture that was split does not remain.
(There will only be the 2 motion pictures that were created after
the split.)
During dividing, do not turn off the camera or remove the card or battery. If you do so, the motion
picture may be deleted.
If you divide a motion picture recorded in [MP4] when the picture display sequence is set to [FILE
NAME], the order of the pictures will change. It is recommended to set the display sequence to
[DATE/TIME] or to display using [Calendar].
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures cannot be divided at a location close to the start or end of the motion picture.
Motion pictures with a short recording time cannot be divided.
215
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Time Lapse Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using
[Time Lapse Shot]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording format.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Time Lapse Video]
2
Use to select the [Time Lapse Shot] picture group and press
[MENU/SET]
3
Create a motion picture after selecting a production method
The process is the same as that used to create a motion picture after recording pictures using
[Time Lapse Shot]. For details, refer to step
5
and the subsequent steps (→154).
For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→155).
[Stop Motion Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using
[Stop Motion Animation]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording
format.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Stop Motion Video]
2
Use to select a stop motion animation group and press [MENU/SET]
3
Create a motion picture after selecting a production method
The process is the same as that used to create a motion picture after recording pictures using
[Stop Motion Animation]. For details, refer to step
8
and the subsequent steps (→157).
For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→158).
216
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Resize]
Picture size can be reduced to facilitate e-mail attachment and use in web pages, etc.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Resize] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select a still picture and size
[Single]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select size and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the
operation is executed.
[Multi] (up to 100 pictures)
Use to select size and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the
operation is executed.
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
To execute → Use
to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET].
OK
Resize setting
Picture quality is reduced after resizing.
Not available in the following cases:
Still pictures recorded at the smallest recording pixel level cannot be further reduced.
Cannot resize the following pictures:
Motion pictures
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Group pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
217
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Cropping]
Enlarge your still pictures and crop unwanted areas.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Cropping]
2
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
3
Select area to crop and press [MENU/SET]
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the
operation is executed.
Expand Change
position
Perform cropping for each picture in the group. (You cannot edit pictures in group units.)
If you crop a picture in the group, it is saved as a new picture.
Original Face Recognition information will not be copied when still pictures are cropped.
Picture quality is reduced after cropping.
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
218
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Rotate] / [Rotate Disp.]
You can automatically display a still picture recorded in portrait orientation by taking the
picture with the camera held vertically, or manually rotate the picture in 90-degree units.
[Rotate] Rotating a picture manually
• You cannot select [Rotate] when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [OFF].
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Rotate]
2
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
You cannot rotate group pictures.
3
Use to select the rotation direction and press
[MENU/SET]
[ ]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees clockwise.
[
]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees counterclockwise.
[Rotate Disp.] Rotating a picture automatically to display
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Rotate Disp.] → [ON]
When this function is set to [OFF], the picture is displayed without changing its orientation.
Not available in the following cases:
When you play back pictures on a PC, they cannot be displayed in the rotated direction unless the
OS or software is compatible with Exif. Exif is a file format for still pictures which allows recording
information, etc. to be added. It was established by “JEITA (Japan Electronics and Information
Technology Industries Association)”.
A picture may not be automatically rotated to display it with portrait orientation on the Multi
Playback screen, which is displayed for settings such as [Delete Multi].
219
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Favorite]
By labelling your favourite pictures with a star [ ], you can play back your favourite
pictures only, or you can delete all pictures except your favourites.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Favorite] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select picture
[Single]
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
Favourite picture setting
[Multi] (up to 999 pictures)
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
2 3
4 5 6
1
Favourite picture setting
To clear all
In step
1
, select [Favorite] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
When you set [Favorite] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set is displayed with the
[Favorite] icon of the first picture.
Only when [Playback Mode] is set to [Normal Play], you can select [Cancel].
Not available in the following case:
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [ ]
220
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Print Set]
Picture/picture no./date printing settings can be made for when printing with DPOF
print-compatible shops or printers. (Ask at the shop to check for compatibility.)
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Print Set] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select a still picture
[Single]
Use to select still picture and press [MENU/SET]
Count
DateDate
[Multi]
Use to select still picture and press [MENU/SET]
Count
2 3
4 5 6
1
DateDate
3
Use to set number of still pictures and press [MENU/SET]
(Repeat steps
2
and
3
when using [Multi] (up to 999 pictures))
Date print setting/release → Press
.
To clear all
In step
1
, select [Print Set] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
When you have performed [Print Set] for pictures in a group, printing settings are made for the
total of number of pictures set in that group. If the total number of pictures is 1,000 or higher,
[999+] is displayed.
When you perform [Print Set] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set and the total
number of pictures are displayed with the Print Set icon of the first picture.
Date print setting cannot be made for pictures with a [Text Stamp] applied.
Depending on the type of printer, the printer settings may take priority over camera settings.
Some DPOF information (print settings) set by other equipment cannot be used. In such cases,
delete all of the DPOF information and then set it again with this camera.
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Cannot be set for files that are not compliant with the DCF standard.
221
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Protect]
Set protection to disable picture deletion. Prevents deletion of important pictures.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Protect] → [Single] or [Multi]
2
Select picture
[Single]
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
Picture protected
[Multi]
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
2 3
4 5 6
1
Picture protected
To clear all
In step
1
, select [Protect] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
When you set the write-protect switch on the card to the “LOCK” position, the
picture is not erased.
The picture is erased when formatting, even if it is protected.
May not be effective when using other devices.
When you set [Protect] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set is displayed with the
[Protect] icon of the first picture.
222
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Face Rec Edit]
Edit or delete the recognition information for pictures with mistaken Face Recognition.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Face Rec Edit] → [REPLACE] or [DELETE]
2
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
3
Use to select a person and press [MENU/SET]
If [DELETE], go to step
5
.
People whose Face Recognition information has not been registered cannot be selected.
4
Use to select the person to replace for another and press [MENU/SET]
5
Use to select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]
When Face Recognition information is deleted, it cannot be restored.
Pictures for which all Face Recognition information has been deleted are not categorised in Face
Recognition during [Category Play] or [Category Selection].
Edit the Face Recognition information in group units for a group picture. (You cannot edit the
information for each picture in a group.)
You can edit only the first picture in a group.
223
SQW0024
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Using the [Playback] menu
[Picture Sort]
You can set the display sequence used for playing back pictures on this unit.
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Picture Sort]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[FILE NAME]
Displays pictures in the folder name or file name sequence. This display
format allows you to find the storage location of a picture on a card more
easily.
[DATE/TIME]
Displays pictures according to the date and time that the pictures were
taken in chronological order. When the pictures are taken using several
cameras and stored on the same card, this display format allows you find
a specific picture more easily.
Pictures may not be displayed according to the [DATE/TIME] sequence immediately after a card
is inserted into this unit. In that case, wait a while, and the pictures will be displayed in the [DATE/
TIME] sequence.
[Delete Confirmation]
You can set the Yes/No options that you want to select first on
the confirmation screen when you delete a picture from either
[Yes] or [No].
"No" first"No" first
"Yes" first"Yes" first
1
Set the menu
[Playback] → [Delete Confirmation]
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
["Yes" first] [Yes] is selected by default to quickly perform a deletion.
["No" first]
[No] is selected by default. This setting will prevent you from
accidentally deleting pictures.
224
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi
®
Function and NFC Function
Use the camera as a wireless LAN device
When using equipment or computer systems that require more reliable security than
wireless LAN devices, ensure that the appropriate measures are taken for safety
designs and defects for the systems used. Panasonic will not take any responsibility
for any damage that arises when using the camera for any purpose other than as a
wireless LAN device.
Use of the Wi-Fi function of this camera is presumed to be in countries where
this camera is sold
There is the risk that the camera violates the radio wave regulations if used in countries
other than those where this camera is sold, and Panasonic takes no responsibility for
any violations.
There is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be intercepted
Please note that there is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be
intercepted by a third party. We strongly recommend that you enable encryption in the
settings of your wireless access point to ensure information security.
Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or
interference
• Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or interference,
such as near microwave ovens. Radio waves may not reach the camera.
• Using the camera near devices such as microwave ovens or cordless telephones
that use the 2.4 GHz radio wave band may cause a decrease in performance in both
devices.
Do not connect to the wireless network you are not authorised to use
When the camera utilises its Wi-Fi function, wireless networks will be searched
automatically. When this happens, wireless networks that you are not authorised to use
(SSID
*
) may be displayed, however do not attempt to connect to the network as it may
be considered as unauthorised access.
*
SSID refers to the name that is used to identify a network over a wireless LAN connection. If the
SSID matches for both devices, transmission is possible.
Before Use
• To use the Wi-Fi function on this unit, a wireless access point or a destination device
equipped with the wireless LAN function is required.
The camera is compatible with NFC
Using the NFC (Near Field Communication) function, the
camera and a smartphone/tablet can easily exchange the
information needed to establish a Wi-Fi connection.
225
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi
®
Function and NFC Function
About the Wi-Fi connection lamp
[Wi-Fi] button
Wi-Fi connection lamp
Lit blue: When the Wi-Fi function is ON
Blinking blue: When sending data
About the [Wi-Fi] button
You can operate the [Wi-Fi]/[Fn2] button in two ways, using it either as the
[Wi-Fi] button or as a function button [Fn2].
It is set to [Wi-Fi] at the time of purchase.
For more details about the function button (→37)
• Before a Wi-Fi connection is established, press the [Wi-Fi] button to perform the
following operations:
(You can also display the same menu by selecting
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function].)
[New Connection]
[Select a destination from History]
(→268)
[Select a destination from Favorite]
(→268)
226
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi
®
Function and NFC Function
• Pressing the [Wi-Fi] button during a Wi-Fi connection enables the following operation.
[Terminate the Connection] Terminates the Wi-Fi connection.
[Change the Destination]
*
1
Terminates the Wi-Fi connection, and allows you to
select a different Wi-Fi connection.
[Change Settings for Sending
Images]
*
2
For details (→271).
[Register the Current Destination to
Favorite]
*
1
Registering the current connection destination or the
connection method, you can easily connect with the
same connection method next time.
[Network Address]
Displays the MAC address and IP address of this unit
(→273).
*
1
This item will not be displayed if you press to send pictures to WEB services while the
pictures are displayed (→254).
*
2
This item will not be displayed if the destination for [Remote Shooting & View], [Playback on
TV] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Printer].
Do not remove the memory card or battery or move to an area without any reception while
sending images.
The camera cannot be used to connect to a public wireless LAN connection.
Use a IEEE802.11b, IEEE802.11g or IEEE802.11n compatible device when using a wireless
access point.
We recommend that you use a fully charged battery when you send pictures.
When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or
the connection may be disrupted. (A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.)
When sending images on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred
depending on the details of your contract.
Pictures may not be completely sent depending on radio wave conditions. If the connection is
terminated while sending pictures, pictures with missing sections may be sent.
The monitor display may become distorted for an instant while connected to the service, however
this will not affect the image being sent.
227
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
What you can do with the Wi-Fi function
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone (→228)
Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording)
Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone/tablet
Saving pictures in the camera to the smartphone/tablet
Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services
Writing the location information on pictures in the camera
Connect easily, transfer pictures easily
You can easily use the Wi-Fi function by
pressing and holding the [Wi-Fi] button or
using the NFC function.
or
Press and
hold
Hold the device
close to the camera
Displaying still pictures on a TV (→242)
Wireless printing (→243)
Sending pictures to AV device (→244)
Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV device in the home (home AV
device).
Sending pictures to a PC (→247)
Using WEB services (→251)
Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social
networking services, etc. You can receive still pictures and motion pictures on a PC or a
smartphone/tablet using the Cloud Sync. Service.
• Hereafter, this manual uses the term “smartphone” for both smartphones and tablets
unless it is necessary to distinguish between them.
228
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a
smartphone
You can remotely operate the camera using a smartphone.
The “Panasonic Image App” (hereafter “Image App”) must be installed on your
smartphone.
Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App”
The “Image App” is an application provided by Panasonic that allows your smartphone to
perform the following operations of a Wi-Fi-compatible LUMIX.
For Android™ apps For iOS apps
Supported OS
Android 2.3.3 or later
*
iOS 6.0 or later
(iPhone 3GS is not supported.)
Installation
procedure
Connect your Android device to a
network
Select “Google Play
TM
Store”
Enter “Panasonic Image App” or
“LUMIX” to search for the app
Select “Panasonic Image App” and
install it
The icon will be added to
the menu.
Connect the iOS device to the
network
Select “App Store
SM
Enter “Panasonic Image App” or
“LUMIX” to search for the app
Select “Panasonic Image App” and
install it
The icon will be added to
the menu.
*
To connect this unit with [Wi-Fi Direct], Android OS 4.0 or above is required and the device must be
compatible with Wi-Fi Direct™.
Use the latest version.
Supported OS versions as of September 2014. Supported OS versions may be
changed without prior notice.
Some of the screens and information provided in this document may be different
depending on the supported operating system and “Image App” version.
The service may not be able to be used properly depending on the type of
smartphone being used.
For details about the operating procedure, etc., refer to [Help] in the “Image App”
menu.
For the latest information on the “Image App”, refer to the support site below.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/ (This site is available in English only.)
When downloading the app on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred
depending on the details of your contract.
229
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Connecting to a smartphone
You can easily establish a Wi-Fi connection on the camera by pressing and holding the
[Wi-Fi] button or using the NFC function.
Preparation
Install “Image App” in advance. (→228)
1
Press and hold the [Wi-Fi] button
[Wi-Fi] button
Wi-Fi connection lamp
(Lit blue)
The information (QR Code, SSID and Password) required for
directly connecting your smartphone to this unit is displayed.
After the second time, the screen for the previously used
connection method will appear.
The same screen can be displayed by selecting items from the
menu as follows.
→ [New Connection] →
[Remote Shooting & View]
When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is
displayed in an enlarged size. If it is difficult to read the code, use
the enlarge view. (If your smartphone cannot read the QR code,
move the camera away from the smartphone or use a connection
method other than the QR code.)
To change the connection method, press the [DISP.] button and
select the connection method. (→232)
SSID and Password
QR Code
2
Operate the smartphone
When the connection is complete, live images being captured by the camera are displayed on
the smartphone.
(It may take some time after the operation for the connection to be established.)
The connection method differs depending on the smartphone used. (→230, 231)
230
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Using an iOS device
• When reading a QR Code to connect
(Steps
to are not necessary when reconnecting.)
Start “Image App” (→228)
Select [QR Code] → [OK]
Read the QR Code displayed on this unit with “Image App”
(When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is displayed in an
enlarged size.)
Install the IMAGE APP profile
Select [Install]
*
, then select [Install Now]
*
→ [Done]
*
.
The message is displayed in the Web browser.
If a passcode is required to unlock the smartphone, you will have to
input the passcode.
Press the home button to close the Web browser
Select [Wi-Fi]
*
under [Settings]
*
on the smartphone
Turn on [Wi-Fi]
*
and select the SSID displayed on this unit
Return to the home screen and start “Image App” (→228)
*
The display may differ depending on the system language setting.
231
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
• When connecting with SSID and password
Select [Wi-Fi]
*
under [Settings]
*
on the smartphone
Turn on [Wi-Fi]
*
and select the SSID displayed on this unit
Enter the password displayed on this unit (First time connecting only)
Return to the home screen and start “Image App” (→228)
*
The display may differ depending on the system language setting.
Using an Android device
• When reading a QR Code to connect
Start “Image App” (→228)
Select [QR Code]
Read the QR Code displayed on this unit with “Image App”
(When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is displayed in an
enlarged size.)
• When connecting with SSID and password
Start “Image App” (→228)
Select [Wi-Fi]
Select the SSID displayed on this unit
Enter the password displayed on this unit (First time connecting only)
• If you check the item to display the password, you can confirm the password as you
enter it.
232
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Changing the connection method
To change the connection method, press
the [DISP.] button and select the connection
method.
When connecting with [Via Network]
(On the camera)
Select [Via Network] and press [MENU/SET]
Connect the camera to a wireless access point by following the connection method (→264).
(On your smartphone)
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set
Start “Image App” (→228)
When connecting with [Direct]
(On the camera)
Select [Direct] and press [MENU/SET]
Select [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection], and connect the camera to the smartphone by
following the connection method (→267).
(On your smartphone)
Start “Image App” (→228)
Closing the connection
After use, close the connection with the smartphone.
(On the camera)
1
Press [Wi-Fi] button
(On the recording standby screen, you can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
2
Select [Terminate the Connection]
A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET].
(On your smartphone)
3
Close “Image App”
<Using an iOS device>
From the “Image App” screen, press the home button on the smartphone to close the app
<Using an Android device>
From the “Image App” screen, press the back button on the smartphone twice to close the app
233
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Connecting to a smartphone using NFC function
Using the NFC (Near Field Communication) function, the camera and a smartphone can
easily exchange the information needed to establish a Wi-Fi connection.
Compatible models:
This function can be used with NFC compatible devices with Android (2.3.3 or above).
(Not available in certain models)
• See the operating instructions of your NFC-compatible smartphone for more
information about smartphone operation and settings.
Preparations
(On the camera)
Set [NFC Operation] to [ON] (→272)
(On your smartphone)
Check if your smartphone is a compatible model
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Install “Image App” in advance (→228)
1
Start “Image App” on your smartphone
2
While the [ ] is displayed on the connection
screen of the “Image App”, hold the smartphone
close to the camera
Hold the smartphone
close to this area
(within 5 mm (0.20 inch))
3
Use to select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]
4
Hold the smartphone close to this area of the
unit again
When the connection is complete, live images captured
by the camera will be displayed on your smartphone.
It may take some time to complete the connection.
Connected smartphones are registered to this unit.
From the next time and on, you can connect by
performing steps
1
and
2
.
234
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
You can register up to 20 smartphones. If the number of registered smartphones exceeds 20,
registrations will be deleted starting from the smartphone touched first.
If you perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings], smartphone registration will be deleted.
If the communication environment is bad, the NFC function may not be usable.
If there is not a response immediately, shift the position slightly.
Do not bump your smartphone strongly against this unit.
See the operating instructions of your NFC-compatible smartphone for more information about
smartphone operation and settings.
Metal objects between this unit and the smartphone may interfere with communication. Also, any
stickers, etc., near the NFC area may affect communication performance.
Not available in the following cases:
The NFC function cannot be used in the following cases:
When the camera is turned off (Including [Sleep Mode])
During motion picture recording
While recording still pictures (during self-timer countdown)
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
When using [Multi Exp.]
During motion picture playback, during slide shows, during panorama picture playback, and
during continuous playback of group pictures (including pauses in each case)
While sending pictures by Wi-Fi
When connected to computer/printer
You cannot transfer still pictures in RAW format, AVCHD motion pictures, or MP4 motion pictures
with [Rec Quality] of [4K].
Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording)
1
Connect to a smartphone (→229)
2
Select [ ] from “Image App”
3
Take pictures
The recorded images are saved in the camera.
When using zoom, the camera could tilt when the lens barrel extends. Make sure to secure the
camera in place with a tripod or by other means.
Some settings are not available.
235
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone
1
Connect to a smartphone (→229)
Switch the
location of the
pictures to be
displayed
2
Select [ ] from “Image App”
The images captured by the camera are displayed on the smartphone.
You can switch a picture to be displayed using the icon at the top left on
the screen. Select [LUMIX] to display a picture saved in the camera.
When the picture is touched, it is played back at a larger size.
Saving pictures in the camera to the smartphone
1
Connect to a smartphone (→229)
2
Select [ ] from “Image App”
3
Press and hold the picture and drag it to save it on the
smartphone
The picture is saved on the smartphone.
Functions can be assigned to the top, bottom, left and right as you wish.
Not available in the following case:
You cannot save still pictures in RAW format, AVCHD motion pictures, or MP4 motion pictures with
[Rec Quality] of [4K].
236
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Easily transferring pictures in the camera
You can establish a Wi-Fi connection using the NFC function and easily transfer over
Wi-Fi the picture on display simply by holding the smartphone close to the camera.
Pictures can be transferred as soon as they are recorded, so you can easily transfer them
to your friends’ and family’s smartphones.
*
*
“Image App” must be installed to use this function.
Preparations
(On the camera)
Set [NFC Operation] to [ON] (→272)
Set [Touch Sharing] to [ON] (→272)
(On your smartphone)
Check if your smartphone is a compatible model
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Install “Image App” in advance (→228)
1
On the camera, play back the picture you wish
to transfer to a smartphone
Hold the smartphone
close to this area
(within 5 mm (0.20 inch))
2
Start “Image App” on the smartphone you are
transferring the picture to
3
While the [ ] is displayed on the connection
screen of the “Image App”, hold the smartphone
close to the camera
It will be transferred to the smartphone.
If you are transferring multiple pictures, repeat steps
1
and
3
. (Multiple pictures cannot be transferred in one
batch.)
It may take several minutes to complete the picture
transfer depending on the environment used.
237
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services
1
Connect to a smartphone (→229)
Switch the
location of the
pictures to be
displayed
2
Select [ ] from “Image App”
3
Press and hold the picture and
drag it to send it to the social
networking service, etc.
The picture will be sent to the social
networking service or other WEB
services.
Functions can be assigned to the top,
bottom, left and right as you wish.
Adding location information to pictures in the camera from a
smartphone
You can send the location information acquired from a smartphone to the camera. After
the information is sent, you can write it on the pictures in the camera.
GPS
Starts location information recording
Ends location information recording
Sends and writes the location
information
Start the recording
• Location information that is different from the information acquired during recording may
be written. Take care regarding the following matters.
Set [Home] of [World Time] of the camera to your home area.
Once a smartphone starts recording the location information, do not change the
[Home] setting of [World Time] of the camera.
• The location information cannot be written to pictures recorded without setting [Clock
Set].
238
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Starts location information recording
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
Select [Geotagging]
Select [ ]
Ends location information recording
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
Select [Geotagging]
Select [ ]
Sends and writes the location information
Connect to a smartphone (→229)
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
Select [Geotagging]
Select [ ]
Follow the messages on the screen to perform the operation.
Location information will not be written to AVCHD motion pictures.
Location information may not be written if there is not enough free space on your card.
You can also use [Location Logging] in the [Playback] menu to write the sent location
information to the pictures.
Caution:
Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, the likeness rights, etc. of the subject when
you use this function. Use at your own risk.
On the smartphone, you can set the acquisition interval of location information and check the
transfer status of location information. Refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu for details.
(When using “Image App” for iOS)
If you press the Home or On/Off button of a smartphone while location information recording is in
progress, recording is stopped.
239
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Operating the camera to send pictures to a smartphone
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD
[Send Images While Recording] (→240)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
(→241)
*
*
Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about
picture playback.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
Preparation
Install “Image App” in advance. (→228)
240
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
[Send Images While Recording]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [Smartphone]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] and press [MENU/SET]
When connecting with [Via Network]
(On the camera)
Connect the camera to a wireless access point (→264)
(On your smartphone)
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set
Start “Image App” (→228)
When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct]
(On the camera)
Connect the camera to a smartphone (→267)
(On your smartphone)
Start “Image App” (→228)
When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct]
Perform step
2
(→229).
3
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press the
[DISP.] button. (→271)
4
Take still pictures
The still pictures are sent automatically after taking them.
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button.
You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
241
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Smartphone]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] and press [MENU/SET]
When connecting with [Via Network]
(On the camera)
Connect the camera to a wireless access point (→264)
(On your smartphone)
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set
Start “Image App” (→228)
When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct]
(On the camera)
Connect the camera to a smartphone (→267)
(On your smartphone)
Start “Image App” (→228)
When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct]
Perform step
2
(→229).
3
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press the
[DISP.] button. (→271)
4
Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
Press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be cancelled.
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button.
To close the connection, select [Exit].
242
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Displaying still pictures on a TV
You can display still pictures on a TV that is compatible with a DLNA certified digital
media renderer (DMR) function.
Preparation
Set the TV to DLNA waiting Mode.
Read the operating instructions for your TV.
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Playback on TV]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the screen is displayed.
4
Take or play back still pictures on this unit
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
When you display the pictures on a TV using the Wi-Fi function, they are not output using 4K
resolution. To output pictures using 4K resolution, connect this unit to the TV using an HDMI micro
cable. (→276)
When a TV is connected to this unit, the TV screen may temporarily return to the status before the
connection. Pictures are displayed again when you take or play back pictures.
Even if [Effect] and [Sound] are set on this unit, these settings are disabled when the pictures are
played back on a TV during Slide Show playback.
It may take some time to establish the Wi-Fi connection or it may not be connected at all
depending on the distance from this unit to the TV.
Not available in the following cases:
Playback of motion pictures or panorama pictures, and continuous playback of group pictures are
not displayed on a TV.
During the multi/calendar playback, pictures displayed on the screen of this unit are not displayed
on TV.
243
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Wireless printing
You can print out recorded still pictures wirelessly from a PictBridge (wireless
LAN-compatible)
*
printer.
*
Compliant with the DPS over IP standards.
Contact the printer manufacturers for details on PictBridge (wireless LAN-compatible) printers.
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Printer]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select a printer you want to connect
4
Select the still picture and print
Pictures are selected the same way as when connecting by USB connection cable (supplied).
For more details (→287).
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
(You can also close the connection by pressing the [
] button.)
Not available in the following case:
Motion pictures cannot be printed.
244
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to AV device
Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV devices in the home (home AV
devices), such as DLNA compatible recorders.
Wireless access point
Home AV device
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD
[Send Images While Recording] (→245)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
(→246)
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about
picture playback.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
Preparations
When sending a picture to AV devices, set your device to DLNA waiting Mode.
Read the operating instructions of your device for details.
245
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to AV device
[Send Images While Recording]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [AV device]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
4
Take still pictures
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
246
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to AV device
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [AV device]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
4
Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
Press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be cancelled.
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button.
To close the connection, select [Exit].
247
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
Still pictures and motion pictures recorded by the camera can be sent to a PC.
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4
AVCHD
*
[Send Images While Recording] (→249)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
(→250)
*
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] can be sent in file sizes of up to 4 GB. Files larger than 4 GB
cannot be sent.
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about
picture playback.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
Preparations
Turn the computer on.
Prepare folders for receiving images on the PC before sending a picture to the PC. (→248)
If the standard settings are changed for the workgroup on the connected PC, you must change
settings in [PC Connection] on this unit. (→272)
248
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
To create a folder that receives images
• Create a PC user account (account name (up to 254 characters) and password (up to
32 characters)) consisting of alphanumeric characters. An attempt to create a receive
folder may fail if the account includes non-alphanumeric characters.
When using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the PC
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” is not compatible with Mac.
For details on hardware requirements and installation, read “Installing supplied software”
(→281, 283).
Create a folder that receives images with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
To create the folder automatically, select [Auto-create]. To specify a folder, create a new folder,
or set a password to the folder, select [Create manually].
For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
When not using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
(For Windows)
Supported OS: Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7 / Windows Vista
Example: Windows 7
Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then right-click
Select [Properties], then enable sharing of the folder
For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system.
(For Mac)
Supported OS: OS X v10.5 to v10.9
Example: OS X v10.8
Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then click on the items in the following
order
[File] → [Get Info]
Enable sharing of the folder
For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system.
249
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
[Send Images While Recording]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [PC]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select the PC you want to connect to
If the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], then enter the computer
name (for Mac, enter the NetBIOS name).
4
Select the folder you want to send to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
5
Take still pictures
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
250
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [PC]
2
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263)
3
Select the PC you want to connect to
If the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], then enter the computer
name (for Mac, enter the NetBIOS name).
4
Select the folder you want to send to
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
5
Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
Press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be cancelled.
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button.
To close the connection, select [Exit].
Folders sorted by the sent date are created in the specified folder, and pictures are saved in those
folders.
If the screen for a user account and password entry appears, enter the one you set on your PC.
If the computer name (for Mac, the NetBIOS name) contains spaces, etc., the name may not be
properly recognised. If you cannot connect, we recommend changing the computer name (for
Mac, the NetBIOS name) to a combination of 15 or less alphanumeric characters only.
251
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social
networking services, etc. By selecting the setting to automatically transfer still pictures
and motion pictures to [Cloud Sync. Service], you can receive the transferred still pictures
and motion pictures on a PC or a smartphone.
Wireless access point
WEB services
Cloud
synchronisation
services
LUMIX CLUB
When sending images to WEB service
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD
[Send Images While Recording] (→253)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
(→253)
*
*
Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• For details about playback of pictures, check the WEB service to which you will send
the pictures.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
Preparation
You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→258) to send a picture to a WEB service.
To send images to a WEB service, you need to register the WEB service. (→252)
252
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Images may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such as a
title, the time and date when the images were taken, and the location where the image was
taken. Check this information before uploading images to WEB services.
Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages resulting from the leakage, loss, etc.
of images uploaded on WEB services.
When uploading images to the WEB service, do not delete images from this camera, even
after they have finished sending, until you have checked that they have been properly
uploaded to the WEB service. Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages
resulting from the deletion of images stored in this unit.
Images uploaded to the WEB service cannot be displayed or deleted with this camera. Check
images by accessing the WEB service with your smartphone or computer.
If sending images fails, a report email outlining the failure will be sent to the email address
registered with “LUMIX CLUB”.
Registering the WEB service to “LUMIX CLUB”
When sending images to WEB services, the WEB service being used must be registered
with the “LUMIX CLUB”.
• Check the “FAQ/Contact us” on the following site for compatible WEB services.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/lumix_faqs/
Preparation
Make sure that you have created an account on the WEB service you want to use, and have the
login information available.
1
Connect to the “LUMIX CLUB” site using a smartphone or computer
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
2
Enter your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password and log in to the service
3
If you have not registered your email address with “LUMIX CLUB”, register the
email address
4
Select the WEB service to be used for WEB service link settings and register it
Follow the instructions on the screen to register the service.
253
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
[Send Images While Recording]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [Web service]
2
Select [Via Network] and connect (→264)
3
Select a WEB service you want to connect
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
4
Take still pictures
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Web service]
2
Select [Via Network] and connect (→264)
3
Select a WEB service you want to connect
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
4
Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
Press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be cancelled.
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button.
To close the connection, select [Exit].
254
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Quickly sending pictures in the camera to WEB services
Once you send a picture, you can send pictures to the WEB service as quickly and
easily as using a smartphone, only when the environment for connecting to a wireless
access point is available.
Display the picture
Use to select [Yes] after pressing
(When a group picture is being displayed, select
[Upload(Wi-Fi)] → [Yes])
The camera is connected to the previously used wireless access
point and the pictures are sent to the WEB service.
*
1,
*
2
Upload this image by Wi-Fi?Upload this image by Wi-Fi?
YesYes
NoNo
*
1
When no connection history is available for the wireless access point, proceed to the connection
method selection screen. Select the connection method and connect the camera to a wireless
access point. (→264)
*
2
If you do not have a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID, proceed to the new login ID sign up screen. Get a
login ID and set a password. (→259)
Performing the operation for the first time
After you select [Yes] in step above, the WEB service selection screen appears.
Use to select WEB services and press [MENU/SET]
Check the setting on the confirmation screen for the transmission setting and press
[MENU/SET]
The picture is sent to the WEB service.
To change the transmission setting for the picture, press the [DISP.] button. (→271)
After the second time, the pictures are sent using the same WEB service and the same
picture transmission settings as before.
When pictures are displayed as a group, they are all sent. When a single picture in a group is
displayed, only the picture being displayed is sent.
To change the transmission settings of a picture or to close the Wi-Fi connection, press the [Wi-Fi]
button. You can also close the connection by pressing the Playback button or [MENU/SET] and
selecting [Yes]. When you switch to Recording Mode, the Wi-Fi connection is closed.
255
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service]
Sending method, and pictures that can be sent
JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD
[Send Images While Recording] (→256)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
(→257)
*
*
Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about
picture playback.
• For more details about picture sending methods. (→270)
Preparation
You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→258) and configure the Cloud Sync. setting to send a
picture to a Cloud Folder. Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on a PC or “Image App” on a smartphone to
configure the Cloud Sync. settings.
About the images sent to a Cloud Folder by the use of [Cloud Sync. Service]
(Current as of September 2014)
• If you set the picture destination to [Cloud Sync. Service], sent pictures are
temporarily saved in the cloud folder, and they can be synchronised with the device
in use, such as the PC or smartphone.
• A Cloud Folder stores transferred images for 30 days (up to 1,000 pictures).
Transferred images are deleted automatically 30 days after the transfer.
Furthermore, when the number of stored images exceeds 1,000, some images may
be deleted depending on the [Cloud Limit] (→271) setting even within 30 days after
the transfer.
• When the download of images from a Cloud Folder to all specified devices is
complete, images may be deleted from the Cloud Folder even within 30 days after
the transfer.
256
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
[Send Images While Recording]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording]
→ [Cloud Sync. Service]
2
Check the message and press [MENU/SET]
3
Select [Via Network] and connect (→264)
4
Check the send setting
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
5
Take still pictures
To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)
You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
(You can also close the connection by pressing
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] →
[Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].)
257
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
1
Set the menu
→ [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Cloud Sync. Service]
2
Check the message and press [MENU/SET]
3
Select [Via Network] and connect (→264)
4
Check the send setting
When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is
displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.]
button. (→271)
5
Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
Press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be cancelled.
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.
To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button.
To close the connection, select [Exit].
258
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
About the [LUMIX CLUB]
Acquire a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID (free).
If you register this unit to the “LUMIX CLUB”, you can synchronise images between the
devices you are using, or transfer these images to WEB services.
Use the “LUMIX CLUB” when uploading pictures to WEB services.
• You can set the same “LUMIX CLUB” login ID for this unit and a smartphone. (→261)
Refer to the “LUMIX CLUB” site for details.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
Please note;
• The service may be suspended due to regular maintenance or unexpected problems,
and service contents may be changed or added to, without prior notice to the users.
• The service may be stopped in whole or in part with a reasonable period of advance
notice.
259
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Acquiring a new login ID ([New account])
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
2
Select [Set/Add Account]
3
Select [New account]
Connect to the network. Proceed to the next page by pressing [MENU/SET].
A confirmation screen will be displayed if a login ID has already been acquired for the camera.
Select [Yes] to acquire a new login ID, or [No] if you do not need to acquire a new login ID.
4
Select the method for connecting to a wireless access point, and set
For details (→264).
The settings screen will only appear during the first connection. Connection methods set on this
unit are stored and will be used for subsequent connections. If you want to change the wireless
access point to connect to, press the [DISP.] button, then change the connecting destination.
5
Read through the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use and press [MENU/SET]
You can press to switch pages.
Turn the zoom lever clockwise to enlarge the page display (x2 magnification).
If you turn the zoom lever counterclockwise after enlarging the page, the page returns to its
original size (no magnification).
You can use
to move the position of the area to be enlarged.
Press [
] button to cancel the process without acquiring a login ID.
6
Enter the password
Enter any combination of 8 to 16 characters and numbers for the password.
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52).
7
Check the login ID and press [MENU/SET]
The login ID (12-digit number) will be displayed automatically.
When logging in to the “LUMIX CLUB” with a computer, you only
need to enter the numbers.
A message is displayed when the connection is complete. Press
[MENU/SET].
Be sure to make a note of the login ID and password.
260
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Using a previously acquired login ID/confirming and changing login ID
and password ([Set Login ID])
Preparation
To use a previously acquired login ID, confirm your ID and password.
To change the “LUMIX CLUB” password on the camera, access the “LUMIX CLUB” website from
your smartphone or PC and change the “LUMIX CLUB” password in advance.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
2
Select [Set/Add Account]
3
Select [Set Login ID]
The login ID and password are displayed.
The password is displayed as “
”.
Close the menu if only checking the login ID.
4
Select the item you wish to change
5
Enter your login ID or password
Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter text.
Enter the new password you have created on your smartphone or PC into the camera. If the
password differs from the one you created on your smartphone or PC, you will not be able to
upload images.
6
Select [Exit]
261
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
To set the same login ID for the camera and the smartphone
• Setting the same login ID on this unit and your smartphone is convenient for sending
images on this unit to other devices or WEB services.
When either this unit or the smartphone has acquired the login ID
Connect this unit to the smartphone (→229)
From the “Image App” menu, set the common login ID
The login IDs for this unit and the smartphone become the same.
• After connecting this unit to the smartphone, the setup screen for a common login ID
may appear when you display the playback screen. You can also set a common login
ID by following the on-screen instructions.
• This operation is not available for [Wi-Fi Direct] connection.
When this unit and the smartphone have acquired different login IDs
When you want to use the smartphone’s login ID for this unit
Change the login ID and password for this unit to those acquired by the smartphone.
When you want to use this unit’s login ID for the smartphone
Change the login ID and password for the smartphone to those acquired by this unit.
Check the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use
Check the details if the terms of use have been updated.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
2
Select [Terms of use]
The camera will connect to the network and the terms of use will be displayed.
262
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Delete your login ID and account from the “LUMIX CLUB”
Delete the login ID from the camera when transferring it to another party or disposing of it.
You can also delete your “LUMIX CLUB” account.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
2
Select [Delete account]
The message is displayed. Press [MENU/SET].
3
Select [Yes] in the login ID delete confirmation screen
The message is displayed. Press [MENU/SET].
4
Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen for deleting the “LUMIX CLUB” account
If you want to continue using the service, selecting [No] will only delete the login ID. Exit the
menu after it is executed.
5
Press [MENU/SET]
The login ID is deleted, and then the message notifying the deletion of your account is displayed.
Press [MENU/SET].
Changes and other actions to login IDs can only be made to the login ID acquired with the camera.
263
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
After selecting the Wi-Fi function and sending destination, select the connection method.
If you are out and unable to use your wireless access point, or temporarily connecting to
equipment you do not ordinarily use, or in a similar situation, it is convenient to make a
direct connection.
If you are connecting with the same settings as used previously, you can quickly start
using the Wi-Fi function by connecting with [Select a destination from History] or [Select a
destination from Favorite].
Wireless access point
Connection method Description
[Via Network] Connects through a wireless access point. (→264)
[Direct] Your equipment connects directly to the camera. (→267)
264
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
[Via Network] Connecting via a wireless access point
Select a connection method to the wireless access point.
• WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure
the settings related to the connection and security of
wireless LAN devices. To check if the wireless access
point you are using is compatible with WPS, refer to the
instruction manual of the wireless access point.
Connection method Description
[WPS (Push-Button)]
Save push button type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ with a WPS mark.
1
Press the wireless access point WPS button until it
switches to WPS Mode
Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details.
[WPS (PIN code)]
Save PIN code type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected Setup with a WPS mark.
1
Select the wireless access point you are connecting to
2
Enter the PIN code displayed on the camera screen
into the wireless access point
3
Press [MENU/SET]
Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details.
[From List]
Select this option when you are not sure about the WPS compatibility,
or when you want to search for and connect to a wireless access
point.
For details (→265).
265
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility
(connecting by [From List])
Search for available wireless access points.
• Confirm encryption key of the selected wireless access point if the network
authentication is encrypted.
• When connecting by [Manual Input], confirm SSID, network authentication type,
encryption type, encryption key of the wireless access point you are using.
1
Select the wireless access point you are connecting to
Pressing [DISP.] button will search for a wireless access point
again.
If no wireless access point is found, refer to “When connecting
with [Manual Input]” (→266).
2
(If network authentication is encrypted)
Enter the encryption key
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52).
266
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
When connecting with [Manual Input]
On the screen of step
1
of “If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility
(connecting by [From List])”, select [Manual Input] (→265)
Enter the SSID of the wireless access point you are connecting to, then select [Set]
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52).
Select the network authentication type
For information on network authentication, see the instruction manual of the wireless access
point.
Select the encryption type
The type of settings that can be changed may vary depending on the details of network
authentication settings.
Network authentication type Encryption types that can be set
[WPA2-PSK] / [WPA-PSK] [TKIP] / [AES]
[Common Key] [WEP]
[Open] [No Encryption] / [WEP]
(When an option other than [No Encryption] is selected)
Enter the encryption key
Check the wireless access points instruction manual and settings when a saving wireless access
point.
If no connection can be established, the wireless access point’s radio waves may be too weak.
Refer to “Message displays” (→299) and “Q&A Troubleshooting” (→310) for details.
Transmission speed may decrease, or may not be usable depending on the environment it is used
in.
267
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
[Direct] Connecting directly
You can select the connection method to your equipment.
Select a connection method with which your equipment is
compatible.
Connection method Description
[Wi-Fi Direct]
*
1
1
Set the device to Wi-Fi Direct™ mode
2
Select [Wi-Fi Direct]
3
Select the device to connect to
Read the operating instructions of your device for details.
[WPS Connection]
*
2
[WPS (Push-Button)]
1
Select [WPS (Push-Button)]
2
Set the device to WPS mode
You can wait longer for a connection by pressing the
[DISP.] button on this unit.
[WPS (PIN code)]
1
Select [WPS (PIN code)]
2
Enter the PIN code of the device into this
unit
[Manual Connection]
1
Enter the SSID and password into the
device. The SSID and password are
displayed on the connection waiting
screen of this unit.
SSID and Password
QR Code
If the transfer destination is [Smartphone], you can
read the QR Code with your smartphone to connect.
(→229)
*
1
To connect this unit with [Wi-Fi Direct], Android OS 4.0 or above is required and the device must be
compatible with Wi-Fi Direct™.
*
2
WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure the settings related to the connection
and security of wireless LAN devices.
268
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
Connecting quickly with the same settings as used previously
([Select a destination from History] / [Select a destination from
Favorite])
The camera keeps a History of times you used the Wi-Fi function. You can register items
in the History to Favourite.
You can easily connect with the same settings as used previously by connecting from
History or Favourite.
1
Press [Wi-Fi] button
2
Select [Select a destination from History] or [Select a
destination from Favorite]
Item Description
[Select a destination from
History]
Connects using the same settings as
used previously.
[Select a destination from
Favorite]
Connects using settings registered in
Favourite.
3
Select the desired connection setting
Registering History items to Favourite
1
Press [Wi-Fi] button
2
Select [Select a destination from History]
3
Select the item you wish to register and press
4
Enter a registration name
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52).
Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character will be treated as two characters.
269
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
Editing items registered in Favourite
1
Press [Wi-Fi] button
2
Select [Select a destination from Favorite]
3
Select the Favourite item you wish to edit and press
4
Select item
Item Description
[Remove from Favorite]
[Change the Order in Favorite] Select the destination
[Change the Registered Name]
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→52).
Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character
will be treated as two characters.
Registering and saving frequently used Wi-Fi connection settings to
Favourites
The number of settings that can be saved in the history is limited. We recommend that
you register and save frequently used Wi-Fi connection settings to Favourite. (→268)
Checking connection details of History or Favourite
When selecting History or Favourite items, you can view connection details by pressing
the [DISP.] button.
Performing [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] deletes content registered in History and Favourite.
When using [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite] to connect to
a network to which many PCs are connected, it may be difficult to make the connection because
the camera searches for previously connected equipment out of a large number of equipment
pieces. If you cannot connect, retry the connection using [New Connection].
270
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
Settings for sending pictures
When sending pictures, first select [New Connection], then
select the method of sending pictures.
After you have completed connecting, you can also change
the sending settings, such as the size of pictures to be sent.
[Send Images While Recording]
A picture can be automatically sent to a specified device every time you take it.
[ ] is displayed on the recording screen while connected by [Send
Images While Recording], and [
] is displayed while files are being
sent.
If you turn off the camera before you have completed sending, or if
you close the Wi-Fi connection, or in similar situations, unsent files
will not be resent.
You may not be able to delete files or use the [Playback] menu
while sending.
11
Not available in the following case:
Motion pictures cannot be sent.
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
You can select and send recorded images.
Details of the [Playback] menu [Favorite] or [Print Set] settings will not be sent.
Not available in the following cases:
Some images taken with a different camera may not be able to be sent.
Images that have been modified or edited with a computer may not be able to be sent.
271
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
About connections
Changing the settings for sending images
After you have completed connecting, you can change the sending settings, such as the
size of pictures to be sent, by pressing the [DISP.] button.
Item Description
[Size]
Resize the image to send.
[Original] / [Auto]
*
1
/ [Change]
If you select [Auto], the image size is determined by the
circumstances at the destination.
You can select the image size for [Change] from [M], [S], or [VGA].
The aspect ratio does not change.
[File Format]
*
2
[JPG] / [RAW+JPG] / [RAW]
[Delete Location Data]
*
3
Select whether to delete the location information from images before
sending them.
[ON]: Delete the location information, then send.
[OFF]: Keep the location information and send.
This operation only deletes the location information from the
images that are set to be sent. (The location information will not
be deleted from the original images stored in this unit.)
[Cloud Limit]
*
4
You can select whether to send images when the Cloud Folder runs
out of free space.
[ON]: Do not send images.
[OFF]: Delete images from the oldest ones, then send new images.
*
1
Only available when the destination is set to [Web service].
*
2
Only available when the destination is set to [PC].
*
3
Only available when the destination for [Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Cloud Sync.
Service] or [Web service].
*
4
Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service].
272
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
[Wi-Fi Setup]
Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function.
[Wi-Fi Setup] cannot be changed when connected to Wi-Fi.
1
Set the menu
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → Desired setting
Item Description
[LUMIX CLUB]
Acquires or changes the
“LUMIX CLUB” login ID.
For details (→258).
[PC Connection]
You can set the workgroup.
You must connect to the same workgroup as the destination
computer when sending pictures to the computer.
(The default is set to “WORKGROUP”)
[Change Workgroup Name]:
Enter the workgroup of the connecting computer. Close the menu
after changing settings.
[Restore to Default]:
Returns settings to default settings. A confirmation screen is
displayed. It is executed when [Yes] is selected.
Exit the menu after it is executed.
Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter
text.
To use with a computer of the standard settings, you do not have
to change the workgroup.
[Device Name]
You can change the name of
this unit.
Press [DISP.] button
Enter the desired device name
Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter
text.
Up to 32 characters can be entered.
[NFC Operation]
Makes NFC function setting.
[ON]: The NFC function works.
[OFF]
[Touch Sharing]
Set the operation to be
performed when a Wi-Fi
connection is established
using the NFC function.
[ON]: When a Wi-Fi connection is established using the NFC
function while playing back a single picture, the picture
(1 picture) is transferred.
[OFF]
273
SQW0024
Wi-Fi
[Wi-Fi Setup]
Item Description
[Wi-Fi Password]
To prevent incorrect operation
or use of the Wi-Fi function
by a third party and to protect
saved personal information,
it is recommended that you
protect the Wi-Fi function with
a password.
Setting a password will automatically display the password input
screen when the Wi-Fi function is used.
[Setup]:
Enter any 4-digit numbers as the password. Close the menu after
changing settings.
[Delete]:
A confirmation screen is displayed. It is executed when [Yes] is
selected.
Exit the menu after it is executed.
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→52).
Make a copy of password. If you forget the password, you can
reset it with [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu, however
other settings will also be reset. (excluding [LUMIX CLUB])
[Network Address]
Displays the MAC address and
IP address of this unit.
A “MAC Address” is a unique address that is used to identify
network equipment.
“IP address” refers to a number that identifies a PC connected to
a network such as the Internet. Usually, the addresses for homes
are automatically assigned by the DHCP function such as a
wireless access point. (Example: 192.168.0.87)
274
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures
Viewing 4K motion pictures
Viewing on TV screen
When you connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV and play
back a motion picture recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K],
you can enjoy high-resolution 4K motion pictures. Although
resolution output will be lower, you can also play back 4K
motion pictures by connecting to a high-definition TV and
other devices that do not have 4K support.
Preparation
When motion pictures are recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K], set [HDMI Mode] (→48) to [AUTO]
or [4K].
Connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV using an HDMI micro cable and display the
playback screen (→276)
When the [VIERA Link] setting on the camera is set to [ON] and the camera is connected to
a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television (VIERA), the television automatically
switches its input and the playback screen is displayed. For details, refer to (→278).
You can also play back motion pictures by inserting the card in a
4K-compatible TV equipped with a SD card slot.
Read the operating instructions for the TV.
Viewing 4K motion pictures on a PC screen
To play back motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
on a PC, use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” stored in the DVD
(supplied).
• To play back and edit 4K motion pictures, a high-performance PC
environment is required.
• For details, refer to the operating instructions of
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
275
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures
Storing 4K motion pictures
Storing 4K motion pictures on your PC
Still/motion pictures can be copied from the camera to your computer by connecting the
two together. For details, refer to (→280).
Storing 4K motion pictures on a DVD
You cannot transfer or copy motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K] to a
Blu-ray disc or DVD using a Panasonic recorder. (Current as of October 2014)
You can use the supplied DVD software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to convert the file size of
a motion picture to a smaller size or copy it to a DVD.
• For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
276
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
You can view pictures on a TV screen by connecting your camera to your TV with the
HDMI micro cable or AV cable (optional).
Preparation
Turn off both camera and TV.
1
Connect camera to TV
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong
direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not
insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
To connect with an HDMI micro cable
An HDMI micro cable can be used to enable viewing of still and motion pictures in
high-resolution.
Align the marks, and insert.
[HDMI] socket
To HDMI video/audio
input socket
HDMI micro cable
Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not
comply with the HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
To connect with an AV cable (optional)
Align the marks, and insert.
[AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket
AV cable (optional)
Yellow:
To video socket
White:
To audio socket
*
*
Monaural audio output.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input source to match the
connection socket
3
Turn on the camera and press the playback button
277
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
To connect with an HDMI micro cable
Check the [HDMI Mode]. (→48)
To play back 24p motion pictures, set [HDMI Mode] to [AUTO]. Otherwise, the picture is not
output at 24 frames per second.
Bars may appear at the sides or at the top and bottom of the screen, depending on the aspect
ratio setting.
Cables that do not comply with HDMI standards will not work.
When an HDMI micro cable is connected, pictures are not displayed on the screen.
HDMI output will be cancelled if a USB connection cable (supplied) is connected simultaneously.
When the AV cable (optional) and HDMI micro cable are connected at the same time, no picture
is output from the AV cable.
Pictures may be momentarily distorted immediately after commencing playback or pausing on
certain televisions.
Audio output is stereo.
Read the operating instructions for the TV.
To connect with an AV cable (optional)
Check the [TV Aspect]. (→47)
Always use a genuine Panasonic AV cable (DMW-AVC1: optional).
You can play back pictures on TVs in other countries (regions) which use the NTSC or PAL
system. You can find [Video Out] setting in [TV Connection] from the [Setup] menu.
Pictures rotated to portrait may be blurred slightly.
Change picture mode settings on TV if aspect ratios are not displayed correctly on widescreen
or high-definition televisions.
The viewfinder display cannot be used.
Read the operating instructions for the TV.
The recorded pictures can be played back on a TV with an SD
Memory Card slot
Proper playback (aspect ratio) will be dependent on the TV used for viewing.
The file format of the motion pictures that can be played back differs depending on the
TV model.
You may not be able to play back panorama pictures. Also you cannot perform
automatic scrolling playback of panorama pictures.
For cards compatible with playback, refer to the operating instructions of the TV.
278
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™)
What is VIERA Link (HDMI)?
VIERA Link is a function that automatically links this camera to VIERA Link-
compatible devices by connecting HDMI micro cables for enabling easy operation
with the VIERA remote control. (Some operations are not available.)
VIERA Link (HDMI) is an exclusive Panasonic function added to the industry-
standard HDMI control functions known as HDMI CEC (Consumer Electronics
Control). Operation is not guaranteed when connecting with non-Panasonic HDMI
CEC-compatible devices. Refer to your product manual to verify compatibility with
VIERA Link (HDMI).
This camera supports VIERA Link (HDMI) Version 5. This is the Panasonic standard
that also supports previous Panasonic VIERA Link devices.
Preparation
Set [VIERA Link] to [ON] (→49).
1
Connect the camera to a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television
(VIERA) with an HDMI micro cable (→276)
2
Turn on the camera and press the playback button
3
Operate with the remote control for the TV
Operate with reference to the operation icons displayed on the screen.
279
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
Other related operations
Turning the unit OFF
• The camera can also be turned off when the television is turned off with the remote
control.
Automatic input select
• This function automatically switches the television input to the camera screen
whenever the camera is turned on while it is connected via the HDMI micro cable.
The television can also be switched on via the camera from Standby Mode
(if “Power on link” on the television is set to “on”).
• If VIERA Link (HDMI) does not function correctly (→323)
Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not comply with the
HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
If you do not know if your TV is VIERA Link (HDMI) compatible, see the TV’s operating
instructions.
Cables that do not comply with HDMI standards will not work.
When VIERA Link is activated, the [HDMI Mode] setting of this unit is automatically recognised.
If the [VIERA Link] setting on the camera is [ON], operations via the camera buttons will be limited.
Ensure that the television you are connecting to has been set up to enable VIERA Link (HDMI)
(consult your television operating instructions for details).
280
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures
on your PC
Still/motion pictures can be copied from the camera to your computer by connecting the
two together.
• Some computers can read directly from the camera’s memory card.
For details, see the instruction manual for your computer.
• If your computer does not support SDXC Memory Cards, a message will be displayed
requesting you to format the card. (Do not format the card. This will erase recorded
pictures.)
If the card is not recognised, refer to the following support website.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html
Computer specifications
You can connect the camera to a computer that can detect a mass storage device
(device that stores a large volume of data).
• Windows: Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7 / Windows Vista
• Mac: OS X v10.5 - v10.9
Some motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] may not be scanned
correctly by copying a file or folder
When using Windows, be sure to use the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the
supplied DVD to copy motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD].
When using Mac, you can copy motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] using “iMovie”.
Note, however, that it may not be possible to copy pictures depending on the picture
quality settings.
(For details about iMovie, please contact Apple Inc.)
281
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
About supplied software
The supplied DVD contains the following software.
Install the software on your computer before using.
PHOTOfunSTUDIO 9.6 PE
You can capture still pictures or motion pictures to your PC, or organise captured pictures
by categorising by recording date, model name of the digital camera used to record, etc.
You can also correct still pictures, edit motion pictures, or write to DVD.
Operating environment
Supported OS
Windows
®
8.1 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows
®
8 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows
®
7 (32-bit/64-bit) and SP1
Windows Vista
®
(32-bit) SP2
CPU
Windows
®
8.1
Pentium
®
ΙΙΙ 1 GHz or higherWindows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Windows Vista
®
Pentium
®
ΙΙΙ 800 MHz or higher
Display 1024×768 pixels or more (1920×1080 pixels or more recommended)
RAM
Windows
®
8.1
1 GB or more (32-bit) / 2 GB or more (64-bit)Windows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Windows Vista
®
512 MB or more
Free hard disk
space
450 MB or more for installing software
• To edit 4K motion pictures, you need the 64-bit versions of Windows 8.1, Windows 8,
or Windows 7.
• Refer to the Operating Instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF) for further
information about the operating environment. You can read the Operating Instructions
after launching the software.
282
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
SILKYPIX Developer Studio 4.2 SE
This software develops and edits RAW file pictures. Edited pictures can be saved in a file
format such as JPEG or TIFF that can be displayed on a PC, etc.
Operating environment
Supported OS
Windows
®
8.1
Windows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Windows Vista
®
Mac
®
OS X v10.5/v10.6/v10.7/v10.8/v10.9
• For details on how to use the SILKYPIX Developer Studio, refer to the “Help” or the
Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s support website:
http://www.isl.co.jp/SILKYPIX/english/p/support/
LoiLoScope 30 day full trial version
(Windows 8.1 / 8 / 7 / Vista)
LoiLoScope is a video editing software that draws out the full power of your PC. Creating
videos is as easy as organising cards on top of a desk. Use your music, picture and
video files to create videos to share with your friends and family by burning it to a DVD,
uploading it to websites, or simply share your videos with your friends via e-mail.
• This will only install a shortcut to the trial version download site.
For more information on how to use LoiLoScope, read the LoiLoScope manual
available for download at the link below.
Manual URL: http://loilo.tv/product/20
283
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Installing supplied software
The software compatible with your PC will be installed.
Preparations
Check your PC’s specifications and operating environment for each software.
Before inserting the DVD (supplied), close all running applications.
1
Insert the DVD with the supplied software
If the automatic playback screen is displayed, you can display the menu by selecting and
executing [Launcher.exe].
In Windows 8.1/Windows 8, you can display the menu by clicking a message that is displayed
after inserting the DVD and then selecting and executing [Launcher.exe].
You can also display the menu by double-clicking [SFMXXXX] in [Computer]. (The “XXXX”
portion differs depending on the model.)
2
Click [Applications]
3
Click [Recommended Installation]
Continue the installation procedure following the instructions displayed on the screen.
If you are using a Mac, you can manually install SILKYPIX.
Insert the DVD with the supplied software
Double-click the application folder on the DVD
Double-click the folder that automatically appears
Double-click the icon in the folder
Not available in the following case:
PHOTOfunSTUDIO / LoiLoScope are not compatible with Mac.
284
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Copying still pictures and motion pictures
Preparations
Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on your computer before starting the copying procedure. (→283)
Turn on the camera and computer.
1
Connect camera to computer
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction,
the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong
socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one or a genuine Panasonic
USB connection cable (DMW-USBC1: optional). Using cables other than the above may cause
a malfunction.
Align the marks, and insert.
[AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket
[Access] (sending data)
Do not disconnect the USB connection cable
(supplied) while [Access] is displayed.
USB connection cable (supplied)
2
Use to select [PC] and press [MENU/SET]
Setting the [USB Mode] to [PC] removes the need to make the setting each time the camera is
connected to the computer.
3
Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to copy pictures to your computer
For details on how to use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”, see the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” manual (PDF).
Do not delete or move copied files and folders using Windows Explorer or other browsers.
Otherwise, you will not be able to play back or edit the files using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”.
For PTP mode
The camera can be connected to your computer even if [USB Mode] (→47) is set to
[PictBridge(PTP)].
• Only picture output can be performed.
• If you cannot connect to your PC in PTP mode, set [USB Mode] to [PC] and
reconnect.
• It may not be possible to import if there are 1,000 or more pictures on the card.
• Motion pictures or RAW pictures cannot be read.
285
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Copying to your computer without using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
You can save pictures to use on your computer by dragging and dropping folders and
files into separate folders on your computer.
The card of this unit contains the following files (folder structure).
*
2
Windows
Drive (“LUMIX”) is
displayed in “Computer”.
Mac
Drive (“LUMIX”) is
displayed on the desktop.
DCIM (Still/motion pictures)
100_PANA (Up to 999 pictures/folder)
Folder number
P1000001.JPG
*
1
File number
P1000999.JPG
:
101_PANA
999_PANA
:
MISC (DPOF files, Favourite)
PRIVATE
AVCHD (Motion pictures in AVCHD)
Colour Space P: sRGB
_: AdobeRGB
Card
*
1
.JPG: Still pictures
.RW2: Still pictures recorded in RAW file
.MP4: [MP4] Motion Pictures
*
2
New folders are created in the following cases:
When there is a picture with file number 999 inside the folder.
When using cards already containing the same folder number (for example, pictures taken with
other cameras, etc.).
When recording after performing [No.Reset]. (→50)
Turn off the camera before inserting or removing memory cards.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). When the
battery starts to run out during communications, a warning beep sounds. Cancel communication
via your computer immediately.
For more details, consult your computer operating manual.
286
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures in
the recorder
Follow the correct method for your device.
Copying by inserting the card into the recorder
You can copy pictures using Panasonic equipment (such as
Blu-ray disc recorders) with support for each file format.
• See the instruction manual for the recorder for details for copying
and playing back.
32
3232
Dubbing playback pictures via AV cables (optional)
You can transfer or copy the pictures played back on this unit to a recorder, disc, video
tapes, or other media using the standard picture quality. This method is useful as it allows
dubbing to be performed even with devices that are not compatible with high definition
images. Audio will be monaural.
1
Connect camera to recorder
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction,
the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong
socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
Align the marks, and insert.
[AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket
AV cable (optional)
To recorder’s input socket
2
Start recording on recorder
3
Start playback on camera
To stop recording (dubbing), stop the recording on your recorder first before stopping the
playback on the camera.
Always use a genuine Panasonic AV cable (DMW-AVC1: optional).
When using a TV with a 4:3 aspect ratio, always change the camera’s [TV Aspect] setting (→47)
to [4:3] before dubbing. Motion pictures copied in the [16:9] setting will appear vertically stretched
when viewed on a 4:3 TV screen.
For details on dubbing and playback methods, refer to your recorder’s operating instructions.
287
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Printing
You can connect directly to a PictBridge-compatible printer for printing.
• Some printers can print directly from the camera’s memory card.
For details, see the manual for your printer.
Preparations
Adjust the print quality or other settings on your printer, as needed.
Turn on the camera and printer.
1
Connect camera to printer
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction,
the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong
socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one or a genuine Panasonic
USB connection cable (DMW-USBC1: optional). Using cables other than the above may cause
a malfunction.
Align the marks, and insert.
[AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket
Do not disconnect the USB connection cable
(supplied) when the cable disconnection icon [
] is
displayed (may not be displayed with some printers).
USB connection cable (supplied)
2
Use to select [PictBridge(PTP)] and press [MENU/SET]
3
Use to select a picture and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET]
(Print settings (→290))
To cancel print
Press [MENU/SET].
288
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Printing
Printing multiple pictures
Multiple pictures are printed at one time.
1
Press to select [Multi Print] in step
3
(→287)
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]: Scroll between pictures with , select pictures to print with the
[MENU/SET]. (Press [MENU/SET] again to release selection.)
Use to select [OK], and press [MENU/SET].
[Select All]: Print all pictures.
[Print Set (DPOF)]: Print pictures selected in [Print Set]. (→220)
[Favorite]: Print pictures selected as [Favorite]. (→219)
3
Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET]
(Print settings (→290))
Select [Yes] if print confirmation screen is displayed.
The group pictures are displayed one by one instead of all pictures at the same time.
Turn off the camera before inserting or removing memory cards.
Disconnect USB connection cable (supplied) after printing.
Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). When
the battery starts to run out during connection, a warning beep sounds. Cancel printing and
disconnect USB connection cable.
An orange “●” displayed during printing indicates an error message.
Print may be divided into several pictures if printing a large amount of pictures.
(Remaining sheets display may differ from the number of pictures set for printing.)
Not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures cannot be printed.
Still pictures recorded in a RAW file cannot be printed. (The still pictures recorded in JPEG file
format at the same time as the RAW file can be printed.)
289
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Printing
Printing with date and text
Time and date can be set to be printed on the picture when taking the picture by
activating the [Text Stamp] function in the [Playback] menu. (→212)
Printing date without [Text Stamp]
Printing in store:
Only recording date can be printed. Request date printing in store.
• Making [Print Set] (→220) settings on the camera in advance allows settings for
numbers of copies and date printing to be designated before giving the card to the
store.
• When printing still pictures of 16:9 Aspect Ratio, check in advance that the store can
accept this size.
Using computer:
Print settings for recording date and text information can be made using
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the supplied DVD.
Using printer:
Recording date can be printed by setting [Print Set] on the camera, or by setting [Print
with Date] (→290) to [ON] when connecting to a printer compatible with date printing.
290
SQW0024
Connecting with other devices
Printing
Making print settings on the camera
Setting options include the number of printed pictures and their size. Make settings before
selecting [Print start].
1
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
Item Settings
[Print with Date] [ON] / [OFF]
[Num.of prints] Set number of pictures (up to 999 pictures)
[Paper Size]
When [
] is selected, the printer settings take priority.
[Page Layout]
[
] (printer takes priority) / [ ] (1 picture, no border) /
[
] (1 picture, with border) / [ ] (2 pictures) / [ ] (4 pictures)
2
Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET]
When setting [Print with Date] to [ON], check the date printing settings on the printer (printer
settings may be prioritised).
To print a picture on which text or a date has been stamped, set [Print with Date] to [OFF]. (The
still picture is printed with the date superimposed on it.)
Items may not be displayed if incompatible with printer.
To arrange [ ] “2 pictures” or [ ] “4 pictures” in the same still picture, set the number of prints
for the still picture to 2 or 4.
To print to paper sizes/layouts not supported by this camera, set to [ ] and make settings on the
printer. (Consult your printer’s operating manual.)
Even with completed [Print Set] settings, dates may not be printed, depending on the shop or
printer used.
291
SQW0024
Others
Optional accessories
External Flash (optional)
When you use the flashes (optional: DMW-FL220, DMW-FL360L, or DMW-FL580L), a
wider effective flash range is provided than with the flash (supplied).
Preparation
Set the camera [ON/OFF] switch to [OFF].
Removing the hot shoe cover
The hot shoe cover is already attached to the hot shoe at the time of purchase.
Remove the hot shoe cover by pulling it in the
direction indicated by arrow while pressing
it in the direction indicated by arrow
Be sure to attach the hot shoe cover when the hot shoe
is not in use.
Keep the hot shoe cover safely after removing it so that
you do not lose it.
Using the flash (DMW-FL360L: optional)
Attach the external flash to the hot shoe and then turn on the camera and the external
flash
Set the menu
[Rec] → [Flash]
Press to select [Flash Mode] and press [MENU/SET]
Press to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
While the external flash is connected, the following icons are displayed.
: External flash Forced ON
:
External flash Red-Eye Removal Forced ON
*
: External flash Slow Sync.
:
External flash Red-Eye Removal Slow Sync.
*
:
External flash Forced OFF
Signal-flashing with wireless flashes is also disabled.
*
When the flash mode is set to [AUTO] or [MANUAL] on the external flash, you cannot select
the item.
292
SQW0024
Others
Optional accessories
When using other commercially available external flashes that don’t
offer direct communication with the camera (DMC-LX100)
• It is necessary to set the exposure on the external flash when it is used. When you use
an external flash in Auto Mode, use an external flash that allows you to set the aperture
value and ISO Sensitivity to match the same settings on the camera.
• Set the camera to [Aperture-Priority] Mode or [Manual Exposure] Mode and then set the
same aperture value and ISO Sensitivity on the external flash. (The proper exposure
cannot be achieved because the aperture value changes in [Shutter-Priority] Mode. The
light of the external flash cannot be properly adjusted since the aperture value cannot
be fixed in [Program AE] Mode.)
You can set the aperture value, shutter speed and ISO Sensitivity on the camera even when the
external flash is attached.
Some commercially available external flashes have synchro terminals with high-voltage or
reversed polarity. If such flashes are used, they could cause a malfunction or hinder normal
operation of the camera.
If you use commercially available external flashes (with communication functions) other than the
ones compatible with this unit, they may not operate normally or they may be damaged. Do not
use them.
Even if the external flash is turned off, the camera may enter the external flash mode when the
external flash is attached. When you are not using the external flash, detach it.
When the external flash is attached, the camera will become unstable, and therefore we
recommend using a tripod to take pictures.
Detach the external flash when you carry the camera.
Be sure to hold both the camera and the external flash when it is attached to the camera. If you
hold only the external flash, it could become detached from the camera.
If the White Balance is set to [ ] when the external flash is used, perform fine adjustment of the
White Balance if the recording results are not satisfactory. (→105)
If you take pictures close to the subject while taking wide-angle pictures, the light of the flash is
obstructed by the lens and the bottom of the screen may be dark.
Refer to (→184) about the settings for the wireless flash.
Refer to the operating instructions of the external flash for further details.
Using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional)
instead of the battery
By using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), you can record and play
back without worrying about the remaining battery charge.
The optional DC coupler can only be used with the designated Panasonic AC adaptor.
Always use a genuine Panasonic AC adaptor (optional).
Also read the AC adaptor and DC coupler operating instructions.
293
SQW0024
Others
50
i
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
• The following images are examples of when the display screen is set to [ ] (monitor
style) in the monitor.
In recording
*
[m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”.
Recording Mode (→59)
Motion picture recording mode
(→58)
Motion picture recording mode
when [4K PHOTO] is set to
[ON] (→195)
Custom Set (→60)
Panorama picture recording
mode (→150)
[Photo Style] (→100)
Flash Mode (→180, 291)
Flash (→182, 184)
50i
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→187)
Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size]
(→108)
Card (displayed only during
recording) (→25)
→ ← ↑ ↓ Panorama Direction (→150)
EXPS
Types of picture effects (Filter)
(→89)
Picture effect (Filter)
adjustment display (→91)
XXmXXs
Elapsed recording time
*
(→190)
Simultaneous recording
indicator (→198)
Automatic switching between
viewfinder and monitor (→54)
[Peaking] (→130)
[Highlight Shadow] (→102)
[HDR] (→112)
[Multi Exp.] (→159)
Electronic shutter (→140)
294
SQW0024
Others
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
50
i
[Quality] (→109)
AFS AFF AFC MF
Focus Mode (→114)
AF Mode (→115)
[Face Recog.] (→162)
AFL AF Lock (→133)
Burst (→142)
[Auto Bracket] (→145)
[Aspect Bracket] (→147)
Self-timer (→148)
Panorama Direction (→150)
Remaining battery (→21)
Picture Mode (Still picture
priorities) (→198)
Macro recording (→126)
Stabiliser (→168)
Jitter alert (→168)
Recording state (Flashes red.)/
Focus (Lights green.) (→56)
Focus (Under low illumination)
(→56)
Wi-Fi connection status
[4K PHOTO] marker (→196)
[Time Lapse Shot] (→153)
[Stop Motion Animation]
(→156)
Histogram (→64)
295
SQW0024
Others
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
50
i
Destination settings / Travel elapsed days
*
2
(→42)
Name
*
2
(→165)
Age in years/months
*
2
(→165)
Current date/time
*
2
World time
*
2
: (→41)
AF area (→56, 121)
Spot metering target (→139)
Self-timer
*
3
(→148)
[Silent Mode] (→161)
[Mic Level Disp.] (→200)
AEL AE Lock (→133)
[Metering Mode] (→139)
Programme Shift (→81)
1.7 Aperture value (→56)
60 Shutter speed (→56)
Exposure compensation value
(→135)
Manual Exposure Assist (→87)
ISO Sensitivity (→136)
[Dial Guide] (→18)
White Balance Bracket (→106)
White Balance Fine Adjustment
(→105)
White Balance (→103)
98
Number of recordable
pictures
*
4
(→27)
R8m30s
Available recording time
*
1
*
4
(→27)
Exposure meter (→81)
Zoom (→170, 174)
*
1
[m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”.
*
2
This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on, after setting the clock and after
switching from Playback Mode to Recording Mode.
*
3
This is displayed during countdown.
*
4
It is possible to switch the display between the number of recordable pictures and available
recording time with the [Remaining Disp.] setting in the [Custom] menu.
296
SQW0024
Others
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
Recording Mode (→59)
Programme Shift (→81)
Motion picture recording mode
(→58)
Motion picture recording mode
when [4K PHOTO] is set to
[ON] (→195)
Custom Set (→60)
Panorama picture recording
mode (→150)
F1.7 Aperture value (→56)
1/60 Shutter speed (→56)
T (time) recording (→87)
Remaining battery (→21)
Card (displayed only during
motion picture recording)
(→25)
ISO Sensitivity (→136)
Exposure compensation value
(→135)
Manual Exposure Assist (→87)
Flash Mode (→180, 291)
Flash (→182, 184)
Single (→141)
Burst (→142)
[Auto Bracket] (→145)
[Aspect Bracket] (→147)
Self-timer (→148)
Panorama Direction (→150)
AFS AFF AFC MF
Focus Mode (→114)
AF Mode (→115)
[Quality] (→109)
50i
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→187)
Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size]
(→108)
Wi-Fi Wi-Fi (→225)
Function button setting (→37)
[Photo Style] (→100)
AWB
White Balance (→103)
[i.Dynamic] (→111)
[Metering Mode] (→139)
98
Number of recordable pictures
(→27)
R8m30s
Available recording time
*
(→27)
On-monitor recording information
*
[m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”.
297
SQW0024
Others
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
15 pic.15 pic.
1ST DAY1ST DAY
11 months 30 days
11 months 30 days
In playback
Playback Mode (→206)
Protected picture (→221)
Number of prints (→220)
With location information
(→207)
Favourites (→219)
Cable disconnect prohibit icon
(→287)
Motion picture playback (→70)
Panorama picture playback
(→152)
Continuous playback of burst
picture group (→201)
Continuous playback of Time
Lapse Shot picture group
(→201)
Continuous playback of stop
motion animation group (→201)
Text stamped display (→212)
XXmXXs
Elapsed playback time
*
1
(→70)
Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size]
(→108)
50i
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→187)
[Quality] (→109)
Remaining battery (→21)
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
15 pic. Number of pictures in burst
XXmXXs
Motion picture recording time
*
1
(→70)
Acquiring information icon
(→302)
1ST DAY
Travel elapsed days (→42)
Upload (Wi-Fi) icon (→254)
Submenu icon (→202, 254)
[Silent Mode] (→161)
11 months 30 days
Age in years/months (→165)
Name
*
2
(→164, 165)
Location
*
2
(→42)
Title
*
2
(→211)
Recording information
*
3
*
1
[m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”.
*
2
The displaying is performed in the following
priority order: title, travel destination, name
(babies and pets), and name ([Face Recog.]).
*
3
This is not displayed for motion pictures
recorded in [AVCHD].
298
SQW0024
Others
List of monitor/viewfinder displays
10:00 1.DEC.2014
100-0001
100-00011/98
R
G
B
Y
Recording information
[i.Dynamic]
*
1
(→111)
[HDR]
*
2
(→112)
[i.Resolution] (→111)
4K motion picture recorded by
setting [4K PHOTO] to [ON] or
a still picture captured from
that 4K motion picture (→195)
Recording date/time
World time (→41)
Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size]
(→108)
[Quality] (→109)
50i
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→187)
[Color Space]
*
2
(→113)
100-0001
Folder/File number
*
1
(→285)
Detailed information display
Histogram (→64)
Recording information
*
1
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
100-0001
Folder/File number
*
1
(→285)
*
1
This is not displayed for motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD].
*
2
This is not displayed for motion pictures.
Histgram display
299
SQW0024
Others
Message displays
The following explains the meaning of major messages displayed on the monitor or
viewfinder, and how to respond to them.
Memory cards
[Memory Card Error] [Format this card?]
The card format cannot be used with this camera.
Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26)
[Insert SD card again] [Try another card]
Access to card has failed.
Insert card again.
Try with a different card.
[Read Error] / [Write Error] [Please check the card]
Data read has failed.
Check whether card has been inserted correctly (→24)
Data write has failed.
Turn off the camera and remove the card. Reinsert the card and turn the camera on again.
Card may possibly be damaged.
Try with a different card.
[Motion recording was cancelled due to the limitation of the writing speed of the card]
The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion
picture. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to “About the
motion picture recording and speed class” (→25).
If recording stops even when using a card of the recommended speed class (→25), the data
writing speed has dropped. If this happens, we recommend backing up the data on the memory
card and formatting it (→26).
[Memory Card Error] [This memory card cannot be used]
Not compatible with the camera. Use a compatible card.
[Cannot record due to incompatible format(NTSC/PAL) data on this card.]
Format the card after saving necessary data on a PC etc. (→26)
Insert a different card.
300
SQW0024
Others
Message displays
Battery
[This battery cannot be used]
Use a genuine Panasonic battery.
Battery cannot be recognised as terminal is dirty.
Wipe any dirt away from the battery terminal.
Wi-Fi function
[Failed to connect wireless access point] / [Connection failed] / [No destination found]
Check following regarding the wireless access point.
The wireless access point information set on this unit is wrong. Check the authentication type,
encryption type, and encryption key. (→266)
Power of the wireless access point is not turned on.
Setting of the wireless access point is not supported by this unit.
Check the network setting of the destination.
Radio waves from other devices may block the connection to a wireless access point.
Check other devices that are connected to the wireless access point and devices that use the
2.4 GHz band.
[No picture to send]
This is displayed when there is no image to transmit due to the restriction of the destination.
Check the file type of the image to transmit. (→239, 243, 244, 247, 251, 255)
[Connection failed. Please retry in a few minutes.] / [Network disconnected. Transfer stopped.]
Radio waves from the wireless access point are getting weak.
Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point.
There is no reply from the server or it has exceeded the communication processing time.
Try again after a while.
Depending on the wireless access point, connection may be automatically disconnected after
specific time has passed.
Reconnect the connection again.
[Upload to the Cloud Folder is available after Cloud Sync settings have been set up on
downloadable devices such as PCs or smartphones.]
Devices that download images from a cloud folder are not registered.
Perform Cloud Sync setting. Configure the settings on a PC with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” or on a
smartphone with “Image App”. For details on [Cloud Sync. Service], refer to (→255).
[Connection failed]
Check following regarding the smartphones you intend to connect.
The smartphone does not operate.
Change the access point to connect to in the smartphone Wi-Fi settings to this camera.
There is no free storage space on the smartphone.
301
SQW0024
Others
Message displays
[Login failed. Please check Login ID and Password.]
Login ID or password for the “LUMIX CLUB” is not correct. Please enter it again. If you have
forgotten the login ID or the password, there is information in the login screen of the “LUMIX CLUB”
website.
[Some files cannot be sent because of destination limit] /
[Transfer completed. Some files are left because of destination limit.]
Check the file format of the image to send.
Sending motion pictures may fail if the file size is too large. Split the motion picture using [Video
Divide]. (→214)
[Unavailable. Please set Login settings on LUMIX CLUB web site.]
Login to the “LUMIX CLUB” from your smartphone or PC, and set the login details of the
destination WEB service.
[Both picture and video sharing service cannot be selected together]
WEB services designed only for pictures, and WEB services designed only for motion pictures
cannot be selected at the same time. Deselect one of the services.
[Cannot get IP address. Please set wireless AP’s IP address setting to DHCP.]
Turn on DHCP settings of the IP address of the connected wireless access points.
[Cannot connect to server]
If a message is displaying asking to update the root certificate, agree to update the root certificate.
302
SQW0024
Others
Message displays
Others
[Some pictures cannot be deleted] [This picture cannot be deleted]
Non-DCF pictures (→67) cannot be deleted.
Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26)
[Cannot be set on this picture]
[Print Set], [Title Edit], [Text Stamp], and other functions cannot be used for pictures that are not
compliant with the DCF standard (→67).
[Please turn camera off and then on again] [System Error]
The lens is not working correctly.
Turn the camera on again. (Consult the dealer or your nearest Service Centre if display still
remains.)
[A folder cannot be created]
Folder numbers in use have reached 999.
Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera (→26).
Folder number is reset to 100 when performing [No.Reset] (→50).
[Picture is displayed for 16:9 TV] [Picture is displayed for 4:3 TV]
AV cable (optional) is connected to camera.
To remove message immediately → Press [MENU/SET].
To change aspect ratio → Change [TV Aspect] (→47).
USB connection cable (supplied) is only connected to camera.
Message disappears when cable is also connected to another device.
[Editing operation cannot proceed as information processing is ongoing.]
If you display the playback screen when the camera contains many picture files, the acquiring
information icon [
] or [ ] may be displayed for a long time. While either one of
these icons is displayed, some of the [Playback] menus cannot be used.
When the camera is turned off while information is being acquired, only the pictures whose
information has been acquired up to that time are saved as a group. When the camera is turned
on again, the camera once again begins acquiring information of the remaining pictures in the
group.
303
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Rec]
You can perform settings such as picture size and flash (supplied/optional).
• The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic],
[i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and
[Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same
name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
[Photo Style]
You can select the effects according to the concept of the picture
that you want to create. Adjusts the colours of effects and picture
quality.
→100
[Picture Size] Set the number of pixels. →108
[Quality] Set the compression rate used for storing pictures. →109
[AFS/AFF/AFC] Select how the focus is adjusted. →114
[Metering Mode]
Type of optical measurement to measure brightness can be
changed.
→139
[Burst Rate] Sets the burst speed to be used for burst recording. →142
[Auto Bracket]
Sets the Single/Burst setting, compensation range, and recording
sequence of Auto Bracket.
→146
[Self Timer]
Sets the time before recording starts when you take a picture
using the self-timer.
→148
[Highlight Shadow]
You can adjust the highlights and shadows in a picture while
confirming the brightness of these areas on the screen.
→102
[i.Dynamic] Correcting contrast and exposure. →111
[i.Resolution]
Records still pictures with sharper outlines and the impression of
high-resolution.
→111
[Simultaneous record
w/o filter]
Sets whether to record pictures with Filter and those without Filter
at the same time.
→91
[iHandheld Night
Shot]
Combines nightscape pictures recorded using high-speed burst
recording into a single picture.
→78
[iHDR]
When there is, for example, strong contrast between the
background and the subject, [iHDR] records multiple still pictures
with differing exposures and combines them to create a single still
picture rich in gradation.
→79
[HDR]
The camera can combine 3 still pictures taken with different
exposures into a single properly exposed picture with rich
gradation.
→112
[Multi Exp.]
You can create an effect similar to the operation of up to four times
of exposure on a single picture.
→159
304
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Time Lapse Shot]
You can preset the recording start time, recording interval, and the
number of pictures to be taken when automatically recording time
lapse motion pictures of subjects such as animals and plants.
→153
[Stop Motion
Animation]
You can stitch still pictures to create stop motion animation. →156
[Panorama Direction]
You can set the recording direction to be used for recording
panorama pictures.
→150
[Shutter Type]
You can take pictures using two types of shutter modes: the
mechanical shutter and electronic shutter.
→140
[Flash]
Performs flash settings in accordance with the recording
conditions.
→180
[Red-Eye Removal]
Automatically detects red-eye and corrects still picture data when
recording with flash.
→180
[ISO Limit Set]
Sets the optimal ISO Sensitivity using the selected value as the
upper limit of ISO Sensitivity when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or
[
].
→137
[ISO Increments] Changes the ISO Sensitivity settings every 1/3 EV or 1 EV steps. →138
[Extended ISO]
You can extend the numeric values that can be set for ISO
Sensitivity.
→138
[Long Shtr NR]
Eliminates the noise made when taking pictures at a slower shutter
speed.
→113
[i.Zoom]
Allows increasing the zoom ratio while suppressing the
deterioration of picture quality.
→172
[Digital Zoom]
Improves the telephoto effect of your pictures. Note that enlarging
will decrease picture quality.
→173
[Color Space]
You can set the method for reproducing the colours to correctly
display the recorded pictures on the screens of a PC or printer,
etc.
→113
[Stabilizer]
Automatically detects jitter during recording and makes
corrections.
→168
[Face Recog.]
Recognises a registered face and automatically adjusts the focus
and exposure for this face with higher priority.
→162
[Profile Setup]
You can set a name or birthday of a baby or pet before taking a
picture to record the name or age in months/years in the picture.
→165
305
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Motion Picture]
You can perform settings, such as recording format and quality, for recording motion
pictures.
• The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic],
[i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and
[Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same
name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
For details, refer to the corresponding item of the [Rec] menu.
[4K PHOTO]
You can set the motion picture mode used for creating a high-
resolution still picture by capturing a single frame from a 4K motion
picture.
→195
[Rec Format]
Sets the file format (AVCHD, MP4) of the motion picture to be
recorded.
→187
[Rec Quality]
Sets the picture quality of the motion picture (size, frame rate, etc.)
to be recorded.
→187
[Picture Mode]
Sets the recording method of still pictures to be taken while
recording motion pictures.
→198
[Continuous AF] Constantly adjusts the focus on a subject that is in focus. →189
[Mic Level Disp.]
You can set whether or not to display the microphone level on the
recording screen.
→200
[Mic Level Adj.] You can adjust the audio input level in 4 steps. →200
[Wind Cut]
If you hear wind noise during an audio recording, you can use
[Wind Cut] to effectively reduce the wind noise.
→200
306
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Custom]
You can set operations of this unit, such as the screen display method and functions of a
button, according to your preferences. You can also register the changed settings.
[Utilize Custom Set
feature]
Calls up the setting registered using [Cust.Set Mem.]. →60
[Cust.Set Mem.] Registers the current camera settings as a custom setting. →60
[Silent Mode] Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time. →161
[AF/AE Lock]
Performs the lock setting of the focus and/or exposure used for
executing AF/AE lock.
→133
[AF/AE Lock Hold]
Sets the [AF/AE LOCK] button operation used for recording by
fixing the focus and/or exposure.
→133
[Shutter AF]
Enables focus adjustment automatically when the shutter button is
pressed halfway.
→124
[Half Press Release]
Enables shutter release when the shutter button is pressed
halfway.
→124
[Quick AF] Enables faster focusing when the shutter button is pressed. →124
[Eye Sensor AF] Automatically adjusts the focus when the eye sensor is activated. →55
[Pinpoint AF Time]
Sets the time for displaying the enlarged screen if the shutter
button is pressed halfway when Auto Focus mode is set to [
].
→122
[Pinpoint AF Display]
Sets whether the assist screen is to be enlarged on a part of the
screen or the entire screen when Auto Focus mode is set to [
].
→122
[AF Assist Lamp]
Illuminates the AF Assist Lamp when the shutter button is pressed
halfway when it is too dark to facilitate focusing.
→125
[Direct Focus Area]
Moves the AF area or MF assist using the cursor button while
recording.
→123
→131
[Focus/Release
Priority]
Disables recording when a subject is out of focus. →125
[AF+MF] Allows manual adjustment of the focus after AF is performed. →125
[MF Assist] Sets the display method for MF Assist (enlarged screen). →131
[MF Assist Display]
Sets whether the Assist screen (enlarged screen) is to be enlarged
on part of the screen or over the entire screen.
→132
[MF Guide]
Displays the MF guide used to check the direction of focus on the
screen when the focus is manually adjusted.
→129
307
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Peaking]
When you perform Manual Focus operation, this function
automatically adds colour to the portions of the image that are in
focus.
→130
[Histogram] Sets whether to display the histogram. →64
[Guide Line] Sets the pattern of the guidelines to be displayed while recording. →65
[Highlight]
Flashes the overexposed areas in black and white during [Auto
Review] or playback.
→72
[Zebra Pattern]
Displays the area, where overexposure may occur, using a zebra
pattern.
→166
[Monochrome Live
View]
You can display the recording screen in black and white. →167
[Constant Preview]
(M Mode)
Allows the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed on the
recording screen to be checked when [Manual Exposure] Mode
is set.
→87
[Expo.Meter] Sets whether to display the exposure meter. →81
[Dial Guide] Sets whether to display the operation guide. →18
[LVF Disp.Style] Sets the viewfinder display method. →63
[Monitor Disp. Style] Switching the monitor display method. →62
[Monitor Info. Disp.] Switches the recording information screen of the monitor. →65
[Rec Area]
Switching the angle of view setting used for recording still pictures
and motion pictures.
→192
[Remaining Disp.]
Switching the display between the number of recordable pictures
that you can take and the available recording time.
→28
[Auto Review]
Set the time to display the pictures you have taken after taking still
pictures.
→57
[Fn Button Set] You can assign frequently-used functions to particular buttons. →37
[Zoom lever] Switches the zoom lever operation setting. →175
[Control Ring] You can assign frequently-used functions to control ring. →40
[Zoom Resume] Retaining the zoom position when the camera is turned off. →175
[Q.MENU] Switches the method for setting Quick Menu items. →34
[iA Button Switch]
Changes the operation method of the [iA] button used for switching
to [Intelligent Auto] Mode.
→75
[Video Button] Enabling/disabling the motion picture button. →192
[Eye Sensor]
Setting the sensitivity of the eye sensor or setting to switch the
display between the viewfinder and monitor.
→55
308
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Setup]
You can perform settings for convenience of use such as the clock setting and changing
of the beep sounds. You can also perform Wi-Fi function related settings.
[Clock Set] Set time, date, and display format. →29
[World Time] Set the local time at travel destination. →41
[Travel Date]
If you set your travel schedule and record pictures, the day of your
trip on which the picture was taken will be recorded.
→42
[Wi-Fi] Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function. →272
[Beep] Sets the beep sounds or shutter sounds. →43
[Live View Mode]
Sets the display speed and picture quality of the screen (Live View
screen) when recording pictures.
→43
[Monitor Display]/
[Viewfinder]
Adjust brightness and colour of the monitor or viewfinder. →44
[Monitor Luminance]
You can adjust the brightness of the monitor depending on how
bright it is around the camera.
→45
[Sleep Mode]
The camera automatically turns off if no operation is performed for
a preset period of time.
→46
[USB Mode]
Select communication method for when connecting camera to a
computer or printer with USB connection cable (supplied).
→47
[TV Connection]
Change the settings to be used when the camera is connected to
a TV or other device.
→47
[Menu Resume] Save the last operated menu position. →49
[Menu Background] Set the background colour for the menu screen. →49
[Menu Information]
Explanations of the menu items and settings are displayed on the
menu screen.
→49
[Language] Set the language displayed on the screen. →49
[Version Disp.]
Check the firmware version of the camera or supplied flash (when
the flash is attached).
→50
[Self Timer Auto Off] The self-timer is cancelled if the unit is turned off. →50
[No.Reset] Reset picture file numbers. →50
[Reset] Reset to the default settings. →50
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings] Return [Wi-Fi] settings to default settings. →51
[Format] Format (initialise) a memory card. →26
309
SQW0024
Others
Menu list
[Playback]
You can specify picture protection, resizing, print settings, and other settings for pictures
you have taken.
[Slide Show] Automatically play pictures in order. →204
[Playback Mode]
You can narrow down the pictures to be displayed with set filters,
such as categories or favourite pictures.
→206
[Location Logging]
You can write location information (longitude/latitude) sent from the
smartphone to the pictures.
→207
[RAW Processing]
You can use the camera to develop still pictures that were
recorded in RAW format. The created still pictures are saved in
JPEG format.
→208
[Title Edit] Allows characters (comments) to be entered on a recorded picture. →211
[Text Stamp]
You can stamp the recording date and time, names, travel
destination, travel dates, etc. on the recorded still pictures.
→212
[Video Divide] A single motion picture can be split into 2 parts. →214
[Time Lapse Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that
was recorded using [Time Lapse Shot].
→215
[Stop Motion Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that
was recorded using [Stop Motion Animation].
→215
[Resize] Picture size can be reduced. →216
[Cropping] Enlarge your still pictures and crop unwanted areas. →217
[Rotate] Manually rotate pictures by 90°. →218
[Rotate Disp.] Automatically rotate portrait pictures. →218
[Favorite]
Allows a label to be assigned to a picture with a mark to set it as
your favourite picture.
→219
[Print Set] Sets the pictures and the number of pictures to be printed. →220
[Protect] Set protection to prevent deletion of pictures by mistake. →221
[Face Rec Edit]
Edit or delete the recognition information for pictures with mistaken
Face Recognition.
→222
[Picture Sort]
You can set the display sequence used for playing back pictures
on this unit.
→223
[Delete Confirmation]
You can set the Yes/No options that you want to select first on the
confirmation screen when you delete a picture from either [Yes]
or [No].
→223
310
SQW0024
Others
Q&A
Troubleshooting
Try checking these items (→310 - 325) first.
If the problem persists,
Performing [Reset] in the [Setup] menu may resolve the issue (→50). (Note that
except for some items such as [Clock Set], all settings are returned to their values at
the time of purchase.)
Also, see the Panasonic support site for the latest support information.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This site is available in English only.)
Battery, power
Camera does not work even if the camera is turned on.
Battery is not inserted correctly (→24), or needs recharging.
Camera switches off as soon as the camera is turned on.
Battery needs recharging.
This unit is turned off automatically.
[Sleep Mode] is activated. (→46)
If you connect to a TV compatible with VIERA Link (HDMI) with an HDMI micro cable and turn off
the TV with the remote control for the TV, this unit also turns off.
If you are not using VIERA Link (HDMI), set [VIERA Link] to [OFF]. (→49)
The battery runs down quickly.
The Wi-Fi connection has been on for a long time.
The battery is used up faster with a Wi-Fi connection. Turn off the camera as often as possible
using [Sleep Mode] (→46) or other methods.
311
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Recording
Cannot record pictures.
Card is full.
Free space by deleting unwanted pictures (→73).
When a large capacity card is used, you may not be able to take a picture for a while after you turn
on the camera.
Focus is not aligned.
When [Focus/Release Priority] is set to [FOCUS], the camera will not record until proper
focusing is achieved. (→125)
Recorded pictures look white.
Lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.).
Turn the camera on to extract lens barrel, and clean lens surface with a soft, dry cloth.
Lens is foggy (→12).
Recorded pictures are too bright/too dark.
Adjust the exposure (→135).
AE Lock (→133) is set inappropriately.
Zooming stops instantaneously.
When using the Extra Optical Zoom, the zooming action will stop temporarily. This is not a
malfunction.
Some pictures are taken when I press the shutter button just once.
Camera is set to use [Auto Bracket], White Balance Bracket, [Aspect Bracket], or [Burst]. Self-
Timer is set to [
].
Clear the setting. (→106, 141)
Unable to perform bracket recording.
The remaining memory space in the card is low.
Check the remaining memory space in the card.
Focus not aligned correctly.
Subject outside of focus range. (→126)
Caused by jitter or subject movement. (→168)
[Focus/Release Priority] is set to [RELEASE]. (→125)
[Shutter AF] is set to [OFF]. (→124)
AF Lock (→133) is set inappropriately.
Recorded pictures are blurred. The stabiliser function ineffective.
Shutter speed is slower in dark locations and the stabiliser function is less effective.
Hold camera firmly with both hands, keeping arms close to body.
Use a tripod and the self-timer when using a slower shutter speed (→148).
312
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Recorded pictures appear coarse, or there is interference.
We recommend trying the following methods.
Lower [Sensitivity] (→136).
Take pictures in brighter locations.
Either adjust [Noise Reduction] of [Photo Style] to a higher setting or set each item other than
[Noise Reduction] to a lower setting. (→101)
Set [Long Shtr NR] to [ON]. (→113)
Change the settings of [Picture Size] (→108) and [Quality] (→109).
When Digital Zoom is used, the picture quality will become lower if you zoom in higher.
Striping or flicker may appear under lighting such as fluorescent lighting and LED lighting
fixture. The subject appears distorted.
This is characteristic of MOS sensors which serve as the camera’s pickup
sensors. This is not a malfunction. If the subject passes quickly in front of the
lens, it will appear slightly distorted.
If you are taking still pictures using [ESHTR], the striping may be reduced by
setting a slower shutter speed. (→84)
Brightness or colouring of recorded picture different from real life.
When recording under fluorescent or LED lighting fixture etc., increasing the shutter speed may
introduce slight changes to brightness and colour. These are a result of the characteristics of the
light source and do not indicate a malfunction.
When recording subjects in extremely bright locations or recording under fluorescent lighting, LED
lighting fixture, mercury lamp, sodium lighting etc., the colours and screen brightness may change
or horizontal striping may appear on the screen.
Reddish horizontal streaks appear on the screen during recording.
This is characteristic of the MOS sensors, which serve as the camera’s pickup sensors. The
streaks appear when the subject has a bright part. Some unevenness may occur in the surrounding
areas, but this is not a malfunction. It is recorded in motion pictures but is not recorded on still
pictures.
It is recommended that you take pictures while taking care not to expose the screen to sunlight or
any other source of strong light.
Motion picture recording stops midway.
The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion
picture. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to “About the
motion picture recording and speed class” (→25).
If recording stops even when using a card of the recommended speed class, the data writing
speed has dropped. If this happens, we recommend backing up the data on the memory card and
formatting it (→26).
313
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
The screen turns dark while recording motion pictures.
While motion pictures are being recorded, the screen may turn dark as time passes in order to slow
battery consumption. This condition, however, will not affect the recorded motion picture.
The screen turns momentarily black or noise is recorded.
While motion pictures are being recorded, the screen may momentarily turn black or noise may be
recorded due to static electricity or strong electromagnetic waves (radio transmitters, high-voltage
lines, etc.) under some environmental conditions.
Sometimes focus adjustment with Auto Focus mode is difficult while recording 4K motion
pictures.
This may occur when taking a picture by reducing the Auto Focus speed in order to adjust the
focus at high precision. This is not a malfunction.
Panorama picture recording stops before finishing.
If the pan motion of the camera is too slow, the camera assumes that the operation has been
aborted and stops recording.
If the pan motion of the camera is too shaky when it is moved toward the recording direction, the
camera stops recording.
The subject cannot be locked. (AF track fails)
If the colour of the subject is similar to that of its background, AF Tracking may not function. Set the
AF lock to the colours specific to the subject.
Low or inaudible operating sound.
The speaker is blocked.
[Silent Mode] is set to [ON] (→161).
314
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Monitor/viewfinder
The monitor/viewfinder is turned off although the camera is turned on.
When a hand or object is close to the eye sensor, the monitor display mode could be switched to
viewfinder display mode without your knowledge. (→54)
Pictures do not show on the monitor.
Viewfinder display mode is activated.
Press the [LVF] button to switch to the monitor display mode. (→54)
Monitor is turned off.
Press the [DISP.] button to switch the display information. (→62)
When you connect the camera to a TV using an HDMI micro cable, the picture is not displayed on
a monitor/viewfinder in the following cases.
During playback
Brightness is unstable.
Aperture value is set while shutter button is pressed halfway. (Does not affect recorded picture.)
This symptom may also occur when the brightness changes because the zoom is operated or the
camera is moved. This is the automatic aperture operation of the camera and is not a malfunction.
The screen flickers indoors.
The screen may flicker for a few seconds after turning on. This is an operation to correct flicker
caused by lighting such as fluorescent lights, LED lights, etc. and is not a malfunction.
The screen is too bright/too dark.
Check [Monitor Luminance] setting. (→45)
Use [Monitor Display]/[Viewfinder] to adjust the brightness of the screen. (→44)
Black/blue/red/green dots or interference appears. Monitor looks distorted when touched.
This is not a fault, and will not be recorded on the actual pictures.
Noise appears on the monitor/viewfinder.
In dark places, noise may appear to maintain the brightness of the monitor/viewfinder.
Cannot switch between the monitor and viewfinder when pressing [LVF] button.
When it is connected to a computer or printer, the camera can display pictures on the monitor only.
315
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Flash
Unable to perform [Flash].
Flash (supplied/optional) is not attached properly.
Properly attach a flash (supplied/optional) to the camera. (→176, 291)
For details about flash settings, refer to (→176 - 186, 291).
No flash emitted.
The flash becomes unavailable in the following cases.
When the picture effect (Filter) is set
When camera is set to use [Auto Bracket], White Balance Bracket, or [Aspect Bracket]
When using [Burst]
During panorama picture recording
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When the electronic shutter is used (→140)
Set [Shutter Type] to [AUTO] or [MSHTR].
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON] (→161)
Set [Silent Mode] to [OFF].
The flash fires twice.
The flash (supplied) fires twice. (Except when [Firing Mode] of [Flash] is set to [MANUAL]) When
red-eye reduction (→180) is set, the firing interval will be longer. Make sure that the subject does
not move until the second firing is completed.
316
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Playback
Pictures have been rotated.
[Rotate Disp.] is activated. (→218)
Cannot view pictures. There are no recorded pictures.
A card is not inserted in the camera.
There is no picture on the card to play back.
Has the file name of the picture been changed on a computer? If so, it cannot be played back on
the camera.
[Playback Mode] is set to other than [Normal Play].
Set [Playback Mode] to [Normal Play]. (→206)
Folder/file number displayed as [-]. Picture is black.
Picture edited on computer or taken with different device.
Battery removed immediately after picture taken, or picture taken with low battery.
Use [Format] to delete (→26).
Incorrect date displayed in Calendar Search.
Picture edited on computer or taken with different device.
[Clock Set] is incorrect (→29). (Incorrect date may be displayed in Calendar Search on pictures
copied to a computer and then back to this unit, if computer and camera dates differ.)
White round spots like soap bubbles appear on the recorded picture.
If you take a picture with the flash in a dark place or indoors, white round spots
may appear on the picture caused by the flash reflecting particles of dust in the
air. This is not a fault. A characteristic of this is that the number of round spots
and their position differ in every picture.
[Thumbnail is displayed] is shown on the screen.
The pictures may have been recorded on another device. If so, they may be displayed with poor
picture quality.
Red areas in pictures appear blackened.
When digital red-eye correction ([
], [ ]) is operating, if a subject is recorded that has skin-
coloured areas with red areas inside, the digital red-eye correction function may blacken the red
areas.
We recommend setting the flash (supplied/optional) to [
], or [Red-Eye Removal] to [OFF]
before recording. (→180)
317
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
An unusual noise, such as a clicking or buzzing noise, is recorded on a motion picture. Audio
is recorded at low volumes.
When recording a motion picture in a quiet environment, noise due to the motion of the aperture
and focusing mechanism may be recorded on the motion picture. Note that this is not a fault. You
can set the focus operation during motion picture recording to [OFF] using [Continuous AF] (→189).
Note that if you perform operations such as zoom, using buttons or dials, while recording a motion
picture, operation noise may be recorded.
If you block the microphone with your fingers while motion pictures are being recorded, the audio
may be recorded at a low volume or may not be recorded at all. In this case, the camera may pick
up the lens operating sounds more easily.
Operating sounds are recorded at the end of the motion picture recording.
Since motion pictures are recorded until the motion picture button is pressed to stop recording, the
operating sound level in the picture may be higher. To suppress this sound, we recommend trying
the following method.
Divide the end part of a motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214) in the [Playback] menu. In
some cases, motion pictures cannot be divided at a position close to the end part of the motion
picture. To avoid this problem, continue recording for an extra 3 seconds.
Playback and operation sounds are too low.
The speaker is blocked. (→15)
Motion pictures taken with this camera cannot be played in other cameras.
Even if a device is compatible with AVCHD and MP4, the motion pictures that were recorded on
this unit may have bad picture quality or sound quality upon playback, or may be unable to be
played back. Also, the recording information may not be displayed correctly.
318
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Wi-Fi function
It cannot connect to the wireless LAN. Radio waves get disconnected.
Use within the communication range of the wireless LAN network.
Connection types and security setting methods are different depending on the wireless access
point.
Refer to the operating instructions of the wireless access point.
When the radio waves are interrupted, the condition may improve by moving the location or
changing the angle of the wireless access point.
When this unit is placed on a metal table or shelf, the connection may not be established easily
because the camera is affected by radio waves. Use the camera away from metal surfaces.
It may not automatically connect when the network SSID of the wireless access point is set not to
broadcast.
Set the network SSID of the wireless access point to broadcast.
Is any device, such as microwave oven, cordless phone, etc., that uses 2.4 GHz frequency
operated nearby?
Radio waves may get interrupted when used simultaneously. Use them sufficiently away from
the device.
Is the 5 GHz/2.4 GHz switchable wireless access point connected to other equipment using the
5 GHz band?
The use of a wireless access point that can use 5 GHz/2.4 GHz simultaneously is
recommended. It cannot be used simultaneously with this camera if it is not compatible.
When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or the
connection may be disrupted. (A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.)
Perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu.
319
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Wireless access point is not displayed. Or it cannot be connected.
Check if the wireless access point to connect is in operating state.
The camera may not display or connect to a wireless access point depending on the radio wave
condition.
Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point.
Remove the obstacles between this unit and the wireless access point.
Change the direction of this unit.
It may not display even if the radio waves exist depending on the setting of the wireless access
point.
Check the settings of the wireless access point.
The wireless access point may not be found depending on the radio wave condition.
Perform the [Manual Input]. (→266)
Is the network SSID of the wireless access point set not to broadcast?
It may not be detected when it is set not to broadcast. Enter and set the network SSID. (→265)
Connection methods differ depending on the wireless access point.
Refer to the operating instructions of the wireless access point.
It takes long time every time to connect to a smartphone.
It may take longer time to connect depending on the Wi-Fi connection setting of the smartphone,
but it is not a malfunction.
This unit is not displayed in the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone.
Try switching the ON/OFF of the Wi-Fi function in the Wi-Fi settings of the smartphone.
I have forgotten the login ID or password for the “LUMIX CLUB”.
Check the information in the login screen of “LUMIX CLUB”.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
320
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
I do not have a wireless access point at my home, but I would like to perform service user
registration of the “LUMIX CLUB”.
Service user registration for the “LUMIX CLUB” is not possible in the environment without a
wireless access point.
The camera cannot be connected to Mac computer/Windows PC via Wi-Fi connection.
Please confirm login name and password are correctly typed.
When the system time of Mac computer or Windows PC connected to a camera differs severely
from that of the camera, the camera cannot be connected to the computer or PC in some OSs.
Please confirm clock set and world time of the camera matches with time, date and time zone in
Windows PC or Mac computer. When both settings do not match severely, please match them.
I am having a problem connecting to my Windows 8 PC. The user name and password are not
recognised.
Depending on the OS version, on Windows 8, for example, there are two types of user account
(local account/Microsoft account).
Be sure to set the local account and use the user name and password for the local account.
The Wi-Fi connection is not recognising my PC.
By default, the Wi-Fi connection uses the default workgroup name of “WORKGROUP”. If the name
of the workgroup has been changed, it will not be recognised.
Select [PC Connection] then [Change Workgroup Name] in the [Wi-Fi Setup] to change the
workgroup name to match that of your PC. (→272)
Pictures cannot be transmitted to the computer.
If a firewall is enabled by the OS or security software, this unit may be unable to connect to the
computer.
Images cannot be transmitted to the WEB service.
Confirm that the login information (login ID/user name/email address/password) is correct.
WEB service server or the network may be busy.
Try again after a while.
Check the site of the WEB service you are sending the image to.
321
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
It takes time to transmit an image to the WEB service.
Is the size of the image too large?
Transmit after dividing the motion picture with [Video Divide] (→214).
Reduce the image size at [Size] (→271), and then send.
It may take longer time to transmit when distance to the wireless access point is far.
Transmit closer to the wireless access point.
The image that was supposed to have uploaded to the WEB service is not there.
Upload may not complete when it is disconnected while transmitting the image.
It may take some time after uploading the image to be reflected in the WEB service depending on
the status of the server.
Wait for a while and try again.
You can check the transmission status on the WEB service link settings by logging into “LUMIX
CLUB”.
I would like to return the image in the WEB service to the camera.
The images in the WEB Service cannot be saved (downloaded) to this unit. Do not delete the
uploaded images, and make a backup of them.
I cannot display or delete the images uploaded to the WEB service by this unit.
The images uploaded to the WEB service cannot be displayed or deleted by this unit.
Perform the task using a smartphone or a PC.
Your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password were deleted after sending the camera in to be
repaired.
The settings stored in the camera may be deleted depending on the type of repair.
Always make a copy of important settings.
Transmission of the image fails midway. There is an image that could not be transmitted.
Image cannot be transmitted when the battery indicator is flashing red.
Is the size of the image too large?
Divide the motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214).
Reduce the image size at [Size] (→271), and then send.
File format of the picture that can be sent differs depending on the destination.
(→239, 243, 244, 247, 251, 255)
Capacity or number of images in the WEB service is full.
Login to “LUMIX CLUB”, and check the status of the destination on the WEB service link
settings.
322
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
I have forgotten the password for the Wi-Fi.
Execute the [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu. (→51)
However, the information you have set on the [Wi-Fi Setup] will be reset.
I cannot send images to an AV device.
Sending may fail depending on the operational status of the AV device. Also, sending may take a
while.
I cannot connect using the NFC function.
The smartphone is not NFC compatible.
This function can be used with NFC compatible devices with Android (2.3.3 or above).
Is the NFC function on the smartphone turned off?
The [NFC Operation] on this unit is set to [OFF]. (→272)
The camera has a hard time recognising some smartphone models. If it is not recognised, slowly
shift the smartphone while it is beside the unit.
If you hold the smartphone for too short a time, the camera may not be able to recognise the
smartphone. Hold the smartphone for a while.
323
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
TV, computer, printer
No image appears on TV. Image blurred or not coloured.
Not connected correctly (→276).
The television has not been switched to auxiliary input.
The display on the TV and on the camera do not match.
Aspect ratio may be incorrect or edges may be cut off with certain televisions.
Cannot play motion pictures on TV.
Card is inserted into TV.
Connect with AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable and play on camera (→276).
Picture is not displayed on full TV screen.
Check [TV Aspect] settings (→47).
No sound is output from the camera speaker.
When the AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable is connected to the camera, no sound is output
from the camera.
VIERA Link (HDMI) is not working.
Is the HDMI micro cable connected correctly? (→276)
Check that the HDMI micro cable is fully inserted.
Is the camera’s [VIERA Link] setting set to [ON]? (→49)
The input setting may not be able to be changed automatically with certain television HDMI
sockets. In this case, please change the input setting with your television’s remote control
(consult your television’s operating instructions for details).
Check the VIERA Link (HDMI) settings on the device you are connecting to.
Turn the camera off and on again.
Turn the “VIERA Link control (HDMI device control)” setting on your television (VIERA) to off and
then to on again. (Consult your VIERAs operating instructions for details.)
Cannot communicate with the computer.
Not connected correctly (→284).
Check whether computer has recognised camera.
Set [USB Mode] to [PC] (→47).
Turn the camera off and then on again.
Computer does not recognise card.
Disconnect USB connection cable (supplied) and reconnect with card in place.
If there are two or more USB terminal on a single PC, try connecting the USB connection cable to
another USB terminal.
324
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Computer does not recognise card. (When using an SDXC Memory Card)
Check whether your computer is compatible with SDXC Memory Cards.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html
A message prompting you to format the card may appear when you connect it. Do not format the
card.
If the [Access] indicator on the screen does not go off, turn the camera off before disconnecting
the USB connection cable.
Cannot print when connecting to printer.
Printer not compatible with PictBridge.
Set [USB Mode] to [PictBridge(PTP)] (→47, 287).
The edges of pictures are cut off when printing.
Release any trimming or edgeless printing settings on printer before printing. (Refer to the
instruction manual for the printer.)
The aspect ratio of pictures is different from that of paper used for printing.
→ If printing in shop, check if 16:9 sizes can be printed.
Cannot print panorama pictures properly.
The aspect ratio of panorama pictures is different from that of regular still pictures, and some
panorama pictures may not be printed correctly.
Use a printer with support for panorama pictures. (Refer to the instruction manual for the printer.)
We recommend adjusting the size of a picture in accordance with print paper using the
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the DVD (supplied).
325
SQW0024
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Others
Menu not displayed in desired language.
Change [Language] setting (→49).
Camera rattles if shaken.
This sound is made by the lens movement and is not a fault.
The lens makes a clicking noise.
When the camera is turned on or off, the lens is moved, or an aperture operation is performed,
such a noise may be heard. This is not a malfunction.
When the brightness changes after a zooming operation or moving the camera, the lens may make
a noise while adjusting the aperture. This is not a malfunction.
Red lamp illuminated when pressing shutter button halfway in dark locations.
[AF Assist Lamp] is set to [ON] (→125).
AF Assist Lamp is not illuminated.
[AF Assist Lamp] is set to [OFF] (→125).
Not illuminated in bright locations.
Part of a picture flashes black and white.
[Highlight] is set to [ON]. (→72)
Camera is hot.
Camera may become a little warm during use, but this does not affect performance or quality.
Clock is incorrect.
Camera has been left for a long period.
→ Reset the clock (→30).
A long time was taken to set the clock (clock will be behind by the same lapse of time).
When using zoom, picture becomes slightly warped and the edges of the subject become
coloured.
Pictures may be slightly warped or coloured around the edges, depending on the zoom ratio, but
this is not a fault.
File numbers are not recorded in sequence.
File numbers are reset when new folders are created (→50).
If you perform this operation after performing a specific operation, the picture may be saved in a
folder with a different folder number than the previous folder number.
File numbers have jumped backwards.
Battery was removed/inserted with the camera turned on. (Numbers may jump backwards if folder/
file numbers are not correctly recorded.)
326
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
When in use
Camera may become warm if used for long periods of time, but this is not a fault.
Keep this unit as far away as possible from electromagnetic equipment (such as
microwave ovens, TVs, video games etc.).
• If you use this unit on top of or near a TV, the pictures and/or sound on this unit may
be disrupted by electromagnetic wave radiation.
• Do not use this unit near cell phones because doing so may result in noise adversely
affecting the pictures and/or sound.
• Recorded data may be damaged, or pictures may be distorted, by strong magnetic
fields created by speakers or large motors.
• Electromagnetic wave radiation may adversely affect this unit, disturbing the pictures
and/or sound.
• If this unit is adversely affected by electromagnetic equipment and stops functioning
properly, turn this unit off and remove the battery or disconnect AC adaptor (optional).
Then reinsert the battery or reconnect AC adaptor and turn this unit on.
Do not use this unit near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines.
• If you record near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines, the recorded pictures and/
or sound may be adversely affected.
Do not extend the supplied cord or cable.
Do not allow camera to come into contact with pesticides or volatile substances (can
cause surface damage or coating to peel).
Do not keep objects that may be influenced magnetically close to the speaker.
• Magnetised objects such as bank cards, commuter passes, watches, may be
adversely affected by the magnetic influence of the speaker.
Never leave the camera and the battery in a car or on a car hood in the summer.
Doing so may cause leakage of the battery electrolyte, overheating, fire or a battery
explosion due to the high temperature.
Caring for your camera
To clean your camera, remove the battery or the DC coupler (optional), or disconnect the
power plug from the outlet, and wipe with a soft, dry cloth.
Use a damp cloth to remove stubborn stains, before wiping with a dry cloth.
Do not use benzine, thinners, alcohol, or kitchen detergent, as these may damage the
outer casing and finish of the camera.
If using a chemically-treated cloth, read the supplied instructions carefully.
327
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
When not using for a while
Turn off the camera before removing battery and card (ensure that battery is removed
to prevent damage through over-discharge).
Do not leave in contact with rubber or plastic bags.
Store together with a drying agent (silica gel) if leaving in drawer, etc. Store batteries in
cool (15 °C to 25 °C (59 °F to 77 °F)) places with low humidity (40%RH to 60%RH) and
no major temperature changes.
Charge battery once per year and use completely before storing again.
Memory cards
To prevent damage to cards and data
• Avoid high temperatures, direct sunlight, electromagnetic waves, and static electricity.
• Do not bend, drop, or expose to strong impacts.
• Do not touch terminals on reverse of card or allow them to become dirty or wet.
Recorded data may be damaged or lost if the camera breaks down due to inappropriate
handling. Panasonic will not be liable for any damage caused due to loss of recorded
data.
When disposing of/transferring memory cards
• If using the “format” or “delete” functions on your camera or computer, this only
changes the file management information, and does not completely delete the data
from within the memory card. When disposing of or transferring your memory cards,
we recommend physically destroying them, or using commercially available computer
data erasing software to completely delete the data from the card. Data within
memory cards should be managed responsibly.
Monitor/viewfinder
Do not press hard on the monitor. This may cause uneven display and damage the
monitor.
In cold climates or other situations when the camera becomes cold, the monitor or
the viewfinder may appear slightly darker than normal immediately after the camera is
turned on. Normal brightness will return once the internal components have warmed up.
The monitor and viewfinder are made with extremely high precision technology.
However there may be some dark or bright spots (red, blue or green) on the screen.
This is not a malfunction. The monitor and viewfinder screens are controlled with
extremely high precision, but some pixels may be inactive. The spots will not be
recorded on pictures on a card.
328
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Battery
The battery is a rechargeable lithium ion battery.
This battery is easily affected by temperature and humidity, and is affected more when the
temperature is high or low.
The time required for charging varies depending on conditions of battery usage.
Charging takes longer at high or low temperatures and when the battery has not been
used in some time.
Battery will be warm during charging and for some time thereafter.
Battery will run out if not used for long periods of time, even after being charged.
Do not leave any metal items (such as clips) near the contact areas of the power plug.
Otherwise, a fire and/or electric shocks may be caused by short-circuiting or the
resulting heat generated.
Frequently charging up battery is not recommended.
(Frequently charging battery reduces maximum usage time and can cause battery to
expand.)
If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan.
Please purchase a new battery.
When charging:
• Wipe dirt from the battery terminal with a dry cloth.
• Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference).
Do not use a damaged or dented battery (especially connectors), e.g. by dropping (can
cause faults).
Charger
Depending on the environment while charging, the charging light may flicker due to
static electricity or electromagnetic radiation, etc. This has no effect on charging.
Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference).
The charger may generate whirring sounds when it is being used. This is not a
malfunction.
After use, be sure to disconnect the power supply device from the electrical outlet. (A
very small amount of current is consumed if it is left connected.)
Keep the terminals of the charger and battery clean. When they get dirty, clean with a
dry cloth.
329
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Lens
Images may appear slightly white if lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.). Turn the camera on,
hold the extracted lens barrel with your fingers, and gently wipe the lens surface with a
soft, dry cloth.
Do not leave the lens exposed to direct sunlight.
When using a tripod or unipod
Do not apply excessive force or tighten screws when they are crooked. (This may
damage the camera, screw hole, or label.)
Ensure that the tripod is stable. (Refer to the tripod instructions.)
You may not be able to remove the card or the battery when using a tripod or unipod.
Personal Information
To protect personal information, we recommend that you set a Wi-Fi password. (→273)
If names or birthdays are set in [Profile Setup] or in the [Face Recog.] function, keep in
mind that the camera and recorded pictures will contain personal information.
Disclaimer
• Data containing personal information can be altered or lost due to malfunction, static
electricity, accidents, breakdowns, repairs, or other operations.
Panasonic will not be liable for any damage that occurs, direct or indirect, as a result
of the alteration or loss of data containing personal information.
When ordering repairs or transferring/disposing of the camera
• After you make a note of the personal information, perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings]/
[Delete account] to delete data containing personal information such as wireless LAN
connection settings that you registered or set in this unit. (→51, 262)
• To protect your personal information, please reset the settings. (→50)
• Remove the memory card from the camera.
• When ordering repairs, settings may be returned to the initial purchase state.
• If the above operations cannot be performed because of a camera malfunction,
consult with the dealer or nearest Service Centre.
When transferring or disposing of your memory card, see “When disposing of/
transferring memory cards” in the previous section. (→327)
Uploading pictures to WEB services
• Pictures may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such
as titles, recording dates and times, and location information. Before uploading the
pictures to WEB services, check the pictures carefully for information that should not
be disclosed.
330
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
HDMI, the HDMI Logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
“AVCHD”, “AVCHD Progressive” and the “AVCHD Progressive” logo are trademarks of
Panasonic Corporation and Sony Corporation.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Adobe is a trademark or registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United
States and/or other countries.
Pentium is a trademark of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
Windows and Windows Vista are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
iMovie, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
iPad, iPhone, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
Android and Google Play are trademarks or registered trademarks of Google Inc.
The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier mark is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
“Wi-Fi
®
” and “Wi-Fi Direct
®
” are registered trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
“Wi-Fi Protected Setup™”, “WPA™” and “WPA2™” are trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
DLNA, the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks, service marks, or certification
marks of the Digital Living Network Alliance.
QR Code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED.
This product uses “DynaFont” from DynaComware Corporation. DynaFont is a registered
trademark of DynaComware Taiwan Inc.
Other names, company names, and product names mentioned in these instructions are
trademarks or registered trademarks of the companies concerned.
331
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
This product is licensed under the AVC patent portfolio license for the personal and non-
commercial use of a consumer to (i) encode video in compliance with the AVC Standard (“AVC
Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC Video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal and
non-commercial activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed to provide AVC Video.
No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use. Additional information may be obtained
from MPEG LA, LLC.
See http://www.mpegla.com.
332
SQW0024
Others
Usage cautions and notes
This product incorporates the following software:
(1) the software developed independently by or for Panasonic Corporation,
(2) the software owned by third party and licenced to Panasonic Corporation, and/or
(3) open source software
The software categorised as (3) is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
Please refer to the detailed terms and conditions thereof displayed by selecting
[MENU/SET] → [Setup] → [Version Disp.] → [Software info].
Disposal of Old Equipment and Batteries
Only for European Union and countries with recycling systems
These symbols on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying
documents mean that used electrical and electronic products and batteries
must not be mixed with general household waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products and used
batteries, please take them to applicable collection points in accordance
with your national legislation.
By disposing of them correctly, you will help to save valuable resources
and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the
environment.
For more information about collection and recycling, please contact your
local municipality.
Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste, in
accordance with national legislation.
Note for the battery symbol (bottom symbol):
This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol. In this
case it complies with the requirement set by the Directive for the chemical
involved.

Documenttranscriptie

Operating Instructions for advanced features Digital Camera Model No. DMC-LX100 Please read these instructions carefully before using this product, and save this manual for future use. Message Display →299 Q&A Troubleshooting →310 Finding the information you need →2 Contents →4 Contents by Function →10 Menu list →303 SQW0024 M0914KZ0 Finding the information you need In this “Operating Instructions for advanced features”, you can find the information you need from the following pages. By clicking a page number, you can jump to the linked page and quickly find the information. Search from “Contents” P.4 - Search from the list of function names P.10 - “Contents by Function” Search from “Names and Functions of Main Parts” P.14 - Search from “List of monitor/ viewfinder displays” P.293 - Search from the list of on-screen messages P.299 - Search from the menu list P.303 - “Message displays” “Menu list” [Rec].......................... P.303 [Motion Picture]......... P.305 [Custom].................... P.306 [Setup] ...................... P.308 [Playback].................. P.309 Search from “Q&A Troubleshooting” P.310 - For details on how to use this manual, see the next page. ® Wi-Fi function 2 →224 SQW0024 How to use this manual Recording mode icons Recording mode: In Recording Modes that show icons in black, you can select and execute indicated menus and functions. ••Click a cross reference in the text to jump to the corresponding page. ••By entering keywords in the search field at the top of the Adobe Reader screen, you can run a keyword search and jump to the corresponding page. ••Operations and other details of this manual may vary depending on the Adobe Reader version you are using. ■■About the symbols in the text Indicates that the menu can be set by pressing [MENU/SET] button. Indicates that the Wi-Fi setting can be made by pressing [Wi-Fi] button. Configurations that can be performed in the [Custom] menu. Tips for skilful use and points for recording. Conditions in which a particular function cannot be used. (→00) Indicates the reference page. Click to go to the corresponding page. Click to view the description on the next page. In this Operating Instructions, steps for setting a menu item are described as follows: → [Rec] → [Quality] → [   ] Click this icon to jump to “Finding the information you need”. Click this icon to jump to “Contents”. Click this icon to jump to “Menu list”. Click this icon to return to the previously displayed page. 3 SQW0024 Contents ■■Finding the information you need...... 2 ■■How to use this manual....................... 3 ■■Contents by Function........................ 10 Before Use ■■Before use.......................................... 12 ■■Standard Accessories....................... 13 ■■Names and Functions of Main Parts........................................... 14 [MENU/SET] button / Cursor button / Control dial.................................................18 Preparations ■■Attaching the lens cap and shoulder strap.................................... 19 ■■Charging battery................................ 20 Remaining battery......................................21 Guidelines for number of recordable pictures and operating time........................22 ■■Inserting and removing the battery/ the card (optional).............................. 24 ■■About the Card................................... 25 Formatting the card (initialisation)..............26 Recording capacity guidelines (pictures/recording time).............................27 ■■Setting the clock................................ 29 Changing time settings...............................30 ■■Setting the menu................................ 31 Setting the menu screen background.........33 ■■Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)..................... 34 Change the Quick Menu to your preferred item.............................................35 ■■Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons)............................. 37 ■■Changing settings using the control ring......................................... 39 ■■Using the [Setup] menu..................... 41 [Clock Set]..................................................41 [World Time]................................................41 [Travel Date]...............................................42 [Wi-Fi].........................................................42 [Beep].........................................................43 [Live View Mode]........................................43 [Monitor Display] / [Viewfinder]...................44 [Monitor Luminance]...................................45 [Sleep Mode]..............................................46 [USB Mode]................................................47 [TV Connection]..........................................47 [Menu Resume]..........................................49 [Menu Background]....................................49 [Menu Information]......................................49 [Language]..................................................49 [Version Disp.]............................................50 [Self Timer Auto Off]....................................50 [No.Reset]...................................................50 [Reset]........................................................50 [Reset Wi-Fi Settings].................................51 [Format]......................................................51 ■■Entering Text...................................... 52 Changing the settings assigned to the control ring..................................................40 4 SQW0024 Contents Basics ■■Holding the camera............................ 53 ■■Recording pictures using the viewfinder .......................................... 54 Switching between the monitor and viewfinder...................................................54 About Eye Sensor AF.................................55 ■■Taking pictures................................... 56 ■■Recording motion pictures............... 58 ■■Select the recording mode................ 59 ■■Switching the display information on the recording screen.................... 62 ■■Viewing your pictures........................ 67 Viewing motion pictures..............................70 ■■Switching the display information on the playback screen..................... 71 ■■Deleting pictures................................ 73 [Delete Single]............................................73 To delete multiple (up to 100)/ To delete all pictures...................................74 Recording mode ■■Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode...................... 75 Taking pictures using a handheld camera ([iHandheld Night Shot]).............................78 Combining pictures into a single still picture with rich gradation ([iHDR]).............79 ■■Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed.... 80 Taking pictures by setting the aperture value ([Aperture-Priority] Mode).................83 Taking pictures by setting the shutter speed ([Shutter-Priority] Mode)..................84 Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed ([Manual Exposure] Mode).........................86 Checking the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed ([Preview] Mode)...........88 Taking pictures after automatically setting the aperture value and shutter speed ([Program AE] Mode)..................................81 Picture effects (Filter) ■■Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter).................................... 89 5 SQW0024 Contents Picture Quality and colouring Settings ■■Adjusting the picture quality with effects [Photo Style]....................... 100 ■■Adjusting highlights and shadows [Highlight Shadow].......................... 102 ■■Adjusting the White Balance.......... 103 ■■Setting the picture quality and size.................................................... 107 Changing the aspect ratio of the still pictures.....................................................107 Setting the picture size.............................108 Setting the compression rate of pictures ([Quality])..................................................109 ■■Using the picture correction functions effectively.........................111 Correcting contrast and exposure ([i.Dynamic])............................................. 111 Enhancing the impression of high-resolution ([i.Resolution]).................. 111 Combining still pictures with different exposures ([HDR]).................................... 112 Suppressing the noise of a long exposure ([Long Shtr NR])........................ 113 Setting the colour space........................... 113 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) ■■Taking pictures with Auto Focus.... 114 Select the focus mode (AFS, AFF, AFC)....................................... 114 Switching [AF Mode]................................. 115 Changing the position and size of the AF area.....................................................121 Setting your preferred focusing method....124 ■■Taking close-up pictures (Macro recording)............................ 126 Focus range..............................................126 ■■Taking pictures with Manual Focus................................... 128 MF Assist..................................................131 ■■Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure [AF/AE Lock].................................... 133 ■■Taking pictures with Exposure Compensation.................................. 135 ■■Setting the ISO Sensitivity.............. 136 Setting the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity..........................................137 Setting the incremental value of ISO Sensitivity..........................................138 Extending the ISO Sensitivity setting........138 ■■Setting the metering mode.............. 139 Shutter and Drive Settings ■■Setting the Shutter Type.................. 140 ■■Selecting a Drive Mode.................... 141 ■■Burst function.................................. 142 ■■Recording while exposure is changed automatically [Auto Bracket].................................. 145 6 ■■Automatically changing the aspect ratio while taking pictures [Aspect Bracket].............................. 147 ■■Taking pictures with self-timer....... 148 ■■Recording panorama pictures........ 150 SQW0024 Contents Functions for specific subjects and purposes ■■Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot]............................ 153 ■■Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation]................. 156 ■■Performing multiple exposures for a single picture [Multi Exp.]..... 159 ■■Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time [Silent Mode].................................... 161 ■■Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.]................................... 162 ■■Setting the profile for a baby or pet to record in a picture............ 165 ■■Displaying the appropriate screen for specific recording conditions.... 166 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash ■■Correcting jitter ............................... 168 ■■Using Zoom...................................... 170 Zoom types and use.................................171 ■■Taking pictures using the flash (supplied).......................................... 176 Attaching the flash....................................176 Changing the firing mode (Manual flash)...........................................179 Changing Flash Mode..............................180 Setting the 2nd curtain sync.....................182 Adjusting the flash output.........................183 Synchronising the flash output with the camera during Exposure Compensation..........................183 Performing wireless flash settings............184 Recording motion pictures ■■Recording motion pictures............. 187 Setting the format, picture size and recording frame rate.................................187 Adjusting the focus while recording motion pictures ([Continuous AF])............189 Recording motion pictures........................190 Recording 4K motion pictures..................194 Creating a high-resolution still picture from a 4K motion picture [4K PHOTO].....195 ■■Taking still pictures while a motion ■■Using the [Motion Picture] menu.... 199 [4K PHOTO]..............................................199 [Rec Format].............................................199 [Rec Quality].............................................199 [Picture Mode]..........................................199 [Continuous AF]........................................199 [Mic Level Disp.].......................................200 [Mic Level Adj.].........................................200 [Wind Cut].................................................200 picture is being recorded................ 198 7 SQW0024 Contents Playing Back and Editing Pictures ■■Viewing the group picture............... 201 ■■Capturing still pictures from motion pictures................................ 203 ■■Using the [Playback] menu............. 204 [Slide Show]..............................................204 [Playback Mode].......................................206 [Location Logging]....................................207 [RAW Processing].....................................208 [Title Edit].................................................. 211 [Text Stamp]..............................................212 [Video Divide]............................................214 [Time Lapse Video]...................................215 [Stop Motion Video]..................................215 [Resize].....................................................216 [Cropping].................................................217 [Rotate] / [Rotate Disp.]............................218 [Favorite]...................................................219 [Print Set]..................................................220 [Protect]....................................................221 [Face Rec Edit].........................................222 [Picture Sort].............................................223 [Delete Confirmation]................................223 Wi-Fi ■■Wi-Fi® Function and NFC Function................................... 224 ■■What you can do with the Wi-Fi function................................... 227 ■■Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone........ 228 Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App”............................228 Connecting to a smartphone....................229 Connecting to a smartphone using NFC function.............................................233 Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording)....................................234 Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone............................................235 Saving pictures in the camera to the smartphone...............................................235 Easily transferring pictures in the camera................................................236 Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services........................237 Adding location information to pictures in the camera from a smartphone.............237 Operating the camera to send pictures to a smartphone........................................239 8 ■■Displaying still pictures on a TV..... 242 ■■Wireless printing.............................. 243 ■■Sending pictures to AV device........ 244 ■■Sending pictures to a PC................ 247 ■■Using WEB services........................ 251 When sending images to WEB service....251 When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service]...............................255 ■■Using “LUMIX CLUB”...................... 258 About the [LUMIX CLUB]..........................258 ■■About connections.......................... 263 [Via Network] Connecting via a wireless access point....264 [Direct] Connecting directly...................................267 Connecting quickly with the same settings as used previously ([Select a destination from History] / [Select a destination from Favorite]).........268 Settings for sending pictures....................270 ■■[Wi-Fi Setup]..................................... 272 SQW0024 Contents Connecting with other devices ■■Enjoying 4K motion pictures.......... 274 Viewing 4K motion pictures......................274 Storing 4K motion pictures.......................275 ■■Viewing on TV screen...................... 276 VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™).....278 ■■Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC............ 280 About supplied software...........................281 Installing supplied software......................283 Copying still pictures and motion pictures.........................................284 ■■Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures in the recorder...... 286 Copying by inserting the card into the recorder....................................................286 Dubbing playback pictures via AV cables (optional)...................................................286 ■■Printing............................................. 287 Printing multiple pictures..........................288 Printing with date and text........................289 Making print settings on the camera.........290 Others ■■Optional accessories....................... 291 External Flash (optional)...........................291 Using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) instead of the battery.............................................292 ■■List of monitor/viewfinder ■■Message displays............................ 299 ■■Menu list........................................... 303 ■■Q&A Troubleshooting..................... 310 ■■Usage cautions and notes.............. 326 displays............................................. 293 9 SQW0024 Contents by Function Recording Recording Recording mode............................................59 [Preview]........................................................88 Picture effects (Filter)....................................89 Macro recording...........................................126 Recording panorama pictures.....................150 [Time Lapse Shot]........................................153 [Stop Motion Animation]...............................156 [Multi Exp.]...................................................159 [Silent Mode]................................................161 Focus (AF/MF) Focus Mode................................................. 114 AF Mode...................................................... 115 Adjusting the AF area position.....................121 Manual Focus..............................................128 AF/AE Lock..................................................133 Exposure AF/AE Lock..................................................133 Exposure Compensation.............................135 ISO sensitivity..............................................136 [Metering Mode]...........................................139 [Auto Bracket]..............................................145 Drive Drive Mode..................................................141 [Aspect Bracket]..........................................147 [Self Timer]..................................................148 Picture Quality and Colour Tone [Photo Style]................................................100 [Highlight Shadow].......................................102 White Balance.............................................103 [Picture Size]...............................................108 [Quality].......................................................109 [i.Dynamic]................................................... 111 [i.Resolution]................................................ 111 [HDR]........................................................... 112 [Long Shtr NR]............................................. 113 [Color Space]............................................... 113 Flash [Flash Mode]................................................180 2nd curtain synchro.....................................182 [Flash Adjust.]..............................................183 Wireless flash settings.................................184 Screen settings [Monochrome Live View].............................167 [Mic Level Disp.]..........................................200 Motion Picture Motion Picture [Rec Format]................................................187 [Rec Quality]................................................187 Motion pictures in 4K...................................194 [4K PHOTO]................................................195 Taking still pictures while a motion picture is being recorded.................198 Audio [Mic Level Adj.]............................................200 [Wind Cut]....................................................200 Setup/Custom Basic settings [Format].........................................................26 [Clock Set].....................................................29 How to set menu items..................................31 [Q.MENU]......................................................34 [Beep]............................................................43 [Sleep Mode].................................................46 [Reset] (initialisation).....................................50 Diopter adjustment........................................55 Display switching.....................................62, 71 10 Customisation [CUSTOM] in the Quick Menu.......................35 Function buttons............................................37 Control ring....................................................40 Custom Set....................................................60 [Custom] menu............................................306 [Cursor Button Lock]......................................38 Motion picture button...................................192 SQW0024 Contents by Function Playback Playback [Auto Review]................................................57 Picture playback............................................67 Playback Zoom..............................................68 Multi Playback...............................................68 Motion picture playback.................................70 Delete............................................................73 Display/playback settings [Slide Show].................................................204 [Rotate]/[Rotate Disp.].................................218 Edit [RAW Processing]........................................208 [Resize]........................................................216 [Cropping]....................................................217 Adding information [Location Logging].......................................207 [Title Edit]..................................................... 211 [Text Stamp].................................................212 Image settings [Favorite]......................................................219 [Print Set].....................................................220 [Protect].......................................................221 Wi-Fi Connect “Image App”.................................................228 NFC.............................................................233 [WPS (Push-Button)]...........................264, 267 Direct connection.........................................267 Image App Remote recording........................................234 Saving images.............................................235 Sending images...................................236, 239 Sending and adding location information....237 [Touch Sharing]............................................272 In combination with other devices Playing back pictures on a TV.....................242 Printing images............................................243 Sending images to an AV device.................244 Sending images to a PC..............................247 Sending images to a WEB service..............251 Using [Cloud Sync. Service]........................255 Connecting with other devices PC “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”...................................281 SILKYPIX.....................................................282 TV [VIERA Link]................................................278 11 Recorder Dubbing.......................................................286 Printer PictBridge....................................................287 SQW0024 Before Use Before use ■■Camera handling Keep the camera away from excessive vibration, force, or pressure. ●●Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which may damage the lens, monitor, viewfinder, or camera body. This may also cause the camera to malfunction or prevent recording. •• Dropping or hitting the camera against a hard surface •• Pushing with excessive force on the lens or monitor The camera is not dust resistant, splash resistant, or waterproof. Avoid using the camera in places with excessive dust or sand, or where water can come into contact with the camera. ●●Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which present a risk that sand, water, or foreign material may enter the camera through the lens or openings around buttons. Be especially careful because these conditions may damage the camera, and such damage may not be repairable. •• In extremely dusty or sandy places •• In the rain or by the shore, where the camera may be exposed to water ■■Condensation (When the lens, the monitor, or viewfinder, is fogged up) ●●Condensation may occur when the camera is exposed to sudden changes of temperature or humidity. Avoid these conditions, which may make the lens, monitor, or viewfinder, dirty, cause mould, or damage the camera. ●●If condensation does occur, turn off the camera and wait about two hours before using it. Once the camera adjusts to the surrounding temperature, the fogging will clear naturally. ■■Always take a test shot first Before important events when you will use the camera (at weddings, for example), always take a test shot to make sure that pictures and sound record correctly. ■■No compensation for missed shots We cannot compensate for missed shots if technical problems with the camera or card prevent recording. ■■Carefully observe copyright laws Unauthorised use of recordings that contain works with copyright for purposes other than personal use is prohibited under copyright law. Recording of certain material may be restricted even for the purpose of personal use. ■■Also refer to “Usage cautions and notes” (→326) 12 SQW0024 Before Use Standard Accessories Check that all the accessories are supplied before using the camera. ●●The accessories and their shape will differ depending on the country or area where the camera was purchased. For details on the accessories, refer to Basic Operating Instructions. ●●Battery Pack is indicated as battery pack or battery in the text. ●●SD Memory Card, SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory Card are indicated as card in the text. ●●Please dispose of all packaging appropriately. ●●Keep small parts in a safe place out of the reach of children. ■■Optional accessories ••Cards are optional. 13 SQW0024 Before Use Names and Functions of Main Parts 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 Self-timer indicator (→148) / AF Assist Lamp (→53, 125) 2 Control ring (→39) 3 Aspect ratio selector switch (→107) 4 Hot shoe (Hot shoe cover) (→176) The hot shoe cover is already attached to the hot shoe at the time of purchase. 5 Aperture ring (→59) 9 8 7 6 Focus selector switch (→114, 126, 128) 7 Lens front ring To attach the auto lens cap (optional), remove the lens front ring. 8 Lens barrel 9 Lens (Filter diameter Φ43 mm) 14 SQW0024 Before Use Names and Functions of Main Parts (Top) 10 11 12 13 14 10 Stereo microphone (→53, 200) Be careful not to cover the microphone with your finger. Doing so may make sound difficult to record. 11 Shutter speed dial (→59) 12 Shutter button 13 Zoom lever (→170) 14 [FILTER] button (→89) 17 16 15 15 Exposure compensation dial (→135) 16 [iA] button (→59) 17 Camera [ON/OFF] switch (Bottom) 18 19 20 21 22 18 Speaker Be careful not to cover the speaker with your finger. Doing so may make sound difficult to hear. 19 Tripod mount (→329) Do not attach to a tripod with a 5.5 mm (0.22 inch) or longer screw. Doing so may damage this unit. It may not be possible to attach certain types of tripods properly. 20 DC coupler cover Open this cover to use an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) in place of the battery. When using an AC adaptor (optional), ensure that the Panasonic DC coupler (optional) and AC adaptor are used. (→292) 21 Release lever (→24) 22 Card/Battery door (→24) 15 SQW0024 Before Use Names and Functions of Main Parts 23 24 25 26 27 29 28 30 23 Viewfinder (LVF) (→54) In this manual, “viewfinder” is used to indicate the LVF. Eye Sensor (→54) 24 25 Diopter adjustment dial (→55) 26 [LVF] button (→54) / [Fn3] button (→37) 27 Strap eyelet (→19) 28 Monitor 29 [HDMI] socket (→276) 30 [AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket (→276, 284, 286, 287) 16 SQW0024 Before Use Names and Functions of Main Parts 27 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 27 Strap eyelet (→19) 31 Wi-Fi® antenna 32 Wi-Fi connection lamp (→225) 33 [Wi-Fi] button (→225) / [Fn2] button (→37) 34 Motion picture button (→58) 35 [AF/AE LOCK] button (→133) 36 NFC antenna (→233) 37 [Q.MENU] button (→34) 38 Playback button (→67) 39 [Fn1] button (→37) / [   ] (Delete/Cancel) button (→32, 73) 40 [DISP.] button (→62, 71) 41 [MENU/SET] button / Cursor button / Control dial (→18) ●●The illustrations and screens in this manual may differ from the actual product. 17 SQW0024 Before Use Names and Functions of Main Parts [MENU/SET] button / Cursor button / Control dial [MENU/SET] button Use this button to display the menus, enter the settings, etc. (→31) Cursor button This button is used to move the cursor on the menu screens and for other functions. (→32) You can perform the following operations while recording. [ISO] button (   ) (→136) [WB] (White Balance) button (   ) (→103) [   ] (Drive Mode) button (   ) Single (→141), Burst (→142), Auto Bracket (→145), Aspect Bracket (→147), Self-timer (→148), Panorama (→150) [   ] (AF Mode) button (   ) (→115, 131) Control dial Turn the dial to select setting items and change setting values. (→32, 67) Disabling the button and dial operation (while recording) When the [Cursor Button Lock] is assigned to the function button, operation of the [MENU/SET] button, cursor button, and control dial is disabled. (→38) Enabling/disabling the operation guide display → [Custom] → [Dial Guide] → [ON] / [OFF] ••When you set the operation guide to [ON], the operation guide for the control ring ([   ]), control dial ([   ]), and other parts appear on the recording screen. ●●In this manual, the button that is to be used is indicated by 18 . SQW0024 Preparations Attaching the lens cap and shoulder strap Cover the lens with the lens cap to protect it when you are not taking pictures. We recommend attaching the lens cap to the camera using the lens cap string to prevent loss of the lens cap. We also recommend attaching the shoulder strap to prevent the camera from being dropped. 1 Use the lens cap string (supplied) to attach the lens cap to the camera Make sure that the thicker portion of the string is not hanging over the lens cap or the shoulder strap eyelet. 2 Attach the lens cap 3 Attach the shoulder strap To attach and remove the lens cap, press the areas shown by arrows in the illustration. Shoulder strap eyelet ••Attach the other end of the shoulder strap. ••Make sure that the shoulder strap does not come loose. ••Attach the shoulder strap with the LUMIX logo on the strap facing out. ••Use the shoulder strap around your shoulder. –– Do not wrap the strap around your neck. It may result in injury or accident. ••Do not leave the shoulder strap where an infant can reach it. –– It may result in an accident by mistakenly wrapping around the neck. 19 SQW0024 Preparations Charging battery Always charge before first use! (battery shipped uncharged) About batteries that you can use with this unit It has been found that counterfeit battery packs which look very similar to the genuine products are made available to purchase in some markets. Some of these battery packs are not adequately protected with internal protection to meet the requirements of appropriate safety standards. There is a possibility that these battery packs may lead to fire or explosion. Please be advised that we are not liable for any accident or failure occurring as a result of use of a counterfeit battery pack. To ensure that safe products are used we recommend that a genuine Panasonic battery pack is used. ••Use the dedicated charger and battery. 1 Attach the battery paying attention to the direction of the battery 2 Connect the charger to the electrical outlet Plug-in type Inlet type Battery Charging light ([CHARGE]) On: Charging in progress Off: Charging complete Charger (model-specific) •• The AC mains lead does not fit entirely into the AC input terminal. A gap will remain. ••Charge the battery with the charger indoors. 3 20 If light is flashing: ••Battery temperature is too high or too low. We recommend charging in a location where the ambient temperature is between 10 °C and 30 °C (50 °F to 86 °F). ••Battery/charger connector is dirty. Clean with a dry cloth. Detach the battery after charging is completed ••The battery charger is in the standby condition when the AC power is supplied. The primary circuit is always “live” as long as the battery charger is connected to an electrical outlet. SQW0024 Preparations Charging battery Notes on charging time Charging time Approx. 190 min ••The charging time indicated above is the time required for charging in case when the battery is completely used up. The time required for charging differs depending on conditions of battery usage. Charging takes longer in cases when temperatures are either high or low and when the battery has not been used for a long period of time. Remaining battery When using the camera, the remaining battery capacity is displayed. Remaining battery (only when using battery) (flashes red) If the battery mark flashes red, recharge or replace a fully charged battery. ●●Always use genuine Panasonic batteries. ●●If you use other batteries, we cannot guarantee the quality of this product. ●●Remove battery from camera after use. •• Keep the battery in a plastic bag, making sure that it is kept away from metallic objects (such as clips) when carrying or storing it. ●●To remove the battery, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the monitor goes off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card or recorded data.) 21 SQW0024 Preparations Charging battery Guidelines for number of recordable pictures and operating time Recording still pictures (When using monitor) Number of recordable pictures Recording time Approx. 350 pictures (Approx. 300 pictures) Approx. 175 min (Approx. 150 min) By CIPA standard Recording still pictures (When using viewfinder (LVF)) Number of recordable pictures Recording time Approx. 320 pictures (Approx. 270 pictures) Approx. 160 min (Approx. 135 min) By CIPA standard •• The values when the flash (supplied) is used are provided in parentheses. ■■Recording conditions by CIPA standard CIPA is an abbreviation of “Camera & Imaging Products Association”. •• [Program AE] Mode •• Temperature: 23 °C (73.4 °F)/Humidity: 50%RH when monitor is on. •• Using a Panasonic SDHC Memory Card. •• Using the supplied battery. •• Starting recording 30 seconds after the camera is turned on (when [Stabilizer] is set to [   ]). •• Recording once every 30 seconds with full flash every second recording. •• Rotating the zoom lever from Tele to Wide or vice versa in every recording. •• Turning the camera off every 10 recordings and leaving it until the temperature of the battery decreases. Number reduced if intervals are longer (e.g. to approx. one quarter for 2-minute intervals under the above conditions). 22 SQW0024 Preparations Charging battery Recording motion pictures (When using monitor) [Rec Format] [AVCHD] [MP4] [MP4] [Rec Quality] [FHD/17M/50i] [FHD/20M/25p] [4K/100M/25p] Approx. 125 min Approx. 135 min Approx. 90 min Approx. 60 min Approx. 65 min Approx. 45 min Available recording time Actual available recording time* * The time you can actually record when repeatedly turning the camera on and off, starting and stopping recording and using zoom. ■■Recording conditions •• Temperature 23 °C (73.4 °F), humidity 50%RH ●●[AVCHD] motion pictures: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds. ●●Motion pictures with their file size set to [FHD], [HD] or [VGA] in [MP4]: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the file size exceeds 4 GB. •• Since the file size becomes larger with [FHD], recording with [FHD] will stop before 29 minutes 59 seconds. ●●Motion pictures with their file size set to [4K] in [MP4]: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes. (You can continue recording without interruption even if the file exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be recorded and played back in separate files.) Viewing pictures (When using monitor) Playback time Approx. 260 min ●●The operating times and number of recordable pictures will differ according to the environment and the operating conditions. For example, in the following cases, the operating times shorten and the number of recordable pictures is reduced. •• In low-temperature environments, such as on ski slopes. •• When operations such as the flash and zoom are used repeatedly. ●●If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan. Please purchase a new battery. 23 SQW0024 Preparations Inserting and removing the battery/the card (optional) ••Make sure that the camera is turned off. 1 2 Slide the release lever to the [OPEN] position and open the card/battery door [OPEN] [LOCK] Release lever Insert the battery and card, making sure that their orientation is correct ••Battery: Insert the battery all the way firmly until a locking sound is heard, and check that the lever is hooked over the battery. ••Card: Insert the card all the way firmly until it clicks. 3 Close the card/battery door and slide the release lever to the [LOCK] position Lever Do not touch the terminal Charged battery (check orientation) Card (check orientation: terminals face monitor) ■■To remove ••To remove battery: Move lever in direction of arrow. ••To remove card: Press the centre of the card. Lever ●●Remove battery from camera after use. ●●Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing. ●●To remove the card or battery, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the monitor turns off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card or recorded data.) 24 SQW0024 Preparations About the Card The following SD standard-based cards (Panasonic brand recommended) can be used. Type of Card SD Memory Cards Capacity Notes 8 MB – 2 GB •• Can be used with devices compatible with the respective formats. •• Before using SDXC Memory Cards, check that your computer and other devices support this type of card. http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html •• This unit is compatible with UHS-Ι UHS Speed Class 3 standard SDHC/SDXC memory cards. •• Only the cards listed on the left with the given capacities are supported. SDHC Memory Cards 4 GB – 32 GB SDXC Memory Cards 48 GB, 64 GB ■■About the motion picture recording and speed class According to the [Rec Format] (→187) and [Rec Quality] (→187) of a motion picture, the required card differs. Use a card that meets the following ratings of the SD Speed Class or UHS Speed Class. ••SD Speed Class and UHS Speed Class are the speed standards regarding continuous writing. Confirm the SD speed by checking the card label or other card related materials. [Rec Format] [Rec Quality] [AVCHD] All [MP4] FHD/HD/VGA [MP4] 4K Speed class Label example Class 4 or higher UHS Speed Class 3 ••Latest information: http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/ (This site is available in English only.) Access to the card The access indication displays red when pictures are being recorded on the card. 50i ●●While the camera is accessing the card (for an operation such as picture writing, reading, deletion, or formatting), do not turn off the camera or remove the battery, card, AC adaptor (optional) or DC coupler (optional). Do not subject the camera to vibrations, impact, or static electricity. The card or the data on the card may be damaged, and this unit may no longer operate normally. If operation fails due to vibration, impact or static electricity, perform the operation again. 25 SQW0024 Preparations About the Card ●●If you set the write-protect switch to “LOCK”, you may not be able to write, delete or format the data or display it by recording date. These operations become available again when you unlock the switch. ●●It is recommended that you copy important pictures to your computer (as electromagnetic waves, static electricity, or faults may cause data to be damaged). Write-protect switch Formatting the card (initialisation) Format the card before recording a picture with this unit. Since data cannot be recovered after formatting, make sure to back up necessary data in advance. 1 Set the menu → [Setup] → [Format] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ●●This requires a sufficiently charged battery, or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). ●●Do not turn off the camera or perform other operations during formatting. ●●Always format cards with this camera. Please reformat the card with this camera if it has already been formatted with a computer or another device. ●●If the card cannot be formatted, please try another card before contacting Panasonic. 26 SQW0024 Preparations About the Card Recording capacity guidelines (pictures/recording time) The number of pictures you can take and the recording time vary in proportion to card capacity (and depending on recording conditions and type of card). Recording picture capacity (still pictures) When aspect ratio is set to [4:3] and [Quality] is set to [   ] [Picture Size] 8 GB 16 GB L (12.5M) 1090 2200 32 GB 4420 8820 M (6.5M) 1880 3810 7630 14970 S (3M) 3220 6500 13030 24700 When aspect ratio is set to [4:3] and [Quality] is set to [  64 GB  ] [Picture Size] 8 GB 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB L (12.5M) 340 700 1400 2800 M (6.5M) 400 810 1620 3230 S (3M) 440 890 1780 3530 ●●When the number of recordable pictures exceeds 9,999, “9999+” is displayed. Recording time capacity (motion pictures) ••The recordable time is the total time of all the motion pictures which have been recorded. ([h], [m] and [s] indicate “hour”, “minute” and “second”.) When [Rec Format] is [AVCHD] [Rec Quality] 27 8 GB [FHD/28M/50p] 37m00s 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 1h15m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s [FHD/17M/50i] 1h00m00s 2h00m00s 4h05m00s 8h15m00s [FHD/24M/25p] 43m00s 1h25m00s 2h55m00s 5h50m00s [FHD/24M/24p] 43m00s 1h25m00s 2h55m00s 5h50m00s SQW0024 Preparations About the Card When [Rec Format] is [MP4] [Rec Quality] [4K/100M/25p] 8 GB 9m00s 16 GB 20m00s 32 GB 64 GB 42m00s 1h20m00s [4K/100M/24p] 9m00s 20m00s 42m00s 1h20m00s [FHD/28M/50p] 37m00s 1h15m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s [FHD/20M/25p] 49m00s 1h40m00s 3h20m00s 6h40m00s [HD/10M/25p] 1h30m00s 3h10m00s 6h25m00s 12h50m00s [VGA/4M/25p] 3h25m00s 7h00m00s 14h10m00s 28h15m00s ●●If the surrounding temperature is high, or a motion picture is recorded continuously, [   ] is displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through to protect the camera. ●●[AVCHD] motion pictures: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds. ●●Motion pictures with their file size set to [FHD], [HD] or [VGA] in [MP4]: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the file size exceeds 4 GB. •• Since the file size becomes larger with [FHD], recording with [FHD] will stop before 29 minutes 59 seconds. ●●Motion pictures with their file size set to [4K] in [MP4]: Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes. (You can continue recording without interruption even if the file exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be recorded and played back in separate files.) ●●The maximum available continuous recording time is displayed on the screen. Switching the display between the number of recordable pictures that you can take and the available recording time → [Custom] →[Remaining Disp.] [   ] (Remaining shots): Displays the number of pictures that can be recorded. [   ] (Remaining time): Displays the remaining recording time. Number of recordable pictures 28 Available recording time SQW0024 Preparations Setting the clock The clock is not set when the camera is shipped. 1 Turn the camera on 2 Press [MENU/SET] while the message is displayed 3 Press 4 5 ••If the language select screen is not displayed, proceed to step 4. to select the language, and press [MENU/SET] ••The [Please set the clock] message appears. Press [MENU/SET] Press to select the items (year, month, day, hour, minute), and press to set ••To cancel → Press [  : Home time : Destination time  ] button. To set the display order or time display format ••Select [Style] and press [MENU/SET] to display the setting screen for display order and time display format. Style Display order Time display format 6 Press [MENU/SET] 7 When [Please set the home area] is displayed, press [MENU/SET] 29 ••A confirmation screen is displayed. Press [MENU/SET]. SQW0024 Preparations Setting the clock 8 Press to set your home area and press [MENU/SET] City or area name Current time Difference from GMT (Greenwich Mean Time) ●●If the clock is not set, the correct date cannot be printed when you order a photo studio to print the picture, or when you stamp the date on the pictures with [Text Stamp]. Changing time settings Select [Clock Set] from the [Setup] menu to change the current time settings. ••Clock settings will be saved for approx. 3 months even after the battery is removed, provided a fully charged battery was installed in the camera for 24 hours beforehand. 1 Select [Clock Set] from the [Setup] menu 2 30 •• For details about how to set the menu (→31) Set the date and time (Perform steps 5 - 6. (→29)) SQW0024 Preparations Setting the menu You can use the menu to set camera and recording functions, operate playback functions, and perform other operations. In particular, the [Setup] menu contains some important settings relating to the camera’s clock and power. Check the settings of this menu before proceeding to use the camera. ●●When [Menu Resume] (→49) in the [Setup] menu is set to [ON], the screen displayed last after you selected the menu item will reappear. It is set to [ON] at the time of purchase. ●●When the [Menu Information] (→49) in the [Setup] menu is set to [ON], descriptions of the menu items and settings will appear on the menu screen. Example: To change the [Quality] setting from [   ] to [   ] in the [Rec] menu In this Operating Instructions, steps for setting a menu item are described as follows: → [Rec] → [Quality] → [   ] 1 31 Press [MENU/SET] to bring up the menu [Rec] (→303 -) You can perform settings for picture size and the flash. [Motion Picture] (→305) You can select the recording format and picture quality and other settings. [Custom] (→306 -) Operation of the unit, such as displaying of the screen and button operations, can be set up according to your preferences. Also, it is possible to register the modified settings. [Setup] (→308) You can perform settings that make usage more convenient, such as the changing the clock settings and beep volume. You can also perform Wi-Fi function-related settings. [Playback] (→309) You can specify picture protection, cropping, print settings, and other settings for pictures you have taken. SQW0024 Preparations Setting the menu 2 Press to select the menu item and press [MENU/SET] Page ••Items can also be selected by turning the control dial. ••You can also switch to the next page by pressing [DISP.] button or rotating the zoom lever. Item 3 Press to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] Selected setting ••Items can also be selected by turning the control dial. Settings 4 Press the [   ] button repeatedly until the recording or playback screen reappears ••During recording, the menu screen can also be exited by pressing the shutter button halfway. 32 SQW0024 Preparations Setting the menu Switching menu type Example: Switching to the [Setup] menu from [Rec] menu 1 2 3 Press Press to select a menu switch icon [   ] •• Items can also be selected by turning the control dial. Press [MENU/SET] •• Select the menu item and perform the setting. Menu type ●●The menu types and items that are displayed vary according to the mode. ●●The setting methods vary depending on the menu item. Setting the menu screen background You can set the background for the menu screen according to your preferences. 1 Set the menu → 2 33 Press [Setup] → [Menu Background] to select the background colour and then press [MENU/SET] •• Exit the menu after it is set. SQW0024 Preparations Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu) You can easily call some of the menu items and set them. ••The menu items and setting items that are displayed differ depending on the recording mode and settings during recording. 1 Press [Q.MENU] button to display the Quick menu 2 Turn the control dial to select the menu item, and press or ••The menu item can also be selected by pressing 50i . 3 Turn the control dial to select the setting 4 Press [Q.MENU] button to close the Quick menu ••The setting can also be selected with . 50i Switching the method for setting Quick Menu items → [Custom] → [Q.MENU] [PRESET]: The default items can be set. [CUSTOM]: The Quick Menu will consist of desired items. (→35) Using the Quick menu on the monitor recording information screen (→62) of [   ] (monitor style) (Press the [DISP.] button repeatedly until the screen appears.) Press the [Q.MENU] button and turn the control dial to select an item, and press [MENU/SET]. Turn the control dial to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] to set. and [MENU/SET]. •• You can also set with 34 SQW0024 Preparations Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu) Change the Quick Menu to your preferred item When [Q.MENU] (→34) in the [Custom] menu is set to [CUSTOM], the Quick Menu can be changed as desired. Up to 15 items can be set to the Quick Menu. 1 Press to select [   ] and press [MENU/SET] 2 3 Press to select the menu item in the top row and press [MENU/SET] Press to select the empty space in the bottom row and then press [MENU/SET] Items that can be setup as Quick Menus •• If there is no empty space in the bottom row, you can replace an existing item with a new select item by selecting the existing item. •• To cancel the setting, move to the bottom row by pressing and select an item to cancel, and then press [MENU/SET]. •• Items that can be set are as follows: Items that can be displayed in the Quick Menu screen [Rec] menu/Recording functions •• [Photo Style] (→100) •• [Picture Size] (→108) •• [Quality] (→109) •• [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) •• [Metering Mode] (→139) •• [i.Dynamic] (→111) •• [i.Resolution] (→111) •• [HDR] (→112) •• [Shutter Type] (→140) •• [Flash Mode] (→180) •• [Flash Adjust.] (→183) •• [i.Zoom] (→172) •• [Digital Zoom] (→173) •• [Stabilizer] (→168) •• [Sensitivity] (→136) •• [White Balance] (→103) •• [AF Mode] (→115) •• [Drive Mode] (→141) [Motion Picture] menu •• [4K PHOTO] (→195) •• [Motion Pic. Set] (→187) 35 •• [Picture Mode] (→198) SQW0024 Preparations Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu) [Custom] menu •• [Silent Mode] (→161) •• [Peaking] (→130) •• [Histogram] (→64) •• [Guide Line] (→65) 4 36 Press [  •• [Zebra Pattern] (→166) •• [Monochrome Live View] (→167) •• [Rec Area] (→192) •• [Zoom lever] (→175)  ] button •• It will return to screen of step 1 (→35). Press [MENU/SET] to switch to the recording screen. SQW0024 Preparations Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons) You can assign frequently-used functions to particular buttons. 1 Set the menu → 2 3 [Custom] → [Fn Button Set] Press to select the function button you want to assign a function to and press [MENU/SET] Press to select the function you want to assign and press [MENU/SET] •• For details on the functions that can be assigned, refer to (→38). •• To restore the default function button settings, select [Restore to Default]. 37 SQW0024 Preparations Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons) Assigning a function to a function button Press the function button to use the assigned function. ••You can assign the following functions to the [Fn1], [Fn2], and [Fn3] buttons. •• [Wi-Fi] (→225): [Fn2]* •• [LVF/Monitor Switch] (→55): [Fn3]* •• [AF/AE Lock] (→133) •• [AF-ON] (→129, 133) •• [Preview] (→88): [Fn1]* •• [Level Gauge] (→66) •• [Focus Area Set] •• [Cursor Button Lock] •• [Photo Style] (→100) [Rec] menu/Recording functions •• [Picture Size] (→108) •• [Quality] (→109) •• [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) •• [Metering Mode] (→139) •• [Highlight Shadow] (→102) •• [i.Dynamic] (→111) •• [i.Resolution] (→111) •• [HDR] (→112) •• [Shutter Type] (→140) •• [Flash Mode] (→180) •• [Flash Adjust.] (→183) •• [i.Zoom] (→172) •• [Digital Zoom] (→173) •• [Stabilizer] (→168) •• [Sensitivity] (→136) •• [White Balance] (→103) •• [AF Mode/MF] (→115) •• [Drive Mode] (→141) •• [Restore to Default] [Motion Picture] menu •• [4K PHOTO] (→195) •• [Motion Pic. Set] (→187) •• [Picture Mode] (→198) [Custom] menu •• [Utilize Custom Set feature] (→60) •• [Silent Mode] (→161) •• [Peaking] (→130) •• [Histogram] (→64) •• [Guide Line] (→65) •• [Zebra Pattern] (→166) •• [Monochrome Live View] (→167) •• [Rec Area] (→192) •• [Zoom lever] (→175) * Function button settings at the time of purchase. ••Certain functions cannot be assigned to some function buttons. ●●The function assigned to the function button may not work in some modes or on some display screens. ●●When [Focus Area Set] is assigned to the function button, you can display the AF area or the MF Assist position setting screen. ●●When the cursor button is locked, operation of the cursor button, [MENU/SET] button, and control dial is disabled. To enable operation, press the function button again. Not available in the following cases: ●●The function assigned to the [Fn1] button will not work in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect], [One Point Color], [Sunshine]) •• When [Multi Exp.] is set ●●The function assigned to the [Fn2] button will not work in the following case: •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When recording 4K motion pictures after setting [4K PHOTO] to [ON] 38 SQW0024 Preparations Changing settings using the control ring The “Control Ring” is an easy and convenient way to adjust several settings, depending on the camera mode selected. You can use the control ring to change the settings of the unit. Items that can be set by the control ring vary depending on recording modes. Following are the pre-assigned settings. Recording mode Setting [Intelligent Auto] Mode Step Zoom (→174) [Program AE] Mode Step Zoom (→174) [Aperture-Priority] Mode Step Zoom (→174) [Shutter-Priority] Mode Shutter speed adjustment* (→84) [Manual Exposure] Mode Shutter speed adjustment* (→86) * You can use the control ring to change the following settings values, which cannot be set using the shutter speed dial. –– Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds (electronic shutter (→140)) –– Slower speed than 1 second (mechanical shutter (→140)) –– Setting in 1/3 EV steps ●●The control ring is assigned to selecting the picture effect (Filter) when you are recording a panorama picture. (→150) ●●When Manual Focus is set, focus adjustment is assigned to the control ring. (→128) ●●The control ring can be used to change to your preferred settings. (→40) 39 SQW0024 Preparations Changing settings using the control ring Changing the settings assigned to the control ring Changes the settings assigned to the control ring. 1 Set the menu → 2 Use [Custom] → [Control Ring] to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] Settings that can be assigned [DEFLT] [Normal] [Zoom] (→170) •• To return to the default setting, select [Normal]. (→39) •• If you do not use the control ring, select [OFF] ([Not Set]). [Step Zoom] (→174) [Sensitivity] (→136) [White Balance] (→103) [Filter Select] (→89) [OFF] [Not Set] ●●The assigned function setting applies to all the Recording Modes. The function assigned to the control ring may not work in some combinations of Recording Mode or settings used for recording (panorama picture recording, Filter setting, etc.) ●●When Manual Focus is set, the control ring is fixed to the function for adjusting the focus. You cannot use the settings assigned using the [Control Ring]. (→128) 40 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu [Clock Set] and [Sleep Mode] are important for clock setting and battery life. Please check these before use. For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Clock Set] Set time, date, and display format. (→30) [World Time] Set the recording date and time with the local time at your destination. ••Set [Home] when you use the camera for the first time after purchasing it. You can set [Destination] after setting [Home]. Settings: [Destination] / [Home] 1 2 Use to select [Destination] or [Home] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select area and press [MENU/SET] Current time at selected destination City/area name Difference with home time When [Destination] has been selected When [Home] has been selected ■■To set summer time Press in step 2. (Press again to release the setting) •• When summer time [   ] is set, the current time is advanced by 1 hour. If the setting is cancelled, the time automatically returns to the current time. ■■When you come back from your travel destination Select [Home] in step 1 and press [MENU/SET]. ●●If you cannot find your destination in the area displayed on the screen, set based on difference with home time. 41 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Travel Date] If you set your travel schedule and record pictures, the day of your trip on which the picture was taken will be recorded. ■■[Travel Setup] Settings: [SET] / [OFF] 1 2 3 4 Use to select [Travel Setup] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the departure date and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the return date and press [MENU/SET] ■■To record [Location] Once the [Travel Setup] is set, you can set the location. Select [Location] in step 1 above, and press [MENU/SET] Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET] Enter your location (Entering text (→52)) ●●To print [Location] or the number of days that have passed, either use [Text Stamp] or print using the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the supplied DVD. ●●The travel date is calculated from the set departure date and the date set in the camera’s clock. When destination is set in [World Time], days elapsed are calculated based on local destination time. ●●When [Travel Setup] is set to [OFF], the number of days elapsed is not recorded. It is not displayed even if [Travel Setup] is set to [SET] after recording. ●●When the current date passes the return date, [Travel Setup] is automatically cancelled. ●●[Travel Date] cannot be recorded for AVCHD motion pictures. ●●[Location] is not recorded when you record motion pictures. [Wi-Fi] Settings: [Wi-Fi Function] / [Wi-Fi Setup] Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function. (→227, 272) 42 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Beep] Sets the beep sounds or shutter sounds. ■■[Beep Volume] Settings: (High) / (Low) / (Off) Settings: (High) / (Low) / (Off) Settings: / ■■[Shutter Vol.] ■■[Shutter Tone] / ●●When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], [Beep Volume] and [Shutter Vol.] are set to “Off”. [Live View Mode] Sets the display speed and picture quality of the screen (Live View screen) when recording pictures. Settings [30fps] [60fps] Picture quality has higher priority over display speed and pictures are displayed at 30 fps. For example, use when you want to record a comparatively slow-moving subject while confirming the focusing. Minimises power consumption and the operating time is extended. Display speed has higher priority over picture quality and pictures are displayed at 60 fps. The displayed pictures will appear slightly grainy. For example, use when you want to record a fast-moving subject. ●●The [Live View Mode] setting does not affect the recorded picture. ●●The display speed may slow down in dark locations. ●●When the viewfinder is used, [Live View Mode] is fixed to [60fps]. ●●When the AC adaptor (optional) is used, [Live View Mode] is fixed to [60fps]. 43 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Monitor Display] / [Viewfinder] Adjust brightness and colour of the monitor or viewfinder. It is suggested to use the default settings. These are intended to provide a preview of the actual picture, as accurately as possible. Settings Adjusts the brightness. [Brightness] Adjusts the contrast. [Contrast] Adjusts the vividness of colours. [Saturation] Adjusts red hues. [Red Tint] Adjusts blue hues. [Blue Tint] 1 Press 2 Press [MENU/SET] to select the setting item and press •• You can also make adjustments with the control dial. to make adjustments ●●It will adjust the monitor when the monitor is in use, and the viewfinder when the viewfinder is in use. ●●Some subjects may look different from their actual appearance, but the recorded picture will not be affected. 44 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Monitor Luminance] Sets the monitor brightness according to the ambient light level. Settings The brightness is adjusted automatically depending on how bright it is around the camera. The brightness is increased. The brightness is standard. The brightness is decreased. ●●Because the picture shown on the monitor screen emphasises brightness, some subjects may look different than their actual appearance, but this will not affect the recorded picture.  ] returns to ordinary brightness if there is no operation for 30 seconds when recording. (Press any button to make the screen brighter again.) ●●Setting [   ] or [   ] reduces the operating time. ●●Cannot select [   ] during playback. ●●When the AC adaptor (optional) is used, the initial setting is [   ]. ●●[  45 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Sleep Mode] The camera automatically turns off if no operation is performed for a preset period of time. ••To restore → Press the shutter button halfway, or turn on the power again. Settings: [10MIN.] / [5MIN.] / [2MIN.] / [1MIN.] / [OFF] Not available in the following cases: •• During motion picture recording/playback •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When connected to computer/printer •• During Slide Shows •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) •• When using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) 46 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [USB Mode] Select communication method for when connecting camera to a computer or printer with USB connection cable (supplied). Settings [Select on connection] [PictBridge(PTP)] Select communication method each time you connect to a computer or PictBridge-compatible printer. Select when connecting to a PictBridge-compatible printer. Select when connecting to a computer. [PC] [TV Connection] Change the settings to be used when the camera is connected to a TV or other device. ■■[Video Out] This setting performs when the AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable is connected. Settings [NTSC] Video output is set to NTSC system. [PAL] Video output is set to PAL system. ■■[TV Aspect] This setting performs when an AV cable (optional) is connected. Settings: [16:9] / [4:3] 47 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [TV Connection] (continued) ■■[HDMI Mode] Set the format for the HDMI output when playing back on the HDMI compatible highdefinition TV connected with this unit using the HDMI micro cable. Settings [AUTO] Automatically sets the output resolution based on information from a connected TV. [4K] Outputs pictures with a resolution of 3840×2160 pixels using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (2,160 lines). [1080p] Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (1,080 lines). [1080i] Outputs pictures using an interlace scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (1,080 lines). [720p] Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (720 lines). [576p]*1/[480p]*2 Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning lines (576*1/480*2 lines). *1 When [Video Out] is set to [PAL] *2 When [Video Out] is set to [NTSC] ●●This will work when the HDMI micro cable is connected. ●●If no image appears on the TV with [AUTO], switch the setting to a constant setting other than [AUTO] to set a format supported by your TV. (Please read the operating instructions for the TV.) 48 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [TV Connection] (continued) ■■[VIERA Link] Enable automatic linking with other VIERA Link-compatible devices, and operability with a VIERA remote control when connecting via an HDMI micro cable. (→278) Settings [ON] Operations may be performed via the remote control of the VIERA Link-compatible device. •• Not all operations will be available. •• Operability of the camera’s own buttons will be limited. [OFF] Operations must be performed via the camera’s own buttons. ●●This will work when the HDMI micro cable is connected. [Menu Resume] Save the last operated menu position. Settings: [ON] / [OFF] [Menu Background] Set the background colour for the menu screen. (→33) [Menu Information] Explanations of the menu items and settings are displayed on the menu screen. Settings: [ON] / [OFF] [Language] Change display language. Set the language displayed on the screen. 49 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Version Disp.] Check the firmware version of the camera or supplied flash (when the flash is attached). ●●When you press [MENU/SET] while the version is displayed, software information for this unit, such as the licence, is displayed. [Self Timer Auto Off] The self-timer is cancelled if the unit is turned off. Settings: [ON] / [OFF] [No.Reset] Reset picture file numbers. (The folder number is updated and the file number starts from 0001.) ••To reset folder number to 100: First, format the card, and reset the file numbers using [No.Reset]. Then, select [Yes] on the folder number reset screen. ●●A folder number between 100 and 999 can be assigned. Numbers cannot be reset once folder number reaches 999. In this case, save all necessary pictures to your computer, and format the card (→26). [Reset] Reset to the default settings. ■■[Reset Rec. settings?] ■■[Reset setup/custom settings?] ●●Information registered in [Face Recog.] is reset if recording settings are reset. ●●When the setup/custom settings are reset, the following settings are also reset: •• The [Profile Setup] setting •• The settings of [Rotate Disp.], [Picture Sort], [Delete Confirmation] in the [Playback] menu ●●Folder numbers and clock settings will not be reset. 50 SQW0024 Preparations Using the [Setup] menu For details on how to select the [Setup] menu settings, refer to (→31) [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] Returns [Wi-Fi] settings to default settings. ●●If you want to dispose or give away your camera, always reset it to prevent your personal information from being mistakenly used. ●●When you request your camera to be fixed, backup your personal information and always reset it as well. [Format] Format (initialise) a memory card. (→26) 51 SQW0024 Preparations Entering Text Use the cursor button to enter names with the Face Recognition function and in [Profile Setup] (babies and pets), or to register locations in [Travel Date] etc. ••Only alphabetical characters and symbols can be entered. ••Example of operation for displaying a screen: → [Rec] → [Profile Setup] → [SET] → [Baby1] → [Name] → [SET] 1 2 Use to select characters Press [MENU/SET] several times until the desired character is displayed Cursor position Text is inserted at the cursor position. ••[   ]: Enter a blank. ■■To change the character type ••Press [DISP.] button ••Use to select [   ] and press [MENU/SET] ■■To continue entering characters ••Use to select [   ] and press [MENU/SET] ••Move the zoom lever toward T side ••Turn the control dial to the right ■■Editing text Use to select [   ] [   ] and press [MENU/SET]. Then, move the cursor to the text to edit ••You can also use the zoom lever or control dial to reposition the cursor. Use to select [Delete] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the correct text, and then press [MENU/SET] 3 When you are finished entering text, use [Set] and press [MENU/SET] to select ●●A maximum of 30 characters can be entered (maximum of 9 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.]). ●●A maximum of 15 characters can be entered for [   ], [   ], [   ], [   ] and [   ] (maximum of 6 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.]). 52 SQW0024 Basics Holding the camera ••To avoid camera shake, hold it with both hands keeping your arms close to your body while standing with your feet slightly apart. ••Do not touch the lens. ••Do not block the microphone when recording motion pictures. ••Do not block the AF Assist Lamp, or the flash when you take a picture using it. Do not look at it from close range. ••Make sure that the camera does not move at the moment the shutter button is pressed. AF Assist Lamp Microphone Shoulder strap ••We recommend using the supplied shoulder strap to avoid dropping the camera. About the direction detect function Still pictures recorded with the camera held vertically can be automatically displayed in portrait orientation during playback. (Only when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [ON].) ••The direction detect function may not operate correctly if pictures are taken with the camera pointing up or down. ••Motion pictures cannot be displayed in portrait orientation. 53 SQW0024 Basics Recording pictures using the viewfinder When you use the viewfinder, you can check the view of the subject even if you are in a bright area. Switching between the monitor and viewfinder You can operate the [LVF]/[Fn3] button in two ways, using it either as the [LVF] button or as a function button [Fn3]. You can use this button as the [LVF] button at the time of purchase. ••For details on the function button, refer to (→37). [LVF] button Eye Sensor 1 Press [LVF] button •• The display is switched as shown below. Automatic switching between viewfinder and monitor Viewfinder display Monitor display Automatic switching between viewfinder and monitor For automatic switching between the viewfinder and monitor, the eye sensor automatically switches the display to viewfinder when your eye or an object moves close to the viewfinder. ••The eye sensor may not work correctly depending on the shape of your eyeglasses, the way you hold the camera, or whether the eyepiece and nearby area are exposed to strong light. In this case, press the [LVF] button to switch the display. ••During motion picture playback or Slide Show, the eye sensor will not automatically switch the display to the viewfinder. ••The sensitivity of the eye sensor can be set using [Eye Sensor] in the [Custom] menu. (→55) 54 SQW0024 Basics Recording pictures using the viewfinder Setting the sensitivity of the eye sensor or setting to switch the display between the viewfinder and monitor → [Custom] → [Eye Sensor] [Sensitivity] Use this setting to set the sensitivity of the eye sensor. [HIGH] / [LOW] [LVF/Monitor Switch] Use this setting to switch the display between the viewfinder and monitor. [LVF/MON AUTO] (Automatic switching between viewfinder and monitor ) / [LVF] (Viewfinder display) / [MON] (Monitor display) •• After the display is switched using the [LVF] button, the setting of [LVF/ Monitor Switch] will also change. About diopter adjustment Adjust the diopter to suit your vision so that you can see the viewfinder clearly. Turn the diopter adjustment dial to adjust until you are able to clearly see the characters displayed in the viewfinder. Diopter adjustment dial About Eye Sensor AF If the eye sensor is activated when [Eye Sensor AF] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the camera automatically adjusts the focus. ••Eye Sensor AF adjusts focus only once when you look into the viewfinder. It does not continuously adjust the focus while you are looking into the viewfinder. ●●Even when [Eye Sensor AF] is set and the camera automatically adjusts the focus, a beep will not sound. Not available in the following case: ●●[Eye Sensor AF] may not work when the lighting is low. 55 SQW0024 Basics Taking pictures ••Press the [  1 2  ] button (   ) to set the drive mode to [   ] ([Single]). Select the recording mode (→59) Adjust focus according to subject Focus display (When focus is aligned: illuminated When focus is not aligned: flashing) Press halfway (press lightly to focus) 3 ••The aperture value and shutter speed are displayed. (If the aperture value and shutter speed are shown in red and flashing, you do not have the appropriate exposure, unless you are using the flash.) ••When you take a picture in a dark location, [   ] is displayed for the focus display and it may take longer Aperture value to adjust focus than usual. Shutter speed ••When [AFS/AFF/AFC] in the [Rec] menu is set to [AFF] or [AFC] AF area (When focus is aligned: –– A beep sounds only the first time the camera is green) focused while you press the shutter button halfway. –– When Auto Focus mode is set to Custom Multi, such as [   ] and [   ], the AF area will be momentarily displayed only for the first time when the camera is focused while you press the shutter button halfway. Take a picture Press fully (press the button all the way to record) ●●The focus display flashes and beep sounds when focus is not aligned. Use the focus range displayed in red as a reference. Even if the focus display is lit, the camera may be unable to bring the subject into focus if it is out of range. ●●The AF area display may be larger depending on recording conditions such as dark locations or zoom ratio. ●●The quality of the picture display may be lower during Auto Focus. Focus display Focus range 56 SQW0024 Basics Taking pictures ●●Subjects/environments which may make focusing difficult: ••Fast-moving or extremely bright objects, or objects with no colour contrast. ••Taking pictures through glass or near objects emitting light. ••In the dark, or with significant jitter. ••When too close to object or when taking pictures of both distant and close objects together in the same picture. Displaying still pictures immediately after taking them → [Custom] → [Auto Review] [Duration Time] Set the time to display the pictures you have taken after taking still pictures. [HOLD]: Displaying pictures until you press the shutter button halfway [5SEC] / [4SEC] / [3SEC] / [2SEC] / [1SEC] / [OFF] [Playback Operation Priority] [ON]: During [Auto Review], you can switch the playback screen or delete pictures. [OFF]: During [Auto Review], you can perform the same button operations as when you take a picture. ••When [Duration Time] is set to [HOLD], [Playback Operation Priority] is fixed to [ON]. 57 SQW0024 Basics Recording motion pictures You can record full high-definition quality images that comply with the AVCHD standard, as well as motion pictures recorded in MP4. You can also record a 4K motion picture in MP4. (→194) Audio is recorded in stereo. 1 Press the motion picture button to start recording ••Immediately release the motion picture button after pressing it. ••You can record motion pictures fitting each Recording Mode (→59). ••While you are recording motion pictures, the recording status indicator (red) will flash. ••If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button. ••Do not block the microphones when recording motion pictures. ••You can also use zoom while recording motion pictures. –– The operating sounds of the zoom lever or control ring may be recorded in some cases. ••Still pictures can be taken during motion picture recording. (→198) 2 Recording state indicator Elapsed recording time Remaining recording time (approx.) Press the motion picture button again to end recording ●●For details, read “Recording motion pictures”. (→187) 58 SQW0024 Basics Select the recording mode To select the recording mode using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial 1 Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial •• Slowly turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial until they click to properly align the position. You can set the aperture ring to [A] (AUTO) or to values between [1.7] and [16]. To select [Intelligent Auto] Mode 1 Press [iA] button •• [Intelligent Auto] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes to [   ]. When you press the [iA] button again, the recording mode is switched to one that enables settings to be made using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial. •• When [Intelligent Auto] Mode is selected, the recording mode that was set using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial is cancelled. [Intelligent Auto] Mode (→75) Take pictures with automatic settings. [Program AE] Mode (→81) Record pictures with the aperture value and shutter speed settings automatically adjusted. [Aperture-Priority] Mode (→83) Determine aperture, then record pictures. [Shutter-Priority] Mode (→84) Determine shutter speed, then record pictures. [Manual Exposure] Mode (→86) Determine the aperture value and shutter speed respectively, and then record pictures. 59 SQW0024 Basics Select the recording mode Registering a combination of settings to be used during recording (Custom Set) You can register up to three combinations of your preferred menu settings. Selecting [Utilize Custom Set feature] from the [Custom] menu enables you to switch quickly to the settings you selected for the custom settings. ■■Registering the custom set Set your preferred menu settings such as [Rec] menu, [Motion Picture] menu, and [Custom] menu Set the menu → [Custom] → [Cust.Set Mem.] Use to select custom set (C1-C3) for registration and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ●●The following menu items are not registered as custom settings. [Rec] menu [Setup] menu [Playback] menu •• Data registered with [Face •• All menus •• [Rotate Disp.] Recog.] •• [Picture Sort] •• The [Profile Setup] setting •• [Delete Confirmation] ■■Using the custom set Set the menu → [Custom] → [Utilize Custom Set feature] Use to select custom set Press [MENU/SET] 50i •• The settings are switched to those settings you selected for the custom set. Using the function button to call up the custom settings Setting the function button to [Utilize Custom Set feature] allows you to switch quickly to your preferred settings by pressing the function button. Assign [Utilize Custom Set feature] to your preferred function button using [Fn Button Set] in the [Custom] menu. (→37) Press the function button to which [Utilize Custom Set feature] is assigned. Use to select custom set and press [MENU/SET] 60 SQW0024 Basics Select the recording mode When changing the menu settings Even if the menu settings are changed temporarily while any one of the custom settings is selected, the currently registered settings will remain unchanged. To change the currently registered settings, overwrite the registered data using [Cust.Set Mem.] on the [Custom] menu. Not available in the following case: •• In the [Intelligent Auto] Mode 61 SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the recording screen You can also turn off the recording information (such as icons for various settings) and the level gauge (→66). 1 Press [DISP.] button to switch the display ••You can use [Monitor Disp. Style] and [LVF Disp.Style] in the [Custom] menu to select either [   ] (Monitor style display layout) or [   ] (Live View Finder style display layout) for the display screen of the monitor and viewfinder. ■■[   ] Monitor style display layout ••The display is switched as shown below. (Example of monitor style display) With information*1 Without information With information*1 50i Without information + level gauge + level gauge 50i Turned off Monitor recording information screen*2 *1 When [Histogram] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], a histogram is displayed. (→64) When [Expo.Meter] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the exposure meter is displayed. (→81) *2 This screen is displayed only when [Monitor Info. Disp.] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON]. (→65) While you are checking the recording information on the monitor, you can use the viewfinder to record pictures. 62 SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the recording screen ■■[   ] Live View Finder style display layout ••The display is switched as shown below. (Example of viewfinder style display) With information (Detailed information)* With information With information (Detailed information)* + level gauge 50i With information + level gauge 50i * When [Histogram] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], a histogram is displayed. (→64) When [Expo.Meter] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the exposure meter is displayed. (→81) ●●If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button. Switching the monitor display method [  [  → [Custom] → [Monitor Disp. Style]  ]: Live View Finder style display layout  ]: Monitor style display layout Switching the viewfinder display method [  [  63 → [Custom] → [LVF Disp.Style]  ]: Live View Finder style display layout  ]: Monitor style display layout SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the recording screen Enabling/disabling the histogram display → Use [Custom] → [Histogram] → [ON] / [OFF] to set the position. Displays distribution of brightness in picture – e.g. if the graph peaks at the right, this means there are several bright areas in the picture. A peak in the centre represents correct brightness (correct exposure). This can be used as a reference for exposure correction, etc. (Example) Dark ← OK → Bright ●●When the histogram is not the same as that of the recorded picture under the following conditions, histogram will be displayed in orange: •• When manual exposure assist indicates settings other than 0 EV in [Manual Exposure] Mode or during Exposure Compensation. •• When the flash fires. •• When the correct exposure is not achieved or when the brightness of the screen cannot be displayed accurately in a dark location. ●●The histogram displayed during recording is only a reference. ●●The histogram is different from those displayed using the image editing software of a computer. 64 SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the recording screen Enabling/disabling the guideline display → [Custom] → [Guide Line] → [   ] / [   ] / [   ] / [OFF] ••The guideline is not displayed during panorama picture recording. When you select [   ], you can use to set the position. Turning on/off the recording information screen of the monitor → 65 [Custom] → [Monitor Info. Disp.] → [ON] / [OFF] SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the recording screen Using the level gauge If you want to make sure that the camera is not slanted or tilted, for example, when you take a picture of a landscape, use the level gauge indication as a reference. 1 Press [DISP.] button to switch the display 2 Press the button to switch the display. Press the button until the level gauge is displayed. Correct camera angle ■■Using the level gauge The yellow line indicates the current angle. Correct the angle of the camera so that it matches the white line. Tilting up or down Tilting left or right •• In this case, it is facing upward. •• In this case, the right side has dropped. ••When the camera is tilted very little or not at all, the level gauge will turn green. ••When pictures are taken in portrait orientation, the level gauge is automatically switched to one for portrait orientation. ●●Even when angle is more or less corrected, there may be an error of about ±1 degree. ●●When [Level Gauge] is assigned to a function button, you can turn the level gauge on and off every time you press the function button. Not available in the following cases: ●●When the camera is being moved, the level gauge may not be displayed correctly. ●●The level gauge may not be displayed correctly or the direction detect function (→53) may not operate correctly if the pictures are taken with the camera pointing sharply up or down. 66 SQW0024 Basics Viewing your pictures 1 Press the Playback button 2 Press or turn the control dial to select the picture to be displayed ••When you press and hold , the pictures are displayed one after another. ••The playback speed of pictures varies depending on the playback conditions. ■■Ending Playback Press the Playback button again or press the Motion picture button. The Playback can also be ended by pressing the shutter button halfway. ●●When the camera is switched to the playback screen, the lens barrel is retracted after approx. 15 seconds. Not available in the following cases: ●●This camera is compliant with the unified DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) standard formulated by the Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association (JEITA), and with Exif (Exchangeable image file format). Files that are not DCF-compliant cannot be played back. ●●It may not be possible to properly play back pictures taken using other cameras on this unit or it may not be possible to use the functions of this unit for those pictures. Sending pictures to the WEB services If you press while a single picture is being displayed, you can send the picture to the WEB service quickly. (→254) 67 SQW0024 Basics Viewing your pictures Zooming in and viewing “Playback Zoom” 1 Move the zoom lever toward T side •• Each time you move the zoom lever toward the T side, the magnification increases through four levels: 2x, 4x, 8x, and 16x. (The picture quality displayed becomes successively lower.) •• To reduce zoom → Move the zoom lever toward W side. . •• Move zoom position → Press Current zoom position ●●Playback zoom cannot be used during motion picture playback, automatic scrolling playback of panorama pictures or continuous playback. Viewing a list of pictures “Multi Playback” 1 Move the zoom lever toward W side •• Move the zoom lever toward the W side and you can switch the display methods in the following order: 1-picture screen (fullscreen) → 12-picture screen → 30-picture screen → Calendar screen. (Move the lever to the T side to return.) •• When you select a picture using the cursor button and press [MENU/SET] on the 12-picture or 30-picture screen, the selected picture is displayed on the 1-picture screen (full-screen). •• Pictures can also be selected with the control dial. ●●Pictures displayed with [!] cannot be played back. 68 SQW0024 Basics Viewing your pictures Viewing pictures by their recording date “Calendar Playback” 1 Move the zoom lever toward the W side to display the calendar screen 2 Use to select recording date and press [MENU/SET] Selected date •• Pictures are displayed in a 12-picture screen. •• You can also select the date with the control dial. ●●You can display the calendar between January 2000 to December 2099. ●●Only months when pictures were taken are shown on the calendar screen. Pictures taken without clock settings are displayed with the date 1st January, 2014. ●●Pictures taken with destination settings made in [World Time] are displayed in the calendar screen using the appropriate date for the destination’s time zone. 69 SQW0024 Basics Viewing your pictures Viewing motion pictures This unit was designed to play motion pictures using the AVCHD and MP4 formats. 1 Select a picture with the motion picture icon ([   ]) in playback mode, and press to start playback •• After playback starts, the elapsed playback time is displayed on the screen. •• Some information will not be displayed for motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]. Motion picture recording time Example: 29 minutes and 30 seconds: [29m30s] Operations during motion picture playback : Pause/play : Stop : Fast rewind (2 steps*1)/Single-frame rewind*2 (while paused) : Fast forward (2 steps*1)/Single-frame forward (while paused) Control dial (counterclockwise): Volume down Control dial (clockwise): Volume up [MENU/SET]: Capturing still pictures from motion pictures (while paused) (→203) *1 The fast forward or rewind speed increases if you press again. *2 Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] are rewound frame by frame approximately every 0.5 seconds. ••If is pressed during fast forward or rewind, it will return to normal playback speed. ●●Motion pictures can be viewed on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the supplied DVD. ●●Motion pictures that were recorded by setting the picture effect (Filter) to [Miniature Effect] are played back at approximately 8x speed. 70 SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the playback screen You can disable the display of picture information (file number, etc.) and recording information (settings used for recording, etc.) when a picture is played back. 1 Press [DISP.] button to switch the display ••The display is switched as shown below. With information*1 Detailed information display*2 Histogram display*2 Without information*1,*2,*3 R G B 10:00 1.DEC.2014 100-0001 Y 1/98 100-0001 Without information *1 If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button. *2 During Playback Zoom, Motion Picture Playback, Automatic Scrolling Playback of panorama pictures, continuous playback or Slide Show: You can only turn the display on or off. *3 This screen is displayed only when [Highlight] (→72) in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON]. ●●A histogram of each colour, including R (red), G (green), B (blue), and Y (luminance), is separately displayed during playback. ●●During Multi Playback or calendar screen: Display cannot be changed. 71 SQW0024 Basics Switching the display information on the playback screen Enabling/disabling the overexposed area display → [Custom] → [Highlight] → [ON] / [OFF] You can set overexposed areas (areas that are too bright and where there are no shades of grey) to flash on the screen when the [Auto Review] function is activated or during playback. This does not affect recorded pictures. [ON] [OFF] ••To reduce overexposed areas, record a picture by setting negative exposure compensation (→135) using the histogram display (→64) and so on as a reference. (The right edge of the histogram shows the overexposed portion.) ••This feature is disabled during Multi Playback, Calendar Playback or Playback Zoom. 72 SQW0024 Basics Deleting pictures Deleted pictures cannot be recovered. Pictures will not be deleted in the following cases: ••Protected pictures. ••Card switch is in “LOCK” position. ••Pictures that are not based on the DCF standard. (→67) ●●Do not turn off the camera while deleting. ●●Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). [Delete Single] 1 Press [  2 Use  ] button to delete displayed picture to select [Delete Single] and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. Delete Single Delete Multi Delete All ●●You can set either [Yes] or [No] as the default setting on the deletion confirmation screen when you perform [Delete Confirmation] in the [Playback] menu. [No] is selected at the time of purchase. (→223) 73 SQW0024 Basics Deleting pictures To delete multiple (up to 100)/To delete all pictures A picture group (→201) is handled as 1 picture. (All the pictures in the selected picture group are deleted.) 1 Press [   ] button while viewing a picture 2 Use to select [Delete Multi]/[Delete All] and press [MENU/SET] Delete Single •• Items can also be selected by turning the control dial. •• When [Delete All] is selected → A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. •• You can select [All Delete Except Favorite] in [Delete All] if there are pictures that have been set as [Favorite] (→219). 3 (When [Delete Multi] is selected) Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] Delete Multi Delete All Picture selected •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. •• Pictures can also be selected with the control dial. OK 4 74 (When [Delete Multi] is selected) Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. •• May take time depending on number of pictures deleted. SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode Recording mode: This mode is recommended for those who want to point and shoot as the camera optimises settings to match the subject and recording environment. The camera optimises the settings and the following functions are activated automatically. ••Automatic Scene Detection / Backlight Compensation / [Face/Eye Detection] / Auto White Balance / Intelligent ISO sensitivity control / [Red-Eye Removal] / [i.Zoom] / [i.Resolution] / [Stabilizer] / [i.Dynamic] / [Long Shtr NR] / [Quick AF] / [AF Assist Lamp] 1 Press [iA] button 2 Point the camera at the subject The camera switches to [Intelligent Auto] Mode. ••When you press the [iA] button again, the recording mode is switched to one that is set using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial. ••When the camera identifies the optimal scene, the icon for each scene turns blue for 2 seconds and then changes to the normal red indication. ••When you press and press the shutter button halfway, AF Tracking is activated. For details (→117). 50i Changing the operation method of the [iA] button → [Custom] → [iA Button Switch] [Single Press]: When you press the [iA] button, the camera switches to [Intelligent Auto] Mode. [Press and hold]: If you press and hold the [iA] button, the camera switches to [Intelligent Auto] Mode. 75 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode Automatic Scene Detection When taking pictures [i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Macro] [i-Night Portrait]*1 [i-Night Scenery] [i-Handheld Night Shot]*2 [i-Food] [i-Baby]*3 [i-Sunset] When scene does not correspond to any of the above * the flash (supplied/optional) is used. *2 When [iHandheld Night Shot] is [ON]. (→78) 3 * When children (that are registered in the camera with Face Recognition) under 3 years old are 1 When recognised. When recording motion pictures [i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Low Light] [i-Macro] When scene does not correspond to any of the above ••In [   ], [   ], and [   ], the camera adjusts the focus on the eye that is closest to this unit and matches the exposure with the face. In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the eye to be focused on cannot be changed. ([Face/Eye Detection]) ••When the camera identifies [   ] as the optimal scene and if the camera determines that jitter is reduced by the use of a tripod or by other means, a shutter speed that is slower than usual is selected. After pressing the shutter button, do not move the camera while recording. ••Automatic Scene Detection does not function until the focus is locked on a subject during AF Tracking. ••When [Face Recog.] is set to [ON] and if the camera recognises a face similar to a registered face, [R] is displayed on the upper right corner of the [   ], [   ], and [   ] icons. ●●Depending on recording conditions, different scene types may be determined for the same subject. About Backlight Compensation Backlight compensation is automatically activated in [Intelligent Auto] Mode. Backlight is a condition where a light shines from behind a subject. When there is a backlight, the subject appears darker and the camera will automatically attempt to correct it by increasing the brightness of the picture. 76 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode Using the flash (supplied/optional) 1 2 3 4 Turn off the camera Remove the hot shoe cover Attach the flash Turn on the camera and the flash For details (→176, 291). ■■Flash When the [ON/OFF] switch for the flash (supplied/optional) is set to [OFF], the flash is set to [   ] (Forced Flash Off). When the [ON/OFF] switch is set to [ON], the flash is set to [   ] (AUTO). When the flash is turned on, the camera automatically sets [   ], [   ] (Auto/Red-Eye Reduction), [   ], or [   ] based on the type of subject and brightness. ●●When [   ] or [   ] is displayed, the [Red-Eye Removal] function is activated to automatically detect red-eye and correct the picture data. ●●When [   ] or [   ] is selected, the shutter speed is reduced. Available menus You can set only the following menus. Menu Item [Rec] [Picture Size] / [Quality] / [AFS/AFF/AFC] / [Burst Rate] / [Self Timer] / [iHandheld Night Shot] / [iHDR] / [Time Lapse Shot] / [Stop Motion Animation] / [Face Recog.] [Motion Picture] [Rec Format] / [Rec Quality] / [AFS/AFF/AFC] [Custom] [Silent Mode] / [Guide Line] / [Remaining Disp.] [Setup] All menu items can be set. (→41) 77 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode Taking pictures using a handheld camera ([iHandheld Night Shot]) If a night scene is detected automatically while the unit is being handheld, [iHandheld Night Shot] can record a still picture with less jitter and less noise without using a tripod by combining a burst of pictures. → [Rec] → [iHandheld Night Shot] → [ON] / [OFF] ●●The angle of view becomes narrow slightly. ●●A message indicating that multiple pictures are to be recorded appears on the screen. After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.  ] will not be identified. ●●When the camera is fixed in place on a tripod or by other means, [  ●●The flash is fixed to the [   ] (Forced Flash Off) setting. Not available in the following cases: ●●This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded. ●●[iHandheld Night Shot] cannot be used in the following cases: •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) 78 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures with automatic settings [Intelligent Auto] Mode Combining pictures into a single still picture with rich gradation ([iHDR]) When there is, for example, strong contrast between the background and the subject, [iHDR] records multiple still pictures with differing exposures and combines them to create a single still picture rich in gradation. [iHDR] is activated when required. When activated, [   ] will be displayed on the screen. → [Rec] → [iHDR] → [ON] / [OFF] ●●The angle of view becomes narrow slightly. ●●A message indicating that multiple pictures are to be recorded appears on the screen. After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation. ●●Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few moments before you can record another picture. ●●In the case of composition from a burst, afterimages may appear if the subject was moving. Not available in the following cases: ●●This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded. ●●[iHDR] cannot be used in the following cases: •• When the flash is used •• When using [Burst] •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) 79 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Recording mode: You can set the exposure using the aperture ring and shutter speed dial settings. Using the [Rec] menu to change settings and set up your own recording environment. You can also record pictures by applying picture effects. (→89) 1 Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial to set your preferred recording mode. Align with the indicator Set the aperture ring where it clicks. Recording mode [Program AE] Mode (→81) [Aperture-Priority] Mode (→83) [Shutter-Priority] Mode (→84) [Manual Exposure] Mode (→86) Aperture ring Shutter speed dial [A] (AUTO) [A] (AUTO) Your preferred settings*1 [A] (AUTO) [A] (AUTO) Your preferred settings*2 Your preferred settings*1 Your preferred settings*2 ••In [Aperture-Priority] Mode, [Shutter-Priority] Mode, and [Manual Exposure] Mode, the effect of the aperture value and shutter speed you have set is not applied to the recording screen. To check the effect on the recording screen, use [Preview] Mode. (→88) The brightness of the screen may vary from the actual pictures recorded. Check the brightness of pictures using the playback screen. A faster shutter speed than the set shutter speed may be used when you record a motion picture. *1 You can set the aperture values between F1.7 and F16. You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom position. *2 You can set the shutter speed between 1 second and 1/4000 seconds. Turn the control ring or control dial to set the shutter speed in the following cases. •• Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second •• Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps 80 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Taking pictures after automatically setting the aperture value and shutter speed ([Program AE] Mode) Take pictures using automatic aperture values and shutter speed settings in accordance with the brightness of a subject. 1 Turn the aperture ring to select [A] (AUTO) 2 Turn the shutter speed dial to select [A] (AUTO) 3 Press the shutter button halfway 4 While the numeric values are displayed in yellow (approximately 10 seconds), turn the control dial to change the values using Programme Shift (→82) [Program AE] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes to [P]. •• If the aperture value and shutter speed flash red, you do not have the correct exposure. 0 250 125 2.0 60 2.8 30 4.0 15 5.6 Programme Shift indication •• To cancel Programme Shift, either turn off the camera or turn the control dial until the Programme Shift indication turns off. •• To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to adjust the compensation value. (→135) Enabling/disabling the exposure meter display → [Custom] → [Expo.Meter] → [ON] / [OFF] ●●When you set this function to [ON], an exposure meter is displayed during Programme Shift, aperture setting, and shutter speed operation. ●●Proper exposure is not possible in the range indicated in red. ●●If the exposure meter is not displayed, press the [DISP.] button to switch the display of the monitor. (→62) ●●The exposure meter will turn off if no operation is performed for approximately 4 seconds. 81 Exposure meter 0 250 125 2.0 60 2.8 30 4.0 15 5.6 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed About Programme Shift The function for maintaining the same exposure (brightness) while changing the shutter speed and aperture value combination is called “Programme Shift”. You can use “Programme Shift” to take pictures by adjusting the shutter speed and aperture value even in [Program AE] Mode. <Example of Programme Shift> 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 (EV) (Aperture value) 1.4 17 2.0 18 2.8 19 4.0 20 5.6 21 8.0 22 11 23 16 24 22 25 1 1/2 1/4 1/8 1/15 1/30 1/60 1/250 1/1000 1/4000 1/16000 (Shutter speed) 1/125 1/500 1/2000 1/8000 Programme Shift amount Programme Shift diagram Programme Shift limit ●●EV is an abbreviation of “Exposure Value”, a unit indicating the amount of exposure. The EV changes with the aperture value or the shutter speed. Not available in the following cases: ●●Programme Shift cannot be used in the following cases: •• During motion picture recording  ] •• When [Sensitivity] is set to [  82 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Taking pictures by setting the aperture value ([Aperture-Priority] Mode) When the aperture value is increased, the range of depth in focus expands, and the picture shows up clearly from the position of the camera to the background. When the aperture value is reduced, the range of depth in focus shrinks, and the background can get blurry. 1 Turn the shutter speed dial to select [A] (AUTO) 2 Turn the aperture ring to select the aperture value [Aperture-Priority] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes to [A]. •• To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to adjust the compensation value. (→135) Aperture values that can be set* F1.7 - F16 Shutter speed set (seconds) 60 - 1/4000 (When the mechanical shutter is used) 1 - 1/16000 (When the electronic shutter is used) * You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom 5 60 8.0 30 11 15 8 4 16 position. Exposure meter Aperture value ●●When you turn the aperture ring, an exposure meter is displayed. If the correct exposure is not achieved, the numeric values of the aperture are shown in red. ●●If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red. 83 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Taking pictures by setting the shutter speed ([Shutter-Priority] Mode) When you increase the shutter speed, you can reduce jitter when recording a subject. When you decrease the shutter speed, the subject’s movement is shown. 1 Turn the aperture ring to select [A] (AUTO) 2 Turn the shutter speed dial to select the shutter speed [Shutter-Priority] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes to [S]. •• To correct the exposure, use the exposure compensation dial to adjust the compensation value. (→135) Shutter speeds that can be set (seconds) 60 - 1/4000 (When the mechanical shutter is used) 1 - 1/16000 (When the electronic shutter is used) Aperture value set F1.7 - F16 8 1 15 8.0 5.6 30 4.0 60 2.8 125 2.0 Exposure meter Shutter speed ■■Setting the shutter speed to values not provided on the shutter speed dial Turn the control ring or control dial to set the following shutter speeds. Check the shutter speed on the screen. For details on setting the shutter method, refer to (→140). •• Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second Turn the shutter speed dial to select [4000-] or [1+] Turn the control ring or control dial to select the shutter speed •• Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps You can set the shutter speed from the setting value of the shutter speed dial in the range of ± 2/3 steps. Example: To set the shutter speed to 1/400 seconds Turn the shutter speed dial to select [500] Turn the control ring or control dial to select [400] 84 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed ●●When you turn the shutter speed dial, an exposure meter is displayed. If the correct exposure is not achieved, the numeric value of the shutter speed is shown in red. ●●If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red. ●●If you switch the recording mode to [Shutter-Priority] Mode when [Sensitivity] is set to [  [Sensitivity] will change to [AUTO]. ●●We recommend using a tripod or self-timer when the shutter speed is slow. 85  ], SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed ([Manual Exposure] Mode) Determine the exposure by manually setting the aperture value and the shutter speed. The Manual Exposure Assist appears on the lower portion of the screen to indicate the exposure. 1 Turn the aperture ring to select the aperture value 2 Turn the shutter speed dial to select the shutter speed [Manual Exposure] Mode is set and the recording mode icon changes to [M]. Shutter speeds that can be set*2 (seconds) Aperture values that can be set*1 F1.7 - F16 T (Time), 60 - 1/4000 (When the mechanical shutter is used) 1 - 1/16000 (When the electronic shutter is used) Exposure meter *1 You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom position. 60 *2 You may not be able to select some shutter speeds depending on the aperture value. 125 250 500 1000 2.0 2.8 4.0 5.6 Manual Exposure Assist Shutter speed Aperture value ■■Setting the shutter speed to values not provided on the shutter speed dial Turn the control ring or control dial to set the following shutter speeds. For the setting procedures, refer to (→84). •• Higher speed than 1/4000 seconds or slower shutter speed than 1 second •• Shutter speed setting in 1/3 EV steps ●●If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the numeric values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red. ●●If you switch the recording mode to [Manual Exposure] Mode when [Sensitivity] is set to [  [Sensitivity] will change to [AUTO]. ●●We recommend using a tripod or self-timer when the shutter speed is slow. 86  ], SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Manual exposure assist (estimate) Shows pictures with standard brightness (appropriate exposure). Shows brighter pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a faster shutter speed or increase aperture value. Shows darker pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a slower shutter speed or reduce aperture value. About T (time) When you set the shutter speed to T (time) and fully press the shutter button, the shutter opens. (Approximately up to 120 seconds) When you press the shutter button again, the shutter closes. Use this function when you want to keep the shutter open for an extended period, for example, to record pictures of fireworks or night scenes. ••When you take pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), make sure to use a fully charged battery (→20). ••Manual exposure assist is not displayed. ••If you set the shutter speed to T (time) when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO], [Sensitivity] will change to [200]. ••You cannot use this function when the electronic shutter is used. ••You can use this function only in [Manual Exposure] Mode. ●●When you take pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), we recommend using remote recording with a tripod or smartphone as a remote shutter release (→228, 234), in order to prevent jitter. ●●When you take still pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), the pictures may have higher noise levels. If you want to suppress noise, we recommend taking pictures by setting [Long Shtr NR] to [ON] in the [Rec] menu. (→113) Enabling/disabling the preview of the selected aperture value and shutter speed effects on the recording screen → [Custom] → [Constant Preview] (M Mode) → [ON] / [OFF] ●●This function is disabled when the flash is used. ●●You can use this function only in [Manual Exposure] Mode. 87 SQW0024 Recording mode Taking pictures after setting the aperture value and shutter speed Checking the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed ([Preview] Mode) Recording mode: You can use [Preview] Mode to check the effects of the selected aperture value and shutter speed. ••Checking the effect of the selected aperture value: This enables you to check the depth of field (focus range) by physically narrowing the lens aperture blades to the aperture value used for the actual recording. ••Checking the effect of the selected shutter speed: This allows you to check motion in a scene by displaying the screen at the shutter speed used for the actual recording. When the shutter speed is increased, the screen is displayed like a frame dropping. Use this function to check the effect when you want to capture an image in a scene by stopping the motion, for example, when you take a picture of water flowing. 1 Assign [Preview] to the function button (→37) 2 •• The following step is an example of assigning [Preview] to the [Fn1] button. Press the [Fn1] button to switch the confirmation screen •• Every time you press the [Fn1] button, the screen switches. Normal recording screen Effect of aperture value Shtr Speed Effect On Fn1 Effect of shutter speed Shtr Speed Effect Off Fn1 Depth of field characteristic Recording conditions Aperture value Small Large Focal length Telephoto Wide-angle Distance to a subject Depth of field (Focus range) Close Shallow (narrow) Example: To take a picture by deliberately blurring the background Far Deep (wide) Example: To take a picture by adjusting the focus while including the background ●●You can take a picture even when [Preview] Mode is activated. ●●The range in which you can check the effect of a selected shutter speed is between 8 seconds and 1/16000 seconds. 88 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) Recording mode: You can select your own settings from various effects and take pictures while confirming these effects on the screen. You can set the effects to be applied to a picture by selecting a sample picture. You can add picture effects while you record a panorama picture. 1 Press [FILTER] button 2 Press or turn the control dial to select the picture effect (Filter) ••You can select from among 22 picture effects (Filter). (→92 - 99) ••The picture effect for the sample picture you selected is applied to the picture shown on the preview display. 3 Preview display No Effect Press [MENU/SET] The display of a picture with a selected picture effect appears on the screen. Example: When the picture effect ([Sunshine]) is selected in [Program AE] Mode Picture effects (This is not displayed when [No Effect] is selected.) Adjusting the picture effect (→91) (This is displayed only when a picture effect is selected.) Changing the picture effect (Filter) Press the [FILTER] button again and perform the same procedure from step 2 above. 89 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) ●●Settings will be stored even if the recording mode is changed or the camera is turned off. ●●If you do not want to add picture effects, please select [No Effect]. ●●When you set a picture effect, the following settings are fixed. •• White Balance: [AWB] •• [Photo Style]: [Standard] •• [Highlight Shadow]: [Standard] •• [i.Dynamic]: [OFF] •• [HDR]: [OFF] •• [Color Space]: [sRGB] ●●The flash is set to [   ] (Forced Flash Off). ●●The display of a picture reflecting a selected effect in the preview screen or recording screen may differ from the actual recorded pictures. Switching the display of a selection screen for applying picture effects (Filter) 1 Press the [DISP.] button to switch the display •• Every time you press the [DISP.] button, the screen for which picture effects are selected changes. •• When you switch the screen to the guide display, a description of the picture effects appears. Normal display No Effect 90 Guide display No Effect List display No Effect SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) Adjusting the picture effects according to your preferences You can easily adjust the setting conditions (such as degree and colouring of an effect) of the picture effects according to your preferences. 1 2 Press to display the setting screen Turn the control dial to adjust the setting conditions of the picture effects •• The settings that can be adjusted vary depending on the selected picture effect. Refer to “Items that can be set” for the corresponding picture effect. •• Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen. •• When you select picture effects, [   ] appears on the screen. •• If you do not want to change the current setting, select the centre point (standard) in the adjustment level bar. Taking two still pictures with and without picture effects ([Simultaneous record w/o filter]) You can take two still pictures at the same time by pressing the shutter button once; one with effects and one without effects. → [Rec] → [Simultaneous record w/o filter] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] •• When [ON] is set, the camera will take a still picture with the effects applied and then a still picture without the effects. •• A still picture recorded without effects applied will use the same menu settings as when the picture effects (Filter) were applied. The following settings are fixed. –– White Balance: [AWB] (You cannot perform fine adjustments.) –– [i.Dynamic]: [OFF] •• After taking the picture, [Auto Review] will display only the still picture with the effects applied. ●●If you set this function to [ON], burst, Auto Bracket, Aspect Bracket, White Balance Bracket, [Time Lapse Shot], [Stop Motion Animation] and panorama picture recording will be disabled. ●●This function is disabled during motion picture recording. 91 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Expressive] This effect emphasises the colour to make a pop art picture. Items that can be set (Press Vividness to display the setting screen) Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring [Retro] This effect gives a faded image. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Yellowish colouring Reddish colouring [Old Days] This effect adds a bright, soft and nostalgic feel to the overall image. Items that can be set (Press Contrast to display the setting screen) Low contrast High contrast [High Key] This effect adds a bright, airy and soft feel to the overall image. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Pinkish colouring Light-bluish colouring ●●When recording a panorama picture in a scene with low brightness, you may not be able to achieve the desired results. 92 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Low Key] This effect adds a dark and relaxing feel to the overall image and enhances bright parts. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Reddish colouring Bluish colouring [Sepia] This effect creates a sepia image. Items that can be set (Press Contrast to display the setting screen) Low contrast High contrast [Monochrome] This effect creates a black and white picture. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Yellowish colouring Bluish colouring [Dynamic Monochrome] This effect gives a higher contrast to create an impressive black and white picture. Items that can be set (Press Contrast 93 Low contrast to display the setting screen) High contrast SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Rough Monochrome] This effect creates a black and white picture with granular noise. Items that can be set (Press Grainy image effect to display the setting screen) Weak grainy image effect Strong grainy image effect ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. [Silky Monochrome] This effect blurs the overall image to add a soft feel to a black and white picture. Items that can be set (Press Degree of defocusing to display the setting screen) Slight defocusing Strong defocusing ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. [Impressive Art] This effect gives your photo a dramatic contrast look. Items that can be set (Press Vividness to display the setting screen) Black & white Gaudy colouring ●●When recording a panorama picture, the places where successively taken pictures are stitched may be noticeable. [High Dynamic] This effect produces the optimum brightness for both dark and bright parts. Items that can be set (Press Vividness 94 Black & white to display the setting screen) Gaudy colouring SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Cross Process] This effect gives your photo a dramatic colour look. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Greenish colouring / Bluish colouring / Yellowish colouring / Reddish colouring [Toy Effect] This effect reduces peripheral brightness to give the impression of a toy camera. Items that can be set (Press Colouring Orangish colour to display the setting screen) Bluish colouring [Toy Pop] This effect creates a vivid and bright image with the look of a toy camera. Items that can be set (Press Range in which peripheral brightness is reduced Small to display the setting screen) Large [Bleach Bypass] This effect gives a higher contrast and a lower saturation to create a calm and tranquil picture. Items that can be set (Press Contrast 95 Low contrast to display the setting screen) High contrast SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Miniature Effect] This effect blurs peripheral areas to give the impression of a diorama. Items that can be set (Press Vividness to display the setting screen) Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring ■■Defocusing a picture You can create the impression of a diorama by intentionally creating a blurred area and focusing area using [Miniature Effect]. You can set the recording direction (direction of blurred area), position and size of the focusing area. Press [Fn1] button Press or to move the focusing area (frame) Turn the control dial to select the size of the focusing area (frame) Press [MENU/SET] •• When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is restored. ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. ●●No audio is recorded for motion pictures. ●●When a motion picture is recorded, the finished recording will be approximately 1/8th of the actual recorded time period. (If you record a motion picture for 8 minutes, the resulting motion picture recording time will be approximately 1 minute.) The recordable time displayed on the camera is approx. 8x longer than actual time needed for recording. When the Recording Mode is changed, be sure to check the recordable time. ●●If you stop recording motion pictures too soon, the camera may continue recording until a certain time. Hold the camera until the camera stops recording. ●●If [MF] is selected for the focus mode, move the focusing area to the position at which the focus has been adjusted. 96 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Soft Focus] This effect blurs the overall image to produce a soft feel. Items that can be set (Press Degree of defocusing to display the setting screen) Slight defocusing Strong defocusing ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. [Fantasy] This effect creates a fantastical image in a pale colour tone. Items that can be set (Press Vividness to display the setting screen) Subdued colouring Gaudy colouring [Star Filter] This effect transforms pin-points of light into a star effect. Items that can be set (Press Length of the rays Rays of light is of light short to display the setting screen) Rays of light is long ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. 97 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [One Point Color] This effect leaves one selected colour to emphasise impressiveness. Items that can be set (Press Amount of colour retained to display the setting screen) Leaves a small amount of colour Leaves a large amount of colour ■■Selecting colour Press [Fn1] button Select the colour to be retained with [MENU/SET] and press •• When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is restored. ●●The selected colour may not be retained for some subjects. 98 SQW0024 Picture effects (Filter) Taking pictures using picture effects (Filter) For the setting procedures for picture effects (Filter), refer to (→89). [Sunshine] This effect adds a cast of light to the scene. Items that can be set (Press Colouring to display the setting screen) Yellowish colouring / Reddish colouring / Bluish colouring / Whitish colouring ■■Setting the light source Press [Fn1] button Press to move the centre of the light source to a different position •• You can move the centre of the light source to the edge of the screen. Tips on positioning the centre of the light source You can move the centre of the light source to a point outside the image to obtain a more natural finish. Turn the control dial to adjust the size of the light source •• You can change the light source among four sizes. •• When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is restored. Press [MENU/SET] ●●The recording screen is displayed like a frame dropping with a slight delay compared to normal recording. 99 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the picture quality with effects [Photo Style] Recording mode: You can adjust the colours and picture quality according to the concept of the picture that you want to create. → [Rec] → [Photo Style] [Standard] Standard setting. [Vivid] Setting with slightly high contrast and saturation. [Natural] Setting with slightly low contrast. [Monochrome] Setting that creates a picture using monochrome shades of grey only, such as black and white. [Scenery] Setting that creates a picture using vivid colours for the blue sky and green. [Portrait] Setting that produces the look of a healthy complexion. [Custom] Setting for using colours and picture quality that were registered in advance. ●●[Photo Style] is fixed to [Standard] when the picture effect (Filter) is set. ●●The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. 100 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the picture quality with effects [Photo Style] ■■Adjusting the picture quality Press to select the type of Photo Style Press to select an item and press [Contrast] [Sharpness] [Noise Reduction] [Saturation]*1 [Color Tone]*1 [Filter Effect]*2 Standard to adjust [+] [–] [+] [–] Increases the contrast in a picture. Decreases the contrast in a picture. Enhances the outlines in a picture. Softens the outlines in a picture. Increases the noise reduction effect to reduce noise. This [+] setting may slightly lower the resolution. Lowers the noise reduction effect to achieve a picture [–] quality with clearer resolution. [+] Gaudy colouring [–] Subdued colouring [+] Bluish colouring [–] Yellowish colouring Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Low) [Yellow] Records a blue sky clearly. Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Medium) [Orange] Records a blue sky with vibrant colours. Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: High) [Red] Records a blue sky with even more vibrant colours. Applies subdued colouring for the skin and lips of a [Green] person. Emphasises green leaves and makes them brighter. [Off] — *1 [Color Tone] is displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected. Otherwise, [Saturation] is displayed. *2 [Filter Effect] is displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected. •• When the picture quality is adjusted, [+] will be displayed in the icon. Press [MENU/SET] ■■Registering the setting for the adjusted picture quality to [Custom] Perform the picture quality adjustment in Step press the [DISP.] button of “Adjusting the picture quality” and •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. 101 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting highlights and shadows [Highlight Shadow] Recording mode: You can adjust the highlights and shadows in a picture while confirming the brightness of these areas on the screen. 1 Set the menu 2 Press → [Rec] → [Highlight Shadow] to select the item ([Standard]) No adjustments. ([Higher contrast]) Makes the highlighted areas brighter and shadowed areas darker. ([Lower contrast]) Makes the highlighted areas darker and shadowed areas brighter. ([Brighten shadows]) / 3 4 / (Custom) Makes the shadowed areas brighter. You can set a custom registration shape. Turn the control ring to adjust the brightness of the highlighted areas and turn the control dial to adjust the brightness of the shadowed areas Highlighted area ••To register your preferred settings, press to select the registration target icon (Custom 1 ([   ]), Custom 2 ([   ]), and Custom 3 ([   ])). Press [MENU/SET] Shadowed area Preview display ●●You can press the [DISP.] button on the brightness adjustment screen to switch the screen display. ●●The settings registered in [   ], [   ], or [   ] will be retained even if the camera is turned off. ●●The settings adjusted in [   ], [   ], [   ], or [   ] will be restored to the default settings when the camera is turned off. ●●The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. 102 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the White Balance Recording mode: In sunlight, under incandescent lights or in other such conditions where the colour of white takes on a reddish or bluish tinge, this item adjusts to the colour of white which is closest to what is seen by the eye in accordance with the light source. 1 Press [WB] button (   ) 2 Turn the control dial to select the White Balance and press [MENU/SET] [AWB] Adjust to the colour under a clear sky.  ] [   ] Adjust to the colour under a cloudy sky. [   ] Adjust to the colour in the shade. [   ] [  [  Automatic adjustment in accordance with the light source. [   ]/[   ]*  ]/[  [  Adjust to the colour under incandescent lights. Adjust to the colour that is optimal for taking pictures using the flash.  ]/[   ]  ] Use the White Balance value that was set manually. Use the preset colour temperature setting. * The [AWB] setting is applied when recording motion pictures. Under fluorescent lighting, LED lighting fixtures, etc., the optimal White Balance will vary depending on the lighting type, so use [AWB], [   ], [   ], [   ] or [   ]. ●●The White Balance may not operate correctly if you take pictures using a flash or the subject is recorded outside of the effective flash range (→177). ●●[White Balance] setting is fixed to [AWB] in the following case: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set 103 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the White Balance ■■Auto White Balance When [AWB] (Automatic White Balance) is set, the colouring is adjusted in accordance with the light source. However, if the scene is too bright or too dark or if other extreme conditions apply, the pictures may appear reddish or bluish. The White Balance may not operate correctly if there is a multiple number of light sources. In that case, set the [White Balance] to settings other than [AWB] to adjust the colouring. : [AWB] operational range 10000K 9000K Blue sky 8000K 7000K 6000K 5000K 4000K 3000K 2000K Cloudy sky (rain) Shade Sunlight White fluorescent lighting Incandescent lighting Sunset/sunrise Candlelight K=Kelvin Colour Temperature Setting the White Balance manually Take a picture of a white object under the target light source to adjust colours. 1 2 3 Press [WB] button (   ) Turn the control dial to select [   ], [   ], [   ], or [   ], and press Point the camera at a white object such as a piece of paper, ensuring that it is inside the frame at the centre of the screen, and press [MENU/SET] ●●It may not be possible to set the correct White Balance if subjects are too bright or too dark. In this case, adjust the brightness and try to set the White Balance again. 104 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the White Balance Setting the White Balance using colour temperature You can set the White Balance using colour temperature. Colour temperature is a numeric value that expresses the colour of light (unit: K*). A picture becomes bluish when the colour temperature value is higher, and reddish when the temperature value is lower. * Kelvin 1 2 3 Press [WB] button (   ) Turn the control dial to select [   ] and press Use to select the colour temperature value and press [MENU/SET] •• You can set the colour temperature from 2,500 K to 10,000 K. Performing White Balance fine adjustments White Balance settings can be individually fine-tuned if colours still do not appear as anticipated. 1 2 Select the White Balance and press Use to perform White Balance fine adjustments : A (amber: orangish colours) : G (green: greenish colours) 3 : B (blue: bluish colours) : M (magenta: reddish colours) •• Pressing [DISP.] button resets the position back to the centre. Press [MENU/SET] ●●When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the A (amber) or B (blue) side, the colour of the White Balance icon displayed on the screen will change to the fine-tuned colour. ●●When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the G (green) or M (magenta) side, [+] (green) or [-] (magenta) will be displayed in the White Balance icon on the screen. ●●Settings remain applied when using flash. ●●You can perform fine adjustments of the White Balance independently for each White Balance setting item. ●●When you set a new White Balance value by selecting [   ], [   ], [   ] or [   ], or change the colour temperature by selecting [   ], the White Balance fine adjustment level will be returned to the standard setting (centre point). 105 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Adjusting the White Balance Bracket recording using White Balance Bracket settings are performed based on the fine adjustment values for White Balance, and three pictures with different colouring are automatically recorded when the shutter button is pressed once. 1 Perform fine adjustments of the White Balance in step 2 of “Performing White Balance fine adjustments” and turn the control dial to perform the Bracket setting 2 Turning the control dial to the right : Horizontal ([A] to [B]) Turning the control dial to the left : Vertical ([G] to [M]) Press [MENU/SET] ●●When the White Balance Bracket is set, [BKT] appears on the White Balance icon. ●●When the camera is turned off (Including [Sleep Mode]), the White Balance Bracket setting is cancelled. ●●The shutter sound will be emitted only once. Not available in the following cases: ●●The White Balance Bracket does not function in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• During motion picture recording •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] •• When the [Quality] setting is set to [  •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] 106  ], [   ] or [   ] SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Setting the picture quality and size Changing the aspect ratio of the still pictures Recording mode: You can easily switch the aspect ratio of still pictures using the aspect ratio selector switch. 1 Switching the aspect ratio selector switch [4:3] Aspect ratio of a 4:3 TV [1:1] Aspect ratio of a square image [16:9] Aspect ratio of high-definition TV, etc. [3:2] Aspect ratio of standard film cameras ●●Edges may be cut off when printing - be sure to check in advance. (→324) Not available in the following case: ●●During panorama picture recording 107 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Setting the picture quality and size Setting the picture size Recording mode: The higher the numbers of pixels, the finer the detail of the pictures will appear even when they are printed onto large sheets. → [Rec] → [Picture Size] Aspect ratio 4:3 1:1 16:9 3:2 [L] 12.5M [L] 10M [L] 11M [L] 12M 4112×3088 [Picture Size] [  M] 6.5M 2976×2232 [  S] 3M 2048×1536 3088×3088 4480×2520 [  M] 5M [  M] 8M S] 2.5M [  S] 2M 2240×2240 [  1536×1536 3840×2160 1920×1080 4272×2856 [  M] 6.5M 3120×2080 [  S] 3M 2112×1408 ●●When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH], [Picture Size] is fixed to [S]. Not available in the following case: •• During panorama picture recording 108 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Setting the picture quality and size Setting the compression rate of pictures ([Quality]) Recording mode: Set the compression rate used for storing pictures. → [Rec] → [Quality] Settings [   ] [   ] JPEG [   ]  ]  ] Description Gives priority to picture quality and saves pictures in JPEG file format. [  [  File format Saves pictures in JPEG file format using standard picture quality. This setting is useful when you want to increase the number of recordable pictures without changing the number of pixels. RAW + JPEG Saves pictures in JPEG file format in addition to the RAW file format.*1 RAW Saves pictures in the RAW file format.*2 *1 If you delete a RAW file from the camera, the corresponding JPEG file is also deleted. *2 The picture size is fixed to the maximum recordable pixels for each image aspect ratio ([L]). About RAW file In RAW file format the data is saved without any picture processing by the camera. This format delivers a higher picture quality than the JPEG format, but the amount of data is greater. To play back and edit RAW file pictures, you must use this unit or dedicated software. You can perform advanced editing of RAW file pictures, such as correcting the White Balance of pictures recorded previously, and save the pictures in file formats that can be displayed on a PC. ••You can develop the RAW file pictures using [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu. (→208) ••To develop and edit RAW file pictures on a PC, use the supplied DVD software (Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s “SILKYPIX Developer Studio”). 109 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Setting the picture quality and size Not available in the following cases: ●●The following effects cannot be used on RAW file pictures. •• [Intelligent Auto] Mode •• Picture effects (Filter) •• White Balance*1 •• [Photo Style]*1 / [Highlight Shadow]*1 / [i.Dynamic]*1 / [Red-Eye Removal]*2 / [i.Resolution]*1 / [Color Space]*1 ([Rec] menu) ●●You cannot set to [   ], [   ] or [   ] in the following case: •• During panorama picture recording *1 When you use [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu, the adjustments are made based on the settings used during recording. Therefore, you can save JPEG file pictures by using the settings applied during recording. 2 * If [Red-Eye Removal] is activated during recording, you can use [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu to save JPEG file pictures in which red-eye was detected and corrected. 110 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Using the picture correction functions effectively Correcting contrast and exposure ([i.Dynamic]) Recording mode: Automatically adjusts contrast and exposure to give more lifelike colours when there is significant contrast between background and subject. → [Rec] → [i.Dynamic] Settings: [AUTO] / [HIGH] / [STANDARD] /[LOW] / [OFF] ●●When [AUTO] is set, you can automatically set the strength of the effects based on the recording conditions. ●●The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. Not available in the following cases: ●●Compensation effect may not be achieved depending on the conditions. ●●The [i.Dynamic] does not function in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] Enhancing the impression of high-resolution ([i.Resolution]) Recording mode: You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to record still pictures with sharper outlines and clearer resolution. → [Rec] → [i.Resolution] Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] /[LOW] / [EXTENDED] / [OFF] ●●When [EXTENDED] is set, you can take more natural pictures with the impression of highresolution. ●●The [EXTENDED] setting will automatically change to the [LOW] setting when recording motion pictures. ●●The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. 111 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Using the picture correction functions effectively Combining still pictures with different exposures ([HDR]) Recording mode: The camera can combine 3 still pictures taken at different exposures into a single properly exposed picture with rich gradation. The individual pictures used to create the HDR picture are not saved. You can minimise the loss of gradations in bright areas and dark areas when, for example, the contrast between the background and the subject is large. A combined HDR picture is saved in JPEG format. → [Rec] → [HDR] [ON] Creates a combined HDR picture. [OFF] Does not create a combined HDR picture. [Dynamic Range] [AUTO]: Takes pictures after automatically setting the adjustment range of the exposure based on the contrast of a subject. [±1EV] / [±2EV] / [±3EV]: Takes pictures using the adjustment range of the exposure being set. [Auto Align] [ON]: Automatically adjusts the displacement of pictures caused by jitter, etc. We recommend using this setting to take pictures with a handheld camera. [OFF]: Does not adjust the displacement of pictures. We recommend using this setting when you use a tripod. [SET] ■■What is HDR? HDR stands for High Dynamic Range and refers to a technique for expressing a wide contrast range. ●●After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation. ●●Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few moments before you will be able to record another picture. ●●A subject that was in motion when it was recorded may be recorded as an afterimage. ●●When [Auto Align] is set to [ON], the angle of view narrows slightly. ●●When you take pictures using a flash, the flash mode is fixed to [   ] (Forced Flash Off). Not available in the following cases: ●●This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded. ●●[HDR] cannot be used in the following cases:  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When the [Quality] setting is set to [  •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) 112 SQW0024 Picture Quality and colouring Settings Using the picture correction functions effectively Suppressing the noise of a long exposure ([Long Shtr NR]) Recording mode: The camera can automatically eliminate the noise made when taking pictures with a slower shutter speed (e.g. to record night scenes) in order to take sharp pictures. → [Rec] → [Long Shtr NR] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] ●●While the camera eliminates the noise, [Long shutter noise reduction ongoing] is displayed for the same period as the shutter speed selected for the signal processing time. Not available in the following cases: ●●The [Long Shtr NR] does not function in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• During motion picture recording •• When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] •• When using the electronic shutter Setting the colour space Recording mode: You can set the method for reproducing the colours to correctly display the recorded pictures on the screens of a PC or printer, etc. → [Rec] → [Color Space] [sRGB] Sets the sRGB colour space. This setting is widely used for devices such as PCs. [AdobeRGB] Sets the AdobeRGB colour space. AdobeRGB colour space has a wider colour reproduction range than sRGB colour space. Therefore, AdobeRGB colour space is mainly used for business applications such as commercial printing. ●●Select [sRGB] if you do not have expert knowledge about AdobeRGB colour space. ●●During motion picture recording, the setting is fixed to [sRGB]. 113 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus 1 Switch the focus selector switch to [   ] or [   ] Auto Focus is activated. Align with the indicator. Select the focus mode (AFS, AFF, AFC) Recording mode: Set the focusing operation to be performed when the shutter button is pressed halfway. → [Rec] → [AFS/AFF/AFC] Focus selector switch * * Settings The movement of the subject and the scene (recommended) Description [AFS] Subject is still (Scenery, anniversary photograph, etc.) “AFS” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Single”. Focus is set automatically when the shutter button is pressed halfway. Focus will be fixed while it is pressed halfway. [AFF] Movement cannot be predicted (Children, pets, etc.) “AFF” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Flexible”. In this mode, focusing is performed automatically when the shutter button is pressed halfway. If the subject moves while the shutter button is pressed halfway, the focus is corrected to match the movement automatically. Subject is moving (Sport, trains, etc.) “AFC” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Continuous”. In this mode, while the shutter button is pressed halfway, focusing is constantly performed to match the movement of the subject. When the subject is moving, the focusing is performed by predicting the subject position at the time of recording. [AFC] — Focusing is performed manually. (→128) * In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the setting is fixed to AF Macro even if you switch the focus selector switch to [  114  ] or [   ] (AF Macro). SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus When recording using [AFF], [AFC] ●●Focusing may take time if the zoom is suddenly changed from max. W to max. T, or if you suddenly move closer to a subject from a greater distance. ●●Press the shutter button halfway again when it is difficult to focus on the subject. ●●While the shutter button pressed halfway, shake may be seen on the screen. ●●If the light on a subject is insufficient when using [AFF] or [AFC], the camera performs the same focusing operation as [AFS]. In this case, the indication on the screen will change to yellow [AFS]. Not available in the following case: ●●The camera adjusts the focus using [AFS] in the following case: •• During panorama picture recording Switching [AF Mode] Recording mode: This allows the focusing method that suits the positions and number of the subjects to be selected. 1 Press [   ] button (   ) 2 Press to select Auto Focus mode and press [MENU/SET] •• If you press when [   ], [   ], [   ], or [   ] is selected, the AF area setting screen appears. For details on operation of the AF area setting screen, refer to (→121). ●●Auto Focus is fixed to [   ] (1-area-focusing) in the following case: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect]) Not available in the following case: ●●Cannot set to [   ] (Pinpoint-focusing) in the following case: •• When [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) is set to [AFF] or [AFC] 115 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Taking front-on pictures of people (Face/Eye Detection) The camera automatically detects the faces and eyes of subjects. The camera adjusts the focus on the eye that is closer to the camera and the exposure using the face (when [Metering Mode] is set to [   ] (Multi Metering)). ••The camera can detect up to 15 faces. The camera can detect only the eyes of faces to be focused on. When the camera recognises a face, the AF area and eye used for focusing are displayed. Yellow: When the shutter button is pressed halfway, the frame turns green when the camera is focused. White: Displayed when more than one face is detected. Other faces that are the same distance away as faces within the yellow AF area are also focused. Eye used for focusing ●●You can change the position and size of the AF area and eye to be used for focusing. (→121) ●●If [Metering Mode] is set to [   ] (Multi Metering) when [   ] (Face/Eye Detection) is selected, the camera will adjust the exposure using the face of a subject. (→139) Not available in the following case: ●●If conditions prevent the face from being recognised, such as when the movement of the subject is too rapid, the AF Mode setting switches to [  116  ] (49-area-focusing). SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Automatically locking the focus on a moving subject 1 (AF Tracking) Align the AF Tracking frame with the subject and press the shutter button halfway When the subject is recognised, the AF Tracking frame changes from white to yellow, and the subject is automatically kept in focus. If AF Lock fails, a red frame flashes for a while and then turns off. Retry the locking operation. •• To release AF Tracking → Press [MENU/SET].  ] •• Focus range: same as macro recording [  •• In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, every time you press , AF Tracking and Face Detection are switched. AF Tracking frame ●●When you set [Metering Mode] to [   ] (Multi Metering), the camera adjusts the exposure using a locked subject. (→139) ●●Under certain recording conditions, such as when the subject is small or dark, [   ] (AF Tracking) may not operate correctly. When [   ] (AF Tracking) does not work, focus will be on [   ] (1-areafocusing). ●●[  Not available in the following cases:  ] (AF Tracking) cannot be used in the following case: •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] ●●In the following cases, [   ] (AF Tracking) performs the operation of [   ] (1-area-focusing). •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Sepia], [Monochrome], [Dynamic Monochrome], [Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine]) •• [Monochrome] in [Photo Style] Subject not centred in picture (49-area-focusing) / , etc. (Custom Multi) (49-area-focusing) Focuses on the subject in the wide range area (up to 49-areafocusing) on the recording screen. ●●You can select the focusing area. (→121) 117 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus , etc. (Custom Multi) You can set the preferred shape of an AF area by selecting 49 points in the AF area, based on the subject. 1 2 Press [   ] button (   ) 3 Use Select a Custom Multi icon ([  •• When you press  ], etc.), and press , the AF area setting screen appears. to select the setting item •• The currently set shape of an AF area is displayed on the bottomleft of the screen. ([Horizontal Pattern]) Horizontal line shape Ideal shape for panning, etc. ([Vertical Pattern]) Vertical line shape Ideal shape for recording structures, etc. ([User Defined]) Custom shape / / (Custom) You can set a custom registration shape. 4 Press 5 Select the AF area Current AF area shape •• The AF area setting screen appears. •• The selected AF area is displayed in yellow whereas the unselected area is displayed in white. When selecting [   ] / [   ] When [   ] is selected, you can set the size and position of the area in the vertical direction and when [   ] is selected, you can set the size and position of the area in the horizontal direction. Operation of buttons Description Moves position Control dial [DISP.] button 118 Changes the size (up to three lines) Restores to the initial settings SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus When selecting [   ] / [   ] / [   ] / [   ] Use to select AF area and press [MENU/SET] to set (repeat) •• If you press [MENU/SET] again, the setting will be cancelled. •• To cancel all the settings, press the [DISP.] button. 6 Press [Fn2] button ■■Registering the set AF area in [   ], [   ], and [  Press on the screen of step 3 on (→118) Use  ] (Custom) to select the registration target icon and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ●●The settings registered in [  ●●The settings adjusted in [  camera is turned off.  ], [   ], or [   ] will be retained even if the camera is turned off.  ], [   ], or [   ] will be restored to the default settings when the ●●If you press the cursor button when [Direct Focus Area] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the AF area setting screen will appear. 119 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Determined position for focus (1-area-focusing) / (Pinpoint-focusing) (1-area-focusing) Focuses on AF area in centre of picture. (Recommended when focus is difficult to align) ••You can change the position and size of the AF area. (→121) Locking the focus If a subject you want to record is not in the centre, follow the steps below. (Only when [AFS/AFF/AFC] is set to [AFS]) Align the AF 1 Adjust focus according to area with the subject Focus display (When focus is aligned: illuminated When focus is not aligned: flashing) subject Hold down halfway 2 AF area (When focus is aligned: green When focus is not aligned: red) Return to desired composition Press fully (Pinpoint-focusing) Enables more precise focusing on a smaller point than [   ] (1-area-focusing). ●●You can set the focus position using the enlarged screen. (→122) ●●When you press the shutter button halfway, an enlarged display of the focus position appears. ●●You can set the timeout for the enlarged display using [Pinpoint AF Time] in the [Custom] menu. (→122)  ] (Pinpoint-focusing) is selected while recording motion pictures, the setting is changed to [   ] (1-area-focusing). ●●If [  Not available in the following case: ●●Cannot set to [   ] (Pinpoint-focusing) in the following case: •• When [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→114) is set to [AFF] or [AFC] 120 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Changing the position and size of the AF area ■■When selecting [   ] / [   ] You can change the position and size of the AF area. Select [   ] or [   ] and press •• The AF area setting screen appears. To change the AF area To move the position of the AF area: Press To change the size of the AF area: Turn the control dial •• If you set the AF area to an eye in the yellow frame when [   ] is selected, the eye to be used for focusing will be changed. •• To restore the AF area to its initial state (position) → Press [DISP.] button. Press [MENU/SET] ■■When selecting [   ] You can set the focus position by selecting an AF area group. The AF area, which is configured with 49 points, is divided into groups consisting of 9 points each (6 points or 4 points for the groups located at the edges of the screen). Examples of group Select [   ] and press •• The AF area setting screen appears. Press to select an AF area group Press [MENU/SET] •• Only the [+] indications (centre points of the selected group) remain on the screen. •• To cancel the settings for the AF area frame, press [MENU/SET]. 121 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus ■■When selecting [   ] You can enlarge the screen to perform more precise settings of the focus position. ••You cannot set the focus position at the edges of the screen. Select [   ] and press Use to set the focus position and press [MENU/SET] •• The enlarged assist screen will appear for setting the focus position. Move [+] to the focus position with •• Pressing [DISP.] button will bring the focus position back to the centre of the assist screen. Changing the display of the assist screen → [Custom] → [Pinpoint AF Display] [FULL]: Enlarges the assist screen using the entire screen. [PIP]: Enlarges the assist screen on part of the screen. ••When [PIP] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3 times to 6 times. When [FULL] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3 times to 10 times. Enlarge or reduce the screen by magnification factors of x1 steps using the control dial. Setting the timeout for the enlarged display →  [Custom] → [Pinpoint AF Time] → [LONG] (approx. 1.5 seconds) / [MID] (approx. 1.0 seconds) / [SHORT] (approx. 0.5 seconds) ••If you release the shutter button, the enlarged display will turn off even before the screen timeout. 122 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Enabling/disabling use of cursor button to move the AF area → [Custom] → [Direct Focus Area] → [ON] / [OFF] When [   ], [   ], or [   ] is selected, you can move the AF area and when [   ] is selected, you can move the enlarged position. ••When [Custom Multi] such as [   ] is selected, the AF area setting screen is displayed. ••Use the Quick menu (→34) to set functions to be assigned to the cursor button, such as [Drive Mode], [White Balance] and [Sensitivity]. ●●When you set [Metering Mode] (→139) to [   ] (spot-focusing), the metering target will move along with the AF area. When the AF area is moved to the edges of the screen, the metering operation may be affected by the surrounding brightness. Not available in the following cases: ●●[Direct Focus Area] is fixed to [OFF] in the following case: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ●●The position and size of the AF area cannot be changed in the Digital Zoom range. 123 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Setting your preferred focusing method You can use the [Custom] menu to set the focusing method in detail. Enabling/disabling focus adjustment when the shutter button is pressed halfway → [Custom] → [Shutter AF] → [ON] / [OFF] Enabling/disabling shutter release when the shutter button is pressed halfway → [Custom] → [Half Press Release] → [ON] / [OFF] Focusing using the [AF/AE LOCK] button You can use the [AF/AE LOCK] button instead of the shutter button to focus on a subject. 1 Set the [Custom] menu → [Custom] → [Shutter AF] → [OFF] → [Custom] → [AF/AE Lock] → [AF-ON] 2 Press the [AF/AE LOCK] button 3 Press the shutter button to take a picture 3 The camera focuses on a subject. •• The camera takes a picture by adjusting the exposure. 2 Enabling/disabling pre-adjustment of focus → [Custom] → [Quick AF] → [ON] / [OFF] The focus is automatically adjusted when camera blurring is small even when the shutter button is not pressed. (Increases battery consumption) ●●Press shutter button halfway if focus is difficult to align. ●●[Quick AF] cannot be used in the following cases: ••In the [Preview] Mode ••When the lighting is low 124 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Auto Focus Turning on/off the AF Assist Lamp → [Custom] → [AF Assist Lamp] → [ON] / [OFF] Illuminates the AF Assist Lamp when the shutter button is pressed halfway when it is too dark to facilitate focusing. (A large AF area is displayed based on recording conditions.) ●●The AF Assist Lamp has an effective distance of 1.5 m (4.9 feet). ●●AF Assist Lamp is effective for a subject at the centre of the screen. Use the lamp by positioning a subject at the centre of the screen. ●●If you do not want to illuminate the AF Assist Lamp when you take a picture in a dark location (e.g. taking a picture of an animal in the dark), set this function to [OFF]. When the AF Assist Lamp is set to [OFF], sharper focusing will become difficult. ●●The setting is fixed to [OFF] in the following case: ••When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON] Enabling/disabling recording when a subject is out of focus → [Custom] → [Focus/Release Priority] [FOCUS]: Recording is disabled unless the focusing is performed properly. [RELEASE]: Recording is performed when you fully press the shutter button to place priority on the shutter release timing that helps to avoid missed opportunities. ●●Note that a picture may be out of focus when [RELEASE] is set, even if the focus mode is set to [AFS], [AFF], or [AFC]. ●●This function is disabled during motion picture recording. Enabling/disabling manual focus adjustment after AF → [Custom] → [AF+MF] → [ON] / [OFF] You can manually perform fine focusing during AF Lock (pressing the shutter button halfway when [AFS/AFF/AFC] is set to [AFS] or setting AF Lock using the [AF/AE LOCK] button). 125 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking close-up pictures (Macro recording) Recording mode: When you want to enlarge the subject, setting to [   ] (AF Macro) enables you to take pictures at an even closer distance than the normal focus range (up to 3 cm (0.098 feet) for max. Wide). 1 Switch the focus selector switch to [   ] Enables closeup focusing on a subject. (Auto Focus functions.) Align with the indicator. Focus range When a subject is too close to the camera, the picture may not be properly focused. Shortest recording distance The shortest recording distance is the distance from the lens front to the subject. This distance changes gradually depending on the zoom position. Max. Wide 0.03 m (0.098 feet) When the focus selector switch is set to [   ] (AF Macro). Max. Tele 0.3 m (0.98 feet) Focus selector switch [   ] [   ] (AF Macro) [   ] (→128) Focus range Zoom Max. Wide Max. Tele 50 cm (1.6 feet) 50 cm (1.6 feet) 3 cm (0.098 feet) 30 cm (0.98 feet) 3 cm (0.098 feet) 30 cm (0.98 feet) •• Focus range is displayed when operating the zoom, etc. 126 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking close-up pictures (Macro recording) ●●In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, the shortest recording distance will be the same as that for [   ], regardless of the focus selector switch setting. ●●It may take some time until distant subjects come into focus. ●●Using a tripod and [Self Timer] is recommended. Also, when recording a subject close to the camera, we recommend taking a picture without using the flash. ●●Moving the camera after aligning the focus is likely to result in poorly focused pictures if subject is close to the camera, due to the margin for focus alignment being severely reduced. ●●Resolution may be reduced around the edges of the picture. 127 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Manual Focus Recording mode: Manual Focus is convenient when you want to lock the focus to take pictures or when it is difficult to adjust focus using Auto Focus. 1 2 3 4 Switch the focus selector switch to [   ] Focus manually on a subject. Align with the indicator. Press [   ] button (   ) Press to determine the area to be enlarged, and press [MENU/SET] ••The screen changes to the assist screen and an enlarged display appears. (MF Assist) (→131) ••If you press [DISP.] button, the area to be enlarged will be reset to the centre. Turn the control ring to adjust focus Turning the control ring to the right: Focusing on a nearby subject Turning the control ring to the left: Focusing on a distant subject ••Colour is added to the portions of the image that are in focus. (Peaking) (→130) ••You can confirm the direction of focus adjustment toward the close distance side or far distance side. (MF Guide) (→129) MF Assist (Enlarged screen) Peaking Indicator for MF Guide (infinity) ●●After zoom operation, readjust the focus. ●●After cancelling [Sleep Mode], be sure to readjust the focus. 128 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Manual Focus Enabling/disabling MF Guide display → [Custom] → [MF Guide] → [ON] / [OFF] Quickly adjusting the focus using Auto Focus → [Custom] → [AF/AE Lock] → [AF-ON] If you press the [AF/AE LOCK] button in Manual Focus, Auto Focus is activated. ●●Auto Focus is activated at the centre of the frame. ●●When Auto Focus is activated on the MF Assist screen, the camera will adjust the focus at the centre of the MF Assist screen. 129 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Manual Focus Enabling/disabling [Peaking] to add colour to the portions of the image that are in focus → [Custom] → [Peaking] ●●[Peaking] functions during Manual Focus or when you are adjusting focus manually using [AF+MF]. [ON] Colour is added to the portions of the image that are in focus. [OFF] The portions of the image that are in focus are not displayed. [Detect Level] [SET] [Display Color] The detection level for in-focus portions is set. When [HIGH] is set, portions to be highlighted are reduced, allowing you to achieve a more precise focus. Settings: [HIGH] / [LOW] •• The detection level setting does not affect the focus range. Sets the highlighting colour used for [Peaking]. Settings The available colour settings differ depending on the setting of [Detect Level]. Changing the [Detect Level] setting also changes the [Display Color] setting as follows. [Detect Level] [Display Color] [HIGH] [LOW] [   ] (Light blue) [   ] (Blue) [   ] (Yellow) [   ] (Orange) [   ] (Green) [   ] (White) ●●When [Peaking] is set to [ON], [   ] ([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) or [   ] ([Detect Level]: [LOW]) will be displayed. ●●When [Fn Button Set] (→37) in the [Custom] menu is set to [Peaking], you can switch the setting in the following order every time the assigned function button is pressed: [ON] ([Detect Level]: [LOW]) → [ON] ([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) → [OFF]. ●●Since portions with clear outlines on the screen are highlighted as in-focus portions, portions to be highlighted vary depending on the recording conditions. ●●The colour used for highlighting does not affect recorded pictures. Not available in the following case: ●●[Peaking] does not function in the following case: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome]) 130 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Manual Focus MF Assist ■■Displaying the MF Assist ••Turn the control ring to display MF Assist. ••You can also display MF Assist by pressing to display the setting screen, pressing the cursor button to set the position to be enlarged, and then pressing [MENU/SET]. ••When you perform the following operation, the position to be enlarged will be returned to the centre. –– When you press the [DISP.] button on the screen used for setting of the position to be enlarged ••If you press the cursor button when [Direct Focus Area] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the setting screen for the enlarged position appears. ■■Closing the MF Assist ••To exit MF Assist, press the shutter button halfway. ••You can also exit MF Assist by pressing [MENU/SET]. ••When you display MF Assist by turning the control ring, MF Assist is automatically ended approximately 10 seconds after you finish the operation. Not available in the following case: ●●The MF Assist is disabled in the Digital Zoom range or when recording motion pictures. Setting the display method of MF Assist → [Custom] → [MF Assist] [   ] Turn the control ring or press the [   ] button (   ) to enlarge the position. [   ] Turn the control ring to enlarge the position. [   ] [OFF] 131 Press the [   ] button (   ) to enlarge the position. The control ring or [   ] button (   ) cannot be used to enlarge the position. SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Manual Focus Changing the MF Assist display → [Custom] → [MF Assist Display] [FULL]: Enlarges the assist screen using the entire screen. [PIP]: Enlarges the assist screen on part of the screen. ••When [PIP] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3 times to 6 times. When [FULL] is selected, the size of the screen is enlarged or reduced approximately 3 times to 10 times. Enlarge or reduce the screen by magnification factors of x1 steps using the control dial. 132 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure [AF/AE Lock] Recording mode: The AF/AE Lock function is convenient, for example, when there is too much contrast with the subject and you cannot get appropriate exposure (AE Lock) or when you want to take a still picture composed with the subject outside the AF area (AF Lock). 1 2 Point the camera at the subject Lock the focus and/or exposure while you press and hold the [AF/AE LOCK] button ••When you release the [AF/AE LOCK] button, the focus and/or exposure lock is cancelled. ••Only the exposure is locked at the time of purchase. 3 While you press and hold the [AF/AE LOCK] button, move the camera to compose the picture you want to take and fully press the shutter button : Focus is locked (AF Lock) ••When [AE LOCK] is set, press the shutter button halfway to focus, then press it fully. Setting the function of the [AF/AE LOCK] button → [Custom] → [AF/AE Lock] [AE LOCK] [AF LOCK] [AF/AE LOCK] [AF-ON] Locks exposure only. •• [AEL], aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the correct exposure is achieved. Locks focus only. •• [AFL], focus, aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the subject comes into focus. Locks focus and exposure. •• [AFL], [AEL], focus, aperture value, and shutter speed are displayed when the subject is in focus and the correct exposure is achieved. Auto Focus is activated. Maintaining/not maintaining the lock when [AF/AE LOCK] button is released → 133 [Custom] → [AF/AE Lock Hold] → [ON] / [OFF] SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure [AF/AE Lock] ●●AF Lock only is effective in the following case: •• [Manual Exposure] Mode ●●During Manual Focus, only AE Lock can be used. ●●Only the AF Lock is enabled when you are recording motion pictures. Once you cancel AF Lock while recording motion pictures, you cannot perform the AF Lock operation again. ●●The subject can be focused again by pressing the shutter button halfway, even when AE is locked. ●●Programme Shift can be set even when AE is locked. ●●Lock is cancelled when a zoom operation is performed after locking the exposure and/or focus. Perform the locking operation again. 134 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Taking pictures with Exposure Compensation Recording mode: Corrects the exposure when there is a backlight or when the subject is too dark or too bright. 1 Turn the exposure compensation dial to select the compensation value Under-exposed Optimum exposure Adjust the exposure to the [+] direction Over-exposed Adjust the exposure to the [-] direction ••You can set the exposure compensation value in the range between –3 EV and +3 EV. ●●Depending on the brightness, this may not be possible in some cases. ●●When [Auto Exposure Comp.] of [Flash] in the [Rec] menu is set to [ON], the flash output is also automatically adjusted based on the exposure compensation value. (→183) 135 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Setting the ISO Sensitivity Recording mode: Set ISO Sensitivity (sensitivity to lighting) manually. We recommend higher settings to take clear pictures in darker locations. 1 Press [ISO] button (   ) 2 Turn the control dial to select ISO Sensitivity and press [MENU/SET] ISO Sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200*1 depending on the brightness of a subject. AUTO (Intelligent ISO) ISO Sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200*1 depending on the movement and brightness of a subject. 100*2/200/400/800/1600/ 3200/6400/12800/25600 ISO Sensitivity is fixed at the selected setting. •• When [ISO Increments] is set to [1/3EV], more ISO Sensitivity settings can be selected. (→138) *1 When [ISO Limit Set] (→137) in the [Rec] menu is set to other than [OFF], the ISO Sensitivity is automatically set in the range up to the [ISO Limit Set] setting value. *2 Only when [Extended ISO] is [ON]. Setting guide Sensitivity Location (recommended) Shutter speed Interference Subject blur 136 [200] Bright (outdoors) Slow Low High [25600] Dark Fast High Low SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Setting the ISO Sensitivity ●●When [High Dynamic] is selected for the picture effect (Filter), [Sensitivity] is fixed to [AUTO]. ●●When a picture effect (Filter) other than [High Dynamic] is selected or when [Multi Exp.] is set, ISO Sensitivity can be set in a range up to [3200]. ●●For details on the available flash range used when the [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO], refer to (→177). ●●Cannot select [   ] in the following cases: •• [Shutter-Priority] Mode •• [Manual Exposure] Mode ●●When [Direct Focus Area] (→123) is set to [ON], the cursor button functions as an operation for moving the AF area. In that case, use the Quick menu (→34) to set the ISO Sensitivity. ●●You can use the following settings when recording motion pictures: [AUTO], [200] - [6400] Setting the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity Recording mode: You can set the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or [  → [Rec] → [ISO Limit Set] Settings: [400] / [800] / [1600] / [3200] / [6400] / [12800] / [25600] / [OFF]  ]. Not available in the following case: •• During motion picture recording 137 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Setting the ISO Sensitivity Setting the incremental value of ISO Sensitivity Recording mode: You can change the setting to increase ISO Sensitivity by 1 EV or 1/3 EV. → [Rec] → [ISO Increments] [1/3EV] [1 EV] [L.100]* / [L.125]* / [L.160]* / [200] / [250] / [320] / [400] / [500] / [640] / [800] / [1000] / [1250] / [1600] / [2000] / [2500] / [3200] / [4000] / [5000] / [6400] / [8000] / [10000] / [12800] / [16000] / [20000] / [25600] [L.100]* / [200] / [400] / [800] / [1600] / [3200] / [6400] / [12800] / [25600] * Only when [Extended ISO] is [ON]. ●●When this setting is changed from [1/3EV] to [1 EV], the setting for [Sensitivity] may be changed. (The closest ISO Sensitivity that can be set for [1 EV] will be used.) Extending the ISO Sensitivity setting Recording mode: You can extend the numeric values that can be set for ISO Sensitivity. → [Rec] → [Extended ISO] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] 138 SQW0024 Adjusting the focus and brightness (exposure) Setting the metering mode Recording mode: You can change the metering method used for measuring brightness. → [Rec] → [Metering Mode] [Metering Mode] (Multiple) (Centre weighted) Brightness measurement position Conditions Whole screen Normal usage (produces balanced pictures) Centre and surrounding area Subject in centre Centre of [+] (spot metering target) Great difference between brightness of subject and background (e.g. person in spotlight on stage, backlighting) (Spot) Spot metering target ••The menu item is common for both the [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. 139 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Setting the Shutter Type Recording mode: You can take pictures using two types of shutter modes: the mechanical shutter and electronic shutter. Mechanical shutter Description Starts the exposure electronically and ends the exposure using the mechanical shutter. Electronic shutter Starts and ends the exposure electronically. Flash ○ – Shutter Speed (seconds) 60 - 1/4000 1*1 - 1/16000 Mechanical shutter sound*2 + Electronic shutter sound*3 Electronic shutter sound*3 Shutter sound *1 You can set ISO Sensitivity up to [ISO 3200]. When ISO Sensitivity is higher than [ISO 3200], the shutter speed will be faster than 1 second. *2 You cannot turn off the mechanical shutter sound. *3 You can use [Shutter Vol.] to adjust the volume of the electronic shutter sound. (→43) 1 Set the menu → [Rec] → [Shutter Type] [AUTO] The shutter mode automatically switches based on the recording conditions and shutter speed. •• The mechanical shutter mode has higher priority over the electronic shutter mode because the mechanical shutter has less function-related restrictions when recording with a flash, etc. [MSHTR] Uses only the mechanical shutter mode to take a picture. [ESHTR] Uses only the electronic shutter mode to take a picture. ●●When [   ] is displayed on the screen, the electronic shutter is used to take a picture. ●●When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH], the electronic shutter is used to take a picture. ●●When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], the electronic shutter is used to take a picture. ●●If you take a picture of a moving subject using the electronic shutter, the subject in the picture may be skewed in some cases. ●●When you take a picture under a fluorescent or LED lighting fixture using the electronic shutter, the recorded picture may have horizontal stripes. If you use a slower shutter speed, the horizontal stripes may be reduced. (→84) ●●Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, likeness rights, etc. of a subject when you use this function. Use at your own risk. 140 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Selecting a Drive Mode Recording mode: You can switch the operation to be performed when you press the shutter button. 1 Press [  2 Press to select the drive mode and press [MENU/SET]  ] button (   ) Drive Mode [Single] When the shutter button is pressed, only one picture is recorded. [Burst] (→142) The pictures are recorded in succession while the shutter button is pressed. [Auto Bracket]* (→145) Each time the shutter button is pressed, the pictures are recorded with different exposure settings based on the Exposure Compensation range. [Aspect Bracket]* When the shutter button is pressed, 4 pictures with 4 different aspect ratios are automatically recorded. (→147) [Self Timer] (→148) When the shutter button is pressed, recording takes place after the set time has elapsed. [Panorama Shot]* (→150) The pictures are recorded in succession while you press the shutter button and move the camera horizontally or vertically, and then the camera combines the pictures into a single panorama picture. * Cannot be set when using [Intelligent Auto] Mode. ••To cancel drive mode, select [   ] ([Single]) or [   ]. The recording is switched to “Single”. ••When you press , you can change the settings of each drive mode. Note, however, that you cannot change the settings of [Single] and [Aspect Bracket]. 141 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Burst function Recording mode: The pictures are recorded in succession while the shutter button is pressed. ••Pictures that are taken while the [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] are recorded together as a single burst group (→201). 1 2 Press to select the burst icon ([  etc.) and press 3 Press to select the burst speed and press [MENU/SET] Press [   ] button (   ) [SH] (Super high speed)*1 Speed (pictures/ sec.) [H] (High speed) [M] (Middle speed) [L] (Low speed) [AFS] 40 11 7 2 [AFF] / [AFC] ― 6.5 6.5 2 None None Available Available With RAW files ― 20*3 20*3 20*3 Without RAW files 60 Live View during burst recording No. of pictures*2  ], Depends on the capacity of the card*3 *1 The electronic shutter will be activated. *2 The number of burst pictures is limited by the picture-taking conditions and the type and/or status of the card used. *3 Pictures can be taken until the card becomes full. However, the burst speed will become slower halfway through the recording. The exact time when the slower burst speed will start depends on the settings of the aspect ratio, picture size, and quality as well as the type of card used. ••The burst speed may become slower depending on the following settings: –– [Picture Size] (→108), [Quality] (→109), Sensitivity (→136), Focus mode (→114), [Focus/Release Priority] (→125) ••Burst speed can also be set with [Burst Rate] in the [Rec] menu. ••For information about RAW files, refer to (→109). 142 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Burst function 4 Focus on the subject and take a picture ••Hold down the shutter button fully to activate the Burst Mode. ■■To cancel burst In step 2, select [   ] ([Single]) or [  50i  ]. Focusing in burst mode Focusing varies depending on the focus mode (→114) and the setting of [Focus/Release Priority] (→125) in the [Custom] menu. Focus mode [AFS] [AFF] / [AFC]*1 [MF] [Focus/Release Priority] [FOCUS] [RELEASE] [FOCUS] Focus At the first picture Normal focusing*2 [RELEASE] Predicted focusing*3 — Focus set with Manual Focus *1 Focus is fixed in the first picture when dark subjects are recorded or the burst speed is set to [SH]. *2 Since the camera records a burst of pictures while it adjusts the focus, the burst speed may be slower. *3 The camera predicts the focus within a possible range by giving higher priority to the burst speed. 143 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Burst function ●●When the burst speed is set to [H] and if many burst pictures are taken, the burst speed may be reduced while burst pictures are being taken. ●●When the burst speed is set to [SH] or [H] (the focus mode is set to [AFS] or [MF]), and the exposure and White Balance are fixed to those of the first picture. When the burst speed is set to [H] (the focus mode is set to [AFF] or [AFC]), [M], or [L], and the exposure and White Balance are adjusted individually for each still picture. ●●Burst speed may be reduced if shutter speed (pictures/sec.) is reduced in darker locations. ●●With repeated recordings, it may take a while between recordings, depending on the usage conditions. ●●It may take a while to store still pictures that were taken using the burst function. If you continue to record while storing, the number of burst pictures that can be taken will be reduced. A high-speed card is recommended when recording using the burst function. Not available in the following cases: ●●The Burst Mode is disabled in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine]) •• When White Balance Bracket is set •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) •• During motion picture recording •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] •• When recording using the flash •• During T (time) recording •• When recording with [iHandheld Night Shot] •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] ●●[SH] in Burst Mode cannot be used In the following cases:  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When [Quality] is set to [  •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] 144 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Recording while exposure is changed automatically [Auto Bracket] Recording mode: Each time the shutter button is pressed, recordings are made of up to 7 pictures with different exposure settings based on the Exposure Compensation range. Example of Auto Bracket recording when [Step] is set to [3·1/3] and [Sequence] is set to [0/–/+] 1st picture 2nd picture 3rd picture ±0 EV –1/3 EV 1 2 Press [  3 Press to select the compensation range and press [MENU/SET] 4 Focus on the subject and take a picture Press to select the Auto Bracket icon ([   ], etc.) and press 50i ••If you press and hold the shutter button, a burst of pictures can be recorded. ••The display of Auto Bracket flashes until all of the burst pictures you have set are recorded. ••The camera restarts recording from the first still picture if you change the Auto Bracket settings or turn off the camera before all of the burst pictures you have set are recorded. ■■To cancel [Auto Bracket] In step 2, select [   ] ([Single]) or [  145 +1/3 EV  ] button (   )  ]. SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Recording while exposure is changed automatically [Auto Bracket] ■■Changing the Single/Burst setting, compensation range, and recording sequence of Auto Bracket Set the menu → [Rec] → [Auto Bracket] Press to select [Single/Burst Settings], [Step] or [Sequence] and press [MENU/SET] Press to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] [Single/Burst Settings] (single) (burst) 3·1/3 3·2/3 3·1 5·1/3 [Step] 5·2/3 5·1 7·1/3 7·2/3 7·1 (3 pictures) (3 pictures) (3 pictures) (5 pictures) (5 pictures) (5 pictures) (7 pictures) (7 pictures) (7 pictures) [Sequence] •• You can take one picture at a time when [   ] is set. •• A burst of pictures can be recorded up to the number of pictures you have set when [  •• Close the menu after changing settings. 0/–/+ –/0/+  ] is set. ●●When you take pictures using Auto Bracket after performing Exposure Compensation, the camera will take pictures using the corrected exposure value as a reference. Not available in the following cases: ●●The [Auto Bracket] is disabled in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine]) •• When White Balance Bracket is set •• During motion picture recording •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] •• When recording using the flash •• During T (time) recording •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) •• When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] 146 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Automatically changing the aspect ratio while taking pictures [Aspect Bracket] Recording mode: When you press the shutter button once, the camera automatically takes four pictures with four types of aspect ratios (4:3, 3:2, 16:9, and 1:1). (The shutter sounds only once.) 1 2 Press [   ] button (   ) Press to select the aspect bracket icon ([   ]) and press [MENU/SET] The range that can be recorded for each aspect ratio is displayed. 3 Focus on the subject and take a picture ■■To cancel aspect bracket In step 2, select [   ] ([Single]) or [   ]. ●●When [Picture Size] is set to [S], the setting is automatically changed to [M]. ●●The same shutter speed, aperture value, focus, [Exposure], [White Balance], and [Sensitivity] settings are used for all four pictures. Not available in the following cases: ●●The [Aspect Bracket] is disabled in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine]) •• During motion picture recording •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] •• During T (time) recording •• When White Balance Bracket is set  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When [Quality] is set to [  •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] 147 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Taking pictures with self-timer Recording mode: We recommend using a tripod. This is also effective for preventing jitter when pressing the shutter button, by setting the self-timer to 2 seconds. 1 2 Press [  3 Press to select the self-timer operation setting and press [MENU/SET]  ] button (   ) Press to select the self-timer icon ([   ], etc.) and press The shutter is activated after 10 seconds. The shutter is activated after 10 seconds and three pictures are taken at intervals of approximately 2 seconds. The shutter is activated after 2 seconds. ••You can also set the time for the self-timer using [Self Timer] in the [Rec] menu. 4 Press the shutter button halfway to focus, then press it fully to start recording ••The focus and exposure are fixed when the shutter button is pressed halfway. ••After the self-timer indicator flashes, recording will start. ■■To cancel self-timer In step 2, select [   ] ([Single]) or [   ]. ••You can cancel the self-timer by turning off the camera. (When [Self Timer Auto Off] (→50) is set to [ON].) 148 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Taking pictures with self-timer ●●If you take a picture with a flash when [  cases.  ] is set, the flash output may not be stable in some Not available in the following cases: ●●It cannot be set to [   ] in the following cases: •• When White Balance Bracket is set •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• During T (time) recording ●●Self-timer is disabled in the following cases: •• During motion picture recording •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only available with [Auto Shooting] setting) 149 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Recording panorama pictures Recording mode: You can easily record a panorama picture by panning the camera towards the direction you want to record, and automatically combining the burst of pictures taken during that time. 1 2 3 Press [   ] button (   ) Press to select the panorama icon ([  and press  ], etc.) Press to select the recording direction and then press [MENU/SET] Left → Right Right → Left Down → Up Up → Down A horizontal guide line is displayed. A vertical guide line is displayed. ••You can also select the recording direction using [Panorama Direction] in the [Rec] menu. Applying a picture effect (Filter) Press the [FILTER] button to select a picture effect (→89) Recording direction Picture effects (This is not displayed when [No Effect] is selected.) Adjusting the picture effect (This is displayed only when a picture effect is selected.) •• You can also set the picture effects by turning the control ring. •• [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect], and [Sunshine] are not available. •• When recording panorama pictures, the following effects are not applied to the recording screen. –– [Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter] Press [MENU/SET] 4 150 Press the shutter button halfway to focus SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Recording panorama pictures 5 Press the shutter button fully and pan the camera in a small circular motion to the recording direction to start recording Taking pictures from left to right 2 sec. 1 sec. Recording direction and progress status (approximate) 3 sec. 4 sec. ••Pan the camera at a constant speed. ••You may not be able to take pictures successfully if you move the camera too quickly or too slowly. 6 Press the shutter button fully again to end recording ••You can also end recording if you stop panning the camera while taking pictures. ••Recording can also be ended by moving the camera to the end of the guide. Tips ●●Pan the camera in the recording direction as steadily as possible. If the camera shakes too much, it may not be able to take pictures or may end up creating a narrow (small) panorama picture. Pan the camera to a point slightly ahead of the point that you want to take. (However, the last frame is not recorded to the end.) 151 SQW0024 Shutter and Drive Settings Recording panorama pictures ■■About panorama picture playback Panorama pictures can be enlarged by operating the zoom lever the same way as with other still pictures. If you play back panorama pictures in the same way as playing back a motion picture, the panorama pictures are scrolled automatically. (→70) ••Unlike motion picture playback, you cannot perform fast forward or fast rewind while the panorama pictures are scrolling automatically. (You can perform single-frame forward or rewind while the automatic scrolling operation is paused.) ■■To cancel In step 2, select [   ] ([Single]) or [   ]. ●●The zoom position is fixed to the W end. ●●[Stabilizer] does not work when it is set to [   ] (Normal). ●●Since the aperture value and shutter speed are automatically controlled during panorama picture recording, settings made by the aperture ring or shutter speed dial are disabled. ●●The focus, exposure and White Balance are all fixed to optimal values for the first picture. If the focusing or brightness of pictures recorded as part of a panorama picture after the first picture are significantly different from those of the first picture, the panorama picture as a whole (when all pictures are stitched together) may not have consistent focus and brightness. ●●When the picture effect (Filter) is set, [White Balance] is fixed to [AWB]. ●●Since several pictures are stitched together to create a panorama picture, some subjects may be distorted or the joining portions of successively taken pictures that are stitched may be noticeable. ●●The number of recording pixels per horizontal line and vertical line of a panorama picture varies depending on the recording direction and number of stitched pictures. The maximum number of recording pixels is as follows: •• Taking pictures in landscape orientation: Approx. 8176×1920 •• Taking pictures in portrait orientation: Approx. 2560×7680 ●●[Shutter Type] is fixed to [AUTO]. Not available in the following cases: ●●You cannot record a panorama picture in the following cases. •• When White Balance Bracket is set  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When [Quality] is set to [  •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• During T (time) recording •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] •• When [Silent Mode] is set •• When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] •• When [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] ●●Panorama pictures may not be created or pictures may not be recorded properly when taking pictures of the following subjects or when taking pictures in the following recording conditions: •• Subjects that have a continuous monotone or pattern (sky, beach, etc.) •• Moving subjects (person, pet, vehicle, waves, or flowers swaying in the wind, etc.) •• Subjects whose colours or patterns change quickly (such as an image appearing on a display) •• Dark locations •• Locations with a flickering light source (fluorescent lamp, candle light, etc.) 152 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot] Recording mode: You can preset data such as recording start time and time lapse to take still pictures automatically. This setting is convenient for taking pictures at constant intervals for landscape scenes, observation of the gradual changes in animals/plants, and other applications. The pictures are recorded as a single group picture (→201). When [Time Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu is used, you can create a motion picture. (→215) ••Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→29) 1 Set the menu 2 Press to select the item and press [MENU/SET] → [Start Time] [Rec] → [Time Lapse Shot] [Now] Starts the recording by fully-pressing the shutter button. [Start Time Set the time to start recording. Any time up to 23 hours Set] 59 minutes ahead can be set. Press to select the item (hour and/or minute), and to set the start time, and then press [MENU/SET] [Shooting Interval] / [Image Count] The recording interval and the number of pictures can be set.  : Select the item (minute/second/number of pictures)  : Setting [MENU/SET]: Set •• You can set the interval from 1 second to 99 minutes 59 seconds in 1-second intervals. •• You can set the number of pictures to be recorded from 1 picture to 9,999 pictures. •• Be sure to use an interval setting that is longer than the exposure time (shutter speed) . (Illustration below) If the interval setting is shorter than the exposure time (shutter speed) (e.g. recording at night), it may cause the recording to skip. First 3 153 Press Second Third to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET] SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot] 4 Press the shutter button fully 5 Select the motion picture creation method 6 154 ••The recording starts automatically. ••During recording standby, the camera turns off automatically when no operation is performed for a preset interval. The [Time Lapse Shot] recording will continue even if the camera is turned off, and the camera is automatically turned on at the recording start time. If you want to turn on the camera manually, press the shutter button halfway. ••When you press the [Fn2] button while the camera is turned on, the pause or end selection screen will appear. Perform the operation based on the instructions on the screen. When you press the [Fn2] button while the camera is in the pause state, the restart or end selection screen will appear. You can also restart the operation from the pause state by fully pressing the shutter button. ••When a confirmation screen for continuing the creation of a motion picture is displayed, select [Yes]. ••[Rec Format]: [MP4] [Rec Quality] Sets the picture quality of the motion picture. [4K/25p] / [4K/24p] / [FHD/50p] / [FHD/25p] / [HD/25p] / [VGA/25p] [Frame Rate] Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you can create a more seamless stop motion animation. [50fps]* / [25fps] / [12.5fps] / [8.3fps] / [6.25fps] / [5fps] / [2.5fps] / [1fps] * Only available with [FHD/50p] setting •• You can set the number of frames to [24fps], [12fps], [8fps], [6fps], [4.8fps], [2.4fps], or [1fps] when [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/24p]. [Sequence] [NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence. [REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording. Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET] ••A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ••You can also create a motion picture using [Time Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu. (→215) SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot] ●●This function is not intended for application-specific systems (monitoring cameras). ●●If you leave the camera unattended during [Time Lapse Shot] recording, make sure that the camera is not stolen. ●●Exercise caution when you perform [Time Lapse Shot] recording for a long period of time in cold regions or in a low-temperature or high-temperature/high-humidity environment, since such use could cause malfunctions. ●●The camera may not be able to record using the preset interval and number of pictures to be recorded under some recording conditions. ●●If the recording time is longer than the preset interval due to a long exposure, this may cause the recording to skip. ●●Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). ●●[Time Lapse Shot] is paused in the following cases: •• When the remaining battery power runs out •• Turning the camera off If this occurs during [Time Lapse Shot] recording, you can restart the operation by replacing the battery or card in the pause state and turning the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [ON]. (Note, however, that the pictures recorded after restarting the operation are saved as another group picture.) When you replace the battery or card, turn the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [OFF]. ●●Do not connect the AV cable (optional), HDMI micro cable or USB connection cable (supplied) during [Time Lapse Shot] recording. ●●When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, the picture will be displayed with a black band on the upper/lower side or the left/right side of a stop motion animation. ●●If the power supply is cut off due to a power outage or AC adaptor disconnection while a motion picture is being recorded using the AC adaptor (optional), that motion picture will not be recorded. ●●You cannot create a motion picture that is longer than 29 minutes 59 seconds, or whose file exceeds 4 GB. ●●When a stop motion animation is shorter than 2 seconds, “2s” will be displayed for the motion picture recording time (→70). ●●When the number of recorded pictures is one, it will not be saved as a group picture. Not available in the following cases: ●●[Time Lapse Shot] cannot be used In the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] •• When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] 155 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation] Recording mode: You can stitch still pictures to create stop motion animation. ••Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→29) ••Still pictures that were captured using frame-by-frame recording are grouped into a single group picture. (→201) Before creating stop motion animation When you use [Stop Motion Animation] to record still pictures by moving a subject such as a doll little by little and then stitching those pictures, you can create a stop motion animation as if the subject is moving. ●●To create stop motion animation using this camera, it is necessary to record 1 to 50 frames of still pictures for every 1 second of motion picture. ●●To produce smooth movement of the subject, record the motion using as many frames as possible and set a higher number of frames per second (frame rate) when you create a stop motion animation. 1 Set the menu 2 Press to select the recording method, and press [MENU/SET] → [Rec] → [Stop Motion Animation] [Auto Shooting] [ON] Takes pictures automatically at a set recording interval. When the shutter button is pressed fully, recording starts. [OFF] Takes pictures manually, one frame at a time. [Shooting Interval] (Available only when [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON]) Set the interval used for [Auto Shooting]. You can set the interval from 1 second to 60 seconds in 1-second intervals. Press to select the interval (seconds), press selected time, and then press [MENU/SET] 156 to set the SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation] 3 4 5 6 Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET] Press to select [New] and press [MENU/SET] Press the shutter button fully ••Up to 9,999 frames can be recorded. Move the subject to decide on the composition ••Repeat the recording of still pictures in the same way. ••When you turn off the camera during recording, a message to restart recording will appear when you turn on the camera. To start recording from the next still picture, select [Yes]. How to create stop motion animation effectively ●●Up to two previously recorded pictures are displayed on the recording screen. Check this screen as a guideline for determining the amount of required motion. ●●You can press the Playback button to check the recorded pictures. Press the [   ] button to delete unnecessary pictures. To return to the recording screen, press the Playback button again. 7 Press [MENU/SET] to end recording. Next, select [Stop Motion Animation] in the [Rec] menu and then press [MENU/SET] again ••A confirmation screen is displayed. It is ended when [Yes] is selected. ••A confirmation screen for creating a motion picture is displayed next, so select [Yes]. 8 157 Select a method to create a stop motion animation ••[Rec Format]: [MP4] [Rec Quality] Sets the picture quality of the motion picture. [4K/25p] / [4K/24p] / [FHD/50p] / [FHD/25p] / [HD/25p] / [VGA/25p] [Frame Rate] Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you can create a more seamless stop motion animation. [50fps]* / [25fps] / [12.5fps] / [8.3fps] / [6.25fps] / [5fps] / [2.5fps] / [1fps] * Only available with [FHD/50p] setting •• You can set the number of frames to [24fps], [12fps], [8fps], [6fps], [4.8fps], [2.4fps], or [1fps] when [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/24p]. [Sequence] [NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence. [REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording. SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation] 9 Press to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET] ••A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ••You can also create a stop motion animation using [Stop Motion Video] in the [Playback] menu. (→215) ■■Adding pictures to an already recorded stop motion animation group When you select [Additional] in step 4, group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion Animation] are displayed. Select a group picture and press [MENU/SET]. Then, select [Yes] on the confirmation screen. ●●[Auto Shooting] may not be performed according to the preset interval because recording could take time under some recording conditions, such as when pictures are taken using a flash. ●●When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, the picture will be displayed with a black band on the upper/lower side or the left/right side of a stop motion animation. ●●When you select the picture quality for an aspect ratio that is different from the original picture, this will produce grainy pictures in a stop motion animation. ●●Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). ●●If the power supply is cut off due to a power outage or AC adaptor disconnection while a motion picture is being recorded using the AC adaptor (optional), that motion picture will not be recorded. ●●You cannot create a motion picture that is longer than 29 minutes 59 seconds, or whose file exceeds 4 GB. ●●When a stop motion animation is shorter than 2 seconds, “2s” will be displayed for the motion picture recording time (→70). ●●If only one still picture is recorded, it will not be recorded as a group picture. You cannot select only one recorded still picture using [Additional]. Not available in the following cases: ●●[Stop Motion Animation] cannot be used in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When the [Simultaneous record w/o filter] is set to [ON] 158 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Performing multiple exposures for a single picture [Multi Exp.] Recording mode: You can create an effect similar to the operation of up to four times of exposure on a single picture. 1 Set the menu 2 Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET] 3 Decide on your composition and take the first picture → [Rec] → [Multi Exp.] ••After recording the first picture, press the shutter button halfway to proceed to the next recording. ••Press to select the item and then press [MENU/ SET]. You can perform the following operations. –– [Next]: Proceed to the next recording. –– [Retake]: Delete the result of the last shot and take another picture. –– [Exit]: E  xit Multi Exposure and save the picture that was taken. 4 Exit Record the second, third, and fourth pictures ••When you press [Fn1] button while taking pictures, the pictures that you took are saved and Multi Exposure is closed. 5 Next Retake Press to select [Exit] and press [MENU/SET] Retake Exit ••You can also end the operation by pressing the shutter button halfway. 159 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Performing multiple exposures for a single picture [Multi Exp.] ■■About the automatic gain compensation setting Select [Auto Gain] on the screen in step 2 (→159). ••[ON]: Combines several pictures into one by automatically adjusting the brightness in accordance with the number of pictures taken. ••[OFF]: Combines several pictures into one by simply overlapping the exposure results of all pictures, as is. Perform the Exposure Compensation based on the requirements of a subject. ■■To overlay the pictures on the RAW file picture in a card Set [Overlay] to [ON] on the screen in step 2 (→159). After selecting [Start], the pictures on a card will be displayed. Select the RAW file pictures and press [MENU/ SET] to continue recording. ••You can perform [Overlay] on RAW file pictures recorded using this camera only. ●●Pictures are not saved in memory until Multi Exposure is ended. ●●Information for the picture taken last will be used as recording information of pictures taken using Multi Exposure. ●●While [Multi Exp.] recording is being performed, you cannot set items displayed in grey on the menu screen. Not available in the following cases: ●●[Multi Exp.] cannot be used in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set •• During panorama picture recording •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] 160 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time [Silent Mode] Recording mode: This mode is useful when you are taking pictures in a quiet environment or public facilities or when you take pictures of a subject such as a baby or animal. 1 Set the menu → [Custom] → [Silent Mode] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] ••This mode will mute beeps, set the flash to [Forced Flash Off], and disable AF Assist Lamp. The settings for the following functions are fixed: –– [Shutter Type]: [ESHTR] –– [Flash Mode]: [   ] (Forced Flash Off) –– [AF Assist Lamp]: [OFF] –– [Beep Volume]: [   ] (Off) –– [Shutter Vol.]: [   ] (Off) ●●Even when this mode is set to [ON], the following lamps/indicators will light or flash. •• Self-timer indicator •• Wi-Fi connection lamp ●●The operation sounds of this camera such as the lens aperture sound are not muted. ●●Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, likeness rights, etc. of a subject when you use this function. Use at your own risk. 161 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.] Recording mode: The Face Recognition function recognises a face similar to a registered face and automatically adjusts focus and exposure for the face with higher priority. Even if a person you want to focus on is standing at the back or corner in a group photo, the camera will automatically recognise the person and record this person’s face clearly. 1 Set the menu → [Rec] → [Face Recog.] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] / [MEMORY] Default [Face Recog.] setting is [OFF]. When the face pictures are registered, the setting will be [ON] automatically. ■■How the Face Recognition function works During recording ••The camera recognises a registered face and adjusts focus and exposure. ••When registered faces that have set names are recognised, the names are displayed (max. 3 people). During playback ••The name and age are displayed (if information is registered). ••The names that have been set for the recognised faces are displayed (max. 3 people). ••Only pictures of the selected registered people are played back ([Category Play]). ●●[Face Recog.] functions only when Auto Focus mode is set to [   ]. ●●Only the first picture of the burst recording will contain Face Recognition information. ●●The name of the person recognised in the first picture is displayed in the case of group pictures. ●●Face Recognition searches for faces similar to those registered, but there is no guarantee it will always recognise these faces. In some cases, the camera cannot recognise or incorrectly recognises even registered people depending on their expression or the environment. ●●Even if Face Recognition information is registered, pictures recorded when the name is [OFF] are not categorised for Face Recognition in [Category Play]. ●●Even if Face Recognition information is changed, Face Recognition information for previously recorded pictures is not changed. For example, if a name is changed, pictures recorded before the change are not categorised for Face Recognition in [Category Play]. ●●To change name information for pictures already recorded, perform a [REPLACE] (→222) in [Face Rec Edit]. 162 SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.] Not available in the following cases: ●●[Face Recog.] cannot be set in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect]) •• During motion picture recording •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] Registering face pictures Up to 6 people’s face pictures can be registered along with such information as name and birthdate. Good example for registering ■■Recording tips when registering face pictures ••Make sure the subject’s eyes are open and mouth closed; a face have the subject face the camera directly, and make sure the outline of the face, the eyes and eyebrows are not hidden by hair. ••Make sure there are no heavy shadows on the face. (During registration, the flash is not used.) ■■If the camera seems to have difficulty recognising faces when recording ••Register additional pictures of the same person’s face, indoors and outdoors or with different expressions or angles. ••Register additional pictures at the place you are recording. ••If a registered person is no longer recognised, re-register that person. 1 2 Use to select [MEMORY] and then press [MENU/SET] Use to select [New] and then press [MENU/SET] •• If 6 people are already registered, first delete a registered person. (→164) 3 163 1 New 2 3 5 6 KEN 4 Align the face with the guide and record •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• Faces of subjects other than people (e.g. pets) cannot be registered. •• When is pressed, an explanation is displayed. SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Recording with the Face Recognition function [Face Recog.] 4 Use to select the item for editing and press [MENU/SET] [Name] Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET] Enter the name (See “Entering Text”: (→52)) [Age] Set the birthdate. Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET] Use to select year, month and day, set with [MENU/SET] [Add Images] , and press Up to 3 face pictures of the person can be registered. Use to select [Add] and press [MENU/SET] •• If only one picture is registered, you can skip the cursor button operation. Just press [MENU/SET] to register an additional face picture. •• When a registered face picture is selected with cursor button, a screen to confirm deletion is displayed. Select [Yes] to delete the face picture. (If only one picture is registered, it cannot be deleted.) Record the picture (step 3 (→163)) Editing or deleting information about registered persons Information about registered people can be edited or deleted. 1 Use to select [MEMORY] and then press [MENU/SET] 2 3 Use to select the picture of the person to be edited or deleted and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] [Info Edit] 164 Edit name or other registered information. (Step 4 above) [Priority] Set priority order for focus and exposure. Use to select the registration order and press [MENU/SET] [Delete] Delete information and face pictures of registered persons. •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Setting the profile for a baby or pet to record in a picture Recording mode: You can set a name or birthday of a baby or pet before taking a picture to record the name or age in months/years in the picture. ■■Setting the name and age in months/years Set the menu → [Rec] → [Profile Setup] Settings: [   ] ([Baby1]) / [   ] ([Baby2]) / [   ] ([Pet]) / [OFF] / [SET] Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET] Use to select [Baby1], [Baby2] or [Pet] and then press [MENU/SET] Use to select [Age] or [Name] and then press [MENU/SET] Use to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET] Age: Set birthday with , and press [MENU/SET] Name: (See “Entering Text”: (→52)) Use to select [Exit] and then press [MENU/SET] to finish ■■Cancelling the display of the name and age in months/years Select [OFF] in step . ●●[Age] and [Name] print setting can be made on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the supplied DVD. Text may also be stamped onto the still picture using [Text Stamp]. Not available in the following case: ●●You cannot record the name or age in months/years in still pictures that are taken while recording motion pictures ([  165  ] (motion picture priorities)) (→198). SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Displaying the appropriate screen for specific recording conditions Checking the area where overexposure may occur ([Zebra Pattern]) Recording mode: You can check the area in a picture that is brighter than a certain brightness, which could result in overexposure, by displaying such an area using a zebra pattern. You can also set the brightness to be represented by the zebra pattern. → [Custom] → [Zebra Pattern] [ZEBRA1] Displays an area brighter than a certain brightness using a right-leaning zebra pattern. [ZEBRA2] Displays an area brighter than a certain brightness using a left-leaning zebra pattern. [OFF] — Sets the brightness to be displayed for each zebra pattern. [Zebra 1] / [Zebra 2] [SET] 166 1 Use to select the brightness and then press [MENU/SET] •• The range of brightness you can select from is [50%] to [105%]. The [OFF] setting is available for [Zebra 2]. When [100%] or [105%] is selected, only the overexposed areas are displayed with the zebra pattern. When a smaller numeric value is set, the range of brightness to be displayed by each zebra pattern will increase. SQW0024 Functions for specific subjects and purposes Displaying the appropriate screen for specific recording conditions ●●If there is overexposure, we recommend taking pictures using a lower exposure value (→135), using the histogram (→64) as a guideline. ●●The displayed zebra pattern is not recorded. ●●If you set [Zebra Pattern] to [Fn Button Set] (→37) in the [Custom] menu, every time you press the assigned function button the setting will switch in the following order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra 2] → [Zebra OFF]. When [ZEBRA2] is set to [OFF], you can switch the setting quickly in the following order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra OFF]. Setting a monochrome display for the recording screen ([Monochrome Live View]) Recording mode: You can display the recording screen in black and white. This function is useful when a black and white screen will make it easier to adjust focus in Manual Focus mode. → [Custom] → [Monochrome Live View] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] ••This does not affect recorded pictures. 167 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Correcting jitter Recording mode: Automatically detects and prevents jitter. 1 Set the menu 2 Use → (Normal) [Rec] → [Stabilizer] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] Corrects vertical and horizontal jitter. (Panning) Corrects vertical jitter. This setting is ideal for panning (technique of recording a subject by matching the camera movement with the movement of a subject going in a specific direction). [OFF] [Stabilizer] does not work. To prevent jitter If a warning is displayed about jitter, use [Stabilizer], a tripod, or [Self Timer]. In some cases, jitter can be reduced by using a higher setting for [Sensitivity]. 168 Jitter alert display 50i SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Correcting jitter ●●When you use a tripod, we recommend setting [Stabilizer] to [OFF]. ●●To perform a panning by selecting [   ], we recommend taking pictures using the viewfinder. ●●Cases where the stabiliser function may be ineffective: •• When there is a lot of jitter •• When the zoom magnification is high (also in the Digital Zoom range) •• When taking pictures while following a moving subject •• When the shutter speed becomes slower to take pictures indoors or in dark places ●●The panning effect by selecting [   ] is not fully achieved in the following cases: •• Bright summer days or other bright locations •• When the shutter speed is higher than 1/100 seconds •• When the motion of a subject is slow and the speed with which the camera is moved is too slow (a nice background blur is not achieved) •• When the camera is not adequately tracking the motion of a subject Not available in the following case: ●●[Stabilizer] cannot be used by selecting [  169  ] (Normal) during panorama picture recording. SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom Recording mode: You can adjust the area of a picture to be taken using zoom. Zoom lever Move the zoom lever Control ring Turn the control ring* * You can perform zoom operation by assigning the [Zoom] setting to the control ring. (→40) T side : Telephoto, Enlarge the subject W side : Wide-angle, Capture a wider area Clockwise: Telephoto, Enlarge the subject Counterclockwise: Wide-angle, Capture a wider area The illustration is an example of when using Optical Zoom, [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] in [Program AE] Mode. Focus range Optical Zoom range i.Zoom range Digital Zoom range Current zoom position (Focal lengths the same as those of a 35 mm film camera) ●●Do not touch the lens barrel during zooming. ●●Adjust the focus after adjusting the zoom. ●●The zoom ratio and the zoom bar displayed on the screen are estimates. ●●The camera may make a rattling noise and vibrate when the zoom lever is operated - this is not a malfunction. 170 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom Zoom types and use The zoom ratio changes when the picture size is changed. Optical Zoom You can zoom in without degrading the picture quality. Maximum magnification: 3.1x Not available in the following case: •• During panorama picture recording Extra optical zoom This function works when picture sizes with [   ] have been selected in [Picture Size] (→108). Extra optical zoom allows you to zoom in using a higher zoom ratio than Optical Zoom, without degrading the picture quality. Maximum magnification: 6.2x (Including the optical zoom ratio. This maximum zoom ratio varies depending on the picture size.) Not available in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Toy Effect], [Toy Pop]) •• During panorama picture recording •• When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON] •• When [iHDR] is set to [ON]  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When the [Quality] setting is set to [  •• During motion picture recording 171 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom To increase the zoom ratio further, the following zoom can be used in combination. [i.Zoom] Recording mode: You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to increase the zoom ratio up to 2x higher than the original zoom ratio with limited deterioration of picture quality. → [Rec] → [i.Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF] → [Motion Picture] → [i.Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF] Not available in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop]) •• During panorama picture recording •• When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set •• When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON] •• When [iHDR] is set to [ON]  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When the [Quality] setting is set to [  172 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom [Digital Zoom] Recording mode: Zoom 4x further than Optical/Extra optical zoom. Note that, with Digital Zoom, enlarging will decrease picture quality. → [Rec] → [Digital Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF] → [Motion Picture] → [Digital Zoom] → [ON] / [OFF] ●●When [Digital Zoom] is used simultaneously with [i.Zoom], you can only increase the zoom ratio up to 2x. ●●When using [Digital Zoom], we recommend using a tripod and the self-timer (→148) for taking pictures. ●●The AF area is largely displayed at the centre in the Digital Zoom range. Not available in the following cases: •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect]) •• During panorama picture recording •• When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH] •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Multi Exp.] is set  ], [   ] or [   ] •• When the [Quality] setting is set to [  173 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom [Step Zoom] Recording mode: You can set the zoom operation to allow easy visualisation of the angle of view (picture angle) for the focal length of a regular fixed focal length lens (as with a 35 mm film camera). When using the [Step Zoom], you can operate the zoom ratio as easily as changing the camera lens. 1 Turn the control ring (→39) Current zoom position (Focal lengths the same as those of a 35 mm film camera) ■■Using the zoom lever for [Step Zoom] You can use the zoom lever for [Step Zoom] by setting [Zoom lever] to [Step Zoom] in the [Custom] menu. ●●The focal length values are for reference only. Not available in the following case: •• During motion picture recording 174 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Using Zoom Changing the zoom operation settings → [Custom] → [Zoom lever] → [Custom] → [Control Ring] Zoom Step Zoom The zoom operates in the normal way. Each time zoom is operated, the zoom stops at the position for one of the preset focal lengths. Retaining the zoom position when the camera is turned off → 175 [Custom] → [Zoom Resume] → [ON] / [OFF] SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Recording mode: When the flash (supplied) is attached, you can use all flash modes ([MANUAL] setting, etc.) available for this unit. (Note, however, that this flash cannot be used as a wireless flash unit.) This section describes how to take a picture using the flash (supplied). ••For details on how to take a picture using the external flash (optional), refer to (→291). With the flash you can take pictures in dark places or adjust the entire contrast of a picture by illuminating a subject with a bright background. Attaching the flash The hot shoe cover is already attached to the hot shoe at the time of purchase. Attach the flash to the hot shoe after removing the hot shoe cover. Removing the hot shoe cover ••Make sure that the Camera [ON/OFF] switch is set to [OFF]. 1 Remove the hot shoe cover by pulling it in the direction indicated by arrow while pressing it in the direction indicated by arrow •• Be sure to attach the hot shoe cover when the hot shoe is not in use. •• Keep the hot shoe cover safely after removing it so that you do not lose it. Attaching the flash 1 2 Turn off the flash Hot shoe Firmly insert the flash into the hot shoe of this unit until it clicks •• Set the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [ON] and turn on the flash when you take a picture. Flash [ON/OFF] switch ●●Keep the hot shoe cover out of reach of children to prevent swallowing. ●●Do not carry the camera holding by the flash when the flash is mounted on the camera. 176 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) ■■Removing the flash Turn off the camera and the flash Press and hold the lock release button and pull the flash in the direction indicated by the arrow to detach the flash Lock release button •• When detaching the flash, do so slowly and carefully. •• Attach the hot shoe cover to the hot shoe of the camera. •• Store the detached flash in its soft case. About [Forced Flash Off] ([   ]) [   ] (Forced Flash Off) will appear on the recording screen and the flash will not fire in the following cases. Communication light emission with a wireless flash is also disabled. (→184) ••When the flash is not attached to the camera ••When the flash [ON/OFF] switch is set to [OFF] even if the flash is attached ••When the flash cannot be used to take pictures, for example, when recording motion pictures ■■The available flash range when [Sensitivity] setting is [AUTO] Edges of picture may become slightly dark if using flash at short distances without using zoom (close to max. W). This may be remedied by using a little zoom. Max. Wide Approx. 60 cm - 14.1 m (1.97 feet - 46 feet)* Max. Tele Approx. 30 cm - 8.5 m (0.98 feet - 27.9 feet)* * When the flash (supplied) is attached and [ISO Limit Set] is [OFF]. 177 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) How to use the flash effectively Taking a picture using the flash with the subject too close may cause overexposure. When you set [Highlight] in the [Custom] menu to [ON], the overexposed areas will flash black and white during [Auto Review] or playback. If that happens, we recommend taking the picture again, for example, after setting a lower flash output using [Flash Adjust.] (→183). ●●Do not put your hands over the light-emitting area of the flash or look at it from close range. Do not use the flash at close distances to other subjects (heat/light may damage subject). ●●Flash charging may take time if battery is low or if using flash repeatedly. When the flash is being charged, the flash icon flashes red, and you cannot take a picture even when you fully press the shutter button. ●●The flash is fixed to [   ] (Forced Flash Off) in following cases: •• During motion picture recording •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set •• During panorama picture recording •• When using the electronic shutter •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON] 178 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Changing the firing mode (Manual flash) Recording mode: You can select whether the flash output is set automatically or manually. 1 Set the menu → 2 Use [Rec] → [Flash] → [Firing Mode] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] [TTL] The camera automatically sets the flash output. [MANUAL] You can set the flash ratio manually. Using [TTL] allows you to take a picture as intended, even for dark scenes where the flash output tends to be higher. ●●When [MANUAL] is selected, the flash ratio (e.g. [1/1]) is displayed with the flash icon on the screen. ■■Setting the flash ratio (When [MANUAL] is selected) Set the menu → [Rec] → [Flash] → [Manual Flash Adjust.] Press to select an item and press [MENU/SET] •• You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64] in 1/3 steps. 179 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Changing Flash Mode Recording mode: Set the flash to match the recording. 1 Set the menu → 2 Press [Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Mode] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] : [Forced Flash On] : [Forced On/Red-Eye]* : [Slow Sync.] : [Slow Sync./Red-Eye]* : [Forced Flash Off] Always takes pictures using the flash. •• Ideal for taking pictures with a backlight or when a subject is located under bright lighting such as a fluorescent light. Takes brighter pictures such as pictures of subjects against a nightscape by decreasing the shutter speed when firing a flash. •• Ideal for taking pictures of people against a nightscape. Always takes pictures without flash under all recording conditions. •• Ideal for taking pictures where the use of flash is prohibited. * This is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF] (→184) and [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL] (→179). Two flashes will be emitted. Do not move until after the second flash. Interval between flashes varies according to brightness of subject. •• The red-eye reduction effect varies depending on the subject and is affected by factors such as distance from the subject and whether the subject is looking at the camera during the preliminary flash. In some cases, red-eye reduction may be negligible. ■■Reducing red-eye Recording mode: Automatically detects red-eye and corrects still picture data when recording with flash red-eye reduction ([   ], [   ]). → [Rec] → [Red-Eye Removal] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] ●●When this function is set to [ON], the flash icon changes to [   ]/[   ]. Not available in the following case: ●●Depending on the circumstance, it may not be possible to correct red-eye. 180 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) ■■Shutter speeds for each flash mode Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds) Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds) 1/60*1 - 1/4000 1 - 1/16000 120*2 - 1/16000 *1 The shutter speed is set to 60 seconds in [Shutter-Priority] Mode and to T (time) in [Manual Exposure] Mode. *2 The shutter speed is set to T (time) in [Manual Exposure] Mode. ••In [Intelligent Auto] Mode, shutter speed changes depending on the identified scene. ■■Flash settings for each Recording Mode (When the flash (supplied) is attached) (○: Available, –: Not available) Recording Mode [Intelligent Auto] Mode –* –* –* –* ○ [Program AE] Mode ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ [Aperture-Priority] Mode ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ [Shutter-Priority] Mode ○ ○ – – ○ [Manual Exposure] Mode ○ ○ – – ○ * You cannot perform flash settings using the [Rec] menu. Set to [  depending on the subject and brightness.  ], [   ], [   ] or [   ] ●●Flash settings may be changed when changing Recording Mode. ●●Flash settings will be retained even if the camera is turned off. 181 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Setting the 2nd curtain sync Recording mode: 2nd curtain sync is a recording method in which the flash fires just before the shutter closes when you take a picture of a moving subject (such as a car) using the flash with a slow shutter speed. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Synchro] Press to select the setting item and press [MENU/SET] [1ST] 1st curtain sync is the normal recording method when using the flash. [2ND] The light source is captured in back of the subject and this produces a picture that is vibrant and lively. ●●Normally, set to [1ST]. ●●If you set to [2ND], [2nd] will be displayed in the flash icon on the screen. ●●[2ND] is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF]. (→184) ●●The [Flash Synchro] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied flash is used. (→291) ●●When a fast shutter speed is set, the [Flash Synchro] effect may not be sufficiently achieved. ●●When [2ND] is set, you cannot set the flash setting to [   ] or [   ]. 182 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Adjusting the flash output Recording mode: Adjust the flash output if a picture taken using the flash is too bright or too dark. 1 Set the menu → 2 Press [Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Adjust.] to set the flash output and press [MENU/SET] Settings: -3 EV to +3 EV (unit: 1/3 EV) When you do not want to adjust the intensity of the flash, select [±0 EV]. ●●When the intensity of the flash is adjusted, [+] or [-] is displayed on the flash icon. ●●[Flash Adjust.] is available only when [Wireless] in the [Flash] is set to [OFF] (→184) and [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL] (→179). ●●The [Flash Adjust.] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied flash is used. (→291) Synchronising the flash output with the camera during Exposure Compensation Recording mode: The flash output is automatically adjusted in accordance with the exposure compensation value. → [Rec] → [Flash] → [Auto Exposure Comp.] Settings: [ON] / [OFF] ●●About Exposure Compensation (→135) ●●The [Auto Exposure Comp.] setting functions even when an external flash other than the supplied flash is used. (→291) 183 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) Performing wireless flash settings Recording mode: When you use the flashes (optional: DMW-FL360L, DMW-FL580L) with the wireless flash recording function, you can separately control the firing of the flashes in three groups and of the flash attached to the hot shoe of the camera. Although the flash (supplied) is not equipped with the wireless flash recording function, it can be attached to the hot shoe of this unit and you can control the firing of the wireless flash. ■■Positioning the wireless flash Position the wireless flash with its wireless sensor facing the camera. The following illustration is an example of the range within which the flash can be positioned. The flash controllable range varies depending on the surrounding environment. Flash controllable range Example of positioning flashes (when a supplied flash is attached) 3 m (9.8 feet) 2m (6.6 feet) 3m (9.8 feet) 2m (6.6 feet) ••This flash positioning example shows a case where flash unit C is positioned in order to eliminate the shadows from the subject’s background, which is produced by flash unit A and flash unit B of the flash group. ••For the number of wireless flashes to be controlled, we recommend setting up to three flash units in each group. ••When a subject is too close, the communication light emission may affect the exposure of the picture. This problem can be mitigated if you decrease the flash output by setting [Communication Light] to [LOW] or using a flash diffuser or similar device. Preparation Attach a supplied flash or an optional flash (DMW-FL360L, DMW-FL580L) to this unit. 1 184 Set the wireless flash to RC mode and position the flash •• Select the channel and group of the wireless flash. SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) 2 Set the menu 3 Press 4 Press to select [Wireless Channel] and press [MENU/SET] Press to select the channel and press [MENU/SET] 5 6 7 → [Rec] → [Flash] → [Wireless] to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET] •• When [Wireless] is set to [ON], [WL] will appear with the flash icon on the recording screen. •• To perform detailed settings for the wireless flash, perform the following settings from the [Flash]. Firing Mode Flash output •• Select the same channel as the channel set for the wireless flash in step 1. Press to select [Wireless Setup] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] •• Press the [DISP.] button to perform a test firing. [External Flash] [A Group]/ [B Group]/ [C Group] Luminosity ratio [Firing Mode] [TTL]: The camera automatically sets the flash output. [AUTO]*: Sets the flash output using an external flash. [MANUAL]: Manually sets the flash ratio of an external flash. [OFF]: An external flash fires only for a communication light emission. [Flash Adjust.] Adjusts the flash output of an external flash manually when [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL]. [Manual Flash Adjust.] Sets the flash ratio of an external flash when [Firing Mode] is set to [MANUAL]. •• You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64] in 1/3 steps. [Firing Mode] [TTL]: The camera automatically sets the wireless flash output. [AUTO]: S  ets the flash output using the wireless flash. [MANUAL]: Manually sets the flash ratio of the wireless flash. [OFF]: The wireless flashes of the set group do not fire. [Flash Adjust.] Adjusts the flash output of the wireless flash manually when [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL]. [Manual Flash Adjust.] Sets the flash ratio of the wireless flash when [Firing Mode] is set to [MANUAL]. •• You can set the flash ratio from [1/1] (flash firing full power) to [1/64] in 1/3 steps. * When the flash (supplied) is attached to this unit, you cannot perform these settings. 185 SQW0024 Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash Taking pictures using the flash (supplied) ■■Setting the communication light emission to be used when wireless flash recording is performed → [Rec] → [Flash] → [Communication Light] Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW] 186 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures You can record full high-definition quality images that comply with the AVCHD standard, as well as motion pictures recorded in MP4. You can also record a 4K motion picture in MP4. (→194) Audio is recorded in stereo. Setting the format, picture size and recording frame rate Recording mode: 1 Set the menu 2 Use 3 4 187 → [Motion Picture] → [Rec Format] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] [AVCHD] This is a data format suitable for playback on high-definition TVs. [MP4] This data format is suited for playing back motion pictures on a computer and other such devices. Use to select [Rec Quality] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] •• Exit the menu after it is executed. SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures When [AVCHD] is selected Item [FHD/28M/50p]* Picture size Recording frame rate Sensor output Bit rate 1920×1080 50p 50 fps Approx. 28 Mbps [FHD/17M/50i] 1920×1080 50i 50 fps Approx. 17 Mbps [FHD/24M/25p] 1920×1080 50i 25 fps Approx. 24 Mbps [FHD/24M/24p] 1920×1080 24p 24 fps Approx. 24 Mbps * AVCHD Progressive When [MP4] is selected Picture size Recording frame rate Sensor output Bit rate [4K/100M/25p] Item 3840×2160 25p 25 fps Approx. 100 Mbps [4K/100M/24p] 3840×2160 24p 24 fps Approx. 100 Mbps [FHD/28M/50p] 1920×1080 50p 50 fps Approx. 28 Mbps [FHD/20M/25p] 1920×1080 25p 25 fps Approx. 20 Mbps [HD/10M/25p] 1280×720 25p 25 fps Approx. 10 Mbps [VGA/4M/25p] 640×480 25p 25 fps Approx. 4 Mbps ••What is bit rate Bit rate is the volume of data for a definite period of time, and the quality becomes higher when the number gets bigger. This unit uses the “VBR” recording method. “VBR” is an abbreviation of “Variable Bit Rate”, and the bit rate (volume of data for definite period of time) is changed automatically depending on the subject to record. Therefore, the recording time is shortened when a subject with fast movement is recorded. 188 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures ■■About the compatibility of the recorded motion pictures Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] or [MP4] may be played back with poor picture or sound quality or playback may not be possible even when played back with equipment compatible with these formats. Also, the recording information may not be displayed properly. In this case, use this unit. ••When you import and play back motion pictures recorded with [FHD/28M/50p], [FHD/24M/25p], or [FHD/24M/24p] in [AVCHD] using a device other than this unit, a compatible Blu-ray disc recorder or PC installed with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” is required. ••For details on motion pictures recorded with [4K/100M/25p] or [4K/100M/24p] in the [MP4] format, refer to “Enjoying 4K motion pictures” (→274). Adjusting the focus while recording motion pictures ([Continuous AF]) Recording mode: Focusing varies depending on the focus mode (→114) and the setting of [Continuous AF] in the [Motion Picture] menu. [Focus] [AFS]/[AFF]/ [AFC] [MF] [Continuous AF] Setting [ON] Allow the focus to be constantly adjusted automatically while recording motion pictures. (→114) [OFF] Fix focus position at the start of motion picture recording. [ON] / [OFF] Allow the focus to be adjusted manually. (→128) ••When the focus mode is set to [AFS], [AFF], or [AFC], the camera will refocus if the shutter button is pressed halfway while recording motion pictures. ••When Auto Focus is activated while you are recording motion pictures, the focusing operation sound may be recorded under some conditions. If you want to suppress this sound, we recommend taking pictures after setting [Continuous AF] to [OFF] in the [Motion Picture] menu. ••When using zoom while recording motion pictures, it may take some time to focus. 189 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Recording mode: You can record motion pictures by manually setting the aperture value and shutter speed. (→80) The camera automatically sets the aperture value and shutter speed and identifies the optimal scene to record motion pictures in [Intelligent Auto] Mode. (→76) 1 Press the motion picture button to start recording •• Immediately release the motion picture button after pressing it. •• While you are recording motion pictures, the recording status indicator (red) will flash. •• If you do not perform any operation for approximately 1 minute or longer, some of the information on the screen is turned off. To display the information again, press the [DISP.] button. This operation takes place to prevent screen burn-in. This is not a malfunction. •• Do not block the microphones when recording motion pictures. •• You can also use zoom while recording motion pictures. –– The operating sounds of the zoom lever or control ring may be recorded in some cases. •• Still pictures can be taken during motion picture recording. (→198) 2 Press the motion picture button again to end recording Recording state indicator Elapsed recording time Remaining recording time (approx.) 190 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures About the aperture value and shutter speed to be used for recording motion pictures ●●About aperture value ••To record motion pictures with a sharp focus on both subject and background, set the aperture value to a higher number. To record motion pictures with a defocused background, set a lower number. ●●About the shutter speed ••To record a sharp motion picture of a fast-moving subject, set a faster shutter speed. To record a motion picture with a trailing effect for a subject’s movements, set a slower shutter speed. ••When you set a faster shutter speed, the screen noise may increase due to the higher sensitivity. ••When you record a subject under fluorescent or LED lighting fixtures, etc., the colours and screen brightness may change or horizontal striping may appear on the screen. If this happens, we recommend manually adjusting the shutter speed to 1/60 seconds or 1/100 seconds. About operation sound when recording ends Since motion pictures are recorded until the motion picture button is pressed to stop recording, the operating sound level in the picture may be higher. To suppress this sound, we recommend trying the following method. ●●Divide the end part of a motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214) in the [Playback] menu. In some cases, motion pictures cannot be divided at a position close to the end part of the motion picture. To avoid this problem, continue recording for an extra 3 seconds. 191 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Enabling/disabling the motion picture button → [Custom] → [Video Button] → [ON] / [OFF] ●●This function prevents incorrect operation of the button. Switching the angle of view setting used for recording still pictures and motion pictures → [Custom] → [Rec Area] → (Picture) / (Motion picture) ●●If the aspect ratio is different for still pictures and motion pictures, the angle of view will change when starting to record a motion picture. When you set [Rec Area] to [   ], the angle of view setting used for recording motion pictures is displayed. ●●[Rec Area] should be interpreted as a guideline. 192 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures ●●If the surrounding temperature is high, or a motion picture is recorded continuously, [   ] is displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through to protect the camera. ●●If Extra optical zoom is used before pressing the motion picture button, these settings will be cleared, and the recordable area will be changed significantly. ●●Note that if you perform operations such as zoom, using buttons or dials, while recording a motion picture, operation noise may be recorded. ●●The zoom speed will be slower than normal during motion picture recording. ●●The available recording time displayed on the screen may not decrease regularly. ●●Depending on the type of the card, the card access indication may appear for a while after recording motion pictures. This is not a malfunction. ●●If you stop recording motion pictures too soon when you have set picture effect (Filter) of [Miniature Effect], the camera may continue recording for a certain time. Hold the camera until the camera stops recording. ●●[ISO Limit Set] is disabled when you are recording motion pictures. ●●Even if you set [Stabilizer] to [   ] (Panning) when you are recording motion pictures, it is fixed to [   ] (Normal). ●●It is recommended to use a fully charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) when recording motion pictures. (→292) ●●If while recording motion pictures using the AC adaptor and the power supply is cut off due to a power outage or if the AC adaptor is disconnected etc., the motion picture being recorded will not be recorded. Not available in the following cases: ●●Motion pictures cannot be recorded in the following cases: •• During panorama picture recording •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect]*, [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine]) * Only when recording motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K] •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] 193 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Recording 4K motion pictures Recording mode: You can record high-resolution 4K motion pictures by setting [Rec Quality] to [4K]. ••To record 4K motion pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25) ••When you record 4K motion pictures, the angle of view will be narrower than motion pictures of other sizes. ■■To record 4K motion pictures Select the recording mode (→59) Set the [Rec Format] in the [Motion Picture] menu to [MP4] (→187) Set [Rec Quality] in the [Motion Picture] menu to [4K/100M/25p] or [4K/100M/24p] (→188) Press the motion picture button to start recording Press the motion picture button again to end recording 194 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Creating a high-resolution still picture from a 4K motion picture [4K PHOTO] You can create a still picture with approximately 8 megapixel resolution from a 4K motion picture recorded by setting [4K PHOTO]. You can create a still picture that captures a moment, similar to high-speed burst recording. This setting is not available in [Intelligent Auto] Mode. Recording 4K motion pictures ••To record 4K motion pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25) 1 Set the menu → 2 Press [Motion Picture] → [4K PHOTO] to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET] A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• The appropriate motion picture mode for capturing a still picture from a 4K motion picture is selected and the motion picture can be recorded using still picture quality. •• Since the camera puts higher priority on the focus of a still picture captured from a 4K motion picture, focusing movement during motion picture recording may be noticeable. The camera will automatically perform the following setting items. Menu [Rec Format] [Rec Quality] 3 195 Press [  Item [MP4] [4K/100M/25p]  ] button to display the recording screen SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures 4 Turn the aperture ring and shutter speed dial to set the recording mode 5 Operate the aspect ratio selector switch to set the aspect ratio for a motion picture •• We recommend setting [Shutter-Priority] Mode and setting the shutter speed to 1/1000 seconds or higher to minimise subject blur. To record a subject that is moving quickly, set the shutter speed to 1/2000 seconds or higher. •• The aspect ratio of a still picture captured from a 4K motion picture is the same as the aspect ratio of the motion picture. 6 Press the motion picture button to start recording •• When you record 4K motion pictures, the angle of view will be narrower than motion pictures of other sizes. Setting a marker ●●When you press the [Fn2] button while recording, you can add a marker to the motion picture. ●●When you create still pictures from a motion picture, you can quickly move to a marker position you want to capture as a still picture. ●●You can add up to 40 markers in a single motion picture. 7 196 Press the motion picture button again to end recording •• Motion picture recording can also be started or finished by pressing the shutter button. SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Recording motion pictures Creating still pictures from a motion picture 1 Display the picture that you want to capture as a still picture by pressing to pause a motion picture being played back on the camera •• You can press to perform single-frame forward/rewind operations. , you can quickly •• When you press the [Fn2] button and press move to the marker position you set while recording the motion picture. (You can perform the same operation even during motion picture playback.) If you press the [Fn2] button again, you can perform single-frame . forward/rewind operations by pressing 2 Fn2 Press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. •• [   ] is displayed for a captured still picture. ●●If you want to capture a still picture from a motion picture while the camera is connected to a TV with the HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF]. 197 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Taking still pictures while a motion picture is being recorded Recording mode: Still pictures can be recorded even while a motion picture is being recorded. (Simultaneous recording) 1 Press the shutter button fully during the motion picture recording ••When you take a still picture, the simultaneous still/motion picture recording icon is displayed. Setting the motion picture priority or still picture priority mode Recording mode: You can use [Picture Mode] in the [Motion Picture] menu to set the recording method of a still picture to be taken while you record a motion picture. (motion picture priorities) (Still picture priorities) •• Takes a still picture using [Picture Size] [S] (2M). The picture quality may be different to [S] (2M) of standard pictures.  ], [   ], •• Only pictures in JPEG file format are recorded when [Quality] is set to [  or [   ]. ([Quality] is used with the [   ] setting when [   ] is set.) •• You can take up to 30 still pictures while you are recording a motion picture. •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set to [Miniature Effect], a still picture may be taken with a slight delay from the time you fully press the shutter button. •• A still picture is taken with [Picture Size] and [Quality] that you have set. •• While a still picture is being taken, the screen turns black. During this period, the still picture is taken in the motion picture and the audio is muted. •• You can take up to 4 still pictures while you are recording a motion picture. ●●The aspect ratio of a still picture is fixed to [16:9]. Not available in the following cases: ●●Still pictures cannot be recorded in the following cases: •• When [Rec Format] is set to [MP4], [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/100M/25p], [4K/100M/24p], or [VGA/4M/25p] •• When [Rec Format] is set to [AVCHD], [Rec Quality] is set to [FHD/24M/24p] (only available with [   ] ([Photo Priority]) setting) 198 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Using the [Motion Picture] menu For the setting procedures for the [Motion Picture] menu, refer to (→31). ••The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic], [i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. ••[Motion Picture] menu will not be displayed in the following cases: –– During panorama picture recording [4K PHOTO] ••For details (→195). [Rec Format] ••For details (→187). [Rec Quality] ••For details (→187). [Picture Mode] ••For details (→198). [Continuous AF] ••For details (→189). 199 SQW0024 Recording motion pictures Using the [Motion Picture] menu For the setting procedures for the [Motion Picture] menu, refer to (→31). [Mic Level Disp.] Recording mode: You can set whether or not to display the microphone level on the recording screen. Settings: [ON] / [OFF] Not available in the following case: ●●When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect]) [Mic Level Adj.] Recording mode: You can adjust the audio input level in 4 steps. Not available in the following case: ●●When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect]) [Wind Cut] Recording mode: If you hear wind noise during an audio recording, you can use [Wind Cut] to effectively reduce the wind noise. Settings: [AUTO] / [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW] / [OFF] ●●When [Wind Cut] is set, the sound quality may differ from that of normal recordings. Not available in the following case: ●●When the picture effect (Filter) is set ([Miniature Effect]) 200 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Viewing the group picture You can consecutively play back multiple pictures in a group or play back group pictures one by one.  ]: Group pictures recorded consecutively by setting [  [Burst Rate] to [SH] (→142) 15 pic. [   ]: Group pictures recorded using [Time Lapse Shot] (→153) [   ]: Group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion Animation] (→156) ••You can delete or edit pictures in group units. (For example, if you delete one of pictures in a group, all pictures in that group will be deleted.) Playing back group pictures consecutively 1 Select a picture with the group picture icon ([  and press  ], [   ], or [   ]), •• When you play back group pictures one by one, the option settings are displayed. [From the first picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the first picture in a group. [From the current picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the picture currently played back. ■■Operations during continuous playback 201 Continuous playback / Pause Stop Fast rewind playback Fast forward playback Returning to the previous picture (while paused) Scrolling to the next picture (while paused) SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Viewing the group picture Playing back group pictures one by one 1 Select a picture with the submenu icon ([  press 2 Use to select [Display In Group] and press [MENU/SET] 3 Use  ]), and •• The submenu screen will appear. Display In Group Upload(Wi-Fi) to scroll through the pictures •• When you use to select [Exit Display In Group] and press [MENU/SET] after pressing again, the normal playback screen reappears. •• You can use the same operations for pictures stored in a group as in normal still picture playback. (Multi Playback, Playback Zoom, deletion of pictures, etc.) ●●Pictures will not be grouped if they are recorded without setting [Clock Set]. ●●Burst pictures recorded on another device may not be recognised as group pictures. 202 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Capturing still pictures from motion pictures Save a scene from a motion picture as a still picture. ••For the method of capturing a still picture from a 4K motion picture recorded by setting [4K PHOTO] to [ON], refer to (→195). 1 Display the picture that you want to capture as a still picture by pressing to pause a motion picture being played back on the camera ••When you press while paused, you can perform fast forward/rewind operations. 2 Press [MENU/SET] ••A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. ••The still picture is saved with aspect ratio of [16:9] and [Quality] of [   ]. The picture size varies depending on the motion picture being played back. –– For motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K]: [M] (8M) –– For motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [FHD], [HD]: [S] (2M) ●●The picture quality becomes slightly lower depending on the [Rec Quality] setting of the original motion picture. ●●When a still picture captured from a motion picture is played back, [   ] is displayed. ●●If you want to capture a still picture from a motion picture while the camera is connected to a TV with the HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF]. Not available in the following case: ●●You cannot capture a still picture from the following motion pictures. •• Motion pictures recorded in [MP4] using the [VGA/4M/25p] setting 203 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu You can specify picture protection, resizing, print settings, and other settings for pictures you have taken. ••For the setting procedures of the menu. (→31) ●●In the following cases, new pictures are created after they have been edited. Before starting to edit, make sure that there is enough free space in the memory card. •• [RAW Processing] •• [Text Stamp] •• [Time Lapse Video] •• [Stop Motion Video] •• [Resize] •• [Cropping] ●●It may not be possible to set or edit pictures taken with other cameras. [Slide Show] Automatically play pictures in order. Recommended when viewing on TV screen. 1 Set the menu → 2 Use 3 Use [Playback] → [Slide Show] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] •• When you select [Category Selection], use to select category and press [MENU/SET]. For details about category, refer to (→206). to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET] ■■Operations during Slide Show Pause/Play Stop Previous Control dial (counterclockwise) 204 Volume down Next Control dial (clockwise) Volume up SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu ■■To change settings such as music or display time Select [Effect] or [Setup] and then press [MENU/SET]. [Effect] [Setup] [AUTO] / [NATURAL] / [SLOW] / [SWING] / [URBAN] / [OFF] [Duration] [1SEC] / [2SEC] / [3SEC] / [5SEC] [Repeat] [ON] / [OFF] [Sound] [OFF]: Music and audio will not play back. [AUTO]: W  ith still pictures, music will play back, and with motion pictures, audio will play back. [Music]: Music effect will play back. [Audio]: Audio is played back from motion pictures. ●●When [URBAN] has been selected, the picture may appear in black and white as a screen effect. ●●[AUTO] can be used only when [Category Selection] is selected. The pictures are played back with the recommended effects for each category. ●●When you perform a Slide Show playback by setting [Video Only] or [Category Selection] to [   ], [   ], or [   ], [Effect] is fixed to [OFF]. ●●When you perform a Slide Show playback for a group picture, and even if [Effect] is set, the effects are disabled. ●●When panorama pictures, motion pictures, or group pictures are played back, the [Duration] setting is disabled. ●●[Duration] can be set only when [Effect] is set to [OFF]. ●●Part of [Effect] cannot be used when displaying pictures on television using an HDMI micro cable or when displaying pictures recorded in portrait position. ●●Music effects cannot be added. 205 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Playback Mode] Recorded pictures can be played back in a variety of ways. 1 Set the menu → 2 Use [Playback] → [Playback Mode] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] When selecting [Category Play] in step 2 above 3 Use to select the category and press [MENU/SET] •• The available categories are as follows. [Face Recog.]* [i-Portrait], [i-Night Portrait], [i-Baby] in Automatic Scene Detection [i-Scenery], [i-Sunset] in Automatic Scene Detection [i-Night Portrait], [i-Night Scenery], [i-Handheld Night Shot] in Automatic Scene Detection [i-Food] in Automatic Scene Detection [Travel Date] A burst of pictures recorded by setting [Burst Rate] to [SH] [Time Lapse Shot], [Time Lapse Video] [Stop Motion Animation], [Stop Motion Video] * Use to select a person to be played back and press [MENU/SET]. Face Recognition is applied for all the pictures in the group. ●●[Playback Mode] automatically changes to [Normal Play] when the camera is turned on, or when switching from the recording standby screen to the playback screen. ●●The category for recording motion pictures is different from the category of still pictures used in some Recording Modes. For that reason, the pictures may not be played back. 206 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Location Logging] After you send location information (latitude and longitude) obtained by your smartphone/ tablet to this unit, you can write this information on pictures using the unit. Preparation Send location information to this unit from your smartphone/tablet. (→237) •• You must install “Panasonic Image App” on your smartphone/tablet. (→228) 1 Set the menu 2 Use to select a period for writing location information, and then press [MENU/SET] → [Playback] → [Location Logging] → [Add Location Data] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed.  ] is displayed for pictures that have location information written to it. •• [  ■■Abort writing location information Press [MENU/SET] while location information is being written •• [   ] is displayed for the period of the abort operation. If selected again while [   ] is displayed, writing location information will resume where it left off. ■■Delete received location information Use to select [Delete Location Data] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select a period for deleting location information, and then press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ●●Location information can be written only to pictures recorded with this unit. Not available in the following cases: ●●Location information may not be written if there is not enough free space on your card. ●●The location information will not be written on pictures that were recorded after you sent the location information (→237). ●●Location information will not be written to AVCHD motion pictures. ●●The location information cannot be written to pictures recorded without setting [Clock Set]. Writing the location information using a smartphone/tablet When you use your smartphone/tablet as a remote controller for this unit, you can write the location information on pictures using the smartphone/tablet. (→238) 207 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [RAW Processing] You can use the camera to develop still pictures that were recorded in RAW format. The created still pictures are saved in JPEG format. You can develop the pictures while confirming the effects on the screen. 1 Set the menu → 2 3 [Playback] → [RAW Processing] Press to select RAW file and press [MENU/SET] Press to select the item •• The following items can be set. The settings used during recording are applied at the time of setting. 208 [White Balance] You can select White Balance to make adjustments. When you select an item with [   ], you can develop the pictures using the same settings that were applied for recording. [Exposure Comp.] You can perform Exposure Compensation in the range from –1 EV to +1 EV. [Photo Style] You can select the [Photo Style] effects ([Standard], [Vivid], [Natural], [Monochrome], [Scenery], or [Portrait]). [i.Dynamic] You can select the [i.Dynamic] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW], or [OFF]). [Contrast] You can adjust the contrast. [Highlight] You can adjust the brightness of a highlighted area. [Shadow] You can adjust the brightness of a shadowed area. [Saturation] / [Color Tone] You can adjust the saturation. (You can adjust the colouring when [Monochrome] is selected for [Photo Style].) [Filter Effect] You can select a Filter effect. (Only when [Monochrome] is selected for [Photo Style]) [Noise Reduction] You can set noise reduction. [i.Resolution] You can select the [i.Resolution] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW], [EXTENDED], or [OFF]). [Sharpness] You can adjust the impression of resolution. [Setup] You can perform the following settings. [Reinstate Adjustments]: You can restore the settings to the ones used during recording. [Color Space]: You can select [Color Space] from either [sRGB] or [Adobe RGB]. [Picture Size]: You can select the picture size ([L], [M], or [S]) of a JPEG file when saving pictures. SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu 4 Press [MENU/SET] to set 5 Press [MENU/SET] 6 Press •• The setting methods vary depending on the item. For details, refer to “Setting each item”. •• The screen in step 3 reappears. To set another item, repeat steps 3 to 5. to select [Begin Processing] and press [MENU/SET] •• Confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. ■■Setting each item When you select an item, the setting screen appears. Control dial Used to make adjustments Used to display the colour temperature setting screen (→105) (Only when [White Balance] is set to [   ]) Used to display the White Balance fine adjustment screen (→105) (Only when [White Balance] is set) [DISP.] [MENU/SET] Used to display the comparison screen Used to finalise an adjustment you just made and to return to the item selection screen ••If you have selected [Noise Reduction], [i.Resolution], or [Sharpness], the comparison screen is not displayed. ••Pictures can be enlarged by operating the zoom lever. The following operating methods are available to make adjustments on the comparison screen. Control dial [DISP.] [MENU/SET] Used to make adjustments Used to return to the setting screen Used to finalise an adjustment you just made and to return to the item selection screen Current setting 209 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu When [Setup] is selected When you select an item, the screen for selecting [Reinstate Adjustments], [Color Space], or [Picture Size] is displayed. Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] •• When [Reinstate Adjustments] is selected, confirmation screen is displayed. When you select [Yes], the item selection screen reappears. Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] ●●The result of a RAW file developed by this camera and a RAW file developed by the supplied DVD software “SILKYPIX Developer Studio” will not be exactly the same. ●●The range that can be set using Exposure Compensation varies from the range used during recording. ●●The [White Balance] setting of still pictures recorded using [Multi Exp.] is fixed to the setting used during recording. ●●If [Red-Eye Removal] is activated during recording, you can use [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu to save JPEG file pictures in which red-eye was detected and corrected. ●●You cannot perform RAW processing using multiple still pictures simultaneously. Not available in the following cases: ●●When an AV cable (optional) or an HDMI micro cable is connected, [RAW Processing] is disabled. ●●You can perform RAW processing on pictures recorded using this unit only. [RAW Processing] cannot be used for pictures recorded on other devices or for pictures recorded in formats other than the RAW format. 210 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Title Edit] You can enter characters (comments) on a recorded picture. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Title Edit] → [Single] or [Multi] Select a still picture [Single] Use Title Edit to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] [Multi] (up to 100 pictures) Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. •• To execute → Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]. 3 [Title Edit] setting OK [Title Edit] already set Enter characters (Entering text (→52)) •• To delete a title, delete all the characters in the character input screen. ●●To print text, use [Text Stamp] or “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the supplied DVD. Not available in the following cases: •• Motion pictures •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [  211  ], [   ] or [   ] SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Text Stamp] You can stamp the recording date and time, names, travel destination, travel dates, etc. on the recorded still pictures. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Text Stamp] → [Single] or [Multi] Select a still picture [Single] Use Text Stamp to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] [Multi] (up to 100 pictures) Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] ( [Text Stamp] setting [Text Stamp] already set) •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. •• To execute → Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]. OK 3 4 5 6 7 212 Use to select [Set] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] (→213) Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] (→213) Press [  Use  ] button to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET] •• Confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu ■■Items that can be stamped [Shooting Date] [Name] [W/O TIME]: Stamp recording date [WITH TIME]: Stamp recording date and time : Stamp name registered in Face Recognition : Stamp name registered in [Profile Setup] [Location] Stamp location registered in [Setup] menu’s [Travel Date] [Travel Date] Stamp number of days that have elapsed since the travel date set in [Setup] menu’s [Travel Date] [Title] Stamp text registered in [Title Edit] ••Items set to [OFF] are not stamped. ●●Do not request date printing in store or make date printing on printer for still pictures with date stamps. (Date printing may be overlapped.) ●●Characters may be cut off on certain printers. ●●If you stamp text on the pictures in a group, those pictures are saved as new pictures. ●●Text is difficult to read when stamped on pictures of 0.3M or less. Not available in the following cases: •• Motion pictures •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [   ] •• Panorama pictures •• Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped •• Still pictures taken without setting clock 213 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Video Divide] A single motion picture can be split into 2 parts. This is convenient when you want to keep just the necessary scenes, or if you wish to delete unnecessary scenes to increase free space on your card, such as when travelling. 1 Set the menu → [Playback] → [Video Divide] 2 3 Use to select a motion picture to split and press [MENU/SET] Press at where you want to split a motion picture to pause it 4 Press •• If you press while paused, you can make finer adjustments to the splitting positions in a motion picture. •• If you press again, the motion picture is played back from the last position prior to activating pause. •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. •• The original motion picture that was split does not remain. (There will only be the 2 motion pictures that were created after the split.) ●●During dividing, do not turn off the camera or remove the card or battery. If you do so, the motion picture may be deleted. ●●If you divide a motion picture recorded in [MP4] when the picture display sequence is set to [FILE NAME], the order of the pictures will change. It is recommended to set the display sequence to [DATE/TIME] or to display using [Calendar]. Not available in the following cases: ●●Motion pictures cannot be divided at a location close to the start or end of the motion picture. ●●Motion pictures with a short recording time cannot be divided. 214 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Time Lapse Video] You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using [Time Lapse Shot]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording format. 1 Set the menu → 2 3 [Playback] → [Time Lapse Video] Use to select the [Time Lapse Shot] picture group and press [MENU/SET] Create a motion picture after selecting a production method •• The process is the same as that used to create a motion picture after recording pictures using [Time Lapse Shot]. For details, refer to step 5 and the subsequent steps (→154). For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→155). [Stop Motion Video] You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using [Stop Motion Animation]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording format. 1 Set the menu → 2 3 215 Use [Playback] → [Stop Motion Video] to select a stop motion animation group and press [MENU/SET] Create a motion picture after selecting a production method •• The process is the same as that used to create a motion picture after recording pictures using [Stop Motion Animation]. For details, refer to step 8 and the subsequent steps (→157). For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→158). SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Resize] Picture size can be reduced to facilitate e-mail attachment and use in web pages, etc. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Resize] → [Single] or [Multi] Select a still picture and size [Single] Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] Use to select size and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. [Multi] (up to 100 pictures) Use to select size and press [MENU/SET] Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. OK •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. •• To execute → Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]. Resize setting ●●Picture quality is reduced after resizing. Not available in the following cases: ●●Still pictures recorded at the smallest recording pixel level cannot be further reduced. ●●Cannot resize the following pictures: •• Motion pictures •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [   ] •• Panorama pictures •• Group pictures •• Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped 216 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Cropping] Enlarge your still pictures and crop unwanted areas. 1 Set the menu → 2 3 Use [Playback] → [Cropping] to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET] Select area to crop and press [MENU/SET] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. Expand Change position ●●Perform cropping for each picture in the group. (You cannot edit pictures in group units.) ●●If you crop a picture in the group, it is saved as a new picture. ●●Original Face Recognition information will not be copied when still pictures are cropped. ●●Picture quality is reduced after cropping. Not available in the following cases: •• Motion pictures •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [   ] •• Panorama pictures •• Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped 217 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Rotate] / [Rotate Disp.] You can automatically display a still picture recorded in portrait orientation by taking the picture with the camera held vertically, or manually rotate the picture in 90-degree units. [Rotate] Rotating a picture manually ••You cannot select [Rotate] when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [OFF]. 1 Set the menu → [Playback] → [Rotate] 2 Use 3 Use to select the rotation direction and press [MENU/SET] to select picture and press [MENU/SET] •• You cannot rotate group pictures. [  [   ]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees clockwise.  ]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees counterclockwise. [Rotate Disp.] 1 Rotating a picture automatically to display Set the menu → [Playback] → [Rotate Disp.] → [ON] •• When this function is set to [OFF], the picture is displayed without changing its orientation. Not available in the following cases: ●●When you play back pictures on a PC, they cannot be displayed in the rotated direction unless the OS or software is compatible with Exif. Exif is a file format for still pictures which allows recording information, etc. to be added. It was established by “JEITA (Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association)”. ●●A picture may not be automatically rotated to display it with portrait orientation on the Multi Playback screen, which is displayed for settings such as [Delete Multi]. 218 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Favorite] By labelling your favourite pictures with a star [ ], you can play back your favourite pictures only, or you can delete all pictures except your favourites. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Favorite] → [Single] or [Multi] Select picture [Single] Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. Favourite picture setting [Multi] (up to 999 pictures) Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Favourite picture setting ■■To clear all In step 1, select [Favorite] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET] ●●When you set [Favorite] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set is displayed with the [Favorite] icon of the first picture. ●●Only when [Playback Mode] is set to [Normal Play], you can select [Cancel]. Not available in the following case: •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [   ] 219 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Print Set] Picture/picture no./date printing settings can be made for when printing with DPOF print-compatible shops or printers. (Ask at the shop to check for compatibility.) 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Print Set] → [Single] or [Multi] Select a still picture [Single] Use to select still picture and press [MENU/SET] Count Date [Multi] Use to select still picture and press [MENU/SET] Count 3 Use 1 2 3 4 5 6 Date to set number of still pictures and press [MENU/SET] (Repeat steps 2 and 3 when using [Multi] (up to 999 pictures)) •• Date print setting/release → Press . ■■To clear all In step 1, select [Print Set] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET] ●●When you have performed [Print Set] for pictures in a group, printing settings are made for the total of number of pictures set in that group. If the total number of pictures is 1,000 or higher, [999+] is displayed. ●●When you perform [Print Set] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set and the total number of pictures are displayed with the Print Set icon of the first picture. ●●Date print setting cannot be made for pictures with a [Text Stamp] applied. ●●Depending on the type of printer, the printer settings may take priority over camera settings. ●●Some DPOF information (print settings) set by other equipment cannot be used. In such cases, delete all of the DPOF information and then set it again with this camera. Not available in the following cases: •• Motion pictures •• Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [   ] •• Cannot be set for files that are not compliant with the DCF standard. 220 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Protect] Set protection to disable picture deletion. Prevents deletion of important pictures. 1 Set the menu → 2 [Playback] → [Protect] → [Single] or [Multi] Select picture [Single] Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. Picture protected [Multi] Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] •• To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Picture protected ■■To clear all In step 1, select [Protect] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET] When you set the write-protect switch on the card to the “LOCK” position, the picture is not erased. ●●The picture is erased when formatting, even if it is protected. ●●May not be effective when using other devices. ●●When you set [Protect] for a picture in a group, the number of pictures set is displayed with the [Protect] icon of the first picture. 221 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Face Rec Edit] Edit or delete the recognition information for pictures with mistaken Face Recognition. 1 Set the menu → [Playback] → [Face Rec Edit] → [REPLACE] or [DELETE] 2 3 Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET] Use to select a person and press [MENU/SET] 4 5 Use •• If [DELETE], go to step 5. •• People whose Face Recognition information has not been registered cannot be selected. Use to select the person to replace for another and press [MENU/SET] to select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET] ●●When Face Recognition information is deleted, it cannot be restored. ●●Pictures for which all Face Recognition information has been deleted are not categorised in Face Recognition during [Category Play] or [Category Selection]. ●●Edit the Face Recognition information in group units for a group picture. (You cannot edit the information for each picture in a group.) ●●You can edit only the first picture in a group. 222 SQW0024 Playing Back and Editing Pictures Using the [Playback] menu [Picture Sort] You can set the display sequence used for playing back pictures on this unit. 1 Set the menu → 2 Use [Playback] → [Picture Sort] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] [FILE NAME] [DATE/TIME] Displays pictures in the folder name or file name sequence. This display format allows you to find the storage location of a picture on a card more easily. Displays pictures according to the date and time that the pictures were taken in chronological order. When the pictures are taken using several cameras and stored on the same card, this display format allows you find a specific picture more easily. ●●Pictures may not be displayed according to the [DATE/TIME] sequence immediately after a card is inserted into this unit. In that case, wait a while, and the pictures will be displayed in the [DATE/ TIME] sequence. [Delete Confirmation] You can set the Yes/No options that you want to select first on the confirmation screen when you delete a picture from either [Yes] or [No]. "Yes" first "No" first 1 Set the menu 2 Use → to select the item and press [MENU/SET] ["Yes" first] ["No" first] 223 [Playback] → [Delete Confirmation] [Yes] is selected by default to quickly perform a deletion. [No] is selected by default. This setting will prevent you from accidentally deleting pictures. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Wi-Fi® Function and NFC Function ■■Use the camera as a wireless LAN device When using equipment or computer systems that require more reliable security than wireless LAN devices, ensure that the appropriate measures are taken for safety designs and defects for the systems used. Panasonic will not take any responsibility for any damage that arises when using the camera for any purpose other than as a wireless LAN device. ■■Use of the Wi-Fi function of this camera is presumed to be in countries where this camera is sold There is the risk that the camera violates the radio wave regulations if used in countries other than those where this camera is sold, and Panasonic takes no responsibility for any violations. ■■There is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be intercepted Please note that there is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be intercepted by a third party. We strongly recommend that you enable encryption in the settings of your wireless access point to ensure information security. ■■Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or interference ••Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or interference, such as near microwave ovens. Radio waves may not reach the camera. ••Using the camera near devices such as microwave ovens or cordless telephones that use the 2.4 GHz radio wave band may cause a decrease in performance in both devices. ■■Do not connect to the wireless network you are not authorised to use When the camera utilises its Wi-Fi function, wireless networks will be searched automatically. When this happens, wireless networks that you are not authorised to use (SSID*) may be displayed, however do not attempt to connect to the network as it may be considered as unauthorised access. * SSID refers to the name that is used to identify a network over a wireless LAN connection. If the SSID matches for both devices, transmission is possible. ■■Before Use ••To use the Wi-Fi function on this unit, a wireless access point or a destination device equipped with the wireless LAN function is required. ■■The camera is compatible with NFC Using the NFC (Near Field Communication) function, the camera and a smartphone/tablet can easily exchange the information needed to establish a Wi-Fi connection. 224 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Wi-Fi® Function and NFC Function ■■About the Wi-Fi connection lamp Wi-Fi connection lamp Lit blue: When the Wi-Fi function is ON Blinking blue: When sending data [Wi-Fi] button ■■About the [Wi-Fi] button You can operate the [Wi-Fi]/[Fn2] button in two ways, using it either as the [Wi-Fi] button or as a function button [Fn2]. It is set to [Wi-Fi] at the time of purchase. For more details about the function button (→37) ••Before a Wi-Fi connection is established, press the [Wi-Fi] button to perform the following operations: → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also display the same menu by selecting [Wi-Fi Function].) [New Connection] [Select a destination from History] (→268) [Select a destination from Favorite] (→268) 225 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Wi-Fi® Function and NFC Function ••Pressing the [Wi-Fi] button during a Wi-Fi connection enables the following operation. [Terminate the Connection] Terminates the Wi-Fi connection. [Change the Destination]*1 Terminates the Wi-Fi connection, and allows you to select a different Wi-Fi connection. [Change Settings for Sending Images]*2 For details (→271). [Register the Current Destination to Favorite]*1 Registering the current connection destination or the connection method, you can easily connect with the same connection method next time. [Network Address] Displays the MAC address and IP address of this unit (→273). *1 This item will not be displayed if you press to send pictures to WEB services while the pictures are displayed (→254). * item will not be displayed if the destination for [Remote Shooting & View], [Playback on TV] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Printer]. 2 This ●●Do not remove the memory card or battery or move to an area without any reception while sending images. ●●The camera cannot be used to connect to a public wireless LAN connection. ●●Use a IEEE802.11b, IEEE802.11g or IEEE802.11n compatible device when using a wireless access point. ●●We recommend that you use a fully charged battery when you send pictures. ●●When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or the connection may be disrupted. (A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.) ●●When sending images on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred depending on the details of your contract. ●●Pictures may not be completely sent depending on radio wave conditions. If the connection is terminated while sending pictures, pictures with missing sections may be sent. ●●The monitor display may become distorted for an instant while connected to the service, however this will not affect the image being sent. 226 SQW0024 Wi-Fi What you can do with the Wi-Fi function Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone (→228) Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording) Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone/tablet Saving pictures in the camera to the smartphone/tablet Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services Writing the location information on pictures in the camera Connect easily, transfer pictures easily You can easily use the Wi-Fi function by pressing and holding the [Wi-Fi] button or using the NFC function. Press and hold Hold the device close to the camera or Displaying still pictures on a TV (→242) Wireless printing (→243) Sending pictures to AV device (→244) Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV device in the home (home AV device). Sending pictures to a PC (→247) Using WEB services (→251) Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social networking services, etc. You can receive still pictures and motion pictures on a PC or a smartphone/tablet using the Cloud Sync. Service. ••Hereafter, this manual uses the term “smartphone” for both smartphones and tablets unless it is necessary to distinguish between them. 227 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone You can remotely operate the camera using a smartphone. The “Panasonic Image App” (hereafter “Image App”) must be installed on your smartphone. Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App” The “Image App” is an application provided by Panasonic that allows your smartphone to perform the following operations of a Wi-Fi-compatible LUMIX. For Android™ apps Supported OS Installation procedure Android 2.3.3 or later* Connect your Android device to a network Select “Google PlayTM Store” Enter “Panasonic Image App” or “LUMIX” to search for the app Select “Panasonic Image App” and install it •• The icon will be added to the menu. For iOS apps iOS 6.0 or later (iPhone 3GS is not supported.) Connect the iOS device to the network Select “App StoreSM” Enter “Panasonic Image App” or “LUMIX” to search for the app Select “Panasonic Image App” and install it •• The icon will be added to the menu. * To connect this unit with [Wi-Fi Direct], Android OS 4.0 or above is required and the device must be compatible with Wi-Fi Direct™. ••Use the latest version. ••Supported OS versions as of September 2014. Supported OS versions may be changed without prior notice. ••Some of the screens and information provided in this document may be different depending on the supported operating system and “Image App” version. ••The service may not be able to be used properly depending on the type of smartphone being used. ••For details about the operating procedure, etc., refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu. ••For the latest information on the “Image App”, refer to the support site below. http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/ (This site is available in English only.) •• When downloading the app on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred depending on the details of your contract. 228 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Connecting to a smartphone You can easily establish a Wi-Fi connection on the camera by pressing and holding the [Wi-Fi] button or using the NFC function. Preparation Install “Image App” in advance. (→228) 1 Press and hold the [Wi-Fi] button Wi-Fi connection lamp (Lit blue) [Wi-Fi] button •• The information (QR Code, SSID and Password) required for directly connecting your smartphone to this unit is displayed. •• After the second time, the screen for the previously used connection method will appear. •• The same screen can be displayed by selecting items from the menu as follows. → [New Connection] → [Remote Shooting & View] 2 229 •• When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is displayed in an enlarged size. If it is difficult to read the code, use the enlarge view. (If your smartphone cannot read the QR code, move the camera away from the smartphone or use a connection method other than the QR code.) •• To change the connection method, press the [DISP.] button and select the connection method. (→232) SSID and Password QR Code Operate the smartphone •• When the connection is complete, live images being captured by the camera are displayed on the smartphone. (It may take some time after the operation for the connection to be established.) •• The connection method differs depending on the smartphone used. (→230, 231) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone ■■Using an iOS device ••When reading a QR Code to connect (Steps to are not necessary when reconnecting.) Start “Image App” (→228) Select [QR Code] → [OK] Read the QR Code displayed on this unit with “Image App” (When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is displayed in an enlarged size.) Install the IMAGE APP profile Select [Install]*, then select [Install Now]* → [Done]*. •• The message is displayed in the Web browser. •• If a passcode is required to unlock the smartphone, you will have to input the passcode. Press the home button to close the Web browser Select [Wi-Fi]* under [Settings]* on the smartphone Turn on [Wi-Fi]* and select the SSID displayed on this unit Return to the home screen and start “Image App” (→228) * The display may differ depending on the system language setting. 230 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone ••When connecting with SSID and password Select [Wi-Fi]* under [Settings]* on the smartphone Turn on [Wi-Fi]* and select the SSID displayed on this unit Enter the password displayed on this unit (First time connecting only) Return to the home screen and start “Image App” (→228) * The display may differ depending on the system language setting. ■■Using an Android device ••When reading a QR Code to connect Start “Image App” (→228) Select [QR Code] Read the QR Code displayed on this unit with “Image App” (When you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code is displayed in an enlarged size.) ••When connecting with SSID and password Start “Image App” (→228) Select [Wi-Fi] Select the SSID displayed on this unit Enter the password displayed on this unit (First time connecting only) ••If you check the item to display the password, you can confirm the password as you enter it. 231 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Changing the connection method To change the connection method, press the [DISP.] button and select the connection method. ■■When connecting with [Via Network] (On the camera) Select [Via Network] and press [MENU/SET] •• Connect the camera to a wireless access point by following the connection method (→264). (On your smartphone) Set Wi-Fi function to “ON” Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set Start “Image App” (→228) ■■When connecting with [Direct] (On the camera) Select [Direct] and press [MENU/SET] •• Select [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection], and connect the camera to the smartphone by following the connection method (→267). (On your smartphone) Start “Image App” (→228) Closing the connection After use, close the connection with the smartphone. (On the camera) 1 Press [Wi-Fi] button (On the recording standby screen, you can also close the connection by pressing → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) 2 Select [Terminate the Connection] •• A confirmation screen is displayed. Select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. (On your smartphone) 3 Close “Image App” <Using an iOS device> From the “Image App” screen, press the home button on the smartphone to close the app <Using an Android device> From the “Image App” screen, press the back button on the smartphone twice to close the app 232 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Connecting to a smartphone using NFC function Using the NFC (Near Field Communication) function, the camera and a smartphone can easily exchange the information needed to establish a Wi-Fi connection. Compatible models: This function can be used with NFC compatible devices with Android (2.3.3 or above). (Not available in certain models) ••See the operating instructions of your NFC-compatible smartphone for more information about smartphone operation and settings. Preparations (On the camera) •• Set [NFC Operation] to [ON] (→272) (On your smartphone) •• Check if your smartphone is a compatible model •• Set Wi-Fi function to “ON” •• Install “Image App” in advance (→228) 1 2 3 4 Start “Image App” on your smartphone While the [   ] is displayed on the connection screen of the “Image App”, hold the smartphone close to the camera Use to select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET] Hold the smartphone close to this area of the unit again •• When the connection is complete, live images captured by the camera will be displayed on your smartphone. •• It may take some time to complete the connection. •• Connected smartphones are registered to this unit. •• From the next time and on, you can connect by performing steps 1 and 2. 233 Hold the smartphone close to this area (within 5 mm (0.20 inch)) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone ●●You can register up to 20 smartphones. If the number of registered smartphones exceeds 20, registrations will be deleted starting from the smartphone touched first. ●●If you perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings], smartphone registration will be deleted. ●●If the communication environment is bad, the NFC function may not be usable. ●●If there is not a response immediately, shift the position slightly. ●●Do not bump your smartphone strongly against this unit. ●●See the operating instructions of your NFC-compatible smartphone for more information about smartphone operation and settings. ●●Metal objects between this unit and the smartphone may interfere with communication. Also, any stickers, etc., near the NFC area may affect communication performance. Not available in the following cases: ●●The NFC function cannot be used in the following cases: •• When the camera is turned off (Including [Sleep Mode]) •• During motion picture recording •• While recording still pictures (during self-timer countdown) •• When using [Time Lapse Shot] •• When using [Stop Motion Animation] •• When using [Multi Exp.] •• During motion picture playback, during slide shows, during panorama picture playback, and during continuous playback of group pictures (including pauses in each case) •• While sending pictures by Wi-Fi •• When connected to computer/printer ●●You cannot transfer still pictures in RAW format, AVCHD motion pictures, or MP4 motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K]. Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording) 1 2 3 234 Connect to a smartphone (→229) Select [   ] from “Image App” Take pictures •• The recorded images are saved in the camera. •• When using zoom, the camera could tilt when the lens barrel extends. Make sure to secure the camera in place with a tripod or by other means. •• Some settings are not available. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone 1 2 Connect to a smartphone (→229) Select [   ] from “Image App” •• The images captured by the camera are displayed on the smartphone. •• You can switch a picture to be displayed using the icon at the top left on the screen. Select [LUMIX] to display a picture saved in the camera. •• When the picture is touched, it is played back at a larger size. Switch the location of the pictures to be displayed Saving pictures in the camera to the smartphone 1 2 3 Connect to a smartphone (→229) Select [   ] from “Image App” Press and hold the picture and drag it to save it on the smartphone •• The picture is saved on the smartphone. •• Functions can be assigned to the top, bottom, left and right as you wish. Not available in the following case: ●●You cannot save still pictures in RAW format, AVCHD motion pictures, or MP4 motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K]. 235 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Easily transferring pictures in the camera You can establish a Wi-Fi connection using the NFC function and easily transfer over Wi-Fi the picture on display simply by holding the smartphone close to the camera. Pictures can be transferred as soon as they are recorded, so you can easily transfer them to your friends’ and family’s smartphones.* * “Image App” must be installed to use this function. Preparations (On the camera) •• Set [NFC Operation] to [ON] (→272) •• Set [Touch Sharing] to [ON] (→272) (On your smartphone) •• Check if your smartphone is a compatible model •• Set Wi-Fi function to “ON” •• Install “Image App” in advance (→228) 1 2 3 On the camera, play back the picture you wish to transfer to a smartphone Start “Image App” on the smartphone you are transferring the picture to While the [   ] is displayed on the connection screen of the “Image App”, hold the smartphone close to the camera •• It will be transferred to the smartphone. •• If you are transferring multiple pictures, repeat steps 1 and 3. (Multiple pictures cannot be transferred in one batch.) •• It may take several minutes to complete the picture transfer depending on the environment used. 236 Hold the smartphone close to this area (within 5 mm (0.20 inch)) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services 1 2 3 Connect to a smartphone (→229) Select [   ] from “Image App” Press and hold the picture and drag it to send it to the social networking service, etc. Switch the location of the pictures to be displayed •• The picture will be sent to the social networking service or other WEB services. •• Functions can be assigned to the top, bottom, left and right as you wish. Adding location information to pictures in the camera from a smartphone You can send the location information acquired from a smartphone to the camera. After the information is sent, you can write it on the pictures in the camera. GPS Starts location information recording Ends location information recording Sends and writes the location information Start the recording ••Location information that is different from the information acquired during recording may be written. Take care regarding the following matters. –– Set [Home] of [World Time] of the camera to your home area. –– Once a smartphone starts recording the location information, do not change the [Home] setting of [World Time] of the camera. ••The location information cannot be written to pictures recorded without setting [Clock Set]. 237 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone ■■Starts location information recording Operate the smartphone Select [   ] Select [Geotagging] Select [   ] ■■Ends location information recording Operate the smartphone Select [   ] Select [Geotagging] Select [   ] ■■Sends and writes the location information Connect to a smartphone (→229) Operate the smartphone Select [   ] Select [Geotagging] Select [   ] •• Follow the messages on the screen to perform the operation. •• Location information will not be written to AVCHD motion pictures. •• Location information may not be written if there is not enough free space on your card. •• You can also use [Location Logging] in the [Playback] menu to write the sent location information to the pictures. ●●Caution: Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, the likeness rights, etc. of the subject when you use this function. Use at your own risk. ●●On the smartphone, you can set the acquisition interval of location information and check the transfer status of location information. Refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu for details. ●●(When using “Image App” for iOS) If you press the Home or On/Off button of a smartphone while location information recording is in progress, recording is stopped. 238 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone Operating the camera to send pictures to a smartphone ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent [Send Images While Recording] (→240) [Send Images Stored in the Camera] (→241) JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD ○ – – – – ○* – ○ * Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about picture playback. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) Preparation Install “Image App” in advance. (→228) 239 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone [Send Images While Recording] 1 Set the menu 2 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] and press [MENU/SET] → [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [Smartphone] ■■When connecting with [Via Network] (On the camera) Connect the camera to a wireless access point (→264) (On your smartphone) Set Wi-Fi function to “ON” Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set Start “Image App” (→228) ■■When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct] (On the camera) Connect the camera to a smartphone (→267) (On your smartphone) Start “Image App” (→228) ■■When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct] Perform step 2 (→229). 3 Select the device you wish to connect to 4 Take still pictures 240 •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→271) •• The still pictures are sent automatically after taking them. •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete. → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone [Send Images Stored in the Camera] 1 Set the menu 2 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] and press [MENU/SET] → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Smartphone] ■■When connecting with [Via Network] (On the camera) Connect the camera to a wireless access point (→264) (On your smartphone) Set Wi-Fi function to “ON” Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set Start “Image App” (→228) ■■When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct] (On the camera) Connect the camera to a smartphone (→267) (On your smartphone) Start “Image App” (→228) ■■When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct] Perform step 2 (→229). 3 Select the device you wish to connect to 4 Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select] •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→271) [Single Select] Select the picture Press [MENU/SET] [Multi Select] Select the picture (repeat) •• If selected again, the setting will be cancelled. Select [OK] •• The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is limited. OK 1 2 3 4 5 6 •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. •• To close the connection, select [Exit]. 241 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Displaying still pictures on a TV You can display still pictures on a TV that is compatible with a DLNA certified digital media renderer (DMR) function. Preparation Set the TV to DLNA waiting Mode. •• Read the operating instructions for your TV. 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) 4 Take or play back still pictures on this unit → [New Connection] → [Playback on TV] Select the device you wish to connect to •• When the connection is established, the screen is displayed. •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226) → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) ●●When you display the pictures on a TV using the Wi-Fi function, they are not output using 4K resolution. To output pictures using 4K resolution, connect this unit to the TV using an HDMI micro cable. (→276) ●●When a TV is connected to this unit, the TV screen may temporarily return to the status before the connection. Pictures are displayed again when you take or play back pictures. ●●Even if [Effect] and [Sound] are set on this unit, these settings are disabled when the pictures are played back on a TV during Slide Show playback. ●●It may take some time to establish the Wi-Fi connection or it may not be connected at all depending on the distance from this unit to the TV. Not available in the following cases: ●●Playback of motion pictures or panorama pictures, and continuous playback of group pictures are not displayed on a TV. ●●During the multi/calendar playback, pictures displayed on the screen of this unit are not displayed on TV. 242 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Wireless printing You can print out recorded still pictures wirelessly from a PictBridge (wireless LAN-compatible)* printer. * Compliant with the DPS over IP standards. Contact the printer manufacturers for details on PictBridge (wireless LAN-compatible) printers. ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent [Send Images Stored in the Camera] JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD ○ – – – ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) 1 Set the menu 2 3 4 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Printer] Select a printer you want to connect Select the still picture and print •• Pictures are selected the same way as when connecting by USB connection cable (supplied). For more details (→287). •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226)  ] button.) (You can also close the connection by pressing the [  Not available in the following case: ●●Motion pictures cannot be printed. 243 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to AV device Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV devices in the home (home AV devices), such as DLNA compatible recorders. Home AV device Wireless access point ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD [Send Images While Recording] (→245) ○ – – – [Send Images Stored in the Camera] (→246) ○ – – – ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about picture playback. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) Preparations When sending a picture to AV devices, set your device to DLNA waiting Mode. •• Read the operating instructions of your device for details. 244 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to AV device [Send Images While Recording] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) 4 Take still pictures 245 → [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [AV device] Select the device you wish to connect to •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226) You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete. → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to AV device [Send Images Stored in the Camera] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) 4 Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select] → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [AV device] Select the device you wish to connect to •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) [Single Select] Select the picture Press [MENU/SET] [Multi Select] Select the picture (repeat) •• If selected again, the setting will be cancelled. Select [OK] •• The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is limited. OK 1 2 3 4 5 6 •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. •• To close the connection, select [Exit]. 246 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to a PC Still pictures and motion pictures recorded by the camera can be sent to a PC. ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD* [Send Images While Recording] (→249) ○ ○ – – [Send Images Stored in the Camera] (→250) ○ ○ ○ ○ * Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] can be sent in file sizes of up to 4 GB. Files larger than 4 GB cannot be sent. ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about picture playback. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) Preparations •• Turn the computer on. •• Prepare folders for receiving images on the PC before sending a picture to the PC. (→248) •• If the standard settings are changed for the workgroup on the connected PC, you must change settings in [PC Connection] on this unit. (→272) 247 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to a PC To create a folder that receives images ••Create a PC user account (account name (up to 254 characters) and password (up to 32 characters)) consisting of alphanumeric characters. An attempt to create a receive folder may fail if the account includes non-alphanumeric characters. ■■When using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the PC •• “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” is not compatible with Mac. •• For details on hardware requirements and installation, read “Installing supplied software” (→281, 283). Create a folder that receives images with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” •• To create the folder automatically, select [Auto-create]. To specify a folder, create a new folder, or set a password to the folder, select [Create manually]. •• For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF). ■■When not using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (For Windows) Supported OS: Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7 / Windows Vista Example: Windows 7 Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then right-click Select [Properties], then enable sharing of the folder •• For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system. (For Mac) Supported OS: OS X v10.5 to v10.9 Example: OS X v10.8 Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then click on the items in the following order [File] → [Get Info] Enable sharing of the folder •• For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system. 248 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to a PC [Send Images While Recording] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) 4 Select the folder you want to send to 5 Take still pictures 249 → [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [PC] Select the PC you want to connect to •• If the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], then enter the computer name (for Mac, enter the NetBIOS name). •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226) You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete. → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Sending pictures to a PC [Send Images Stored in the Camera] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→263) 4 Select the folder you want to send to 5 Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select] → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [PC] Select the PC you want to connect to •• If the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], then enter the computer name (for Mac, enter the NetBIOS name). •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) [Single Select] Select the picture Press [MENU/SET] [Multi Select] Select the picture (repeat) •• If selected again, the setting will be cancelled. Select [OK] •• The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is limited. OK 1 2 3 4 5 6 •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. •• To close the connection, select [Exit]. ●●Folders sorted by the sent date are created in the specified folder, and pictures are saved in those folders. ●●If the screen for a user account and password entry appears, enter the one you set on your PC. ●●If the computer name (for Mac, the NetBIOS name) contains spaces, etc., the name may not be properly recognised. If you cannot connect, we recommend changing the computer name (for Mac, the NetBIOS name) to a combination of 15 or less alphanumeric characters only. 250 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social networking services, etc. By selecting the setting to automatically transfer still pictures and motion pictures to [Cloud Sync. Service], you can receive the transferred still pictures and motion pictures on a PC or a smartphone. WEB services Cloud synchronisation services LUMIX CLUB Wireless access point When sending images to WEB service ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD [Send Images While Recording] (→253) ○ – – – [Send Images Stored in the Camera] (→253) ○ – ○* – * Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••For details about playback of pictures, check the WEB service to which you will send the pictures. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) Preparation You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→258) to send a picture to a WEB service. To send images to a WEB service, you need to register the WEB service. (→252) 251 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services ●●Images may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such as a title, the time and date when the images were taken, and the location where the image was taken. Check this information before uploading images to WEB services. ●●Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages resulting from the leakage, loss, etc. of images uploaded on WEB services. ●●When uploading images to the WEB service, do not delete images from this camera, even after they have finished sending, until you have checked that they have been properly uploaded to the WEB service. Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages resulting from the deletion of images stored in this unit. ●●Images uploaded to the WEB service cannot be displayed or deleted with this camera. Check images by accessing the WEB service with your smartphone or computer. ●●If sending images fails, a report email outlining the failure will be sent to the email address registered with “LUMIX CLUB”. Registering the WEB service to “LUMIX CLUB” When sending images to WEB services, the WEB service being used must be registered with the “LUMIX CLUB”. ••Check the “FAQ/Contact us” on the following site for compatible WEB services. http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/lumix_faqs/ Preparation Make sure that you have created an account on the WEB service you want to use, and have the login information available. 1 Connect to the “LUMIX CLUB” site using a smartphone or computer 2 3 Enter your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password and log in to the service 4 252 http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/ If you have not registered your email address with “LUMIX CLUB”, register the email address Select the WEB service to be used for WEB service link settings and register it •• Follow the instructions on the screen to register the service. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services [Send Images While Recording] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] and connect (→264) 4 Take still pictures → [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [Web service] Select a WEB service you want to connect •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226) You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete. → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) [Send Images Stored in the Camera] 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Via Network] and connect (→264) 4 Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select] → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Web service] Select a WEB service you want to connect •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) [Single Select] Select the picture Press [MENU/SET] [Multi Select] Select the picture (repeat) •• If selected again, the setting will be cancelled. Select [OK] •• The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is limited. OK 1 2 3 4 5 6 •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. •• To close the connection, select [Exit]. 253 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services ■■Quickly sending pictures in the camera to WEB services Once you send a picture, you can send pictures to the WEB service as quickly and easily as using a smartphone, only when the environment for connecting to a wireless access point is available. Display the picture Use to select [Yes] after pressing (When a group picture is being displayed, select [Upload(Wi-Fi)] → [Yes]) •• The camera is connected to the previously used wireless access point and the pictures are sent to the WEB service.*1, *2 Upload this image by Wi-Fi? Yes No *1 When no connection history is available for the wireless access point, proceed to the connection method selection screen. Select the connection method and connect the camera to a wireless access point. (→264) *2 If you do not have a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID, proceed to the new login ID sign up screen. Get a login ID and set a password. (→259) Performing the operation for the first time After you select [Yes] in step above, the WEB service selection screen appears. Use to select WEB services and press [MENU/SET] Check the setting on the confirmation screen for the transmission setting and press [MENU/SET] •• The picture is sent to the WEB service. •• To change the transmission setting for the picture, press the [DISP.] button. (→271) •• After the second time, the pictures are sent using the same WEB service and the same picture transmission settings as before. ●●When pictures are displayed as a group, they are all sent. When a single picture in a group is displayed, only the picture being displayed is sent. ●●To change the transmission settings of a picture or to close the Wi-Fi connection, press the [Wi-Fi] button. You can also close the connection by pressing the Playback button or [MENU/SET] and selecting [Yes]. When you switch to Recording Mode, the Wi-Fi connection is closed. 254 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service] ■■Sending method, and pictures that can be sent [Send Images While Recording] (→256) [Send Images Stored in the Camera] (→257) JPEG RAW MP4 AVCHD ○ – – – – ○* – ○ * Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] ••Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device. ••See the operating instructions of the destination device for more information about picture playback. ••For more details about picture sending methods. (→270) Preparation You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→258) and configure the Cloud Sync. setting to send a picture to a Cloud Folder. Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on a PC or “Image App” on a smartphone to configure the Cloud Sync. settings. ■■About the images sent to a Cloud Folder by the use of [Cloud Sync. Service] (Current as of September 2014) ••If you set the picture destination to [Cloud Sync. Service], sent pictures are temporarily saved in the cloud folder, and they can be synchronised with the device in use, such as the PC or smartphone. ••A Cloud Folder stores transferred images for 30 days (up to 1,000 pictures). Transferred images are deleted automatically 30 days after the transfer. Furthermore, when the number of stored images exceeds 1,000, some images may be deleted depending on the [Cloud Limit] (→271) setting even within 30 days after the transfer. ••When the download of images from a Cloud Folder to all specified devices is complete, images may be deleted from the Cloud Folder even within 30 days after the transfer. 255 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services [Send Images While Recording] 1 Set the menu 2 3 4 Check the message and press [MENU/SET] 5 Take still pictures 256 → [New Connection] → [Send Images While Recording] → [Cloud Sync. Service] Select [Via Network] and connect (→264) Check the send setting •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) •• To change the setting or disconnect, press [Wi-Fi] button. (→226) You cannot change the settings while sending still pictures. Wait until sending is complete. → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → (You can also close the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes].) SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using WEB services [Send Images Stored in the Camera] 1 Set the menu 2 3 4 Check the message and press [MENU/SET] 5 Select [Single Select] or [Multi Select] → [New Connection] → [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Cloud Sync. Service] Select [Via Network] and connect (→264) Check the send setting •• When the connection is established, the confirmation screen for the transmission setting is displayed. Check the setting and press [MENU/SET]. To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. (→271) [Single Select] Select the picture Press [MENU/SET] [Multi Select] Select the picture (repeat) •• If selected again, the setting will be cancelled. Select [OK] •• The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is limited. OK 1 2 3 4 5 6 •• A confirmation screen is displayed. If you select [Yes], the operation is executed. •• To change the send setting, press [DISP.] button. •• To close the connection, select [Exit]. 257 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using “LUMIX CLUB” About the [LUMIX CLUB] Acquire a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID (free). If you register this unit to the “LUMIX CLUB”, you can synchronise images between the devices you are using, or transfer these images to WEB services. Use the “LUMIX CLUB” when uploading pictures to WEB services. ••You can set the same “LUMIX CLUB” login ID for this unit and a smartphone. (→261) Refer to the “LUMIX CLUB” site for details. http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/ Please note; ••The service may be suspended due to regular maintenance or unexpected problems, and service contents may be changed or added to, without prior notice to the users. ••The service may be stopped in whole or in part with a reasonable period of advance notice. 258 SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using “LUMIX CLUB” Acquiring a new login ID ([New account]) 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Set/Add Account] 4 Select the method for connecting to a wireless access point, and set 5 Read through the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use and press [MENU/SET] 6 Enter the password 7 Check the login ID and press [MENU/SET] 259 → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB] Select [New account] •• Connect to the network. Proceed to the next page by pressing [MENU/SET]. •• A confirmation screen will be displayed if a login ID has already been acquired for the camera. Select [Yes] to acquire a new login ID, or [No] if you do not need to acquire a new login ID. •• For details (→264). •• The settings screen will only appear during the first connection. Connection methods set on this unit are stored and will be used for subsequent connections. If you want to change the wireless access point to connect to, press the [DISP.] button, then change the connecting destination. •• You can press to switch pages. •• Turn the zoom lever clockwise to enlarge the page display (x2 magnification). •• If you turn the zoom lever counterclockwise after enlarging the page, the page returns to its original size (no magnification). to move the position of the area to be enlarged. •• You can use  ] button to cancel the process without acquiring a login ID. •• Press [  •• Enter any combination of 8 to 16 characters and numbers for the password. •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). •• The login ID (12-digit number) will be displayed automatically. When logging in to the “LUMIX CLUB” with a computer, you only need to enter the numbers. •• A message is displayed when the connection is complete. Press [MENU/SET]. •• Be sure to make a note of the login ID and password. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using “LUMIX CLUB” Using a previously acquired login ID/confirming and changing login ID and password ([Set Login ID]) Preparation To use a previously acquired login ID, confirm your ID and password. To change the “LUMIX CLUB” password on the camera, access the “LUMIX CLUB” website from your smartphone or PC and change the “LUMIX CLUB” password in advance. 1 Set the menu 2 3 Select [Set/Add Account] 4 5 Select the item you wish to change 6 Select [Exit] 260 → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB] Select [Set Login ID] •• The login ID and password are displayed. •• The password is displayed as “ ”. •• Close the menu if only checking the login ID. Enter your login ID or password •• Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter text. •• Enter the new password you have created on your smartphone or PC into the camera. If the password differs from the one you created on your smartphone or PC, you will not be able to upload images. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using “LUMIX CLUB” To set the same login ID for the camera and the smartphone ••Setting the same login ID on this unit and your smartphone is convenient for sending images on this unit to other devices or WEB services. ■■When either this unit or the smartphone has acquired the login ID Connect this unit to the smartphone (→229) From the “Image App” menu, set the common login ID •• The login IDs for this unit and the smartphone become the same. ••After connecting this unit to the smartphone, the setup screen for a common login ID may appear when you display the playback screen. You can also set a common login ID by following the on-screen instructions. ••This operation is not available for [Wi-Fi Direct] connection. ■■When this unit and the smartphone have acquired different login IDs When you want to use the smartphone’s login ID for this unit Change the login ID and password for this unit to those acquired by the smartphone. When you want to use this unit’s login ID for the smartphone Change the login ID and password for the smartphone to those acquired by this unit. Check the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use Check the details if the terms of use have been updated. 1 Set the menu → 2 261 [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB] Select [Terms of use] •• The camera will connect to the network and the terms of use will be displayed. SQW0024 Wi-Fi Using “LUMIX CLUB” Delete your login ID and account from the “LUMIX CLUB” Delete the login ID from the camera when transferring it to another party or disposing of it. You can also delete your “LUMIX CLUB” account. 1 Set the menu → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB] 2 Select [Delete account] 3 Select [Yes] in the login ID delete confirmation screen 4 Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen for deleting the “LUMIX CLUB” account 5 Press [MENU/SET] •• The message is displayed. Press [MENU/SET]. •• The message is displayed. Press [MENU/SET]. •• If you want to continue using the service, selecting [No] will only delete the login ID. Exit the menu after it is executed. •• The login ID is deleted, and then the message notifying the deletion of your account is displayed. Press [MENU/SET]. ●●Changes and other actions to login IDs can only be made to the login ID acquired with the camera. 262 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections After selecting the Wi-Fi function and sending destination, select the connection method. If you are out and unable to use your wireless access point, or temporarily connecting to equipment you do not ordinarily use, or in a similar situation, it is convenient to make a direct connection. If you are connecting with the same settings as used previously, you can quickly start using the Wi-Fi function by connecting with [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite]. Wireless access point Connection method Description [Via Network] Connects through a wireless access point. (→264) [Direct] Your equipment connects directly to the camera. (→267) 263 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections [Via Network] Connecting via a wireless access point Select a connection method to the wireless access point. ••WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure the settings related to the connection and security of wireless LAN devices. To check if the wireless access point you are using is compatible with WPS, refer to the instruction manual of the wireless access point. Connection method Description Save push button type wireless access point that is compatible with Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ with a WPS mark. [WPS (Push-Button)] 1 Press the wireless access point WPS button until it switches to WPS Mode •• Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details. Save PIN code type wireless access point that is compatible with Wi-Fi Protected Setup with a WPS mark. [WPS (PIN code)] 1 2 Select the wireless access point you are connecting to 3 Press [MENU/SET] Enter the PIN code displayed on the camera screen into the wireless access point •• Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details. [From List] 264 Select this option when you are not sure about the WPS compatibility, or when you want to search for and connect to a wireless access point. •• For details (→265). SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility (connecting by [From List]) Search for available wireless access points. ••Confirm encryption key of the selected wireless access point if the network authentication is encrypted. ••When connecting by [Manual Input], confirm SSID, network authentication type, encryption type, encryption key of the wireless access point you are using. 1 Select the wireless access point you are connecting to •• Pressing [DISP.] button will search for a wireless access point again. •• If no wireless access point is found, refer to “When connecting with [Manual Input]” (→266). 2 (If network authentication is encrypted) Enter the encryption key •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). 265 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections ■■When connecting with [Manual Input] On the screen of step 1 of “If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility (connecting by [From List])”, select [Manual Input] (→265) Enter the SSID of the wireless access point you are connecting to, then select [Set] •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). Select the network authentication type •• For information on network authentication, see the instruction manual of the wireless access point. Select the encryption type •• The type of settings that can be changed may vary depending on the details of network authentication settings. Network authentication type Encryption types that can be set [WPA2-PSK] / [WPA-PSK] [TKIP] / [AES] [Common Key] [WEP] [Open] [No Encryption] / [WEP] (When an option other than [No Encryption] is selected) Enter the encryption key ●●Check the wireless access points instruction manual and settings when a saving wireless access point. ●●If no connection can be established, the wireless access point’s radio waves may be too weak. Refer to “Message displays” (→299) and “Q&A Troubleshooting” (→310) for details. ●●Transmission speed may decrease, or may not be usable depending on the environment it is used in. 266 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections [Direct] Connecting directly You can select the connection method to your equipment. Select a connection method with which your equipment is compatible. Connection method [Wi-Fi Direct]*1 1 2 3 Description Set the device to Wi-Fi Direct™ mode Select [Wi-Fi Direct] Select the device to connect to •• Read the operating instructions of your device for details. [WPS (Push-Button)] 1 2 [WPS Connection]*2 [Manual Connection] Select [WPS (Push-Button)] Set the device to WPS mode •• You can wait longer for a connection by pressing the [DISP.] button on this unit. [WPS (PIN code)] 1 2 Select [WPS (PIN code)] 1 Enter the SSID and password into the device. The SSID and password are displayed on the connection waiting screen of this unit. Enter the PIN code of the device into this unit •• If the transfer destination is [Smartphone], you can read the QR Code with your smartphone to connect. (→229) QR Code SSID and Password *1 To connect this unit with [Wi-Fi Direct], Android OS 4.0 or above is required and the device must be compatible with Wi-Fi Direct™. *2 WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure the settings related to the connection and security of wireless LAN devices. 267 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections Connecting quickly with the same settings as used previously ([Select a destination from History] / [Select a destination from Favorite]) The camera keeps a History of times you used the Wi-Fi function. You can register items in the History to Favourite. You can easily connect with the same settings as used previously by connecting from History or Favourite. 1 Press [Wi-Fi] button 2 Select [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite] Item 3 Description [Select a destination from History] Connects using the same settings as used previously. [Select a destination from Favorite] Connects using settings registered in Favourite. Select the desired connection setting Registering History items to Favourite 1 2 3 4 268 Press [Wi-Fi] button Select [Select a destination from History] Select the item you wish to register and press Enter a registration name •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). •• Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character will be treated as two characters. SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections Editing items registered in Favourite 1 2 3 4 Press [Wi-Fi] button Select [Select a destination from Favorite] Select the Favourite item you wish to edit and press Select item Item Description [Remove from Favorite] — [Change the Order in Favorite] Select the destination [Change the Registered Name] •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). •• Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character will be treated as two characters. Registering and saving frequently used Wi-Fi connection settings to Favourites ●●The number of settings that can be saved in the history is limited. We recommend that you register and save frequently used Wi-Fi connection settings to Favourite. (→268) Checking connection details of History or Favourite ●●When selecting History or Favourite items, you can view connection details by pressing the [DISP.] button. ●●Performing [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] deletes content registered in History and Favourite. ●●When using [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite] to connect to a network to which many PCs are connected, it may be difficult to make the connection because the camera searches for previously connected equipment out of a large number of equipment pieces. If you cannot connect, retry the connection using [New Connection]. 269 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections Settings for sending pictures When sending pictures, first select [New Connection], then select the method of sending pictures. After you have completed connecting, you can also change the sending settings, such as the size of pictures to be sent. [Send Images While Recording] A picture can be automatically sent to a specified device every time you take it. ●●[   ] is displayed on the recording screen while connected by [Send Images While Recording], and [   ] is displayed while files are being sent. ●●If you turn off the camera before you have completed sending, or if you close the Wi-Fi connection, or in similar situations, unsent files will not be resent. ●●You may not be able to delete files or use the [Playback] menu while sending. 1 Not available in the following case: ●●Motion pictures cannot be sent. [Send Images Stored in the Camera] You can select and send recorded images. ●●Details of the [Playback] menu [Favorite] or [Print Set] settings will not be sent. Not available in the following cases: ●●Some images taken with a different camera may not be able to be sent. ●●Images that have been modified or edited with a computer may not be able to be sent. 270 SQW0024 Wi-Fi About connections Changing the settings for sending images After you have completed connecting, you can change the sending settings, such as the size of pictures to be sent, by pressing the [DISP.] button. Item [Size] Description Resize the image to send. [Original] / [Auto]*1 / [Change] •• If you select [Auto], the image size is determined by the circumstances at the destination. •• You can select the image size for [Change] from [M], [S], or [VGA]. The aspect ratio does not change. [File Format]*2 [JPG] / [RAW+JPG] / [RAW] [Delete Location Data]*3 Select whether to delete the location information from images before sending them. [ON]: Delete the location information, then send. [OFF]: Keep the location information and send. •• This operation only deletes the location information from the images that are set to be sent. (The location information will not be deleted from the original images stored in this unit.) [Cloud Limit]*4 You can select whether to send images when the Cloud Folder runs out of free space. [ON]: Do not send images. [OFF]: Delete images from the oldest ones, then send new images. *1 Only available when the destination is set to [Web service]. *2 Only available when the destination is set to [PC]. *3 Only available when the destination for [Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Cloud Sync. Service] or [Web service]. *4 Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service]. 271 SQW0024 Wi-Fi [Wi-Fi Setup] Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function. [Wi-Fi Setup] cannot be changed when connected to Wi-Fi. 1 Set the menu → [Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → Desired setting Item Description [LUMIX CLUB] Acquires or changes the “LUMIX CLUB” login ID. •• For details (→258). [PC Connection] You can set the workgroup. You must connect to the same workgroup as the destination computer when sending pictures to the computer. (The default is set to “WORKGROUP”) [Change Workgroup Name]: Enter the workgroup of the connecting computer. Close the menu after changing settings. [Restore to Default]: Returns settings to default settings. A confirmation screen is displayed. It is executed when [Yes] is selected. Exit the menu after it is executed. •• Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter text. •• To use with a computer of the standard settings, you do not have to change the workgroup. [Device Name] You can change the name of this unit. Press [DISP.] button Enter the desired device name •• Refer to “Entering Text” (→52) for information on how to enter text. •• Up to 32 characters can be entered. [NFC Operation] Makes NFC function setting. [ON]: The NFC function works. [OFF] [Touch Sharing] Set the operation to be performed when a Wi-Fi connection is established using the NFC function. [ON]: When a Wi-Fi connection is established using the NFC function while playing back a single picture, the picture (1 picture) is transferred. [OFF] 272 SQW0024 Wi-Fi [Wi-Fi Setup] Item [Wi-Fi Password] To prevent incorrect operation or use of the Wi-Fi function by a third party and to protect saved personal information, it is recommended that you protect the Wi-Fi function with a password. Description Setting a password will automatically display the password input screen when the Wi-Fi function is used. [Setup]: Enter any 4-digit numbers as the password. Close the menu after changing settings. [Delete]: A confirmation screen is displayed. It is executed when [Yes] is selected. Exit the menu after it is executed. •• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→52). •• Make a copy of password. If you forget the password, you can reset it with [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu, however other settings will also be reset. (excluding [LUMIX CLUB]) [Network Address] Displays the MAC address and IP address of this unit. 273 •• A “MAC Address” is a unique address that is used to identify network equipment. •• “IP address” refers to a number that identifies a PC connected to a network such as the Internet. Usually, the addresses for homes are automatically assigned by the DHCP function such as a wireless access point. (Example: 192.168.0.87) SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Enjoying 4K motion pictures Viewing 4K motion pictures ■■Viewing on TV screen When you connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV and play back a motion picture recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K], you can enjoy high-resolution 4K motion pictures. Although resolution output will be lower, you can also play back 4K motion pictures by connecting to a high-definition TV and other devices that do not have 4K support. Preparation When motion pictures are recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K], set [HDMI Mode] (→48) to [AUTO] or [4K]. Connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV using an HDMI micro cable and display the playback screen (→276) •• When the [VIERA Link] setting on the camera is set to [ON] and the camera is connected to a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television (VIERA), the television automatically switches its input and the playback screen is displayed. For details, refer to (→278). •• You can also play back motion pictures by inserting the card in a 4K-compatible TV equipped with a SD card slot. •• Read the operating instructions for the TV. ■■Viewing 4K motion pictures on a PC screen To play back motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] on a PC, use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” stored in the DVD (supplied). ••To play back and edit 4K motion pictures, a high-performance PC environment is required. ••For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF). 274 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Enjoying 4K motion pictures Storing 4K motion pictures ■■Storing 4K motion pictures on your PC Still/motion pictures can be copied from the camera to your computer by connecting the two together. For details, refer to (→280). ■■Storing 4K motion pictures on a DVD You cannot transfer or copy motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K] to a Blu-ray disc or DVD using a Panasonic recorder. (Current as of October 2014) You can use the supplied DVD software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to convert the file size of a motion picture to a smaller size or copy it to a DVD. ••For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF). 275 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Viewing on TV screen You can view pictures on a TV screen by connecting your camera to your TV with the HDMI micro cable or AV cable (optional). Preparation Turn off both camera and TV. 1 Connect camera to TV Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit. ■■To connect with an HDMI micro cable An HDMI micro cable can be used to enable viewing of still and motion pictures in high-resolution. [HDMI] socket Align the marks, and insert. To HDMI video/audio input socket HDMI micro cable Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not comply with the HDMI standards will not work. “High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long) ■■To connect with an AV cable (optional) [AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket Align the marks, and insert. AV cable (optional) 2 3 276 Yellow: To video socket White: To audio socket* *Monaural audio output. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input source to match the connection socket Turn on the camera and press the playback button SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Viewing on TV screen ■■To connect with an HDMI micro cable ●●Check the [HDMI Mode]. (→48) ●●To play back 24p motion pictures, set [HDMI Mode] to [AUTO]. Otherwise, the picture is not output at 24 frames per second. ●●Bars may appear at the sides or at the top and bottom of the screen, depending on the aspect ratio setting. ●●Cables that do not comply with HDMI standards will not work. ●●When an HDMI micro cable is connected, pictures are not displayed on the screen. ●●HDMI output will be cancelled if a USB connection cable (supplied) is connected simultaneously. ●●When the AV cable (optional) and HDMI micro cable are connected at the same time, no picture is output from the AV cable. ●●Pictures may be momentarily distorted immediately after commencing playback or pausing on certain televisions. ●●Audio output is stereo. ●●Read the operating instructions for the TV. ■■To connect with an AV cable (optional) ●●Check the [TV Aspect]. (→47) ●●Always use a genuine Panasonic AV cable (DMW-AVC1: optional). ●●You can play back pictures on TVs in other countries (regions) which use the NTSC or PAL system. You can find [Video Out] setting in [TV Connection] from the [Setup] menu. ●●Pictures rotated to portrait may be blurred slightly. ●●Change picture mode settings on TV if aspect ratios are not displayed correctly on widescreen or high-definition televisions. ●●The viewfinder display cannot be used. ●●Read the operating instructions for the TV. The recorded pictures can be played back on a TV with an SD Memory Card slot ●●Proper playback (aspect ratio) will be dependent on the TV used for viewing. ●●The file format of the motion pictures that can be played back differs depending on the TV model. ●●You may not be able to play back panorama pictures. Also you cannot perform automatic scrolling playback of panorama pictures. ●●For cards compatible with playback, refer to the operating instructions of the TV. 277 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Viewing on TV screen VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™) What is VIERA Link (HDMI)? ●●VIERA Link is a function that automatically links this camera to VIERA Linkcompatible devices by connecting HDMI micro cables for enabling easy operation with the VIERA remote control. (Some operations are not available.) ●●VIERA Link (HDMI) is an exclusive Panasonic function added to the industrystandard HDMI control functions known as HDMI CEC (Consumer Electronics Control). Operation is not guaranteed when connecting with non-Panasonic HDMI CEC-compatible devices. Refer to your product manual to verify compatibility with VIERA Link (HDMI). ●●This camera supports VIERA Link (HDMI) Version 5. This is the Panasonic standard that also supports previous Panasonic VIERA Link devices. Preparation Set [VIERA Link] to [ON] (→49). 1 2 3 278 Connect the camera to a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television (VIERA) with an HDMI micro cable (→276) Turn on the camera and press the playback button Operate with the remote control for the TV •• Operate with reference to the operation icons displayed on the screen. SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Viewing on TV screen ■■Other related operations Turning the unit OFF ••The camera can also be turned off when the television is turned off with the remote control. Automatic input select ••This function automatically switches the television input to the camera screen whenever the camera is turned on while it is connected via the HDMI micro cable. The television can also be switched on via the camera from Standby Mode (if “Power on link” on the television is set to “on”). ••If VIERA Link (HDMI) does not function correctly (→323) ●●Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not comply with the HDMI standards will not work. “High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long) ●●If you do not know if your TV is VIERA Link (HDMI) compatible, see the TV’s operating instructions. ●●Cables that do not comply with HDMI standards will not work. ●●When VIERA Link is activated, the [HDMI Mode] setting of this unit is automatically recognised. ●●If the [VIERA Link] setting on the camera is [ON], operations via the camera buttons will be limited. ●●Ensure that the television you are connecting to has been set up to enable VIERA Link (HDMI) (consult your television operating instructions for details). 279 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC Still/motion pictures can be copied from the camera to your computer by connecting the two together. ••Some computers can read directly from the camera’s memory card. For details, see the instruction manual for your computer. ••If your computer does not support SDXC Memory Cards, a message will be displayed requesting you to format the card. (Do not format the card. This will erase recorded pictures.) If the card is not recognised, refer to the following support website. http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html ■■Computer specifications You can connect the camera to a computer that can detect a mass storage device (device that stores a large volume of data). ••Windows: Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7 / Windows Vista ••Mac: OS X v10.5 - v10.9 Some motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] may not be scanned correctly by copying a file or folder ●●When using Windows, be sure to use the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the supplied DVD to copy motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]. ●●When using Mac, you can copy motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] using “iMovie”. Note, however, that it may not be possible to copy pictures depending on the picture quality settings. (For details about iMovie, please contact Apple Inc.) 280 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC About supplied software The supplied DVD contains the following software. Install the software on your computer before using. PHOTOfunSTUDIO 9.6 PE You can capture still pictures or motion pictures to your PC, or organise captured pictures by categorising by recording date, model name of the digital camera used to record, etc. You can also correct still pictures, edit motion pictures, or write to DVD. ••Operating environment Supported OS Windows® 8.1 (32-bit/64-bit) Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit) Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit) and SP1 Windows Vista® (32-bit) SP2 Windows® 8.1 CPU Windows® 8 Windows Vista® Display Pentium® III 1 GHz or higher Windows® 7 Pentium® III 800 MHz or higher 1024×768 pixels or more (1920×1080 pixels or more recommended) Windows® 8.1 RAM Windows® 8 Windows Vista® Free hard disk space 1 GB or more (32-bit) / 2 GB or more (64-bit) Windows® 7 512 MB or more 450 MB or more for installing software ••To edit 4K motion pictures, you need the 64-bit versions of Windows 8.1, Windows 8, or Windows 7. ••Refer to the Operating Instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF) for further information about the operating environment. You can read the Operating Instructions after launching the software. 281 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC SILKYPIX Developer Studio 4.2 SE This software develops and edits RAW file pictures. Edited pictures can be saved in a file format such as JPEG or TIFF that can be displayed on a PC, etc. ••Operating environment Supported OS Windows® 8.1 Windows® 8 Windows® 7 Windows Vista® Mac® OS X v10.5/v10.6/v10.7/v10.8/v10.9 ••For details on how to use the SILKYPIX Developer Studio, refer to the “Help” or the Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s support website: http://www.isl.co.jp/SILKYPIX/english/p/support/ LoiLoScope 30 day full trial version (Windows 8.1 / 8 / 7 / Vista) LoiLoScope is a video editing software that draws out the full power of your PC. Creating videos is as easy as organising cards on top of a desk. Use your music, picture and video files to create videos to share with your friends and family by burning it to a DVD, uploading it to websites, or simply share your videos with your friends via e-mail. ••This will only install a shortcut to the trial version download site. ••For more information on how to use LoiLoScope, read the LoiLoScope manual available for download at the link below. Manual URL: http://loilo.tv/product/20 282 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC Installing supplied software The software compatible with your PC will be installed. Preparations •• Check your PC’s specifications and operating environment for each software. •• Before inserting the DVD (supplied), close all running applications. 1 Insert the DVD with the supplied software 2 3 Click [Applications] •• If the automatic playback screen is displayed, you can display the menu by selecting and executing [Launcher.exe]. •• In Windows 8.1/Windows 8, you can display the menu by clicking a message that is displayed after inserting the DVD and then selecting and executing [Launcher.exe]. •• You can also display the menu by double-clicking [SFMXXXX] in [Computer]. (The “XXXX” portion differs depending on the model.) Click [Recommended Installation] •• Continue the installation procedure following the instructions displayed on the screen. ●●If you are using a Mac, you can manually install SILKYPIX. Insert the DVD with the supplied software Double-click the application folder on the DVD Double-click the folder that automatically appears Double-click the icon in the folder Not available in the following case: ●●PHOTOfunSTUDIO / LoiLoScope are not compatible with Mac. 283 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC Copying still pictures and motion pictures Preparations •• Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on your computer before starting the copying procedure. (→283) •• Turn on the camera and computer. 1 Connect camera to computer •• Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit. •• Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one or a genuine Panasonic USB connection cable (DMW-USBC1: optional). Using cables other than the above may cause a malfunction. [AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket Align the marks, and insert. [Access] (sending data) •• Do not disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) while [Access] is displayed. USB connection cable (supplied) 2 Use 3 Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to copy pictures to your computer to select [PC] and press [MENU/SET] •• Setting the [USB Mode] to [PC] removes the need to make the setting each time the camera is connected to the computer. •• For details on how to use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”, see the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” manual (PDF). ●●Do not delete or move copied files and folders using Windows Explorer or other browsers. Otherwise, you will not be able to play back or edit the files using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”. ■■For PTP mode The camera can be connected to your computer even if [USB Mode] (→47) is set to [PictBridge(PTP)]. ••Only picture output can be performed. ••If you cannot connect to your PC in PTP mode, set [USB Mode] to [PC] and reconnect. ••It may not be possible to import if there are 1,000 or more pictures on the card. ••Motion pictures or RAW pictures cannot be read. 284 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC ■■Copying to your computer without using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” You can save pictures to use on your computer by dragging and dropping folders and files into separate folders on your computer. ••The card of this unit contains the following files (folder structure). DCIM (Still/motion pictures) 100_PANA (Up to 999 pictures/folder) Card ●●Windows Drive (“LUMIX”) is displayed in “Computer”. ●●Mac Drive (“LUMIX”) is displayed on the desktop. Folder number P1000001.JPG*1 File number : P1000999.JPG Colour Space P: sRGB _: AdobeRGB 101_PANA : 999_PANA *2 MISC (DPOF files, Favourite) PRIVATE AVCHD (Motion pictures in AVCHD) *1 .JPG: Still pictures .RW2: Still pictures recorded in RAW file .MP4: [MP4] Motion Pictures *2 New folders are created in the following cases: •• When there is a picture with file number 999 inside the folder. •• When using cards already containing the same folder number (for example, pictures taken with other cameras, etc.). •• When recording after performing [No.Reset]. (→50) ●●Turn off the camera before inserting or removing memory cards. ●●Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). When the battery starts to run out during communications, a warning beep sounds. Cancel communication via your computer immediately. ●●For more details, consult your computer operating manual. 285 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures in the recorder Follow the correct method for your device. Copying by inserting the card into the recorder You can copy pictures using Panasonic equipment (such as Blu-ray disc recorders) with support for each file format. ••See the instruction manual for the recorder for details for copying and playing back. 32 Dubbing playback pictures via AV cables (optional) You can transfer or copy the pictures played back on this unit to a recorder, disc, video tapes, or other media using the standard picture quality. This method is useful as it allows dubbing to be performed even with devices that are not compatible with high definition images. Audio will be monaural. 1 Connect camera to recorder •• Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit. [AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket Align the marks, and insert. AV cable (optional) 2 3 To recorder’s input socket Start recording on recorder Start playback on camera •• To stop recording (dubbing), stop the recording on your recorder first before stopping the playback on the camera. ●●Always use a genuine Panasonic AV cable (DMW-AVC1: optional). ●●When using a TV with a 4:3 aspect ratio, always change the camera’s [TV Aspect] setting (→47) to [4:3] before dubbing. Motion pictures copied in the [16:9] setting will appear vertically stretched when viewed on a 4:3 TV screen. ●●For details on dubbing and playback methods, refer to your recorder’s operating instructions. 286 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Printing You can connect directly to a PictBridge-compatible printer for printing. ••Some printers can print directly from the camera’s memory card. For details, see the manual for your printer. Preparations •• Adjust the print quality or other settings on your printer, as needed. •• Turn on the camera and printer. 1 Connect camera to printer •• Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation) Also, do not insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit. •• Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one or a genuine Panasonic USB connection cable (DMW-USBC1: optional). Using cables other than the above may cause a malfunction. [AV OUT/DIGITAL] socket Align the marks, and insert. •• Do not disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) when the cable disconnection icon [   ] is displayed (may not be displayed with some printers). 2 3 4 Use USB connection cable (supplied) to select [PictBridge(PTP)] and press [MENU/SET] Use to select a picture and press [MENU/SET] Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET] (Print settings (→290)) ■■To cancel print Press [MENU/SET]. 287 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Printing Printing multiple pictures Multiple pictures are printed at one time. 1 2 3 Press to select [Multi Print] in step 3 (→287) Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET] Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET] •• [Multi Select]: Scroll between pictures with , select pictures to print with the [MENU/SET]. (Press [MENU/SET] again to release selection.) Use to select [OK], and press [MENU/SET]. •• [Select All]: Print all pictures. •• [Print Set (DPOF)]: Print pictures selected in [Print Set]. (→220) •• [Favorite]: Print pictures selected as [Favorite]. (→219) (Print settings (→290)) •• Select [Yes] if print confirmation screen is displayed. ●●The group pictures are displayed one by one instead of all pictures at the same time. ●●Turn off the camera before inserting or removing memory cards. ●●Disconnect USB connection cable (supplied) after printing. ●●Use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional). When the battery starts to run out during connection, a warning beep sounds. Cancel printing and disconnect USB connection cable. ●●An orange “●” displayed during printing indicates an error message. ●●Print may be divided into several pictures if printing a large amount of pictures. (Remaining sheets display may differ from the number of pictures set for printing.) Not available in the following cases: ●●Motion pictures cannot be printed. ●●Still pictures recorded in a RAW file cannot be printed. (The still pictures recorded in JPEG file format at the same time as the RAW file can be printed.) 288 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Printing Printing with date and text Time and date can be set to be printed on the picture when taking the picture by activating the [Text Stamp] function in the [Playback] menu. (→212) ■■Printing date without [Text Stamp] Printing in store: Only recording date can be printed. Request date printing in store. ••Making [Print Set] (→220) settings on the camera in advance allows settings for numbers of copies and date printing to be designated before giving the card to the store. ••When printing still pictures of 16:9 Aspect Ratio, check in advance that the store can accept this size. Using computer: Print settings for recording date and text information can be made using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the supplied DVD. Using printer: Recording date can be printed by setting [Print Set] on the camera, or by setting [Print with Date] (→290) to [ON] when connecting to a printer compatible with date printing. 289 SQW0024 Connecting with other devices Printing Making print settings on the camera Setting options include the number of printed pictures and their size. Make settings before selecting [Print start]. to select the item and press [MENU/SET] 1 Use Item 2 Settings [Print with Date] [ON] / [OFF] [Num.of prints] Set number of pictures (up to 999 pictures) [Paper Size] When [  [Page Layout] [  [  Use  ] is selected, the printer settings take priority.  ] (printer takes priority) / [   ] (1 picture, no border) /  ] (1 picture, with border) / [   ] (2 pictures) / [   ] (4 pictures) to select the setting and press [MENU/SET] ●●When setting [Print with Date] to [ON], check the date printing settings on the printer (printer settings may be prioritised). ●●To print a picture on which text or a date has been stamped, set [Print with Date] to [OFF]. (The still picture is printed with the date superimposed on it.) ●●Items may not be displayed if incompatible with printer. ●●To arrange [   ] “2 pictures” or [   ] “4 pictures” in the same still picture, set the number of prints for the still picture to 2 or 4. ●●To print to paper sizes/layouts not supported by this camera, set to [   ] and make settings on the printer. (Consult your printer’s operating manual.) ●●Even with completed [Print Set] settings, dates may not be printed, depending on the shop or printer used. 290 SQW0024 Others Optional accessories External Flash (optional) When you use the flashes (optional: DMW-FL220, DMW-FL360L, or DMW-FL580L), a wider effective flash range is provided than with the flash (supplied). Preparation Set the camera [ON/OFF] switch to [OFF]. Removing the hot shoe cover The hot shoe cover is already attached to the hot shoe at the time of purchase. Remove the hot shoe cover by pulling it in the direction indicated by arrow while pressing it in the direction indicated by arrow ••Be sure to attach the hot shoe cover when the hot shoe is not in use. ••Keep the hot shoe cover safely after removing it so that you do not lose it. ■■Using the flash (DMW-FL360L: optional) Attach the external flash to the hot shoe and then turn on the camera and the external flash Set the menu → [Rec] → [Flash] Press Press to select [Flash Mode] and press [MENU/SET] to select the item and press [MENU/SET] •• While the external flash is connected, the following icons are displayed. : External flash Forced ON : External flash Red-Eye Removal Forced ON* : External flash Slow Sync. : External flash Red-Eye Removal Slow Sync.* : External flash Forced OFF •• Signal-flashing with wireless flashes is also disabled. * When the flash mode is set to [AUTO] or [MANUAL] on the external flash, you cannot select the item. 291 SQW0024 Others Optional accessories When using other commercially available external flashes that don’t offer direct communication with the camera (DMC-LX100) ••It is necessary to set the exposure on the external flash when it is used. When you use an external flash in Auto Mode, use an external flash that allows you to set the aperture value and ISO Sensitivity to match the same settings on the camera. ••Set the camera to [Aperture-Priority] Mode or [Manual Exposure] Mode and then set the same aperture value and ISO Sensitivity on the external flash. (The proper exposure cannot be achieved because the aperture value changes in [Shutter-Priority] Mode. The light of the external flash cannot be properly adjusted since the aperture value cannot be fixed in [Program AE] Mode.) ●●You can set the aperture value, shutter speed and ISO Sensitivity on the camera even when the external flash is attached. ●●Some commercially available external flashes have synchro terminals with high-voltage or reversed polarity. If such flashes are used, they could cause a malfunction or hinder normal operation of the camera. ●●If you use commercially available external flashes (with communication functions) other than the ones compatible with this unit, they may not operate normally or they may be damaged. Do not use them. ●●Even if the external flash is turned off, the camera may enter the external flash mode when the external flash is attached. When you are not using the external flash, detach it. ●●When the external flash is attached, the camera will become unstable, and therefore we recommend using a tripod to take pictures. ●●Detach the external flash when you carry the camera. ●●Be sure to hold both the camera and the external flash when it is attached to the camera. If you hold only the external flash, it could become detached from the camera. ●●If the White Balance is set to [   ] when the external flash is used, perform fine adjustment of the White Balance if the recording results are not satisfactory. (→105) ●●If you take pictures close to the subject while taking wide-angle pictures, the light of the flash is obstructed by the lens and the bottom of the screen may be dark. ●●Refer to (→184) about the settings for the wireless flash. ●●Refer to the operating instructions of the external flash for further details. Using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) instead of the battery By using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), you can record and play back without worrying about the remaining battery charge. The optional DC coupler can only be used with the designated Panasonic AC adaptor. ●●Always use a genuine Panasonic AC adaptor (optional). ●●Also read the AC adaptor and DC coupler operating instructions. 292 SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays ••The following images are examples of when the display screen is set to [  style) in the monitor.  ] (monitor In recording 50i XXmXXs Recording Mode (→59) Motion picture recording mode (→58) Motion picture recording mode when [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] (→195) Custom Set (→60) Panorama picture recording mode (→150) Elapsed recording time* (→190) Simultaneous recording indicator (→198) Automatic switching between viewfinder and monitor (→54) [Peaking] (→130) [Highlight Shadow] (→102) [HDR] (→112) [Multi Exp.] (→159) Electronic shutter (→140) [Photo Style] (→100) 50i →←↑↓ EXPS Flash Mode (→180, 291) Flash (→182, 184) [Rec Format]/[Rec Quality] (→187) Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size] (→108) Card (displayed only during recording) (→25) Panorama Direction (→150) Types of picture effects (Filter) (→89) Picture effect (Filter) adjustment display (→91) * [m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”. 293 SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays 50i [Quality] (→109) AFS AFF AFC MF Focus Mode (→114) AF Mode (→115) AFL [Face Recog.] (→162) AF Lock (→133) Burst (→142) [Auto Bracket] (→145) [Aspect Bracket] (→147) Self-timer (→148) Panorama Direction (→150) Remaining battery (→21) Picture Mode (Still picture priorities) (→198) Macro recording (→126) Recording state (Flashes red.)/ Focus (Lights green.) (→56) Focus (Under low illumination) (→56) Wi-Fi connection status [4K PHOTO] marker (→196) [Time Lapse Shot] (→153) [Stop Motion Animation] (→156) Histogram (→64) Stabiliser (→168) Jitter alert (→168) 294 SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays 50i Destination settings / Travel elapsed days*2 (→42) Name*2 (→165) Age in years/months*2 (→165) Current date/time*2 World time*2: (→41) AEL 1.7 60 AF area (→56, 121) Spot metering target (→139) Self-timer*3 (→148) [Silent Mode] (→161) [Mic Level Disp.] (→200) AE Lock (→133) [Metering Mode] (→139) Programme Shift (→81) Aperture value (→56) Shutter speed (→56) Exposure compensation value (→135) Manual Exposure Assist (→87) ISO Sensitivity (→136) [Dial Guide] (→18) White Balance Bracket (→106) White Balance Fine Adjustment (→105) White Balance (→103) 98 R8m30s Number of recordable pictures*4 (→27) Available recording time*1*4 (→27) Exposure meter (→81) Zoom (→170, 174) *1 [m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”. *2 This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on, after setting the clock and after switching from Playback Mode to Recording Mode. *3 This is displayed during countdown. *4 It is possible to switch the display between the number of recordable pictures and available recording time with the [Remaining Disp.] setting in the [Custom] menu. 295 SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays ■■On-monitor recording information F1.7 1/60 Recording Mode (→59) Programme Shift (→81) Motion picture recording mode (→58) Motion picture recording mode when [4K PHOTO] is set to [ON] (→195) Custom Set (→60) Panorama picture recording mode (→150) Aperture value (→56) Shutter speed (→56) T (time) recording (→87) Remaining battery (→21) Card (displayed only during motion picture recording) (→25) ISO Sensitivity (→136) Exposure compensation value (→135) Manual Exposure Assist (→87) Flash Mode (→180, 291) Flash (→182, 184) Single (→141) Burst (→142) [Auto Bracket] (→145) [Aspect Bracket] (→147) Self-timer (→148) Panorama Direction (→150) AFS AFF AFC MF Focus Mode (→114) AF Mode (→115) 50i Wi-Fi [Quality] (→109) [Rec Format]/[Rec Quality] (→187) Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size] (→108) Wi-Fi (→225) Function button setting (→37) [Photo Style] (→100) AWB White Balance (→103) [i.Dynamic] (→111) 98 R8m30s [Metering Mode] (→139) Number of recordable pictures (→27) Available recording time* (→27) * [m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”. 296 SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays In playback 15 pic. 1ST DAY 11 months 30 days Playback Mode (→206) Protected picture (→221) Number of prints (→220) With location information (→207) Favourites (→219) Cable disconnect prohibit icon (→287) Motion picture playback (→70) Panorama picture playback (→152) Continuous playback of burst picture group (→201) Continuous playback of Time Lapse Shot picture group (→201) Continuous playback of stop motion animation group (→201) Text stamped display (→212) XXmXXs 50i 1/98 15 pic. XXmXXs 297 Acquiring information icon (→302) 1ST DAY Travel elapsed days (→42) Upload (Wi-Fi) icon (→254) Submenu icon (→202, 254) [Silent Mode] (→161) 11 months 30 days Age in years/months (→165) Name*2 (→164, 165) Location*2 (→42) Title*2 (→211) Recording information*3 Elapsed playback time*1 (→70) Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size] (→108) [Rec Format]/[Rec Quality] (→187) [Quality] (→109) Remaining battery (→21) *1 [m] and [s] indicate “minute” and “second”. Picture number/Total pictures *2 The displaying is performed in the following Number of pictures in burst priority order: title, travel destination, name Motion picture recording time*1 (babies and pets), and name ([Face Recog.]). 3 (→70) * This is not displayed for motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]. SQW0024 Others List of monitor/viewfinder displays ■■Detailed information display 10:00 1.DEC.2014 100-0001 Recording information [i.Dynamic]*1 (→111) Recording date/time World time (→41) [HDR]*2 (→112) [i.Resolution] (→111) 4K motion picture recorded by setting [4K PHOTO] to [ON] or a still picture captured from that 4K motion picture (→195) 50i 100-0001 Aspect Ratio/[Picture Size] (→108) [Quality] (→109) [Rec Format]/[Rec Quality] (→187) [Color Space]*2 (→113) Folder/File number*1 (→285) ■■Histgram display R G B Y 1/98 Histogram (→64) 100-0001 1/98 100-0001 Picture number/Total pictures Folder/File number*1 (→285) Recording information*1 *1 This is not displayed for motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]. *2 This is not displayed for motion pictures. 298 SQW0024 Others Message displays The following explains the meaning of major messages displayed on the monitor or viewfinder, and how to respond to them. ■■Memory cards [Memory Card Error] [Format this card?] •• The card format cannot be used with this camera. → Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26) [Insert SD card again] [Try another card] •• Access to card has failed. → Insert card again. •• Try with a different card. [Read Error] / [Write Error] [Please check the card] •• Data read has failed. → Check whether card has been inserted correctly (→24) •• Data write has failed. → Turn off the camera and remove the card. Reinsert the card and turn the camera on again. •• Card may possibly be damaged. → Try with a different card. [Motion recording was cancelled due to the limitation of the writing speed of the card] •• The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion picture. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to “About the motion picture recording and speed class” (→25). → If recording stops even when using a card of the recommended speed class (→25), the data writing speed has dropped. If this happens, we recommend backing up the data on the memory card and formatting it (→26). [Memory Card Error] [This memory card cannot be used] •• Not compatible with the camera. Use a compatible card. [Cannot record due to incompatible format(NTSC/PAL) data on this card.] •• Format the card after saving necessary data on a PC etc. (→26) → Insert a different card. 299 SQW0024 Others Message displays ■■Battery [This battery cannot be used] •• Use a genuine Panasonic battery. •• Battery cannot be recognised as terminal is dirty. → Wipe any dirt away from the battery terminal. ■■Wi-Fi function [Failed to connect wireless access point] / [Connection failed] / [No destination found] •• Check following regarding the wireless access point. → The wireless access point information set on this unit is wrong. Check the authentication type, encryption type, and encryption key. (→266) → Power of the wireless access point is not turned on. → Setting of the wireless access point is not supported by this unit. •• Check the network setting of the destination. •• Radio waves from other devices may block the connection to a wireless access point. → Check other devices that are connected to the wireless access point and devices that use the 2.4 GHz band. [No picture to send] •• This is displayed when there is no image to transmit due to the restriction of the destination. Check the file type of the image to transmit. (→239, 243, 244, 247, 251, 255) [Connection failed. Please retry in a few minutes.] / [Network disconnected. Transfer stopped.] •• Radio waves from the wireless access point are getting weak. → Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point. •• There is no reply from the server or it has exceeded the communication processing time. → Try again after a while. •• Depending on the wireless access point, connection may be automatically disconnected after specific time has passed. → Reconnect the connection again. [Upload to the Cloud Folder is available after Cloud Sync settings have been set up on downloadable devices such as PCs or smartphones.] •• Devices that download images from a cloud folder are not registered. •• Perform Cloud Sync setting. Configure the settings on a PC with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” or on a smartphone with “Image App”. For details on [Cloud Sync. Service], refer to (→255). [Connection failed] •• Check following regarding the smartphones you intend to connect. → The smartphone does not operate. → Change the access point to connect to in the smartphone Wi-Fi settings to this camera. → There is no free storage space on the smartphone. 300 SQW0024 Others Message displays [Login failed. Please check Login ID and Password.] •• Login ID or password for the “LUMIX CLUB” is not correct. Please enter it again. If you have forgotten the login ID or the password, there is information in the login screen of the “LUMIX CLUB” website. [Some files cannot be sent because of destination limit] / [Transfer completed. Some files are left because of destination limit.] •• Check the file format of the image to send. •• Sending motion pictures may fail if the file size is too large. Split the motion picture using [Video Divide]. (→214) [Unavailable. Please set Login settings on LUMIX CLUB web site.] •• Login to the “LUMIX CLUB” from your smartphone or PC, and set the login details of the destination WEB service. [Both picture and video sharing service cannot be selected together] •• WEB services designed only for pictures, and WEB services designed only for motion pictures cannot be selected at the same time. Deselect one of the services. [Cannot get IP address. Please set wireless AP’s IP address setting to DHCP.] •• Turn on DHCP settings of the IP address of the connected wireless access points. [Cannot connect to server] •• If a message is displaying asking to update the root certificate, agree to update the root certificate. 301 SQW0024 Others Message displays ■■Others [Some pictures cannot be deleted] [This picture cannot be deleted] •• Non-DCF pictures (→67) cannot be deleted. → Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26) [Cannot be set on this picture] •• [Print Set], [Title Edit], [Text Stamp], and other functions cannot be used for pictures that are not compliant with the DCF standard (→67). [Please turn camera off and then on again] [System Error] •• The lens is not working correctly. → Turn the camera on again. (Consult the dealer or your nearest Service Centre if display still remains.) [A folder cannot be created] •• Folder numbers in use have reached 999. → Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera (→26). Folder number is reset to 100 when performing [No.Reset] (→50). [Picture is displayed for 16:9 TV] [Picture is displayed for 4:3 TV] •• AV cable (optional) is connected to camera. → To remove message immediately → Press [MENU/SET]. → To change aspect ratio → Change [TV Aspect] (→47). •• USB connection cable (supplied) is only connected to camera. → Message disappears when cable is also connected to another device. [Editing operation cannot proceed as information processing is ongoing.] •• If you display the playback screen when the camera contains many picture files, the acquiring  ] or [   ] may be displayed for a long time. While either one of information icon [  these icons is displayed, some of the [Playback] menus cannot be used. →W  hen the camera is turned off while information is being acquired, only the pictures whose information has been acquired up to that time are saved as a group. When the camera is turned on again, the camera once again begins acquiring information of the remaining pictures in the group. 302 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Rec] You can perform settings such as picture size and flash (supplied/optional). ••The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic], [i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. [Photo Style] You can select the effects according to the concept of the picture that you want to create. Adjusts the colours of effects and picture quality. →100 [Picture Size] Set the number of pixels. →108 [Quality] Set the compression rate used for storing pictures. →109 [AFS/AFF/AFC] Select how the focus is adjusted. →114 [Metering Mode] Type of optical measurement to measure brightness can be changed. →139 [Burst Rate] Sets the burst speed to be used for burst recording. →142 [Auto Bracket] Sets the Single/Burst setting, compensation range, and recording sequence of Auto Bracket. →146 [Self Timer] Sets the time before recording starts when you take a picture using the self-timer. →148 [Highlight Shadow] You can adjust the highlights and shadows in a picture while confirming the brightness of these areas on the screen. →102 [i.Dynamic] Correcting contrast and exposure. →111 [i.Resolution] Records still pictures with sharper outlines and the impression of high-resolution. →111 [Simultaneous record w/o filter] Sets whether to record pictures with Filter and those without Filter at the same time. →91 [iHandheld Night Shot] Combines nightscape pictures recorded using high-speed burst recording into a single picture. →78 [iHDR] When there is, for example, strong contrast between the background and the subject, [iHDR] records multiple still pictures with differing exposures and combines them to create a single still picture rich in gradation. →79 [HDR] The camera can combine 3 still pictures taken with different exposures into a single properly exposed picture with rich gradation. →112 [Multi Exp.] You can create an effect similar to the operation of up to four times →159 of exposure on a single picture. 303 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Time Lapse Shot] You can preset the recording start time, recording interval, and the number of pictures to be taken when automatically recording time lapse motion pictures of subjects such as animals and plants. →153 [Stop Motion Animation] You can stitch still pictures to create stop motion animation. →156 [Panorama Direction] You can set the recording direction to be used for recording panorama pictures. →150 [Shutter Type] You can take pictures using two types of shutter modes: the mechanical shutter and electronic shutter. →140 [Flash] Performs flash settings in accordance with the recording conditions. →180 [Red-Eye Removal] Automatically detects red-eye and corrects still picture data when recording with flash. →180 [ISO Limit Set] Sets the optimal ISO Sensitivity using the selected value as the upper limit of ISO Sensitivity when [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or  ]. [  →137 [ISO Increments] Changes the ISO Sensitivity settings every 1/3 EV or 1 EV steps. →138 [Extended ISO] You can extend the numeric values that can be set for ISO Sensitivity. →138 [Long Shtr NR] Eliminates the noise made when taking pictures at a slower shutter →113 speed. [i.Zoom] Allows increasing the zoom ratio while suppressing the deterioration of picture quality. →172 [Digital Zoom] Improves the telephoto effect of your pictures. Note that enlarging will decrease picture quality. →173 [Color Space] You can set the method for reproducing the colours to correctly display the recorded pictures on the screens of a PC or printer, etc. →113 [Stabilizer] Automatically detects jitter during recording and makes corrections. →168 [Face Recog.] Recognises a registered face and automatically adjusts the focus and exposure for this face with higher priority. →162 [Profile Setup] You can set a name or birthday of a baby or pet before taking a picture to record the name or age in months/years in the picture. →165 304 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Motion Picture] You can perform settings, such as recording format and quality, for recording motion pictures. ••The [Photo Style], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic], [i.Resolution], [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] menu items are common for both [Rec] and [Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same name in other menu will also be changed automatically. For details, refer to the corresponding item of the [Rec] menu. [4K PHOTO] You can set the motion picture mode used for creating a highresolution still picture by capturing a single frame from a 4K motion →195 picture. [Rec Format] Sets the file format (AVCHD, MP4) of the motion picture to be recorded. [Rec Quality] Sets the picture quality of the motion picture (size, frame rate, etc.) →187 to be recorded. [Picture Mode] Sets the recording method of still pictures to be taken while recording motion pictures. →198 [Continuous AF] Constantly adjusts the focus on a subject that is in focus. →189 [Mic Level Disp.] You can set whether or not to display the microphone level on the recording screen. →200 [Mic Level Adj.] You can adjust the audio input level in 4 steps. →200 [Wind Cut] If you hear wind noise during an audio recording, you can use [Wind Cut] to effectively reduce the wind noise. →200 305 →187 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Custom] You can set operations of this unit, such as the screen display method and functions of a button, according to your preferences. You can also register the changed settings. [Utilize Custom Set feature] Calls up the setting registered using [Cust.Set Mem.]. [Cust.Set Mem.] Registers the current camera settings as a custom setting. →60 [Silent Mode] Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time. →161 [AF/AE Lock] Performs the lock setting of the focus and/or exposure used for executing AF/AE lock. →133 [AF/AE Lock Hold] Sets the [AF/AE LOCK] button operation used for recording by fixing the focus and/or exposure. →133 [Shutter AF] Enables focus adjustment automatically when the shutter button is pressed halfway. →124 [Half Press Release] Enables shutter release when the shutter button is pressed halfway. →124 [Quick AF] Enables faster focusing when the shutter button is pressed. →124 [Eye Sensor AF] Automatically adjusts the focus when the eye sensor is activated. →55 [Pinpoint AF Time] Sets the time for displaying the enlarged screen if the shutter button is pressed halfway when Auto Focus mode is set to [  →122 [Pinpoint AF Display] Sets whether the assist screen is to be enlarged on a part of the screen or the entire screen when Auto Focus mode is set to [   ]. →122 [AF Assist Lamp] Illuminates the AF Assist Lamp when the shutter button is pressed halfway when it is too dark to facilitate focusing. →125 [Direct Focus Area] Moves the AF area or MF assist using the cursor button while recording. →123 →131 [Focus/Release Priority] Disables recording when a subject is out of focus. →125 [AF+MF] Allows manual adjustment of the focus after AF is performed. →125 [MF Assist] Sets the display method for MF Assist (enlarged screen). →131 [MF Assist Display] Sets whether the Assist screen (enlarged screen) is to be enlarged →132 on part of the screen or over the entire screen. [MF Guide] Displays the MF guide used to check the direction of focus on the screen when the focus is manually adjusted. 306 →60  ]. →129 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Peaking] When you perform Manual Focus operation, this function automatically adds colour to the portions of the image that are in focus. →130 [Histogram] Sets whether to display the histogram. →64 [Guide Line] Sets the pattern of the guidelines to be displayed while recording. →65 [Highlight] Flashes the overexposed areas in black and white during [Auto Review] or playback. →72 [Zebra Pattern] Displays the area, where overexposure may occur, using a zebra pattern. →166 [Monochrome Live View] You can display the recording screen in black and white. →167 [Constant Preview] (M Mode) Allows the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed on the recording screen to be checked when [Manual Exposure] Mode is set. →87 [Expo.Meter] Sets whether to display the exposure meter. →81 [Dial Guide] Sets whether to display the operation guide. →18 [LVF Disp.Style] Sets the viewfinder display method. →63 [Monitor Disp. Style] Switching the monitor display method. →62 [Monitor Info. Disp.] Switches the recording information screen of the monitor. →65 [Rec Area] Switching the angle of view setting used for recording still pictures and motion pictures. →192 [Remaining Disp.] Switching the display between the number of recordable pictures that you can take and the available recording time. →28 [Auto Review] Set the time to display the pictures you have taken after taking still pictures. →57 [Fn Button Set] You can assign frequently-used functions to particular buttons. →37 [Zoom lever] Switches the zoom lever operation setting. →175 [Control Ring] You can assign frequently-used functions to control ring. →40 [Zoom Resume] Retaining the zoom position when the camera is turned off. →175 [Q.MENU] Switches the method for setting Quick Menu items. →34 [iA Button Switch] Changes the operation method of the [iA] button used for switching →75 to [Intelligent Auto] Mode. [Video Button] Enabling/disabling the motion picture button. →192 [Eye Sensor] Setting the sensitivity of the eye sensor or setting to switch the display between the viewfinder and monitor. →55 307 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Setup] You can perform settings for convenience of use such as the clock setting and changing of the beep sounds. You can also perform Wi-Fi function related settings. [Clock Set] Set time, date, and display format. [World Time] Set the local time at travel destination. →41 [Travel Date] If you set your travel schedule and record pictures, the day of your trip on which the picture was taken will be recorded. →42 [Wi-Fi] Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function. →272 [Beep] Sets the beep sounds or shutter sounds. →43 [Live View Mode] Sets the display speed and picture quality of the screen (Live View →43 screen) when recording pictures. [Monitor Display]/ [Viewfinder] Adjust brightness and colour of the monitor or viewfinder. →44 [Monitor Luminance] You can adjust the brightness of the monitor depending on how bright it is around the camera. →45 [Sleep Mode] The camera automatically turns off if no operation is performed for a preset period of time. →46 [USB Mode] Select communication method for when connecting camera to a computer or printer with USB connection cable (supplied). →47 [TV Connection] Change the settings to be used when the camera is connected to a TV or other device. →47 [Menu Resume] Save the last operated menu position. →49 [Menu Background] Set the background colour for the menu screen. →49 [Menu Information] Explanations of the menu items and settings are displayed on the menu screen. →49 [Language] Set the language displayed on the screen. →49 [Version Disp.] Check the firmware version of the camera or supplied flash (when the flash is attached). →50 [Self Timer Auto Off] The self-timer is cancelled if the unit is turned off. →50 [No.Reset] Reset picture file numbers. →50 [Reset] Reset to the default settings. →50 [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] Return [Wi-Fi] settings to default settings. →51 [Format] Format (initialise) a memory card. →26 308 →29 SQW0024 Others Menu list [Playback] You can specify picture protection, resizing, print settings, and other settings for pictures you have taken. [Slide Show] Automatically play pictures in order. →204 [Playback Mode] You can narrow down the pictures to be displayed with set filters, such as categories or favourite pictures. →206 [Location Logging] You can write location information (longitude/latitude) sent from the →207 smartphone to the pictures. [RAW Processing] You can use the camera to develop still pictures that were recorded in RAW format. The created still pictures are saved in JPEG format. →208 [Title Edit] Allows characters (comments) to be entered on a recorded picture. →211 [Text Stamp] You can stamp the recording date and time, names, travel destination, travel dates, etc. on the recorded still pictures. →212 [Video Divide] A single motion picture can be split into 2 parts. →214 [Time Lapse Video] You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using [Time Lapse Shot]. →215 [Stop Motion Video] You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using [Stop Motion Animation]. →215 [Resize] Picture size can be reduced. →216 [Cropping] Enlarge your still pictures and crop unwanted areas. →217 [Rotate] Manually rotate pictures by 90°. →218 [Rotate Disp.] Automatically rotate portrait pictures. →218 [Favorite] Allows a label to be assigned to a picture with a mark to set it as your favourite picture. →219 [Print Set] Sets the pictures and the number of pictures to be printed. →220 [Protect] Set protection to prevent deletion of pictures by mistake. →221 [Face Rec Edit] Edit or delete the recognition information for pictures with mistaken →222 Face Recognition. [Picture Sort] You can set the display sequence used for playing back pictures on this unit. →223 [Delete Confirmation] You can set the Yes/No options that you want to select first on the confirmation screen when you delete a picture from either [Yes] or [No]. →223 309 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting Try checking these items (→310 - 325) first. If the problem persists, Performing [Reset] in the [Setup] menu may resolve the issue (→50). (Note that except for some items such as [Clock Set], all settings are returned to their values at the time of purchase.) Also, see the Panasonic support site for the latest support information. http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/ (This site is available in English only.) ■■Battery, power Camera does not work even if the camera is turned on. •• Battery is not inserted correctly (→24), or needs recharging. Camera switches off as soon as the camera is turned on. •• Battery needs recharging. This unit is turned off automatically. •• [Sleep Mode] is activated. (→46) •• If you connect to a TV compatible with VIERA Link (HDMI) with an HDMI micro cable and turn off the TV with the remote control for the TV, this unit also turns off. → If you are not using VIERA Link (HDMI), set [VIERA Link] to [OFF]. (→49) The battery runs down quickly. •• The Wi-Fi connection has been on for a long time. → The battery is used up faster with a Wi-Fi connection. Turn off the camera as often as possible using [Sleep Mode] (→46) or other methods. 310 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Recording Cannot record pictures. •• Card is full. → Free space by deleting unwanted pictures (→73). •• When a large capacity card is used, you may not be able to take a picture for a while after you turn on the camera. •• Focus is not aligned. → When [Focus/Release Priority] is set to [FOCUS], the camera will not record until proper focusing is achieved. (→125) Recorded pictures look white. •• Lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.). → Turn the camera on to extract lens barrel, and clean lens surface with a soft, dry cloth. •• Lens is foggy (→12). Recorded pictures are too bright/too dark. •• Adjust the exposure (→135). •• AE Lock (→133) is set inappropriately. Zooming stops instantaneously. •• When using the Extra Optical Zoom, the zooming action will stop temporarily. This is not a malfunction. Some pictures are taken when I press the shutter button just once. •• Camera is set to use [Auto Bracket], White Balance Bracket, [Aspect Bracket], or [Burst]. SelfTimer is set to [   ]. → Clear the setting. (→106, 141) Unable to perform bracket recording. •• The remaining memory space in the card is low. → Check the remaining memory space in the card. Focus not aligned correctly. •• Subject outside of focus range. (→126) •• Caused by jitter or subject movement. (→168) •• [Focus/Release Priority] is set to [RELEASE]. (→125) •• [Shutter AF] is set to [OFF]. (→124) •• AF Lock (→133) is set inappropriately. Recorded pictures are blurred. The stabiliser function ineffective. •• Shutter speed is slower in dark locations and the stabiliser function is less effective. → Hold camera firmly with both hands, keeping arms close to body. •• Use a tripod and the self-timer when using a slower shutter speed (→148). 311 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting Recorded pictures appear coarse, or there is interference. •• We recommend trying the following methods. → Lower [Sensitivity] (→136). → Take pictures in brighter locations. → Either adjust [Noise Reduction] of [Photo Style] to a higher setting or set each item other than [Noise Reduction] to a lower setting. (→101) → Set [Long Shtr NR] to [ON]. (→113) → Change the settings of [Picture Size] (→108) and [Quality] (→109). •• When Digital Zoom is used, the picture quality will become lower if you zoom in higher. Striping or flicker may appear under lighting such as fluorescent lighting and LED lighting fixture. The subject appears distorted. •• This is characteristic of MOS sensors which serve as the camera’s pickup sensors. This is not a malfunction. If the subject passes quickly in front of the lens, it will appear slightly distorted. •• If you are taking still pictures using [ESHTR], the striping may be reduced by setting a slower shutter speed. (→84) Brightness or colouring of recorded picture different from real life. •• When recording under fluorescent or LED lighting fixture etc., increasing the shutter speed may introduce slight changes to brightness and colour. These are a result of the characteristics of the light source and do not indicate a malfunction. •• When recording subjects in extremely bright locations or recording under fluorescent lighting, LED lighting fixture, mercury lamp, sodium lighting etc., the colours and screen brightness may change or horizontal striping may appear on the screen. Reddish horizontal streaks appear on the screen during recording. •• This is characteristic of the MOS sensors, which serve as the camera’s pickup sensors. The streaks appear when the subject has a bright part. Some unevenness may occur in the surrounding areas, but this is not a malfunction. It is recorded in motion pictures but is not recorded on still pictures. •• It is recommended that you take pictures while taking care not to expose the screen to sunlight or any other source of strong light. Motion picture recording stops midway. •• The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion picture. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to “About the motion picture recording and speed class” (→25). •• If recording stops even when using a card of the recommended speed class, the data writing speed has dropped. If this happens, we recommend backing up the data on the memory card and formatting it (→26). 312 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting The screen turns dark while recording motion pictures. •• While motion pictures are being recorded, the screen may turn dark as time passes in order to slow battery consumption. This condition, however, will not affect the recorded motion picture. The screen turns momentarily black or noise is recorded. •• While motion pictures are being recorded, the screen may momentarily turn black or noise may be recorded due to static electricity or strong electromagnetic waves (radio transmitters, high-voltage lines, etc.) under some environmental conditions. Sometimes focus adjustment with Auto Focus mode is difficult while recording 4K motion pictures. •• This may occur when taking a picture by reducing the Auto Focus speed in order to adjust the focus at high precision. This is not a malfunction. Panorama picture recording stops before finishing. •• If the pan motion of the camera is too slow, the camera assumes that the operation has been aborted and stops recording. •• If the pan motion of the camera is too shaky when it is moved toward the recording direction, the camera stops recording. The subject cannot be locked. (AF track fails) •• If the colour of the subject is similar to that of its background, AF Tracking may not function. Set the AF lock to the colours specific to the subject. Low or inaudible operating sound. •• The speaker is blocked. •• [Silent Mode] is set to [ON] (→161). 313 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Monitor/viewfinder The monitor/viewfinder is turned off although the camera is turned on. •• When a hand or object is close to the eye sensor, the monitor display mode could be switched to viewfinder display mode without your knowledge. (→54) Pictures do not show on the monitor. •• Viewfinder display mode is activated. → Press the [LVF] button to switch to the monitor display mode. (→54) •• Monitor is turned off. → Press the [DISP.] button to switch the display information. (→62) •• When you connect the camera to a TV using an HDMI micro cable, the picture is not displayed on a monitor/viewfinder in the following cases. –– During playback Brightness is unstable. •• Aperture value is set while shutter button is pressed halfway. (Does not affect recorded picture.) This symptom may also occur when the brightness changes because the zoom is operated or the camera is moved. This is the automatic aperture operation of the camera and is not a malfunction. The screen flickers indoors. •• The screen may flicker for a few seconds after turning on. This is an operation to correct flicker caused by lighting such as fluorescent lights, LED lights, etc. and is not a malfunction. The screen is too bright/too dark. •• Check [Monitor Luminance] setting. (→45) •• Use [Monitor Display]/[Viewfinder] to adjust the brightness of the screen. (→44) Black/blue/red/green dots or interference appears. Monitor looks distorted when touched. •• This is not a fault, and will not be recorded on the actual pictures. Noise appears on the monitor/viewfinder. •• In dark places, noise may appear to maintain the brightness of the monitor/viewfinder. Cannot switch between the monitor and viewfinder when pressing [LVF] button. •• When it is connected to a computer or printer, the camera can display pictures on the monitor only. 314 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Flash Unable to perform [Flash]. •• Flash (supplied/optional) is not attached properly. → Properly attach a flash (supplied/optional) to the camera. (→176, 291) •• For details about flash settings, refer to (→176 - 186, 291). No flash emitted. The flash becomes unavailable in the following cases. •• When the picture effect (Filter) is set •• When camera is set to use [Auto Bracket], White Balance Bracket, or [Aspect Bracket] •• When using [Burst] •• During panorama picture recording •• When [HDR] is set to [ON] •• When the electronic shutter is used (→140) → Set [Shutter Type] to [AUTO] or [MSHTR]. •• When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON] (→161) → Set [Silent Mode] to [OFF]. The flash fires twice. •• The flash (supplied) fires twice. (Except when [Firing Mode] of [Flash] is set to [MANUAL]) When red-eye reduction (→180) is set, the firing interval will be longer. Make sure that the subject does not move until the second firing is completed. 315 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Playback Pictures have been rotated. •• [Rotate Disp.] is activated. (→218) Cannot view pictures. There are no recorded pictures. •• A card is not inserted in the camera. •• There is no picture on the card to play back. •• Has the file name of the picture been changed on a computer? If so, it cannot be played back on the camera. •• [Playback Mode] is set to other than [Normal Play]. → Set [Playback Mode] to [Normal Play]. (→206) Folder/file number displayed as [-]. Picture is black. •• Picture edited on computer or taken with different device. •• Battery removed immediately after picture taken, or picture taken with low battery. → Use [Format] to delete (→26). Incorrect date displayed in Calendar Search. •• Picture edited on computer or taken with different device. •• [Clock Set] is incorrect (→29). (Incorrect date may be displayed in Calendar Search on pictures copied to a computer and then back to this unit, if computer and camera dates differ.) White round spots like soap bubbles appear on the recorded picture. •• If you take a picture with the flash in a dark place or indoors, white round spots may appear on the picture caused by the flash reflecting particles of dust in the air. This is not a fault. A characteristic of this is that the number of round spots and their position differ in every picture. [Thumbnail is displayed] is shown on the screen. •• The pictures may have been recorded on another device. If so, they may be displayed with poor picture quality. Red areas in pictures appear blackened.  ]) is operating, if a subject is recorded that has skin•• When digital red-eye correction ([   ], [  coloured areas with red areas inside, the digital red-eye correction function may blacken the red areas. → We recommend setting the flash (supplied/optional) to [   ], or [Red-Eye Removal] to [OFF] before recording. (→180) 316 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting An unusual noise, such as a clicking or buzzing noise, is recorded on a motion picture. Audio is recorded at low volumes. •• When recording a motion picture in a quiet environment, noise due to the motion of the aperture and focusing mechanism may be recorded on the motion picture. Note that this is not a fault. You can set the focus operation during motion picture recording to [OFF] using [Continuous AF] (→189). •• Note that if you perform operations such as zoom, using buttons or dials, while recording a motion picture, operation noise may be recorded. •• If you block the microphone with your fingers while motion pictures are being recorded, the audio may be recorded at a low volume or may not be recorded at all. In this case, the camera may pick up the lens operating sounds more easily. Operating sounds are recorded at the end of the motion picture recording. •• Since motion pictures are recorded until the motion picture button is pressed to stop recording, the operating sound level in the picture may be higher. To suppress this sound, we recommend trying the following method. → Divide the end part of a motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214) in the [Playback] menu. In some cases, motion pictures cannot be divided at a position close to the end part of the motion picture. To avoid this problem, continue recording for an extra 3 seconds. Playback and operation sounds are too low. •• The speaker is blocked. (→15) Motion pictures taken with this camera cannot be played in other cameras. •• Even if a device is compatible with AVCHD and MP4, the motion pictures that were recorded on this unit may have bad picture quality or sound quality upon playback, or may be unable to be played back. Also, the recording information may not be displayed correctly. 317 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Wi-Fi function It cannot connect to the wireless LAN. Radio waves get disconnected. •• Use within the communication range of the wireless LAN network. •• Connection types and security setting methods are different depending on the wireless access point. → Refer to the operating instructions of the wireless access point. •• When the radio waves are interrupted, the condition may improve by moving the location or changing the angle of the wireless access point. •• When this unit is placed on a metal table or shelf, the connection may not be established easily because the camera is affected by radio waves. Use the camera away from metal surfaces. •• It may not automatically connect when the network SSID of the wireless access point is set not to broadcast. → Set the network SSID of the wireless access point to broadcast. •• Is any device, such as microwave oven, cordless phone, etc., that uses 2.4 GHz frequency operated nearby? → Radio waves may get interrupted when used simultaneously. Use them sufficiently away from the device. •• Is the 5 GHz/2.4 GHz switchable wireless access point connected to other equipment using the 5 GHz band? → The use of a wireless access point that can use 5 GHz/2.4 GHz simultaneously is recommended. It cannot be used simultaneously with this camera if it is not compatible. •• When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or the connection may be disrupted. (A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.) •• Perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu. 318 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting Wireless access point is not displayed. Or it cannot be connected. •• Check if the wireless access point to connect is in operating state. •• The camera may not display or connect to a wireless access point depending on the radio wave condition. → Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point. → Remove the obstacles between this unit and the wireless access point. → Change the direction of this unit. •• It may not display even if the radio waves exist depending on the setting of the wireless access point. → Check the settings of the wireless access point. •• The wireless access point may not be found depending on the radio wave condition. → Perform the [Manual Input]. (→266) •• Is the network SSID of the wireless access point set not to broadcast? → It may not be detected when it is set not to broadcast. Enter and set the network SSID. (→265) •• Connection methods differ depending on the wireless access point. → Refer to the operating instructions of the wireless access point. It takes long time every time to connect to a smartphone. •• It may take longer time to connect depending on the Wi-Fi connection setting of the smartphone, but it is not a malfunction. This unit is not displayed in the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone. → Try switching the ON/OFF of the Wi-Fi function in the Wi-Fi settings of the smartphone. I have forgotten the login ID or password for the “LUMIX CLUB”. •• Check the information in the login screen of “LUMIX CLUB”. http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/ 319 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting I do not have a wireless access point at my home, but I would like to perform service user registration of the “LUMIX CLUB”. •• Service user registration for the “LUMIX CLUB” is not possible in the environment without a wireless access point. The camera cannot be connected to Mac computer/Windows PC via Wi-Fi connection. → Please confirm login name and password are correctly typed. → When the system time of Mac computer or Windows PC connected to a camera differs severely from that of the camera, the camera cannot be connected to the computer or PC in some OSs. Please confirm clock set and world time of the camera matches with time, date and time zone in Windows PC or Mac computer. When both settings do not match severely, please match them. I am having a problem connecting to my Windows 8 PC. The user name and password are not recognised. •• Depending on the OS version, on Windows 8, for example, there are two types of user account (local account/Microsoft account). → Be sure to set the local account and use the user name and password for the local account. The Wi-Fi connection is not recognising my PC. •• By default, the Wi-Fi connection uses the default workgroup name of “WORKGROUP”. If the name of the workgroup has been changed, it will not be recognised. → Select [PC Connection] then [Change Workgroup Name] in the [Wi-Fi Setup] to change the workgroup name to match that of your PC. (→272) Pictures cannot be transmitted to the computer. •• If a firewall is enabled by the OS or security software, this unit may be unable to connect to the computer. Images cannot be transmitted to the WEB service. •• Confirm that the login information (login ID/user name/email address/password) is correct. •• WEB service server or the network may be busy. → Try again after a while. → Check the site of the WEB service you are sending the image to. 320 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting It takes time to transmit an image to the WEB service. •• Is the size of the image too large? → Transmit after dividing the motion picture with [Video Divide] (→214). → Reduce the image size at [Size] (→271), and then send. •• It may take longer time to transmit when distance to the wireless access point is far. → Transmit closer to the wireless access point. The image that was supposed to have uploaded to the WEB service is not there. •• Upload may not complete when it is disconnected while transmitting the image. •• It may take some time after uploading the image to be reflected in the WEB service depending on the status of the server. → Wait for a while and try again. •• You can check the transmission status on the WEB service link settings by logging into “LUMIX CLUB”. I would like to return the image in the WEB service to the camera. •• The images in the WEB Service cannot be saved (downloaded) to this unit. Do not delete the uploaded images, and make a backup of them. I cannot display or delete the images uploaded to the WEB service by this unit. •• The images uploaded to the WEB service cannot be displayed or deleted by this unit. → Perform the task using a smartphone or a PC. Your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password were deleted after sending the camera in to be repaired. •• The settings stored in the camera may be deleted depending on the type of repair. → Always make a copy of important settings. Transmission of the image fails midway. There is an image that could not be transmitted. •• Image cannot be transmitted when the battery indicator is flashing red. •• Is the size of the image too large? → Divide the motion picture using [Video Divide] (→214). → Reduce the image size at [Size] (→271), and then send. •• File format of the picture that can be sent differs depending on the destination. (→239, 243, 244, 247, 251, 255) •• Capacity or number of images in the WEB service is full. → Login to “LUMIX CLUB”, and check the status of the destination on the WEB service link settings. 321 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting I have forgotten the password for the Wi-Fi. → Execute the [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu. (→51) However, the information you have set on the [Wi-Fi Setup] will be reset. I cannot send images to an AV device. •• Sending may fail depending on the operational status of the AV device. Also, sending may take a while. I cannot connect using the NFC function. •• The smartphone is not NFC compatible. This function can be used with NFC compatible devices with Android (2.3.3 or above). •• Is the NFC function on the smartphone turned off? •• The [NFC Operation] on this unit is set to [OFF]. (→272) •• The camera has a hard time recognising some smartphone models. If it is not recognised, slowly shift the smartphone while it is beside the unit. •• If you hold the smartphone for too short a time, the camera may not be able to recognise the smartphone. Hold the smartphone for a while. 322 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■TV, computer, printer No image appears on TV. Image blurred or not coloured. •• Not connected correctly (→276). •• The television has not been switched to auxiliary input. The display on the TV and on the camera do not match. •• Aspect ratio may be incorrect or edges may be cut off with certain televisions. Cannot play motion pictures on TV. •• Card is inserted into TV. → Connect with AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable and play on camera (→276). Picture is not displayed on full TV screen. •• Check [TV Aspect] settings (→47). No sound is output from the camera speaker. •• When the AV cable (optional) or HDMI micro cable is connected to the camera, no sound is output from the camera. VIERA Link (HDMI) is not working. •• Is the HDMI micro cable connected correctly? (→276) → Check that the HDMI micro cable is fully inserted. •• Is the camera’s [VIERA Link] setting set to [ON]? (→49) → The input setting may not be able to be changed automatically with certain television HDMI sockets. In this case, please change the input setting with your television’s remote control (consult your television’s operating instructions for details). → Check the VIERA Link (HDMI) settings on the device you are connecting to. → Turn the camera off and on again. → Turn the “VIERA Link control (HDMI device control)” setting on your television (VIERA) to off and then to on again. (Consult your VIERA’s operating instructions for details.) Cannot communicate with the computer. •• Not connected correctly (→284). •• Check whether computer has recognised camera. → Set [USB Mode] to [PC] (→47). → Turn the camera off and then on again. Computer does not recognise card. •• Disconnect USB connection cable (supplied) and reconnect with card in place. •• If there are two or more USB terminal on a single PC, try connecting the USB connection cable to another USB terminal. 323 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting Computer does not recognise card. (When using an SDXC Memory Card) → Check whether your computer is compatible with SDXC Memory Cards. http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html → A message prompting you to format the card may appear when you connect it. Do not format the card. → If the [Access] indicator on the screen does not go off, turn the camera off before disconnecting the USB connection cable. Cannot print when connecting to printer. •• Printer not compatible with PictBridge. •• Set [USB Mode] to [PictBridge(PTP)] (→47, 287). The edges of pictures are cut off when printing. •• Release any trimming or edgeless printing settings on printer before printing. (Refer to the instruction manual for the printer.) •• The aspect ratio of pictures is different from that of paper used for printing. → If printing in shop, check if 16:9 sizes can be printed. Cannot print panorama pictures properly. •• The aspect ratio of panorama pictures is different from that of regular still pictures, and some panorama pictures may not be printed correctly. → Use a printer with support for panorama pictures. (Refer to the instruction manual for the printer.) → We recommend adjusting the size of a picture in accordance with print paper using the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software on the DVD (supplied). 324 SQW0024 Others Q&A Troubleshooting ■■Others Menu not displayed in desired language. •• Change [Language] setting (→49). Camera rattles if shaken. •• This sound is made by the lens movement and is not a fault. The lens makes a clicking noise. •• When the camera is turned on or off, the lens is moved, or an aperture operation is performed, such a noise may be heard. This is not a malfunction. •• When the brightness changes after a zooming operation or moving the camera, the lens may make a noise while adjusting the aperture. This is not a malfunction. Red lamp illuminated when pressing shutter button halfway in dark locations. •• [AF Assist Lamp] is set to [ON] (→125). AF Assist Lamp is not illuminated. •• [AF Assist Lamp] is set to [OFF] (→125). •• Not illuminated in bright locations. Part of a picture flashes black and white. •• [Highlight] is set to [ON]. (→72) Camera is hot. •• Camera may become a little warm during use, but this does not affect performance or quality. Clock is incorrect. •• Camera has been left for a long period. → Reset the clock (→30). •• A long time was taken to set the clock (clock will be behind by the same lapse of time). When using zoom, picture becomes slightly warped and the edges of the subject become coloured. •• Pictures may be slightly warped or coloured around the edges, depending on the zoom ratio, but this is not a fault. File numbers are not recorded in sequence. •• File numbers are reset when new folders are created (→50). •• If you perform this operation after performing a specific operation, the picture may be saved in a folder with a different folder number than the previous folder number. File numbers have jumped backwards. •• Battery was removed/inserted with the camera turned on. (Numbers may jump backwards if folder/ file numbers are not correctly recorded.) 325 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes When in use ●●Camera may become warm if used for long periods of time, but this is not a fault. ●●Keep this unit as far away as possible from electromagnetic equipment (such as microwave ovens, TVs, video games etc.). ••If you use this unit on top of or near a TV, the pictures and/or sound on this unit may be disrupted by electromagnetic wave radiation. ••Do not use this unit near cell phones because doing so may result in noise adversely affecting the pictures and/or sound. ••Recorded data may be damaged, or pictures may be distorted, by strong magnetic fields created by speakers or large motors. ••Electromagnetic wave radiation may adversely affect this unit, disturbing the pictures and/or sound. ••If this unit is adversely affected by electromagnetic equipment and stops functioning properly, turn this unit off and remove the battery or disconnect AC adaptor (optional). Then reinsert the battery or reconnect AC adaptor and turn this unit on. Do not use this unit near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines. ••If you record near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines, the recorded pictures and/ or sound may be adversely affected. ●●Do not extend the supplied cord or cable. ●●Do not allow camera to come into contact with pesticides or volatile substances (can cause surface damage or coating to peel). ●●Do not keep objects that may be influenced magnetically close to the speaker. ••Magnetised objects such as bank cards, commuter passes, watches, may be adversely affected by the magnetic influence of the speaker. ●●Never leave the camera and the battery in a car or on a car hood in the summer. Doing so may cause leakage of the battery electrolyte, overheating, fire or a battery explosion due to the high temperature. Caring for your camera To clean your camera, remove the battery or the DC coupler (optional), or disconnect the power plug from the outlet, and wipe with a soft, dry cloth. ●●Use a damp cloth to remove stubborn stains, before wiping with a dry cloth. ●●Do not use benzine, thinners, alcohol, or kitchen detergent, as these may damage the outer casing and finish of the camera. ●●If using a chemically-treated cloth, read the supplied instructions carefully. 326 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes When not using for a while ●●Turn off the camera before removing battery and card (ensure that battery is removed to prevent damage through over-discharge). ●●Do not leave in contact with rubber or plastic bags. ●●Store together with a drying agent (silica gel) if leaving in drawer, etc. Store batteries in cool (15 °C to 25 °C (59 °F to 77 °F)) places with low humidity (40%RH to 60%RH) and no major temperature changes. ●●Charge battery once per year and use completely before storing again. Memory cards ●●To prevent damage to cards and data ••Avoid high temperatures, direct sunlight, electromagnetic waves, and static electricity. ••Do not bend, drop, or expose to strong impacts. ••Do not touch terminals on reverse of card or allow them to become dirty or wet. ●●Recorded data may be damaged or lost if the camera breaks down due to inappropriate handling. Panasonic will not be liable for any damage caused due to loss of recorded data. ●●When disposing of/transferring memory cards ••If using the “format” or “delete” functions on your camera or computer, this only changes the file management information, and does not completely delete the data from within the memory card. When disposing of or transferring your memory cards, we recommend physically destroying them, or using commercially available computer data erasing software to completely delete the data from the card. Data within memory cards should be managed responsibly. Monitor/viewfinder ●●Do not press hard on the monitor. This may cause uneven display and damage the monitor. ●●In cold climates or other situations when the camera becomes cold, the monitor or the viewfinder may appear slightly darker than normal immediately after the camera is turned on. Normal brightness will return once the internal components have warmed up. The monitor and viewfinder are made with extremely high precision technology. However there may be some dark or bright spots (red, blue or green) on the screen. This is not a malfunction. The monitor and viewfinder screens are controlled with extremely high precision, but some pixels may be inactive. The spots will not be recorded on pictures on a card. 327 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes Battery The battery is a rechargeable lithium ion battery. This battery is easily affected by temperature and humidity, and is affected more when the temperature is high or low. ●●The time required for charging varies depending on conditions of battery usage. Charging takes longer at high or low temperatures and when the battery has not been used in some time. ●●Battery will be warm during charging and for some time thereafter. ●●Battery will run out if not used for long periods of time, even after being charged. ●●Do not leave any metal items (such as clips) near the contact areas of the power plug. Otherwise, a fire and/or electric shocks may be caused by short-circuiting or the resulting heat generated. ●●Frequently charging up battery is not recommended. (Frequently charging battery reduces maximum usage time and can cause battery to expand.) ●●If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan. Please purchase a new battery. ●●When charging: ••Wipe dirt from the battery terminal with a dry cloth. ••Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference). ●●Do not use a damaged or dented battery (especially connectors), e.g. by dropping (can cause faults). Charger ●●Depending on the environment while charging, the charging light may flicker due to static electricity or electromagnetic radiation, etc. This has no effect on charging. ●●Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference). ●●The charger may generate whirring sounds when it is being used. This is not a malfunction. ●●After use, be sure to disconnect the power supply device from the electrical outlet. (A very small amount of current is consumed if it is left connected.) ●●Keep the terminals of the charger and battery clean. When they get dirty, clean with a dry cloth. 328 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes Lens ●●Images may appear slightly white if lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.). Turn the camera on, hold the extracted lens barrel with your fingers, and gently wipe the lens surface with a soft, dry cloth. ●●Do not leave the lens exposed to direct sunlight. When using a tripod or unipod ●●Do not apply excessive force or tighten screws when they are crooked. (This may damage the camera, screw hole, or label.) ●●Ensure that the tripod is stable. (Refer to the tripod instructions.) ●●You may not be able to remove the card or the battery when using a tripod or unipod. Personal Information To protect personal information, we recommend that you set a Wi-Fi password. (→273) If names or birthdays are set in [Profile Setup] or in the [Face Recog.] function, keep in mind that the camera and recorded pictures will contain personal information. ●●Disclaimer ••Data containing personal information can be altered or lost due to malfunction, static electricity, accidents, breakdowns, repairs, or other operations. Panasonic will not be liable for any damage that occurs, direct or indirect, as a result of the alteration or loss of data containing personal information. ●●When ordering repairs or transferring/disposing of the camera ••After you make a note of the personal information, perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings]/ [Delete account] to delete data containing personal information such as wireless LAN connection settings that you registered or set in this unit. (→51, 262) ••To protect your personal information, please reset the settings. (→50) ••Remove the memory card from the camera. ••When ordering repairs, settings may be returned to the initial purchase state. ••If the above operations cannot be performed because of a camera malfunction, consult with the dealer or nearest Service Centre. ●●When transferring or disposing of your memory card, see “When disposing of/ transferring memory cards” in the previous section. (→327) ●●Uploading pictures to WEB services ••Pictures may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such as titles, recording dates and times, and location information. Before uploading the pictures to WEB services, check the pictures carefully for information that should not be disclosed. 329 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes ●●SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC. ●●HDMI, the HDMI Logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries. ●●HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation. ●●“AVCHD”, “AVCHD Progressive” and the “AVCHD Progressive” logo are trademarks of Panasonic Corporation and Sony Corporation. ●●Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. ●●Adobe is a trademark or registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries. ●●Pentium is a trademark of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries. ●●Windows and Windows Vista are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. ●●iMovie, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. ●●iPad, iPhone, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. ●●App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc. ●●Android and Google Play are trademarks or registered trademarks of Google Inc. ●●The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance®. ●●The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier mark is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance®. ●●“Wi-Fi®” and “Wi-Fi Direct®” are registered trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance®. ●●“Wi-Fi Protected Setup™”, “WPA™” and “WPA2™” are trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance®. ●●DLNA, the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks, service marks, or certification marks of the Digital Living Network Alliance. ●●QR Code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED. ●●This product uses “DynaFont” from DynaComware Corporation. DynaFont is a registered trademark of DynaComware Taiwan Inc. ●●Other names, company names, and product names mentioned in these instructions are trademarks or registered trademarks of the companies concerned. 330 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes This product is licensed under the AVC patent portfolio license for the personal and noncommercial use of a consumer to (i) encode video in compliance with the AVC Standard (“AVC Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC Video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal and non-commercial activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed to provide AVC Video. No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use. Additional information may be obtained from MPEG LA, LLC. See http://www.mpegla.com. 331 SQW0024 Others Usage cautions and notes This product incorporates the following software: (1) the software developed independently by or for Panasonic Corporation, (2) the software owned by third party and licenced to Panasonic Corporation, and/or (3) open source software The software categorised as (3) is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Please refer to the detailed terms and conditions thereof displayed by selecting [MENU/SET] → [Setup] → [Version Disp.] → [Software info]. Disposal of Old Equipment and Batteries Only for European Union and countries with recycling systems These symbols on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying documents mean that used electrical and electronic products and batteries must not be mixed with general household waste. For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products and used batteries, please take them to applicable collection points in accordance with your national legislation. By disposing of them correctly, you will help to save valuable resources and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the environment. For more information about collection and recycling, please contact your local municipality. Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste, in accordance with national legislation. Note for the battery symbol (bottom symbol): This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol. In this case it complies with the requirement set by the Directive for the chemical involved. 332 SQW0024
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138
  • Page 139 139
  • Page 140 140
  • Page 141 141
  • Page 142 142
  • Page 143 143
  • Page 144 144
  • Page 145 145
  • Page 146 146
  • Page 147 147
  • Page 148 148
  • Page 149 149
  • Page 150 150
  • Page 151 151
  • Page 152 152
  • Page 153 153
  • Page 154 154
  • Page 155 155
  • Page 156 156
  • Page 157 157
  • Page 158 158
  • Page 159 159
  • Page 160 160
  • Page 161 161
  • Page 162 162
  • Page 163 163
  • Page 164 164
  • Page 165 165
  • Page 166 166
  • Page 167 167
  • Page 168 168
  • Page 169 169
  • Page 170 170
  • Page 171 171
  • Page 172 172
  • Page 173 173
  • Page 174 174
  • Page 175 175
  • Page 176 176
  • Page 177 177
  • Page 178 178
  • Page 179 179
  • Page 180 180
  • Page 181 181
  • Page 182 182
  • Page 183 183
  • Page 184 184
  • Page 185 185
  • Page 186 186
  • Page 187 187
  • Page 188 188
  • Page 189 189
  • Page 190 190
  • Page 191 191
  • Page 192 192
  • Page 193 193
  • Page 194 194
  • Page 195 195
  • Page 196 196
  • Page 197 197
  • Page 198 198
  • Page 199 199
  • Page 200 200
  • Page 201 201
  • Page 202 202
  • Page 203 203
  • Page 204 204
  • Page 205 205
  • Page 206 206
  • Page 207 207
  • Page 208 208
  • Page 209 209
  • Page 210 210
  • Page 211 211
  • Page 212 212
  • Page 213 213
  • Page 214 214
  • Page 215 215
  • Page 216 216
  • Page 217 217
  • Page 218 218
  • Page 219 219
  • Page 220 220
  • Page 221 221
  • Page 222 222
  • Page 223 223
  • Page 224 224
  • Page 225 225
  • Page 226 226
  • Page 227 227
  • Page 228 228
  • Page 229 229
  • Page 230 230
  • Page 231 231
  • Page 232 232
  • Page 233 233
  • Page 234 234
  • Page 235 235
  • Page 236 236
  • Page 237 237
  • Page 238 238
  • Page 239 239
  • Page 240 240
  • Page 241 241
  • Page 242 242
  • Page 243 243
  • Page 244 244
  • Page 245 245
  • Page 246 246
  • Page 247 247
  • Page 248 248
  • Page 249 249
  • Page 250 250
  • Page 251 251
  • Page 252 252
  • Page 253 253
  • Page 254 254
  • Page 255 255
  • Page 256 256
  • Page 257 257
  • Page 258 258
  • Page 259 259
  • Page 260 260
  • Page 261 261
  • Page 262 262
  • Page 263 263
  • Page 264 264
  • Page 265 265
  • Page 266 266
  • Page 267 267
  • Page 268 268
  • Page 269 269
  • Page 270 270
  • Page 271 271
  • Page 272 272
  • Page 273 273
  • Page 274 274
  • Page 275 275
  • Page 276 276
  • Page 277 277
  • Page 278 278
  • Page 279 279
  • Page 280 280
  • Page 281 281
  • Page 282 282
  • Page 283 283
  • Page 284 284
  • Page 285 285
  • Page 286 286
  • Page 287 287
  • Page 288 288
  • Page 289 289
  • Page 290 290
  • Page 291 291
  • Page 292 292
  • Page 293 293
  • Page 294 294
  • Page 295 295
  • Page 296 296
  • Page 297 297
  • Page 298 298
  • Page 299 299
  • Page 300 300
  • Page 301 301
  • Page 302 302
  • Page 303 303
  • Page 304 304
  • Page 305 305
  • Page 306 306
  • Page 307 307
  • Page 308 308
  • Page 309 309
  • Page 310 310
  • Page 311 311
  • Page 312 312
  • Page 313 313
  • Page 314 314
  • Page 315 315
  • Page 316 316
  • Page 317 317
  • Page 318 318
  • Page 319 319
  • Page 320 320
  • Page 321 321
  • Page 322 322
  • Page 323 323
  • Page 324 324
  • Page 325 325
  • Page 326 326
  • Page 327 327
  • Page 328 328
  • Page 329 329
  • Page 330 330
  • Page 331 331
  • Page 332 332

Panasonic DMCLX100 de handleiding

Type
de handleiding
Deze handleiding is ook geschikt voor

in andere talen